The fourteenth of August [Editor's Note: 1834] was the day fixed upon for the
sailing of the brig Pilgrim, on her voyage from Boston, round Cape
Horn, to the Western coast of North America. As she was to get under
way early in the afternoon, I made my appearance on board at
twelve o'clock, in full sea-rig, with my chest, containing an outfit for a
two or three years' voyage, which I had undertaken from a determination to
cure, if possible, by an entire change of life, and by a long absence from
books, with a plenty of hard work, plain food, and open air, a weakness of
the eyes, which had obliged me to give up my studies, and which no medical
aid seemed likely to remedy.
The change from the tight frock-coat, silk cap, and kid gloves
of an undergraduate at Harvard, to the loose duck trousers, checked shirt,
and tarpaulin hat of a sailor, though somewhat of a transformation, was soon
made; and I supposed that I should pass very well for a Jack tar. But it is
impossible to deceive the practised eye in these matters; and while I thought
myself to be looking as salt as Neptune himself, I was, no doubt, known for
a landsman by every one on board as soon as I hove in sight. A sailor has
a peculiar cut to his clothes, and a way of wearing them which a green hand
can never get. The trousers, tight round the hips, and thence hanging long
and loose round the feet, a superabundance of checked shirt, a low-crowned,
well-varnished black hat, worn on the back of the head, with half a fathom
of black ribbon hanging over the left eye, and a slip-tie to the black
silk neckerchief, with sundry other minutiae, are signs, the want of which
betrays the beginner at once. Besides the points in my dress which were out
of the way, doubtless my complexion and hands were quite enough to
distinguish me from the regular salt who, with a sunburnt cheek, wide step,
and rolling gait, swings his bronzed and toughened hands athwart-ships, half
opened, as though just ready to grasp a rope.
``With all my imperfections on my head,'' I joined the crew,
and we hauled out into the stream, and came to anchor for the night. The
next day we were employed in preparation for sea, reeving studding-sail gear,
crossing royal yards, putting on chafing gear, and taking on board our
powder. On the following night, I stood my first watch. I remained awake
nearly all the first part of the night from fear that I might not hear when I
was called; and when I went on deck, so great were my ideas of the importance
of my trust, that I walked regularly fore and aft the whole length of the
vessel, looking out over the bows and taffrail at each turn, and was not a
little surprised at the coolness of the old seaman whom I called to take my
place, in stowing himself snugly away under the long-boat for a nap. That was
a sufficient lookout, he thought, for a fine night, at anchor in a safe
harbor.
The next morning was Saturday, and, a breeze having sprung up
from the southward, we took a pilot on board, hove up our anchor,
and began beating down the bay. I took leave of those of my friends who
came to see me off, and had barely opportunity for a last look at the city
and well-known objects, as no time is allowed on board ship for sentiment. As
we drew down into the lower harbor, we found the wind ahead in the bay, and
were obliged to come to anchor in the roads. We remained there through the
day and a part of the night. My watch began at eleven o'clock at night, and
I received orders to call the captain if the wind came out from
the westward. About midnight the wind became fair, and, having summoned
the captain, I was ordered to call all hands. How I accomplished this, I do
not know, but I am quite sure that I did not give the true hoarse boatswain
call of ``A-a-ll ha-a-a-nds ! up anchor, a-ho-oy!'' In a short time every one
was in motion, the sails loosed, the yards braced, and we began to heave up
the anchor, which was our last hold upon Yankee land. I could take
but small part in these preparations. My little knowledge of a vessel was
all at fault. Unintelligible orders were so rapidly given, and so immediately
executed; there was such a hurrying about, and such an intermingling of
strange cries and stranger actions, that I was completely bewildered. There
is not so helpless and pitiable an object in the world as a landsman
beginning a sailor's life. At length those peculiar, long-drawn sounds which
denote that the crew are heaving at the windlass began, and in a few minutes
we were under way. The noise of the water thrown from the bows was heard,
the vessel leaned over from the damp night-breeze, and rolled with the heavy
groundswell, and we had actually begun our long, long journey. This was
literally bidding good night to my native land.
CHAPTER II
The first day we passed at sea was Sunday. As we were just
from port, and there was a great deal to be done on board, we were kept at
work all day, and at night the watches were set, and everything was put into
sea order. When we were called aft to be divided into watches, I had a good
specimen of the manner of a sea-captain. After the division had been made, he
gave a short characteristic speech, walking the quarter-deck with a cigar in
his mouth, and dropping the words out between the puffs.
``Now, my men, we have begun a long voyage. If we get along
well together, we shall have a comfortable time; if we don't, we
shall have hell afloat. All you have got to do is to obey your orders, and
do your duty like men,—then you will fare well enough; if you don't, you
will fare hard enough,—I can tell you. If we pull together, you will find
me a clever fellow; if we don't, you will find me a bloody rescal. That's all
I've got to say. Go below, the larboard watch!''
I, being in the starboard or second mate's watch, had
the opportunity of keeping the first watch at sea. Stimson, a young man
making, like myself, his first voyage, was in the same watch, and as he was
the son of a professional man, and had been in a merchant's counting-room in
Boston, we found that we had some acquaintances and topics in common. We
talked these matters over— Boston, what our friends were probably doing, our
voyage, &c.— until he went to take his turn at the lookout, and left me
to myself. I had now a good opportunity for reflection. I felt for the
first time the perfect silence of the sea. The officer was walking the
quarter-deck, where I had no right to go, one or two men were talking on the
forecastle, whom I had little inclination to join, so that I was left open to
the full impression of everything about me. However much I was affected by
the beauty of the sea, the bright stars, and the clouds driven swiftly
over them, I could not but remember that I was separating myself from all
the social and intellectual enjoyments of life. Yet, strange as it may seem,
I did then and afterwards take pleasure in these reflections, hoping by them
to prevent my becoming insensible to the value of what I was
losing.
But all my dreams were soon put to flight by an order from
the officer to trim the yards, as the wind was getting ahead; and I could
plainly see by the looks the sailors occasionally cast to windward, and by
the dark clouds that were fast coming up, that we had bad weather to prepare
for, and I had heard the captain say that he expected to be in the Gulf
Stream by twelve o'clock. In a few minutes eight bells were struck, the watch
called, and we went below. I now began to feel the first discomforts of a
sailor's life. The steerage, in which I lived, was filled with coils
of rigging, spare sails, old junk, and ship stores, which had not been
stowed away. Moreover, there had been no berths put up for us to sleep in,
and we were not allowed to drive nails to hang our clothes upon. The sea,
too, had risen, the vessel was rolling heavily, and everything was pitched
about in grand confusion. There was a complete ``hurrah's nest,'' as the
sailors say, ``everything on top and nothing at hand.'' A large hawser had
been coiled away on my chest; my hats, boots, mattress, and blankets had
all fetched away and gone over to leeward, and were jammed and broken under
the boxes and coils of rigging. To crown all, we were allowed no light to
find anything with, and I was just beginning to feel strong symptoms of
sea-sickness, and that listlessness and inactivity which accompany it. Giving
up all attempts to collect my things together, I lay down on the sails,
expecting every moment to hear the cry, ``All hands ahoy!'' which the
approaching storm would make necessary. I shortly heard the raindrops
falling on deck thick and fast, and the watch evidently had their
hands full of work, for I could hear the loud and repeated orders of
the mate, trampling of feet, creaking of the blocks, and all
the accompaniments of a coming storm. In a few minutes the slide of the
hatch was thrown back, which let down the noise and tumult of the deck still
louder, the cry of ``All hands ahoy! tumble up here and take in sail,''
saluted our ears, and the hatch was quickly shut again. When I got upon deck,
a new scene and a new experience was before me.
The little brig was close-hauled upon the wind, and lying
over, as it then seemed to me, nearly upon her beam ends. The heavy
head sea was beating against her bows with the noise and force almost of a
sledgehammer, and flying over the deck, drenching us completely through. The
topsail halyards had been let go, and the great sails were filling out and
backing against the masts with a noise like thunder; the wind was whistling
through the rigging; loose ropes were flying about; loud and, to me,
unintelligible orders constantly given, and rapidly executed; and the
sailors ``singing out'' at the ropes in their hoarse and peculiar
strains.
In addition to all this, I had not got my ``sea legs on,''
was dreadfully sea-sick, with hardly strength enough to hold on
to anything, and it was ``pitch dark.'' This was my condition when I was
ordered aloft, for the first time, to reef topsails.
How I got along, I cannot now remember. I ``laid out'' on
the yards and held on with all my strength. I could not have been of much
service, for I remember having been sick several times before I left the
topsail yard, making wild vomits into the black night, to leeward. Soon all
was snug aloft, and we were again allowed to go below. This I did not
consider much of a favor, for the confusion of everything below, and that
inexpressible sickening smell, caused by the shaking up of bilge water in the
hold, made the steerage but an indifferent refuge from the cold, wet decks.
I had often read of the nautical experiences of others, but I felt as
though there could be none worse than mine; for, in addition to every other
evil, I could not but remember that this was only the first night of a two
years' voyage. When we were on deck, we were not much better off, for we were
continually ordered about by the officer, who said that it was good for us to
be in motion. Yet anything was better than the horrible state of things
below. I remember very well going to the hatchway and putting my head
down, when I was oppressed by nausea, and always being
relieved immediately. It was an effectual emetic.
This state of things continued for two days.
Wednesday, August 20th. We had the watch on deck from four
till eight, this morning. When we came on deck at four o'clock, we found
things much changed for the better. The sea and wind had gone down, and the
stars were out bright. I experienced a corresponding change in my feelings,
yet continued extremely weak from my sickness. I stood in the waist on the
weather side, watching the gradual breaking of the day, and the first streaks
of the early light. Much has been said of the sunrise at sea; but it will
not compare with the sunrise on shore. It lacks the accompaniments of the
songs of birds, the awakening hum of humanity, and the glancing of the first
beams upon trees, hills, spires, and house-tops, to give it life and spirit.
There is no scenery. But, although the actual rise of the sun at sea is not
so beautiful, yet nothing will compare for melancholy and dreariness with
the early breaking of day upon ``Old Ocean's gray and melancholy
waste.''
There is something in the first gray streaks stretching along
the eastern horizon and throwing an indistinct light upon the face of the
deep, which combines with the boundlessness and unknown depth of the sea
around, and gives one a feeling of loneliness, of dread, and of melancholy
foreboding, which nothing else in nature can. This gradually passes away as
the light grows brighter, and when the sun comes up, the ordinary monotonous
sea day begins.
From such reflections as these, I was aroused by the order
from the officer, ``Forward there! rig the headpump!'' I found that
no time was allowed for daydreaming, but that we must ``turn to'' at the
first light. Having called up the ``idlers,'' namely, carpenter, cook, and
steward, and rigged the pump, we began washing down the decks. This
operation, which is performed every morning at sea, takes nearly two hours;
and I had hardly strength enough to get through it. After we had finished,
swabbed down decks, and coiled up the rigging, I sat on the spars, waiting
for seven bells, which was the signal for breakfast. The officer, seeing
my lazy posture, ordered me to slush the mainmast, from the royal-mast-head
down. The vessel was then rolling a little, and I had taken no food for three
days, so that I felt tempted to tell him that I had rather wait till after
breakfast; but I knew that I must ``take the bull by the horns,'' and that if
I showed any sign of want of spirit or backwardness, I should be ruined at
once. So I took my bucket of grease and climbed up to the
royal-mast-head. Here the rocking of the vessel, which increases the higher
you go from the foot of the mast, which is the fulcrum of the lever,
and the smell of the grease, which offended my fastidious senses, upset my
stomach again, and I was not a little rejoiced when I had finished my job and
got upon the comparative terra firma of the deck. In a few minutes seven
bells were struck, the log hove, the watch called, and we went to breakfast.
Here I cannot but remember the advice of the cook, a simple-hearted African.
``Now,'' says he, ``my lad, you are well cleaned out; you haven't got a drop
of your 'long-shore swash aboard of you. You must begin on a new tack,—
pitch all your sweetmeats overboard, and turn to upon good hearty salt beef
and ship bread, and I'll promise you, you'll have your ribs well sheathed,
and be as hearty as any of 'em, afore you are up to the Horn.'' This would be
good advice to give to passengers, when they set their hearts on the little
niceties which they have laid in, in case of sea-sickness.
I cannot describe the change which half a pound of cold salt
beef and a biscuit or two produced in me. I was a new being. Having
a watch below until noon, so that I had some time to myself, I got a huge
piece of strong, cold salt beef from the cook, and kept gnawing upon it until
twelve o'clock. When we went on deck, I felt somewhat like a man, and could
begin to learn my sea duty with considerable spirit. At about two o'clock, we
heard the loud cry of ``Sail ho!'' from aloft, and soon saw two sails to
windward, going directly athwart our hawse. This was the first time that
I had seen a sail at sea. I thought then, and have always since, that no
sight exceeds it in interest, and few in beauty. They passed to leeward of
us, and out of hailing distance; but the captain could read the names on
their sterns with the glass. They were the ship Helen Mar, of New York, and
the brig Mermaid, of Boston. They were both steering westward, and were bound
in for our ``dear native land.''
Thursday, August 21st. This day the sun rose clear; we had a
fine wind, and everything was bright and cheerful. I had now got my
sea legs on, and was beginning to enter upon the regular duties of a sea
life. About six bells, that is, three o'clock P.M., we saw a sail on our
larboard bow. I was very desirous, like every new sailor, to speak her. She
came down to us, backed her main-top-sail, and the two vessels stood ``head
on,'' bowing and curveting at each other like a couple of war-horses reined
in by their riders. It was the first vessel that I had seen near, and I was
surprised to find how much she rolled and pitched in so quiet a sea. She
plunged her head into the sea, and then, her stern settling gradually down,
her huge bows rose up, showing the bright copper, and her stem and
breasthooks dripping, like old Neptune's locks, with the brine. Her decks
were filled with passengers, who had come up at the cry of ``Sail ho!''
and who, by their dress and features, appeared to be Swiss and
French emigrants. She hailed us at first in French, but receiving no
answer, she tried us in English. She was the ship La Carolina, from
Havre, for New York. We desired her to report the brig Pilgrim, from
Boston, for the northwest coast of America, five days out. She then
filled away and left us to plough on through our waste of
waters.
There is a settled routine for hailing ships at sea:
``Ship a-hoy!'' Answer, ``Hulloa!'' ``What ship is that, pray?''
``The ship Carolina, from Havre, bound to New York. Where are you from?''
``The brig Pilgrim, from Boston, bound to the coast of California, five days
out.'' Unless there is leisure, or something special to say, this form is not
much varied from.
This day ended pleasantly; we had got into regular and
comfortable weather, and into that routine of sea life which is only broken
by a storm, a sail, or the sight of land.
CHAPTER III
As we have now had a long ``spell'' of fine weather, without
any incident to break the monotony of our lives, I may have no
better place for a description of the duties, regulations, and customs
of an American merchantman, of which ours was a fair specimen.
The captain, in the first place, is lord paramount. He stands
no watch, comes and goes when he pleases, is accountable to no one, and
must be obeyed in everything, without a question even from his chief officer.
He has the power to turn his officers off duty, and even to break them and
make them do duty as sailors in the forecastle.[1] Where there are no
passengers and no supercargo, as in our vessel, he has no companion but his
own dignity, and few pleasures, unless he differs from most of his kind,
beyond the consciousness of possessing supreme power, and, occasionally,
the exercise of it.
The prime minister, the official organ, and the active
and superintending officer is the chief mate. He is first
lieutenant, boatswain, sailing-master, and quartermaster. The captain
tells him what he wishes to have done, and leaves to him the care
of overseeing, of allotting the work, and also the responsibility of its
being well done. The mate (as he is always called, par excellence) also keeps
the log-book, for which he is responsible to the owners and insurers, and has
the charge of the stowage, safe-keeping, and delivery of the cargo. He is
also, ex officio, the wit of the crew; for the captain does not condescend to
joke with the men, and the second mate no one cares for; so that
when ``the mate'' thinks fit to entertain ``the people'' with a
coarse joke or a little practical wit, every one feels bound to
laugh.
The second mate is proverbially a dog's berth. He is
neither officer nor man. He is obliged to go aloft to reef and furl
the topsails, and to put his hands into the tar and slush, with the rest,
and the men do not much respect him as an officer. The crew call him the
``sailor's waiter,'' as he has to furnish them with spun-yarn, marline, and
all other stuffs that they need in their work, and has charge of the
boatswain's locker, which includes serving-boards, marline-spikes, &c.,
&c. He is expected by the captain to maintain his dignity and to enforce
obedience, and still is kept at a great distance from the mate, and obliged
to work with the crew. He is one to whom little is given and of whom much
is required. His wages are usually double those of a common sailor, and he
eats and sleeps in the cabin; but he is obliged to be on deck nearly all his
time, and eats at the second table, that is, makes a meal out of what the
captain and chief mate leave.
The steward is the captain's servant, and has charge of
the pantry, from which every one, even the mate himself, is
excluded. These distinctions usually find him an enemy in the mate, who
does not like to have any one on board who is not entirely under
his control; the crew do not consider him as one of their number, so he is
left to the mercy of the captain.
The cook, whose title is ``Doctor,'' is the patron of the
crew, and those who are in his favor can get their wet mittens
and stockings dried, or light their pipes at the galley in
the night-watch. These two worthies, together with the carpenter
(and sailmaker, if there be one), stand no watch, but, being employed all
day, are allowed to ``sleep in'' at night, unless all hands are
called.
The crew are divided into two divisions, as equally as may
be, called the watches. Of these, the chief mate commands the larboard,
and the second mate the starboard. They divide the time between them, being
on and off duty, or, as it is called, on deck and below, every other four
hours. The three night-watches are called the first, the middle, and the
morning watch. If, for instance, the chief mate with the larboard watch have
the first night-watch from eight to twelve, at that hour the starboard
watch and the second mate take the deck, while the larboard watch and the
first mate go below until four in the morning, when they come on deck again
and remain until eight. As the larboard watch will have been on deck eight
hours out of the twelve, while the starboard watch will have been up only
four hours, the former have what is called a ``forenoon watch below,'' that
is, from eight A.M. till twelve M. In a man-of-war, and in some merchantmen,
this alternation of watches is kept up throughout the twenty-four hours,
which is called having ``watch and watch''; but our ship, like most
merchantmen, had ``all hands'' from twelve o'clock till dark, except in very
bad weather, when we were allowed ``watch and watch.''
An explanation of the ``dog-watches'' may, perhaps, be
necessary to one who has never been at sea. Their purpose is to shift
the watches each night, so that the same watch shall not be on deck at the
same hours throughout a voyage. In order to effect this, the watch from four
to eight P.M. is divided into two half-watches, one from four to six, and the
other from six to eight. By this means they divide the twenty-four hours into
seven watches instead of six, and thus shift the hours every night. As the
dog-watches come during twilight, after the day's work is done, and before
the night-watch is set, they are the watches in which everybody is
on deck. The captain is up, walking on the weather side of
the quarter-deck, the chief mate on the lee side, and the second
mate about the weather gangway. The steward has finished his work in the
cabin, and has come up to smoke his pipe with the cook in the galley. The
crew are sitting on the windlass or lying on the forecastle, smoking,
singing, or telling long yarns. At eight o'clock eight bells are struck, the
log is hove, the watch set, the wheel relieved, the galley shut up, and the
watch off duty goes below.
The morning begins with the watch on deck's ``turning to''
at daybreak and washing down, scrubbing, and swabbing the decks. This,
together with filling the ``scuttled butt'' with fresh water, and coiling up
the rigging, usually occupies the time until seven bells (half after seven),
when all hands get breakfast. At eight the day's work begins, and lasts until
sundown, with the exception of an hour for dinner.
Before I end my explanations, it may be well to define a
day's work, and to correct a mistake prevalent among landsmen about
a sailor's life. Nothing is more common than to hear people say, ``Are not
sailors very idle at sea? What can they find to do?'' This is a natural
mistake, and, being frequently made, is one which every sailor feels
interested in having corrected. In the first place, then, the discipline of
the ship requires every man to be at work upon something when he is on deck,
except at night and on Sundays. At all other times you will never see a man,
on board a well-ordered vessel, standing idle on deck, sitting down, or
leaning over the side. It is the officers' duty to keep every one at work,
even if there is nothing to be done but to scrape the rust from the chain
cables. In no state prison are the convicts more regularly set to work, and
more closely watched. No conversation is allowed among the crew at their
duty, and though they frequently do talk when aloft, or when near one
another, yet they stop when an officer is nigh.
With regard to the work upon which the men are put, it is a
matter which probably would not be understood by one who has not been
at sea. When I first left port, and found that we were kept
regularly employed for a week or two, I supposed that we were getting
the vessel into sea trim, and that it would soon be over, and we should
have nothing to do but to sail the ship; but I found that it continued so for
two years, and at the end of the two years there was as much to be done as
ever. As has often been said, a ship is like a lady's watch, always out of
repair. When first leaving port, studding-sail gear is to be rove, all the
running rigging to be examined, that which is unfit for use to be
got down, and new rigging rove in its place; then the standing rigging is
to be overhauled, replaced, and repaired in a thousand different ways; and
wherever any of the numberless ropes or the yards are chafing or wearing upon
it, there ``chafing gear,'' as it is called, must be put on. This chafing
gear consists of worming, parcelling, roundings, battens, and service of all
kinds,— rope-yarns, spun-yarn, marline, and seizing-stuffs. Taking
off, putting on, and mending the chafing gear alone, upon a vessel, would
find constant employment for a man or two men, during working hours, for a
whole voyage.
The next point to be considered is, that all the ``small
stuffs'' which are used on board a ship—such as spun-yarn,
marline, seizing-stuff, &c., &c.—are made on board. The owners of
a vessel buy up incredible quantities of ``old junk,'' which the sailors
unlay, and, after drawing out the yarns, knot them together, and roll them up
in balls. These ``rope-yarns'' are constantly used for various purposes, but
the greater part is manufactured into spun-yarn. For this purpose, every
vessel is furnished with a ``spun-yarn winch''; which is very
simple, consisting of a wheel and spindle. This may be heard
constantly going on deck in pleasant weather; and we had employment, during
a great part of the time, for three hands, in drawing and knotting yarns,
and making spun-yarn.
Another method of employing the crew is ``setting-up''
rigging. Whenever any of the standing rigging becomes slack (which
is continually happening), the seizings and coverings must be taken off,
tackles got up, and, after the rigging is bowsed well taut, the seizings and
coverings be replaced, which is a very nice piece of work. There is also such
a connection between different parts of a vessel, that one rope can seldom be
touched without requiring a change in another. You cannot stay a mast aft by
the back stays, without slacking up the head stays, &c., &c. If we
add to this all the tarring, greasing, oiling, varnishing, painting,
scraping, and scrubbing which is required in the course of a long voyage,
and also remember this is all to be done in addition to watching at night,
steering, reefing, furling, bracing, making and setting sail, and pulling,
hauling, and climbing in every direction, one will hardly ask, ``What can a
sailor find to do at sea?''
If, after all this labor,—after exposing their lives and
limbs in storms, wet and cold,--
``Wherein the cub-drawn bear would
couch The lion and the belly-pinched
wolf Keep their furs dry,''--
the merchants and captains think that the sailors have not
earned their twelve dollars a month (out of which they clothe themselves),
and their salt beef and hard bread, they keep them picking oakum—ad
infinitum. This is the usual resource upon a rainy day, for then it will not
do to work upon rigging; and when it is pouring down in floods, instead of
letting the sailors stand about in sheltered places, and talk, and keep
themselves comfortable, they are separated to different parts of the ship
and kept at work picking oakum. I have seen oakum stuff placed about in
different parts of the ship, so that the sailors might not be idle in the
snatches between the frequent squalls upon crossing the equator. Some
officers have been so driven to find work for the crew in a ship ready for
sea, that they have set them to pounding the anchors (often done) and
scraping the chain cables. The ``Philadelphia Catechism'' is
``Six days shalt thou labor and do all thou art
able, And on the seventh,-- holystone the decks and scrape
the cable.''
This kind of work, of course, is not kept up off Cape Horn,
Cape of Good Hope, and in extreme north and south latitudes; but I
have seen the decks washed down and scrubbed when the water would
have frozen if it had been fresh, and all hands kept at work upon
the rigging, when we had on our pea-jackets, and our hands so numb that we
could hardly hold our marline-spikes.
I have here gone out of my narrative course in order that any
who read this may, at the start, form as correct an idea of a
sailor's life and duty as possible. I have done it in this place
because, for some time, our life was nothing but the unvarying
repetition of these duties, which can be better described together.
Before leaving this description, however, I would state, in order to
show landsmen how little they know of the nature of a ship, that
a ship-carpenter is kept constantly employed, during good weather, on
board vessels which are in what is called perfect sea order.
CHAPTER IV
After speaking the Carolina, on the 21st of August,
nothing occurred to break the monotony of our life until--
Friday, September 5th, when we saw a sail on our
weather (starboard) beam. She proved to be a brig under English
colors, and, passing under our stern, reported herself as forty-nine
days from Buenos Ayres, bound to Liverpool. Before she had passed
us, ``Sail ho!'' was cried again, and we made another sail, broad on our
weather bow, and steering athwart our hawse. She passed out of hail, but we
made her out to be an hermaphrodite brig, with Brazilian colors in her main
rigging. By her course, she must have been bound from Brazil to the south of
Europe, probably Portugal.
Sunday, September 7th. Fell in with the northeast
trade-winds. This morning we caught our first dolphin, which I was very
eager to see. I was disappointed in the colors of this fish when
dying. They were certainly very beautiful, but not equal to what has
been said of them. They are too indistinct. To do the fish justice, there
is nothing more beautiful than the dolphin when swimming a few feet below the
surface, on a bright day. It is the most elegantly formed, and also the
quickest, fish in salt water; and the rays of the sun striking upon it, in
its rapid and changing motions, reflected from the water, make it look like a
stray beam from a rainbow.
This day was spent like all pleasant Sundays at sea. The decks
are washed down, the rigging coiled up, and everything put in order; and,
throughout the day, only one watch is kept on deck at a time. The men are all
dressed in their best white duck trousers, and red or checked shirts, and
have nothing to do but to make the necessary changes in the sails. They
employ themselves in reading, talking, smoking, and mending their clothes. If
the weather is pleasant, they bring their work and their books upon deck, and
sit down upon the forecastle and windlass. This is the only day on which
these privileges are allowed them. When Monday comes, they put on their tarry
trousers again, and prepare for six days of labor.
To enhance the value of Sunday to the crew, they are allowed
on that day a pudding, or, as it is called, a ``duff.'' This is nothing
more than flour boiled with water, and eaten with molasses. It is very heavy,
dark, and clammy, yet it is looked upon as a luxury, and really forms an
agreeable variety with salt beef and pork. Many a rascally captain has made
up with his crew, for hard usage, by allowing them duff twice a week on the
passage home.
On board some vessels Sunday is made a day of instruction and
of religious exercises; but we had a crew of swearers, from the captain to
the smallest boy; and a day of rest, and of something like quiet, social
enjoyment, was all that we could expect.
We continued running large before the northeast trade-winds
for several days, until Monday--
September 22d, when, upon coming on deck at seven bells in
the morning, we found the other watch aloft throwing water upon the sails;
and, looking astern, we saw a small clipper-built brig with a black hull
heading directly after us. We went to work immediately, and put all the
canvas upon the brig which we could get upon her, rigging out oars for extra
studding-sail yards, and continued wetting down the sails by buckets of water
whipped up to the mast-head, until about nine o'clock, when there came on
a drizzling rain. The vessel continued in pursuit, changing her course as we
changed ours, to keep before the wind. The captain, who watched her with his
glass, said that she was armed, and full of men, and showed no colors. We
continued running dead before the wind, knowing that we sailed better so, and
that clippers are fastest on the wind. We had also another advantage. The
wind was light, and we spread more canvas than she did, having royals and
sky-sails fore and aft, and ten studding-sails; while she, being an
hermaphrodite brig, had only a gaff topsail aft. Early in the morning she was
overhauling us a little, but after the rain came on and the wind grew
lighter, we began to leave her astern. All hands remained on deck throughout
the day, and we got our fire-arms in order; but we were too few to
have done anything with her, if she had proved to be what we
feared. Fortunately there was no moon, and the night which followed
was exceedingly dark, so that, by putting out all the lights on board and
altering our course four points, we hoped to get out of her reach. We removed
the light in the binnacle, and steered by the stars, and kept perfect silence
through the night. At daybreak there was no sign of anything in the horizon,
and we kept the vessel off to her course.
Wednesday, October 1st. Crossed the equator in lon. 24° 24'
W. I now, for the first time, felt at liberty, according to the old usage,
to call myself a son of Neptune, and was very glad to be able to claim the
title without the disagreeable initiation which so many have to go through.
After once crossing the line, you can never be subjected to the process, but
are considered as a son of Neptune, with full powers to play tricks upon
others. This ancient custom is now seldom allowed, unless there are
passengers on board, in which case there is always a good deal of
sport.
It had been obvious to all hands for some time that the
second mate, whose name was Foster, was an idle, careless fellow, and
not much of a sailor, and that the captain was exceedingly dissatisfied
with him. The power of the captain in these cases was well known, and we all
anticipated a difficulty. Foster (called Mr. by virtue of his office) was but
half a sailor, having always been short voyages, and remained at home a long
time between them. His father was a man of some property, and intended to
have given his son a liberal education; but he, being idle and worthless,
was sent off to sea, and succeeded no better there; for, unlike
many scamps, he had none of the qualities of a sailor,—he was ``not of
the stuff that they make sailors of.'' He used to hold long yarns with the
crew, and talk against the captain, and play with the boys, and relax
discipline in every way. This kind of conduct always makes the captain
suspicious, and is never pleasant, in the end, to the men; they preferring to
have an officer active, vigilant, and distant as may be with kindness. Among
other bad practices, he frequently slept on his watch, and, having
been discovered asleep by the captain, he was told that he would be turned
off duty if he did it again. To prevent his sleeping on deck, the hen-coops
were ordered to be knocked up, for the captain never sat down on deck
himself, and never permitted an officer to do so.
The second night after crossing the equator, we had the watch
from eight till twelve, and it was ``my helm'' for the last two
hours. There had been light squalls through the night, and the
captain told Mr. Foster, who commanded our watch, to keep a
bright lookout. Soon after I came to the helm, I found that he was
quite drowsy, and at last he stretched himself on the companion and
went fast asleep. Soon afterwards the captain came softly on deck,
and stood by me for some time looking at the compass. The officer
at length became aware of the captain's presence, but, pretending not to
know it, began humming and whistling to himself, to show that he was not
asleep, and went forward, without looking behind him, and ordered the main
royal to be loosed. On turning round to come aft, he pretended surprise at
seeing the master on deck. This would not do. The captain was too ``wide
awake'' for him, and, beginning upon him at once, gave him a grand blow-up,
in true nautical style: ``You're a lazy, good-for-nothing rascal;
you're neither man, boy, soger, nor sailor! you're no more than a
thing aboard a vessel! you don't earn your salt! you're worse than a Mahon
soger!'' and other still more choice extracts from the sailor's vocabulary.
After the poor fellow had taken this harangue, he was sent into his
state-room, and the captain stood the rest of the watch himself.
At seven bells in the morning, all hands were called aft, and
told that Foster was no longer an officer on board, and that we
might choose one of our own number for second mate. It is not uncommon for
the captain to make this offer, and it is good policy, for the crew think
themselves the choosers, and are flattered by it, but have to obey,
nevertheless. Our crew, as is usual, refused to take the responsibility of
choosing a man of whom we would never be able to complain, and left it to the
captain. He picked out an active and intelligent young sailor, born on the
banks of the Kennebec, who had been several Canton voyages, and proclaimed
him in the following manner: ``I choose Jim Hall; he's your second mate.
All you've got to do is, to obey him as you would me; and remember that he is
Mr. Hall.'' Foster went forward into the forecastle as a common sailor, and
lost the handle to his name, while young fore-mast Jim became Mr. Hall, and
took up his quarters in the land of knives and forks and
tea-cups.
Sunday, October 5th. It was our morning watch; when, soon
after the day began to break, a man on the forecastle called out,
``Land ho!'' I had never heard the cry before, and did not know what
it meant (and few would suspect what the words were, when hearing
the strange sound for the first time); but I soon found, by the direction
of all eyes, that there was land stretching along on our weather beam. We
immediately took in studding-sails and hauled our wind, running in for the
land. This was done to determine our longitude; for by the captain's
chronometer we were in 25° W., but by his observations we were much farther;
and he had been for some time in doubt whether it was his chronometer or his
sextant which was out of order. This land-fall settled the matter, and
the former instrument was condemned, and, becoming still worse, was never
afterwards used.
As we ran in towards the coast, we found that we were directly
off the port of Pernambuco, and could see with the telescope the roofs of
the houses, and one large church, and the town of Olinda. We ran along by the
mouth of the harbor, and saw a full-rigged brig going in. At two P.M. we
again stood out to sea, leaving the land on our quarter, and at sundown it
was out of sight. It was here that I first saw one of those singular things
called catamarans. They are composed of logs lashed together upon the water,
the men sitting with their feet in the water; have one large sail,
are quite fast, and, strange as it may seem, are trusted as good
sea boats. We saw several, with from one to three men in each,
boldly putting out to sea, after it had become almost dark. The Indians go
out in them after fish, and as the weather is regular in certain seasons,
they have no fear. After taking a new departure from Olinda, we kept off on
our way to Cape Horn.
We met with nothing remarkable until we were in the latitude
of the river La Plata. Here there are violent gales from the southwest,
called Pamperos, which are very destructive to the shipping in the river, and
are felt for many leagues at sea. They are usually preceded by lightning. The
captain told the mates to keep a bright lookout, and if they saw lightning at
the southwest, to take in sail at once. We got the first touch of one during
my watch on deck. I was walking in the lee gangway, and thought that I saw
lightning on the lee bow. I told the second mate, who came over and looked
out for some time. It was very black in the southwest, and in about ten
minutes we saw a distinct flash. The wind, which had been southeast, had now
left us, and it was dead calm. We sprang aloft immediately and furled the
royals and top-gallant-sails, and took in the flying jib, hauled up
the mainsail and trysail, squared the after yards, and awaited the attack.
A huge mist capped with black clouds came driving towards us, extending over
that portion of the horizon, and covering the stars, which shone brightly in
the other part of the heavens. It came upon us at once with a blast, and a
shower of hail and rain, which almost took our breath from us. The hardiest
was obliged to turn his back. We let the halyards run, and fortunately were
not taken aback. The little vessel ``paid off'' from the wind, and ran on
for some time directly before it, tearing through the water with everything
flying. Having called all hands, we close-reefed the topsails and trysail,
furled the courses and jib, set the fore-topmast staysail, and brought her up
nearly to her course, with the weather braces hauled in a little, to ease
her.
This was the first blow I had met, which could really be
called a gale. We had reefed our topsails in the Gulf Stream, and I
thought it something serious, but an older sailor would have
thought nothing of it. As I had now become used to the vessel and to
my duty, I was of some service on a yard, and could knot my reef-point as
well as anybody. I obeyed the order to lay aloft with the rest, and found
the reefing a very exciting scene; for one watch reefed the fore-topsail, and
the other the main, and every one did his utmost to get his topsail hoisted
first. We had a great advantage over the larboard watch, because the chief
mate never goes aloft, while our new second mate used to jump into
the rigging as soon as we began to haul out the reef-tackle, and have the
weather earing passed before there was a man upon the yard. In this way we
were almost always able to raise the cry of ``Haul out to leeward'' before
them; and, having knotted our points, would slide down the shrouds and
back-stays, and sing out at the topsail halyards, to let it be known that we
were ahead of them. Reefing is the most exciting part of a sailor's duty. All
hands are engaged upon it, and after the halyards are let go, there is
no time to be lost,—no ``sogering,'' or hanging back, then. If one is
not quick enough, another runs over him. The first on the yard goes to the
weather earing, the second to the lee, and the next two to the ``dog's
ears''; while the others lay along into the bunt, just giving each other
elbow-room. In reefing, the yard-arms (the extremes of the yards) are the
posts of honor; but in furling, the strongest and most experienced stand in
the slings (or middle of the yard) to make up the bunt. If the second mate
is a smart fellow, he will never let any one take either of these posts
from him; but if he is wanting either in seamanship, strength, or activity,
some better man will get the bunt and earings from him, which immediately
brings him into disrepute.
We remained for the rest of the night, and throughout the
next day, under the same close sail, for it continued to blow very fresh;
and though we had no more hail, yet there was a soaking rain, and it was
quite cold and uncomfortable; the more so, because we were not prepared for
cold weather, but had on our thin clothes. We were glad to get a watch below,
and put on our thick clothing, boots, and southwesters. Towards sundown the
gale moderated a little, and it began to clear off in the southwest.
We shook our reefs out, one by one, and before midnight had top-gallant
sails upon her.
We had now made up our minds for Cape Horn and cold weather,
and entered upon the necessary preparations.
Tuesday, November 4th. At daybreak, saw land upon our
larboard quarter. There were two islands, of different size, but of
the same shape; rather high, beginning low at the water's edge,
and running with a curved ascent to the middle. They were so far off as to
be of a deep blue color, and in a few hours we sank them in the northeast.
These were the Falkland Islands. We had run between them and the main land of
Patagonia. At sunset, the second mate, who was at the mast-head, said that he
saw land on the starboard bow. This must have been the island of Staten Land;
and we were now in the region of Cape Horn, with a fine breeze from
the northward, topmast and top-gallant studding-sails set, and
every prospect of a speedy and pleasant passage round.
CHAPTER V
Wednesday, November 5th. The weather was fine during the
previous night, and we had a clear view of the Magellan Clouds and of
the Southern Cross. The Magellan Clouds consist of three small nebulae in
the southern part of the heavens,—two bright, like the milky-way, and one
dark. They are first seen, just above the horizon, soon after crossing the
southern tropic. The Southern Cross begins to be seen at 18° N., and, when
off Cape Horn, is nearly overhead. It is composed of four stars in that form,
and is one of the brightest constellations in the heavens.
During the first part of this day (Wednesday) the wind was
light, but after noon it came on fresh, and we furled the royals. We still
kept the studding-sails out, and the captain said he should go round with
them if he could. Just before eight o'clock (then about sundown, in that
latitude) the cry of ``All hands ahoy!'' was sounded down the fore scuttle
and the after hatchway, and, hurrying upon deck, we found a large black cloud
rolling on toward us from the southwest, and darkening the whole heavens.
``Here comes Cape Horn!'' said the chief mate; and we had hardly time
to haul down and clew up before it was upon us. In a few minutes a heavier
sea was raised than I had ever seen, and as it was directly ahead, the little
brig, which was no better than a bathing-machine, plunged into it, and all
the forward part of her was under water; the sea pouring in through the
bow-ports and hawse-holes and over the knight-heads, threatening to
wash everything overboard. In the lee scuppers it was up to a man's waist.
We sprang aloft and double-reefed the topsails, and furled the other sails,
and made all snug. But this would not do; the brig was laboring and straining
against the head sea, and the gale was growing worse and worse. At the same
time sleet and hail were driving with all fury against us. We clewed down,
and hauled out the reef-tackles again, and close-reefed the fore-topsail,
and furled the main, and hove her to, on the starboard tack. Here was an
end to our fine prospects. We made up our minds to head winds and cold
weather; sent down the royal yards, and unrove the gear; but all the rest of
the top hamper remained aloft, even to the sky-sail masts and studding-sail
booms.
Throughout the night it stormed violently,—rain, hail, snow,
and sleet beating upon the vessel,—the wind continuing ahead, and the
sea running high. At daybreak (about three A.M.) the deck was covered with
snow. The captain sent up the steward with a glass of grog to each of the
watch; and all the time that we were off the Cape, grog was given to the
morning watch, and to all hands whenever we reefed topsails. The clouds
cleared away at sunrise, and, the wind becoming more fair, we again made sail
and stood nearly up to our course.
Thursday, November 6th. It continued more pleasant through
the first part of the day, but at night we had the same scene over again.
This time we did not heave to, as on the night before, but endeavored to beat
to windward under close-reefed topsails, balance-reefed trysail, and fore
top-mast staysail. This night it was my turn to steer, or, as the sailors
say, my trick at the helm, for two hours. Inexperienced as I was, I made out
to steer to the satisfaction of the officer, and neither Stimson nor I
gave up our tricks, all the time that we were off the Cape. This
was something to boast of, for it requires a good deal of skill
and watchfulness to steer a vessel close hauled, in a gale of
wind, against a heavy head sea. ``Ease her when she pitches,'' is
the word; and a little carelessness in letting her ship a heavy sea might
sweep the decks, or take a mast out of her.
Friday, November 7th. Towards morning the wind went down,
and during the whole forenoon we lay tossing about in a dead calm, and in
the midst of a thick fog. The calms here are unlike those in most parts of
the world, for here there is generally so high a sea running, with periods of
calm so short that it has no time to go down; and vessels, being under no
command of sails or rudder, lie like logs upon the water. We were obliged to
steady the booms and yards by guys and braces, and to lash everything well
below. We now found our top hamper of some use, for though it is liable
to be carried away or sprung by the sudden ``bringing up'' of a vessel
when pitching in a chopping sea, yet it is a great help in steadying a vessel
when rolling in a long swell,—giving more slowness, ease, and regularity to
the motion.
The calm of the morning reminds me of a scene which I forgot
to describe at the time of its occurrence, but which I remember from its
being the first time that I had heard the near breathing of whales. It was on
the night that we passed between the Falkland Islands and Staten Land. We had
the watch from twelve to four, and, coming upon deck, found the little brig
lying perfectly still, enclosed in a thick fog, and the sea as smooth as
though oil had been poured upon it; yet now and then a long, low
swell rolling under its surface, slightly lifting the vessel, but without
breaking the glassy smoothness of the water. We were surrounded far and near
by shoals of sluggish whales and grampuses, which the fog prevented our
seeing, rising slowly to the surface, or perhaps lying out at length, heaving
out those lazy, deep, and long-drawn breathings which give such
an impression of supineness and strength. Some of the watch were asleep,
and the others were quiet, so that there was nothing to break the illusion,
and I stood leaning over the bulwarks, listening to the slow breathings of
the mighty creatures,—now one breaking the water just alongside, whose
black body I almost fancied that I could see through the fog; and again
another, which I could just hear in the distance,—until the low and
regular swell seemed like the heaving of the ocean's mighty bosom to
the sound of its own heavy and long-drawn respirations.
Towards the evening of this day (Friday, 7th) the fog cleared
off, and we had every appearance of a cold blow; and soon after sundown it
came on. Again it was clew up and haul down, reef and furl, until we had got
her down to close-reefed topsails, double-reefed trysail, and reefed fore
spenser. Snow, hail, and sleet were driving upon us most of the night, and
the sea was breaking over the bows and covering the forward part of the
little vessel; but, as she would lay her course, the captain refused to heave
her to.
Saturday, November 8th. This day began with calm and thick
fog, and ended with hail, snow, a violent wind, and
close-reefed topsails.
Sunday, November 9th. To-day the sun rose clear and continued
so until twelve o'clock, when the captain got an observation. This was
very well for Cape Horn, and we thought it a little remarkable that, as we
had not had one unpleasant Sunday during the whole voyage, the only tolerable
day here should be a Sunday. We got time to clear up the steerage and
forecastle, and set things to rights, and to overhaul our wet clothes a
little. But this did not last very long. Between five and six—the sun was
then nearly three hours high—the cry of ``All Starbowlines ahoy!''
summoned our watch on deck, and immediately all hands were called. A
true specimen of Cape Horn was coming upon us. A great cloud of a
dark slate-color was driving on us from the southwest; and we did our best
to take in sail (for the light sails had been set during the first part of
the day) before we were in the midst of it. We had got the light sails
furled, the courses hauled up, and the topsail reef-tackles hauled out, and
were just mounting the fore-rigging when the storm struck us. In an instant
the sea, which had been comparatively quiet, was running higher and higher;
and it became almost as dark as night. The hail and sleet were harder than I
had yet felt them; seeming almost to pin us down to the rigging. We were
longer taking in sail than ever before; for the sails were stiff and wet, the
ropes and rigging covered with snow and sleet, and we ourselves cold and
nearly blinded with the violence of the storm. By the time we had got down
upon deck again, the little brig was plunging madly into a tremendous head
sea, which at every drive rushed in through the bow-ports and over the bows,
and buried all the forward part of the vessel. At this instant the chief
mate, who was standing on the top of the windlass, at the foot of the
spenser-mast, called out, ``Lay out there and furl the jib!'' This was no
agreeable or safe duty, yet it must be done. John, a Swede (the best sailor
on board), who belonged on the forecastle, sprang out upon the bowsprit.
Another one must go. It was a clear case of holding back. I was near the
mate, but sprang past several, threw the downhaul over the windlass, and
jumped between the knight-heads out upon the bowsprit. The crew
stood abaft the windlass and hauled the jib down, while John and I got out
upon the weather side of the jib-boom, our feet on the foot-ropes, holding on
by the spar, the great jib flying off to leeward and slatting so as almost to
throw us off the boom. For some time we could do nothing but hold on, and the
vessel, diving into two huge seas, one after the other, plunged us twice into
the water up to our chins. We hardly knew whether we were on or off; when,
the boom lifting us up dripping from the water, we were raised high into the
air and then plunged below again. John thought the boom would go every
moment, and called out to the mate to keep the vessel off, and haul down the
staysail; but the fury of the wind and the breaking of the seas against the
bows defied every attempt to make ourselves heard, and we were obliged to
do the best we could in our situation. Fortunately no other seas so heavy
struck her, and we succeeded in furling the jib ``after a fashion''; and,
coming in over the staysail nettings, were not a little pleased to find that
all was snug, and the watch gone below; for we were soaked through, and it
was very cold. John admitted that it had been a post of danger, which good
sailors seldom do when the thing is over. The weather continued nearly
the same through the night.
Monday, November 10th. During a part of this day we were hove
to, but the rest of the time were driving on, under close-reefed sails,
with a heavy sea, a strong gale, and frequent squalls of hail and
snow.
Tuesday, November 11th. The same.
Wednesday. The same.
Thursday. The same.
We had now got hardened to Cape weather, the vessel was
under reduced sail, and everything secured on deck and below, so that
we had little to do but to steer and to stand our watch. Our clothes were
all wet through, and the only change was from wet to more wet. There is no
fire in the forecastle, and we cannot dry clothes at the galley. It was in
vain to think of reading or working below, for we were too tired, the
hatchways were closed down, and everything was wet and uncomfortable, black
and dirty, heaving and pitching. We had only to come below when the watch was
out, wring our wet clothes, hang them up to chafe against the bulkheads,
and turn in and sleep as soundly as we could, until our watch was called
again. A sailor can sleep anywhere,—no sound of wind, water, canvas, rope,
wood, or iron can keep him awake,—and we were always fast asleep when three
blows on the hatchway, and the unwelcome cry of ``All Starbowlines ahoy!
eight bells there below! do you hear the news?'' (the usual formula of
calling the watch) roused us up from our berths upon the cold, wet decks. The
only time when we could be said to take any pleasure was at night
and morning, when we were allowed a tin pot full of hot tea (or, as the
sailors significantly call it, ``water bewitched'') sweetened with molasses.
This, bad as it was, was still warm and comforting, and, together with our
sea biscuit and cold salt beef, made a meal. Yet even this meal was attended
with some uncertainty. We had to go ourselves to the galley and take our kid
of beef and tin pots of tea, and run the risk of losing them before we could
get below. Many a kid of beef have I seen rolling in the scuppers, and the
bearer lying at his length on the decks. I remember an English lad who was
the life of the crew—whom we afterwards lost overboard—standing for
nearly ten minutes at the galley, with his pot of tea in his hand, waiting
for a chance to get down into the forecastle; and, seeing what he thought was
a ``smooth spell,'' started to go forward. He had just got to the end of
the windlass, when a great sea broke over the bows, and for a moment I saw
nothing of him but his head and shoulders; and at the next instant, being
taken off his legs, he was carried aft with the sea, until her stern lifting
up, and sending the water forward, he was left high and dry at the side of
the long-boat, still holding on to his tin pot, which had now nothing in it
but salt water. But nothing could ever daunt him, or overcome, for a moment,
his habitual good-humor. Regaining his legs, and shaking his fist at the
man at the wheel, he rolled below, saying, as he passed, ``A man's no sailor,
if he can't take a joke.'' The ducking was not the worst of such an affair,
for, as there was an allowance of tea, you could get no more from the galley;
and though the others would never suffer a man to go without, but would
always turn in a little from their own pots to fill up his, yet this was at
best but dividing the loss among all hands.
Something of the same kind befell me a few days after. The
cook had just made for us a mess of hot ``scouse,''—that is,
biscuit pounded fine, salt beef cut into small pieces, and a few
potatoes, boiled up together and seasoned with pepper. This was a
rare treat, and I, being the last at the galley, had it put in my charge
to carry down for the mess. I got along very well as far as the hatchway, and
was just going down the steps, when a heavy sea, lifting the stern out of
water, and, passing forward, dropping it again, threw the steps from their
place, and I came down into the steerage a little faster than I meant to,
with the kid on top of me, and the whole precious mess scattered over the
floor. Whatever your feelings may be, you must make a joke of everything at
sea; and if you were to fall from aloft and be caught in the belly of
a sail, and thus saved from instant death, it would not do to look at all
disturbed, or to treat it as a serious matter.
Friday, November 14th. We were now well to the westward of
the Cape, and were changing our course to northward as much as we dared,
since the strong southwest winds, which prevailed then, carried us in towards
Patagonia. At two P.M. we saw a sail on our larboard beam, and at four we
made it out to be a large ship, steering our course, under single-reefed
topsails. We at that time had shaken the reefs out of our topsails, as the
wind was lighter, and set the main top-gallant sail. As soon as our captain
saw what sail she was under, he set the fore top-gallant sail and
flying jib; and the old whaler—for such his boats and short sail
showed him to be—felt a little ashamed, and shook the reefs out of
his topsails, but could do no more, for he had sent down his top-gallant
masts off the Cape. He ran down for us, and answered our hail as the
whale-ship New England, of Poughkeepsie, one hundred and twenty days from New
York. Our captain gave our name, and added, ninety-two days from Boston. They
then had a little conversation about longitude, in which they found that they
could not agree. The ship fell astern, and continued in sight during
the night. Toward morning, the wind having become light, we crossed our
royal and skysail yards, and at daylight we were seen under a cloud of sail,
having royals and skysails fore and aft. The ``spouter,'' as the sailors call
a whaleman, had sent up his main top-gallant mast and set the sail, and made
signal for us to heave to. About half past seven their whale-boat came
alongside, and Captain Job Terry sprang on board, a man known in every port
and by every vessel in the Pacific Ocean. ``Don't you know Job Terry? I
thought everybody knew Job Terry,'' said a green hand, who came in the boat,
to me, when I asked him about his captain. He was indeed a singular man. He
was six feet high, wore thick cowhide boots, and brown coat and trousers,
and, except a sunburnt complexion, had not the slightest appearance of a
sailor; yet he had been forty years in the whale-trade, and, as he said
himself, had owned ships, built ships, and sailed ships. His boat's
crew were a pretty raw set, just out of the bush, and, as the
sailor's phrase is, ``hadn't got the hayseed out of their hair.''
Captain Terry convinced our captain that our reckoning was a little
out, and, having spent the day on board, put off in his boat at sunset for
his ship, which was now six or eight miles astern. He began a ``yarn'' when
he came aboard, which lasted, with but little intermission, for four hours.
It was all about himself, and the Peruvian government, and the Dublin
frigate, and her captain, Lord James Townshend, and President Jackson, and
the ship Ann M'Kim, of Baltimore. It would probably never have come to an
end, had not a good breeze sprung up, which sent him off to his own vessel.
One of the lads who came in his boat, a thoroughly
countrified-looking fellow, seemed to care very little about the vessel,
rigging, or anything else, but went round looking at the live stock,
and leaned over the pigsty, and said he wished he was back again tending
his father's pigs.
A curious case of dignity occurred here. It seems that in
a whale-ship there is an intermediate class, called boat-steerers. One of
them came in Captain Terry's boat, but we thought he was cockswain of the
boat, and a cockswain is only a sailor. In the whaler, the boat-steerers are
between the officers and crew, a sort of petty officers; keep by themselves
in the waist, sleep amidships, and eat by themselves, either at a separate
table, or at the cabin table, after the captain and mates are done. Of
all this hierarchy we were entirely ignorant, so the poor boat-steerer was
left to himself. The second mate would not notice him, and seemed surprised
at his keeping amidships, but his pride of office would not allow him to go
forward. With dinner-time came the experimentum crucis. What would he do? The
second mate went to the second table without asking him. There was nothing
for him but famine or humiliation. We asked him into the forecastle, but
he faintly declined. The whale-boat's crew explained it to us, and
we asked him again. Hunger got the victory over pride of rank, and his
boat-steering majesty had to take his grub out of our kid, and eat with his
jack-knife. Yet the man was ill at ease all the time, was sparing of his
conversation, and kept up the notion of a condescension under stress of
circumstances. One would say that, instead of a tendency to equality in human
beings, the tendency is to make the most of inequalities, natural or
artificial.
At eight o'clock we altered our course to the northward, bound
for Juan Fernandez.
This day we saw the last of the albatrosses, which had been
our companions a great part of the time off the Cape. I had
been interested in the bird from descriptions, and Coleridge's poem, and
was not at all disappointed. We caught one or two with a baited hook which we
floated astern upon a shingle. Their long, flapping wings, long legs, and
large, staring eyes, give them a very peculiar appearance. They look well on
the wing; but one of the finest sights that I have ever seen was an albatross
asleep upon the water, during a calm, off Cape Horn, when a heavy sea
was running. There being no breeze, the surface of the water was unbroken,
but a long, heavy swell was rolling, and we saw the fellow, all white,
directly ahead of us, asleep upon the waves, with his head under his wing;
now rising on the top of one of the big billows, and then falling slowly
until he was lost in the hollow between. He was undisturbed for some time,
until the noise of our bows, gradually approaching, roused him, when, lifting
his head, he stared upon us for a moment, and then spread his wide wings
and took his flight.
CHAPTER VI
Monday, November 17th. This was a black day in our calendar.
At seven o'clock in the morning, it being our watch below, we were aroused
from a sound sleep by the cry of ``All hands ahoy! a man overboard!'' This
unwonted cry sent a thrill through the heart of every one, and, hurrying on
deck, we found the vessel hove flat aback, with all her studding-sails set;
for, the boy who was at the helm leaving it to throw something overboard, the
carpenter, who was an old sailor, knowing that the wind was light, put
the helm down and hove her aback. The watch on deck were lowering away the
quarter-boat, and I got on deck just in time to fling myself into her as she
was leaving the side; but it was not until out upon the wide Pacific, in our
little boat, that I knew whom we had lost. It was George Ballmer, the young
English sailor, whom I have before spoken of as the life of the crew. He was
prized by the officers as an active and willing seaman, and by the men as
a lively, hearty fellow, and a good shipmate. He was going aloft to fit a
strap round the main topmasthead, for ringtail halyards, and had the strap
and block, a coil of halyards, and a marline-spike about his neck. He fell
from the starboard futtock shrouds, and, not knowing how to swim, and being
heavily dressed, with all those things round his neck, he probably sank
immediately. We pulled astern, in the direction in which he fell, and though
we knew that there was no hope of saving him, yet no one wished to speak
of returning, and we rowed about for nearly an hour, without an idea of
doing anything, but unwilling to acknowledge to ourselves that we must give
him up. At length we turned the boat's head and made towards the
brig.
Death is at all times solemn, but never so much so as at sea.
A man dies on shore; his body remains with his friends, and ``the mourners
go about the streets''; but when a man falls overboard at sea and is lost,
there is a suddenness in the event, and a difficulty in realizing it, which
give to it an air of awful mystery. A man dies on shore,—you follow his
body to the grave, and a stone marks the spot. You are often prepared for the
event. There is always something which helps you to realize it when
it happens, and to recall it when it has passed. A man is shot down by
your side in battle, and the mangled body remains an object, and a real
evidence; but at sea, the man is near you,—at your side,—you hear his
voice, and in an instant he is gone, and nothing but a vacancy shows his
loss. Then, too, at sea—to use a homely but expressive phrase—you miss a
man so much. A dozen men are shut up together in a little bark upon the wide,
wide sea, and for months and months see no forms and hear no voices but
their own, and one is taken suddenly from among them, and they miss him at
every turn. It is like losing a limb. There are no new faces or new scenes to
fill up the gap. There is always an empty berth in the forecastle, and one
man wanting when the small night-watch is mustered. There is one less to take
the wheel, and one less to lay out with you upon the yard. You miss his form,
and the sound of his voice, for habit had made them almost necessary to you,
and each of your senses feels the loss.
All these things make such a death peculiarly solemn, and
the effect of it remains upon the crew for some time. There is
more kindness shown by the officers to the crew, and by the crew to
one another. There is more quietness and seriousness. The oath and
the loud laugh are gone. The officers are more watchful, and the crew go
more carefully aloft. The lost man is seldom mentioned, or is dismissed with
a sailor's rude eulogy,—``Well, poor George is gone! His cruise is up soon!
He knew his work, and did his duty, and was a good shipmate.'' Then usually
follows some allusion to another world, for sailors are almost all believers,
in their way; though their notions and opinions are unfixed and at loose
ends. They say, ``God won't be hard upon the poor fellow,'' and seldom get
beyond the common phrase which seems to imply that their sufferings and hard
treatment here will be passed to their credit in the books of the Great
Captain hereafter,—``To work hard, live hard, die hard, and go to hell
after all, would be hard indeed!'' Our cook, a simple-hearted old African,
who had been through a good deal in his day, and was rather seriously
inclined, always going to church twice a day when on shore, and reading
his Bible on a Sunday in the galley, talked to the crew about spending the
Lord's Days badly, and told them that they might go as suddenly as George
had, and be as little prepared.
Yet a sailor's life is at best but a mixture of a little good
with much evil, and a little pleasure with much pain. The beautiful
is linked with the revolting, the sublime with the commonplace, and the
solemn with the ludicrous.
Not long after we had returned on board with our sad report,
an auction was held of the poor man's effects. The captain had
first, however, called all hands aft and asked them if they were satisfied
that everything had been done to save the man, and if they thought there was
any use in remaining there longer. The crew all said that it was in vain, for
the man did not know how to swim, and was very heavily dressed. So we then
filled away and kept the brig off to her course.
The laws regulating navigation make the captain answerable for
the effects of a sailor who dies during the voyage, and it is either a law
or a custom, established for convenience, that the captain should soon hold
an auction of his things, in which they are bid off by the sailors, and the
sums which they give are deducted from their wages at the end of the voyage.
In this way the trouble and risk of keeping his things through the voyage are
avoided, and the clothes are usually sold for more than they would be worth
on shore. Accordingly, we had no sooner got the ship before the wind, than
his chest was brought up upon the forecastle, and the sale began. The jackets
and trousers in which we had seen him dressed so lately were exposed and bid
off while the life was hardly out of his body, and his chest was taken aft
and used as a store-chest, so that there was nothing left which could be
called his. Sailors have an unwillingness to wear a dead man's
clothes during the same voyage, and they seldom do so, unless they are
in absolute want.
As is usual after a death, many stories were told about
George. Some had heard him say that he repented never having learned
to swim, and that he knew that he should meet his death by
drowning. Another said that he never knew any good to come of a voyage
made against the will, and the deceased man shipped and spent his advance,
and was afterwards very unwilling to go, but, not being able to refund, was
obliged to sail with us. A boy, too, who had become quite attached to him,
said that George talked to him, during most of the watch on the night before,
about his mother and family at home, and this was the first time that he had
mentioned the subject during the voyage.
The night after this event, when I went to the galley to get
a light, I found the cook inclined to be talkative, so I sat down on the
spars, and gave him an opportunity to hold a yarn. I was the more inclined to
do so, as I found that he was full of the superstitions once more common
among seamen, and which the recent death had waked up in his mind. He talked
about George's having spoken of his friends, and said he believed few men
died without having a warning of it, which he supported by a great many
stories of dreams, and of unusual behavior of men before death. From
this he went on to other superstitions, the Flying Dutchman, &c.,
and talked rather mysteriously, having something evidently on his mind. At
length he put his head out of the galley and looked carefully about to see if
any one was within hearing, and, being satisfied on that point, asked me in a
low tone,--
``I say! you know what countryman 'e carpenter
be?''
``Yes,'' said I; ``he's a German.''
``What kind of a German?'' said the cook.
``He belongs to Bremen,'' said I.
``Are you sure o' dat?'' said he.
I satisfied him on that point by saying that he could speak
no language but the German and English.
``I'm plaguy glad o' dat,'' said the cook. ``I was mighty
'fraid he was a Fin. I tell you what, I been plaguy civil to that man
all the voyage.''
I asked him the reason of this, and found that he was
fully possessed with the notion that Fins are wizards, and especially have
power over winds and storms. I tried to reason with him about it, but he had
the best of all arguments, that from experience, at hand, and was not to be
moved. He had been to the Sandwich Islands in a vessel in which the
sail-maker was a Fin, and could do anything he was of a mind to. This
sail-maker kept a junk bottle in his berth, which was always just half full
of rum, though he got drunk upon it nearly every day. He had seen him sit for
hours together, talking to this bottle, which he stood up before him
on the table. The same man cut his throat in his berth, and everybody said
he was possessed.
He had heard of ships, too, beating up the gulf of Finland
against a head wind, and having a ship heave in sight astern,
overhaul, and pass them, with as fair a wind as could blow, and
all studding-sails out, and find she was from Finland.
``Oh, no!'' said he; ``I've seen too much o' dem men to want
to see 'em 'board a ship. If dey can't have dare own way, they'll play the
d---l with you.''
As I still doubted, he said he would leave it to John, who was
the oldest seaman aboard, and would know, if anybody did. John, to
be sure, was the oldest, and at the same time the most ignorant, man in
the ship; but I consented to have him called. The cook stated the matter to
him, and John, as I anticipated, sided with the cook, and said that he
himself had been in a ship where they had a head wind for a fortnight, and
the captain found out at last that one of the men, with whom he had had same
hard words a short time before, was a Fin, and immediately told him if he
didn't stop the head wind he would shut him down in the fore peak. The Fin
would not give in, and the captain shut him down in the fore peak,
and would not give him anything to eat. The Fin held out for a day and a
half, when he could not stand it any longer, and did something or other which
brought the wind round again, and they let him up.
``Dar,'' said the cook, ``what you tink o' dat?''
I told him I had no doubt it was true, and that it would have
been odd if the wind had not changed in fifteen days, Fin or no
Fin.
``O,'' says he, ``go 'way! You tink, 'cause you been to
college, you know better dan anybody. You know better dan dem as 'as
seen it wid der own eyes. You wait till you've been to sea as long as
I have, and den you'll know.''
CHAPTER VII
We continued sailing along with a fair wind and fine weather
until--
Tuesday, November 25th, when at daylight we saw the island of
Juan Fernandez directly ahead, rising like a deep blue cloud out of
the sea. We were then probably nearly seventy miles from it; and so high
and so blue did it appear that I mistook it for a cloud resting over the
island, and looked for the island under it, until it gradually turned to a
deader and greener color, and I could mark the inequalities upon its surface.
At length we could distinguish trees and rocks; and by the afternoon this
beautiful island lay fairly before us, and we directed our course to
the only harbor. Arriving at the entrance soon after sundown, we found a
Chilian man-of-war brig, the only vessel, coming out. She hailed us; and an
officer on board, whom we supposed to be an American, advised us to run in
before night, and said that they were bound to Valparaiso. We ran immediately
for the anchorage, but, owing to the winds which drew about the mountains and
came to us in flaws from different points of the compass, we did not come to
an anchor until nearly midnight. We had a boat ahead all the time that
we were working in, and those aboard ship were continually bracing the
yards about for every puff that struck us, until about twelve o'clock, when
we came to in forty fathoms water, and our anchor struck bottom for the first
time since we left Boston,—one hundred and three days. We were then divided
into three watches, and thus stood out the remainder of the
night.
I was called on deck to stand my watch at about three in
the morning, and I shall never forget the peculiar sensation which
I experienced on finding myself once more surrounded by land, feeling the
night-breeze coming from off shore, and hearing the frogs and crickets. The
mountains seemed almost to hang over us, and apparently from the very heart
of them there came out, at regular intervals, a loud echoing sound, which
affected me as hardly human. We saw no lights, and could hardly account for
the sound, until the mate, who had been there before, told us that it was
the ``Alerta'' of the Chilian soldiers, who were stationed over some convicts
confined in caves nearly half-way up the mountain. At the expiration of my
watch, I went below, feeling not a little anxious for the day, that I might
see more nearly, and perhaps tread upon, this romantic, I may almost say
classic, island.
When all hands were called it was nearly sunrise, and between
that time and breakfast, although quite busy on board in getting
up water-casks, &c., I had a good view of the objects about me.
The harbor was nearly land-locked, and at the head of it was a landing,
protected by a small breakwater of stones, upon which two large boats were
hauled up, with a sentry standing over them. Near this was a variety of huts
or cottages, nearly a hundred in number, the best of them built of mud or
unburnt clay, and whitewashed, but the greater part Robinson Crusoe like,—
only of posts and branches of trees. The governor's house, as it
is called, was the most conspicuous, being large, with grated windows,
plastered walls, and roof of red tiles; yet, like all the rest, only of one
story. Near it was a small chapel, distinguished by a cross; and a long, low,
brown-looking building, surrounded by something like a palisade, from which
an old and dingy-looking Chilian flag was flying. This, of course, was
dignified by the title of Presidio. A sentinel was stationed at the chapel,
another at the governor's house, and a few soldiers, armed with
bayonets, looking rather ragged, with shoes out at the toes, were
strolling about among the houses, or waiting at the landing-place for
our boat to come ashore.
The mountains were high, but not so overhanging as they
appeared to be by starlight. They seemed to bear off towards the centre
of the island, and were green and well wooded, with some large, and, I am
told, exceedingly fertile valleys, with mule-tracks leading to different
parts of the island.
I cannot here forget how Stimson and I got the laugh of the
crew upon us by our eagerness to get on shore. The captain having ordered
the quarter-boat to be lowered, we both, thinking it was going ashore, sprang
down into the forecastle, filled our jacket pockets with tobacco to barter
with the people ashore, and, when the officer called for ``four hands in the
boat,'' nearly broke our necks in our haste to be first over the side, and
had the pleasure of pulling ahead of the brig with a tow-line for half
an hour, and coming on board again to be laughed at by the crew, who had
seen our manoeuvre.
After breakfast, the second mate was ordered ashore with
five hands to fill the water-casks, and, to my joy, I was among
the number. We pulled ashore with empty casks; and here again
fortune favored me, for the water was too thick and muddy to be put
into the casks, and the governor had sent men up to the head of the stream
to clear it out for us, which gave us nearly two hours of leisure. This
leisure we employed in wandering about among the houses, and eating a little
fruit which was offered to us. Ground apples, melons, grapes, strawberries of
an enormous size, and cherries abound here. The latter are said to have been
planted by Lord Anson. The soldiers were miserably clad, and asked with
some interest whether we had shoes to sell on board. I doubt very much if
they had the means of buying them. They were very eager to get tobacco, for
which they gave shells, fruit, &c. Knives were also in demand, but we
were forbidden by the governor to let any one have them, as he told us that
all the people there, except the soldiers and a few officers, were convicts
sent from Valparaiso, and that it was necessary to keep all weapons from
their hands. The island, it seems, belongs to Chili, and had been used by
the government as a penal colony for nearly two years; and the governor,—
an Englishman who had entered the Chilian navy,—with a priest, half a dozen
taskmasters, and a body of soldiers, were stationed there to keep them in
order. This was no easy task; and, only a few months before our arrival, a
few of them had stolen a boat at night, boarded a brig lying in the harbor,
sent the captain and crew ashore in their boat, and gone off to sea.
We were informed of this, and loaded our arms and kept strict watch on
board through the night, and were careful not to let the convicts get our
knives from us when on shore. The worst part of the convicts, I found, were
locked up under sentry, in caves dug into the side of the mountain, nearly
half-way up, with mule-tracks leading to them, whence they were taken by day
and set to work under taskmasters upon building an aqueduct, a wharf,
and other public works; while the rest lived in the houses which they put
up for themselves, had their families with them, and seemed to me to be the
laziest people on the face of the earth. They did nothing but take a paseo
into the woods, a paseo among the houses, a paseo at the landing-place,
looking at us and our vessel, and too lazy to speak fast; while the others
were driven about, at a rapid trot, in single file, with burdens on their
shoulders, and followed up by their taskmasters, with long rods in their
hands, and broad-brimmed straw hats upon their heads. Upon what
precise grounds this great distinction was made, I do not know, and
I could not very well know, for the governor was the only man who spoke
English upon the island, and he was out of my walk, for I was a sailor ashore
as well as on board.
Having filled our casks we returned on board, and soon after,
the governor dressed in a uniform like that of an American
militia officer, the Padre, in the dress of the gray friars, with hood
and all complete, and the Capitan, with big whiskers and
dirty regimentals, came on board to dine. While at dinner a large
ship appeared in the offing, and soon afterwards we saw a light whale-boat
pulling into the harbor. The ship lay off and on, and a boat came alongside
of us, and put on board the captain, a plain young Quaker, dressed all in
brown. The ship was the Cortes, whaleman, of New Bedford, and had put in to
see if there were any vessels from round the Horn, and to hear the latest
news from America. They remained aboard a short time, and had a little
talk with the crew, when they left us and pulled off to their ship, which,
having filled away, was soon out of sight.
A small boat which came from the shore to take away the
governor and suite—as they styled themselves—brought, as a present
to the crew, a large pail of milk, a few shells, and a block
of sandal-wood. The milk, which was the first we had tasted since leaving
Boston, we soon despatched; a piece of the sandal-wood I obtained, and
learned that it grew on the hills in the centre of the island. I regretted
that I did not bring away other specimens; but what I had—the piece of
sandalwood, and a small flower which I plucked and brought on board in the
crown of my tarpaulin, and carefully pressed between the leaves of a volume
of Cowper's Letters—were lost, with my chest and its contents, by
another's negligence, on our arrival home.
About an hour before sundown, having stowed our water-casks,
we began getting under way, and were not a little while about it; for we
were in thirty fathoms water, and in one of the gusts which came from off
shore had let go our other bow anchor; and as the southerly wind draws round
the mountains and comes off in uncertain flaws, we were continually swinging
round, and had thus got a very foul hawse. We hove in upon our chain, and
after stoppering and unshackling it again and again, and hoisting
and hauling down sail, we at length tripped our anchor and stood out to
sea. It was bright starlight when we were clear of the bay, and the lofty
island lay behind us in its still beauty, and I gave a parting look and bade
farewell to the most romantic spot of earth that my eyes had ever seen. I did
then, and have ever since, felt an attachment for that island together
peculiar. It was partly, no doubt, from its having been the first land that I
had seen since leaving home, and still more from the associations which every
one has connected with it in his childhood from reading Robinson Crusoe.
To this I may add the height and romantic outline of its mountains, the
beauty and freshness of its verdure and the extreme fertility of its soil,
and its solitary position in the midst of the wide expanse of the South
Pacific, as all concurring to give it its charm.
When thoughts of this place have occurred to me at different
times, I have endeavored to recall more particulars with regard to it. It
is situated in about 33° 30' S., and is distant a little more than three
hundred miles from Valparaiso, on the coast of Chili, which is in the same
latitude. It is about fifteen miles in length and five in breadth. The harbor
in which we anchored (called by Lord Anson Cumberland Bay) is the only one in
the island, two small bights of land on each side of the main bay (sometimes
dignified by the name of bays) being little more than landing-places for
boats. The best anchorage is at the western side of the harbor, where
we lay at about three cables' lengths from the shore, in a little more
than thirty fathoms water. This harbor is open to the N. N. E., and in fact
nearly from N. to E.; but the only dangerous winds being the southwest, on
which side are the highest mountains, it is considered safe. The most
remarkable thing, perhaps, about it is the fish with which it abounds. Two of
our crew, who remained on board, caught in a short time enough to last us for
several days, and one of the men, who was a Marblehead man, said that he
never saw or heard of such an abundance. There were cod,
bream, silver-fish, and other kinds, whose names they did not know,
or which I have forgotten.
There is an abundance of the best of water upon the island,
small streams running through every valley, and leaping down from
the sides of the hills. One stream of considerable size flows through the
centre of the lawn upon which the houses are built, and furnishes an easy and
abundant supply to the inhabitants. This, by means of a short wooden
aqueduct, was brought quite down to our boats. The convicts had also built
something in the way of a breakwater, and were to build a landing-place for
boats and goods, after which the Chilian government intended to lay port
charges.
Of the wood, I can only say that it appeared to be abundant;
the island in the month of November, when we were there, being in all the
freshness and beauty of spring, appeared covered with trees. These were
chiefly aromatic, and the largest was the myrtle. The soil is very loose and
rich, and wherever it is broken up there spring up radishes, turnips, ground
apples, and other garden fruits. Goats, we were told, were not abundant, and
we saw none, though it was said we might, if we had gone into the interior.
We saw a few bullocks winding about in the narrow tracks upon the sides of
the mountains, and the settlement was completely overrun with dogs of every
nation, kindred, and degree. Hens and chickens were also abundant, and seemed
to be taken good care of by the women. The men appeared to be the laziest of
mortals; and indeed, as far as my observation goes, there are no people to
whom the newly invented Yankee word of ``loafer'' is more applicable
than to the Spanish Americans. These men stood about doing nothing, with
their cloaks, little better in texture than an Indian's blanket, but of rich
colors, thrown over their shoulders with an air which it is said that a
Spanish beggar can always give to his rags, and with politeness and courtesy
in their address, though with holes in their shoes, and without a sou in
their pockets. The only interruption to the monotony of their day seemed to
be when a gust of wind drew round between the mountains and blew off
the boughs which they had placed for roofs to their houses, and gave them
a few minutes' occupation in running about after them. One of these gusts
occurred while we were ashore, and afforded us no little amusement in seeing
the men look round, and, if they found that their roofs had stood, conclude
that they might stand too, while those who saw theirs blown off, after
uttering a few Spanish oaths, gathered their cloaks over their shoulders, and
started off after them. However, they were not gone long, but soon returned
to their habitual occupation of doing nothing.
It is perhaps needless to say that we saw nothing of the
interior; but all who have seen it give favorable accounts of it.
Our captain went with the governor and a few servants upon mules over the
mountains, and, upon their return, I heard the governor request him to stop
at the island on his passage home, and offer him a handsome sum to bring a
few deer with him from California, for he said that there were none upon the
island, and he was very desirous of having it stocked.
A steady though light southwesterly wind carried us well off
from the island, and when I came on deck for the middle watch I could just
distinguish it from its hiding a few low stars in the southern horizon,
though my unpractised eyes would hardly have known it for land. At the close
of the watch a few trade-wind clouds which had arisen, though we were hardly
yet in their latitude, shut it out from our view, and the next
day,--
Thursday, November 27th, upon coming on deck in the morning,
we were again upon the wide Pacific, and saw no more land until we arrived
upon the western coast of the great continent of America.
CHAPTER VIII
As we saw neither land nor sail from the time of leaving
Juan Fernandez until our arrival in California, nothing of
interest occurred except our own doings on board. We caught the
southeast trades, and ran before them for nearly three weeks, without
so much as altering a sail or bracing a yard. The captain took advantage
of this fine weather to get the vessel in order for coming upon the coast.
The carpenter was employed in fitting up a part of the steerage into a
trade-room; for our cargo, we now learned, was not to be landed, but to be
sold by retail on board; and this trade-room was built for the samples and
the lighter goods to be kept in, and as a place for the general business.
In the mean time we were employed in working upon the rigging. Everything
was set up taut, the lower rigging rattled down, or rather rattled up
(according to the modern fashion), an abundance of spun-yarn and
seizing-stuff made, and finally the whole standing-rigging, fore and aft, was
tarred down. It was my first essay at the latter business, and I had enough
of it; for nearly all of it came upon my friend Stimson and myself. The men
were needed at the other work, and Henry Mellus, the other young man who
came out with us before the mast, was laid up with the rheumatism in his
feet, and the boy Sam was rather too young and small for the business; and as
the winds were light and regular he was kept during most of the daytime at
the helm, so that we had quite as much as we wished of it. We put on short
duck frocks, and, taking a small bucket of tar and a bunch of oakum in
our hands, went aloft, one at the main royal-mast-head, and the other at
the fore, and began tarring down. This is an important operation, and is
usually done about once in six months in vessels upon a long voyage. It was
done in our vessel several times afterwards, but by the whole crew at once,
and finished off in a day; but at this time, as most of it, as I have said,
came upon two of us, and we were new at the business, it took several
days. In this operation they always begin at the mast-head, and work down,
tarring the shrouds, backstays, standing parts of the lifts, the ties,
runners, &c., and go out to the yard-arms, and come in, tarring, as they
come, the lifts and foot-ropes. Tarring the stays is more difficult, and is
done by an operation which the sailors call ``riding down.'' A long piece of
rope—top-gallant-studding-sail halyards, or something of the kind—is
taken up to the mast-head from which the stay leads, and rove through a block
for a girt-line, or, as the sailors usually call it, a gant-line; with the
end of this, a bowline is taken round the stay, into which the man
gets with his bucket of tar and bunch of oakum; and the other end
being fast on deck, with some one to tend it, he is lowered down
gradually, and tars the stay carefully as he goes. There he ``swings aloft
'twixt heaven and earth,'' and if the rope slips, breaks, or is let go,
or if the bowline slips, he falls overboard or breaks his neck.
This, however, is a thing which never enters into a sailor's
calculation. He only thinks of leaving no holidays (places not tarred),—
for, in case he should, he would have to go over the whole again,—or of
dropping no tar upon deck, for then there would be a soft word in his ear
from the mate. In this manner I tarred down all the head-stays, but found the
rigging about the jib-booms, martingale, and spritsail yard, upon which I was
afterwards put, the hardest. Here you have to ``hang on with your eyelids''
and tar with your hands.
This dirty work could not last forever; and on Saturday night
we finished it, scraped all the spots from the deck and rails, and, what
was of more importance to us, cleaned ourselves thoroughly, rolled up our
tarry frocks and trousers and laid them away for the next occasion, and put
on our clean duck clothes, and had a good comfortable sailor's Saturday
night. The next day was pleasant, and indeed we had but one unpleasant Sunday
during the whole voyage, and that was off Cape Horn, where we could expect
nothing better. On Monday we began painting, and getting the vessel
ready for port. This work, too, is done by the crew, and every sailor who
has been long voyages is a little of a painter, in addition to his other
accomplishments. We painted her, both inside and out, from the truck to the
water's edge. The outside is painted by lowering stages over the side by
ropes, and on those we sat, with our brushes and paint-pots by us, and our
feet half the time in the water. This must be done, of course, on a smooth
day, when the vessel does not roll- much. I remember very well being over
the side painting in this way, one fine afternoon, our vessel
going quietly along at the rate of four or five knots, and a
pilot-fish, the sure precursor of a shark, swimming alongside of us.
The captain was leaning over the rail watching him, and we went quietly on
with our work. In the midst of our painting, on--
Friday, December 19th, we crossed the equator for the second
time. I had the sense of incongruity which all have when, for the
first time, they find themselves living under an entire change of seasons;
as, crossing the line under a burning sun in the midst
of December.
Thursday, December 25th. This day was Christmas, but it
brought us no holiday. The only change was that we had a ``plum duff''
for dinner, and the crew quarrelled with the steward because he did not
give us our usual allowance of molasses to eat with it. He thought the plums
would be a substitute for the molasses, but we were not to be cheated out of
our rights in that way.
Such are the trifles which produce quarrels on shipboard. In
fact, we had been too long from port. We were getting tired of
one another, and were in an irritable state, both forward and aft.
Our fresh provisions were, of course, gone, and the captain had stopped
our rice, so that we had nothing but salt beef and salt pork throughout the
week, with the exception of a very small duff on Sunday. This added to the
discontent; and many little things, daily and almost hourly occurring, which
no one who has not himself been on a long and tedious voyage can conceive of
or properly appreciate,—little wars and rumors of wars, reports
of things said in the cabin, misunderstanding of words and looks, apparent
abuses,—brought us into a condition in which everything seemed to go wrong.
Every encroachment upon the time allowed for rest appeared unnecessary. Every
shifting of the studding-sails was only to ``haze''[1] the crew.
In the midst of this state of things, my messmate Stimson and
I petitioned the captain for leave to shift our berths from the steerage,
where we had previously lived, into the forecastle. This, to our delight, was
granted, and we turned in to bunk and mess with the crew forward. We now
began to feel like sailors, which we never fully did when we were in the
steerage. While there, however useful and active you may be, you are but
a mongrel,—a sort of afterguard and ``ship's cousin.'' You
are immediately under the eye of the officers, cannot dance, sing, play,
smoke, make a noise, or growl, or take any other sailor's pleasure; and you
live with the steward, who is usually a go-between; and the crew never feel
as though you were one of them. But if you live in the forecastle, you are
``as independent as a wood-sawyer's clerk'' (nauticé), and are a sailor. You
hear sailors' talk, learn their ways, their peculiarities of feeling
as well as speaking and acting; and, moreover, pick up a great deal of
curious and useful information in seamanship, ship's customs, foreign
countries, &c., from their long yarns and equally long disputes. No man
can be a sailor, or know what sailors are, unless he has lived in the
forecastle with them,—turned in and out with them, and eaten from the
common kid. After I had been a week there, nothing would have tempted me to
go back to my old berth, and never afterwards, even in the worst of weather,
when in a close and leaking forecastle off Cape Horn, did I for a
moment wish myself in the steerage. Another thing which you learn
better in the forecastle than you can anywhere else is, to make and
mend clothes, and this is indispensable to sailors. A large part of their
watches below they spend at this work, and here I learned the art myself,
which stood me in so good stead afterwards.
But to return to the state of the crew. Upon our coming into
the forecastle, there was some difficulty about the uniting of
the allowances of bread, by which we thought we were to lose a few pounds.
This set us into a ferment. The captain would not condescend to explain, and
we went aft in a body, with John, the Swede, the oldest and best sailor of
the crew, for spokesman. The recollection of the scene that followed always
brings up a smile, especially the quarter-deck dignity and elocution of the
captain. He was walking the weather side of the quarter-deck, and,
seeing us coming aft, stopped short in his walk, and with a voice and look
intended to annihilate us called out, ``Well, what the d---l do you want
now?'' Whereupon we stated our grievances as respectfully as we could, but he
broke in upon us, saying that we were getting fat and lazy, didn't have
enough to do, and it was that which made us find fault. This provoked us, and
we began to give word for word. This would never answer. He clinched his
fist, stamped and swore, and ordered us all forward, saying, with
oaths enough interspersed to send the words home, ``Away with you!
go forward every one of you! I'll haze you! I'll work you up! You don't
have enough to do! If you a' n't careful I'll make a hell of heaven! . . . .
You've mistaken your man! I'm Frank Thompson, all the way from `down east.'
I've been through the mill, ground and bolted, and come out a regular-built
down-east johnny-cake, when it's hot, d---d good, but when it's cold, d---d
sour and indigestible;—and you'll find me so!'' The latter part of
this harangue made a strong impression, and the ``down-east johnny-cake''
became a byword for the rest of the voyage, and on the coast of California,
after our arrival. One of his nicknames in all the ports was ``The Down-east
Johnny-cake.'' So much for our petition for the redress of grievances. The
matter was, however, set right, for the mate, after allowing the captain
due time to cool off, explained it to him, and at night we were all called
aft to hear another harangue, in which, of course, the whole blame of the
misunderstanding was thrown upon us. We ventured to hint that he would not
give us time to explain; but it wouldn't do. We were driven back discomfited.
Thus the affair blew over, but the irritation caused by it remained; and we
never had peace or a good understanding again so long as the captain
and crew remained together.
We continued sailing along in the beautiful temperate climate
of the Pacific. The Pacific well deserves its name, for except in the
southern part, at Cape Horn, and in the western parts, near the China and
Indian oceans, it has few storms, and is never either extremely hot or cold.
Between the tropics there is a slight haziness, like a thin gauze, drawn over
the sun, which, without obstructing or obscuring the light, tempers the heat
which comes down with perpendicular fierceness in the Atlantic and Indian
tropics. We sailed well to the westward to have the full advantage of
the northeast trades, and when we had reached the latitude of
Point Conception, where it is usual to make the land, we were
several hundred miles to the westward of it. We immediately changed
our course due east, and sailed in that direction for a number of days. At
length we began to heave-to after dark, for fear of making the land at night,
on a coast where there are no lighthouses and but indifferent charts, and at
daybreak on the morning of--
Tuesday, January 13th, 1835, we made the land at Point
Conception, lat. 34° 32' N., lon. 120° 06' W. The port of Santa Barbara,
to which we were bound, lying about fifty miles to the southward of this
point, we continued sailing down the coast during the day and following
night, and on the next morning,
January 14th, we came to anchor in the spacious bay of Santa
Barbara, after a voyage of one hundred and fifty days from
Boston.
CHAPTER IX
California extends along nearly the whole of the western coast
of Mexico, between the Gulf of California in the south and the Bay of San
Francisco on the north, or between the 22d and 38th degrees of north
latitude. It is subdivided into two provinces,—Lower or Old California,
lying between the gulf and the 32d degree of latitude, or near it (the
division line running, I believe, between the bay of Todos Santos and the
port of San Diego), and New or Upper California, the southernmost port of
which is San Diego, in lat. 32° 39', and the northernmost, San Francisco,
situated in the large bay discovered by Sir Francis Drake, in lat. 37° 58',
and now known as the Bay of San Francisco, so named, I suppose, by
Franciscan missionaries. Upper California has the seat of its government
at Monterey, where is also the custom-house, the only one on the coast,
and at which every vessel intending to trade on the coast must enter its
cargo before it can begin its traffic. We were to trade upon this coast
exclusively, and therefore expected to go first to Monterey, but the
captain's orders from home were to put in at Santa Barbara, which is the
central port of the coast, and wait there for the agent, who transacts all
the business for the firm to which our vessel belonged.
The bay, or, as it was commonly called, the canal of
Santa Barbara, is very large, being formed by the main land on one
side (between Point Conception on the north and Point Santa Buenaventura
on the south), which here bends in like a crescent, and by three large
islands opposite to it and at the distance of some twenty miles. These points
are just sufficient to give it the name of a bay, while at the same time it
is so large and so much exposed to the southeast and northwest winds, that it
is little better than an open roadstead; and the whole swell of the
Pacific Ocean rolls in here before a southeaster, and breaks with so
heavy a surf in the shallow waters, that it is highly dangerous to
lie near in to the shore during the southeaster season, that is, between
the months of November and April.
This wind (the southeaster) is the bane of the coast
of California. Between the months of November and April (including a part
of each), which is the rainy season in this latitude, you are never safe from
it; and accordingly, in the ports which are open to it, vessels are obliged,
during these months, to lie at anchor at a distance of three miles from the
shore, with slip-ropes on their cables, ready to slip and go to sea at a
moment's warning. The only ports which are safe from this wind are San
Francisco and Monterey in the north, and San Diego in the south.
As it was January when we arrived, and the middle of
the southeaster season, we came to anchor at the distance of three miles
from the shore, in eleven fathoms water, and bent a slip-rope and buoys to
our cables, cast off the yard-arm gaskets from the sails, and stopped them
all with rope-yarns. After we had done this, the boat went ashore with the
captain, and returned with orders to the mate to send a boat ashore for him
at sundown. I did not go in the first boat, and was glad to find that
there was another going before night; for after so long a voyage as
ours had been, a few hours seem a long time to be in sight and out
of reach of land. We spent the day on board in the usual duties; but as
this was the first time we had been without the captain, we felt a little
more freedom, and looked about us to see what sort of a country we had got
into, and were to pass a year or two of our lives in.
It was a beautiful day, and so warm that we wore straw hats,
duck trousers, and all the summer gear. As this was midwinter, it
spoke well for the climate; and we afterwards found that the
thermometer never fell to the freezing point throughout the winter, and
that there was very little difference between the seasons, except
that during a long period of rainy and southeasterly weather,
thick clothes were not uncomfortable.
The large bay lay about us, nearly smooth, as there was hardly
a breath of wind stirring, though the boat's crew who went ashore told us
that the long groundswell broke into a heavy surf on the beach. There was
only one vessel in the port—a long, sharp brig of about three hundred tons,
with raking masts, and very square yards, and English colors at her peak. We
afterwards learned that she was built at Guayaquil, and named the Ayacucho,
after the place where the battle was fought that gave Peru her
independence, and was now owned by a Scotchman named Wilson, who commanded
her, and was engaged in the trade between Callao and other parts of South
America and California. She was a fast sailer, as we frequently afterwards
saw, and had a crew of Sandwich-Islanders on board. Beside this vessel, there
was no object to break the surface of the bay. Two points ran out as the
horns of the crescent, one of which—the one to the westward—was low
and sandy, and is that to which vessels are obliged to give a wide berth
when running out for a southeaster; the other is high, bold, and well wooded,
and has a mission upon it, called Santa Buenaventura, from which the point is
named. In the middle of this crescent, directly opposite the anchoring
ground, lie the Mission and town of Santa Barbara, on a low plain, but little
above the level of the sea, covered with grass, though entirely
without trees, and surrounded on three sides by an amphitheatre
of mountains, which slant off to the distance of fifteen or twenty miles.
The Mission stands a little back of the town, and is a large building, or
rather collection of buildings, in the centre of which is a high tower, with
a belfry of five bells. The whole, being plastered, makes quite a show at a
distance, and is the mark by which vessels come to anchor. The town lies a
little nearer to the beach,—about half a mile from it,—and is composed
of one-story houses built of sun-baked clay, or adobe, some of
them whitewashed, with red tiles on the roofs. I should judge that there
were about a hundred of them; and in the midst of them stands the Presidio,
or fort, built of the same materials, and apparently but little stronger. The
town is finely situated, with a bay in front, and an amphitheatre of hills
behind. The only thing which diminishes its beauty is, that the hills have no
large trees upon them, they having been all burnt by a great fire
which swept them off about a dozen years ago, and they had not yet
grown again. The fire was described to me by an inhabitant, as having been
a very terrible and magnificent sight. The air of the whole valley was so
heated that the people were obliged to leave the town and take up their
quarters for several days upon the beach.
Just before sundown, the mate ordered a boat's crew ashore,
and I went as one of the number. We passed under the stern of the English
brig, and had a long pull ashore. I shall never forget the impression which
our first landing on the beach of California made upon me. The sun had just
gone down; it was getting dusky; the damp night-wind was beginning to blow,
and the heavy swell of the Pacific was setting in, and breaking in loud and
high ``combers'' upon the beach. We lay on our oars in the swell, just
outside of the surf, waiting for a good chance to run in, when a boat,
which had put off from the Ayacucho, came alongside of us, with a crew of
dusky Sandwich-Islanders, talking and hallooing in their outlandish tongue.
They knew that we were novices in this kind of boating, and waited to see us
go in. The second mate, however, who steered our boat, determined to have the
advantage of their experience, and would not go in first. Finding, at length,
how matters stood, they gave a shout, and taking advantage of a
great comber which came swelling in, rearing its head, and lifting up the
sterns of our boats nearly perpendicular, and again dropping them in the
trough, they gave three or four long and strong pulls, and went in on top of
the great wave, throwing their oars overboard, and as far from the boat as
they could throw them, and, jumping out the instant the boat touched the
beach, they seized hold of her by the gunwale, on each side, and ran her up
high and dry upon the sand. We saw, at once, how the thing was to be
done, and also the necessity of keeping the boat stern out to the sea; for
the instant the sea should strike upon her broadside or quarter, she would be
driven up broadside on, and capsized. We pulled strongly in, and as soon as
we felt that the sea had got hold of us, and was carrying us in with the
speed of a race-horse, we threw the oars as far from the boat as we could,
and took hold of the gunwales, ready to spring out and seize her when
she struck, the officer using his utmost strength, with his steering-oar,
to keep her stern out. We were shot up upon the beach, and, seizing the boat,
ran her up high and dry, and, picking up our oars, stood by her, ready for
the captain to come down.
Finding that the captain did not come immediately, we put our
oars in the boat, and, leaving one to watch it, walked about the beach to
see what we could of the place. The beach is nearly a mile in length between
the two points, and of smooth sand. We had taken the only good landing-place,
which is in the middle, it being more stony toward the ends. It is about
twenty yards in width from high-water mark to a slight bank at which the soil
begins, and so hard that it is a favorite place for running horses. It
was growing dark, so that we could just distinguish the dim outlines of
the two vessels in the offing; and the great seas were rolling in in regular
lines, growing larger and larger as they approached the shore, and hanging
over the beach upon which they were to break, when their tops would curl over
and turn white with foam, and, beginning at one extreme of the line, break
rapidly to the other, as a child's long card house falls when a card is
knocked down at one end. The Sandwich-Islanders, in the mean time,
had turned their boat round, and ran her down into the water, and
were loading her with hides and tallow. As this was the work in which we
were soon to be engaged, we looked on with some curiosity. They ran the boat
so far into the water that every large sea might float her, and two of them,
with their trousers rolled up, stood by the bows, one on each side, keeping
her in her right position. This was hard work; for beside the force they had
to use upon the boat, the large seas nearly took them off their legs. The
others were running from the boat to the bank, upon which, out of
the reach of the water, was a pile of dry bullocks' hides,
doubled lengthwise in the middle, and nearly as stiff as boards.
These they took upon their heads, one or two at a time, and carried
down to the boat, in which one of their number stowed them away. They were
obliged to carry them on their heads, to keep them out of the water and we
observed that they had on thick woollen caps. ``Look here, Bill, and see what
you're coming to!'' said one of our men to another who stood by the boat.
``Well, Dana,'' said the second mate to me, ``this does not look much like
Harvard College, does it? But it is what I call `head work.''' To tell the
truth, it did not look very encouraging.
After they had got through with the hides, the Kanakas laid
hold of the bags of tallow (the bags are made of hide, and are about the
size of a common meal-bag), and lifted each upon the shoulders of two men,
one at each end, who walked off with them to the boat, when all prepared to
go aboard. Here, too, was something for us to learn. The man who steered
shipped his oar and stood up in the stern, and those that pulled the two
after oars sat upon their benches, with their oars shipped, ready to strike
out as soon as she was afloat. The two men remained standing at the bows;
and when, at length, a large sea came in and floated her, seized hold of
the gunwales, and ran out with her till they were up to their armpits, and
then tumbled over the gunwales into the bows, dripping with water. The men at
the oars struck out, but it wouldn't do; the sea swept back and left them
nearly high and dry. The two fellows jumped out again; and the next time they
succeeded better, and, with the help of a deal of outlandish hallooing
and bawling, got her well off. We watched them till they were out of the
breakers, and saw them steering for their vessel, which was now hidden in the
darkness.
The sand of the beach began to be cold to our bare feet; the
frogs set up their croaking in the marshes, and one solitary owl, from the
end of the distant point, gave out his melancholy note, mellowed by the
distance, and we began to think that it was high time for ``the old man,'' as
a shipmaster is commonly called, to come down. In a few minutes we heard
something coming towards us. It was a man on horseback. He came on the full
gallop, reined up near us, addressed a few words to us, and, receiving no
answer, wheeled round and galloped off again. He was nearly as dark as
an Indian, with a large Spanish hat, blanket cloak or serape, and leather
leggins, with a long knife stuck in them. ``This is the seventh city that
ever I was in, and no Christian one neither,'' said Bill Brown. ``Stand by!''
said John, ``you haven't seen the worst of it yet.'' In the midst of this
conversation the captain appeared; and we winded the boat round, shoved her
down, and prepared to go off. The captain, who had been on the
coast before, and ``knew the ropes,'' took the steering-oar, and we
went off in the same way as the other boat. I, being the youngest, had the
pleasure of standing at the bow, and getting wet through. We went off well,
though the seas were high. Some of them lifted us up, and, sliding from under
us, seemed to let us drop through the air like a flat plank upon the body of
the water. In a few minutes we were in the low, regular swell, and pulled for
a light, which, as we neared it, we found had been run up to our trysail
gaff.
Coming aboard, we hoisted up all the boats, and, diving down
into the forecastle, changed our wet clothes, and got our supper.
After supper the sailors lighted their pipes (cigars, those of us who had
them), and we had to tell all we had seen ashore. Then followed conjectures
about the people ashore, the length of the voyage, carrying hides, &c.,
&c., until eight bells, when all hands were called aft, and the ``anchor
watch'' set. We were to stand two in a watch, and, as the nights were pretty
long, two hours were to make a watch. The second mate was to keep the
deck until eight o'clock, all hands were to be called at daybreak, and the
word was passed to keep a bright lookout, and to call the mate if it should
come on to blow from the southeast. We had, also, orders to strike the bells
every half-hour through the night, as at sea. My watchmate was John, the
Swedish sailor, and we stood from twelve to two, he walking the larboard side
and I the starboard. At daylight all hands were called, and we went
through the usual process of washing down, swabbing, &c., and
got breakfast at eight o'clock. In the course of the forenoon, a boat went
aboard of the Ayacucho and brought off a quarter of beef, which made us a
fresh bite for dinner. This we were glad enough to have, and the mate told us
that we should live upon fresh beef while we were on the coast, as it was
cheaper here than the salt. While at dinner, the cook called ``Sail ho!''
and, coming on deck, we saw two sails bearing round the point. One was a
large ship under top-gallant sails, and the other a small hermaphrodite
brig. They both backed their topsails and sent boats aboard of us.
The ship's colors had puzzled us, and we found that she was from Genoa,
with an assorted cargo, and was trading on the coast. She filled away again,
and stood out, being bound up the coast to San Francisco. The crew of the
brig's boat were Sandwich-Islanders, but one of them, who spoke a little
English, told us that she was the Loriotte, Captain Nye, from Oahu, and was
engaged in the hide and tallow trade. She was a lump of a thing, what the
sailors call a butter-box. This vessel, as well as the Ayacucho, and
others which we afterwards saw engaged in the same trade, have English
or Americans for officers, and two or three before the mast to do the work
upon the rigging, and to be relied upon for seamanship, while the rest of the
crew are Sandwich-Islanders, who are active and very useful in
boating.
The three captains went ashore after dinner, and came off
again at night. When in port, everything is attended to by the chief
mate; the captain, unless he is also supercargo, has little to do, and is
usually ashore much of his time. This we thought would be pleasanter for us,
as the mate was a good-natured man, and not very strict. So it was for a
time, but we were worse off in the end; for wherever the captain is a severe,
energetic man, and the mate has neither of these qualities, there will always
be trouble. And trouble we had already begun to anticipate. The captain
had several times found fault with the mate, in presence of the crew; and
hints had been dropped that all was not right between them. When this is the
case, and the captain suspects that his chief officer is too easy and
familiar with the crew, he begins to interfere in all the duties, and to draw
the reins more taut, and the crew have to suffer.
CHAPTER X
This night, after sundown, it looked black at the southward
and eastward, and we were told to keep a bright lookout. Expecting to be
called, we turned in early. Waking up about midnight, I found a man who had
just come down from his watch striking a light. He said that it was beginning
to puff from the southeast, that the sea was rolling in, and he had called
the captain; and as he threw himself down on his chest with all his clothes
on, I knew that he expected to be called. I felt the vessel pitching at her
anchor, and the chain surging and snapping, and lay awake, prepared for
an instant summons. In a few minutes it came,—three knocks on
the scuttle, and ``All hands ahoy! bear-a-hand[1] up and make sail.''
We sprang for our clothes, and were about half dressed, when the
mate called out, down the scuttle, ``Tumble up here, men! tumble
up! before she drags her anchor.'' We were on deck in an instant. ``Lay
aloft and loose the topsails!'' shouted the captain, as soon as the first man
showed himself. Springing into the rigging, I saw that the Ayacucho's
topsails were loosed, and heard her crew singing out at the sheets as they
were hauling them home. This had probably started our captain; as ``Old
Wilson'' (the captain of the Ayacucho) had been many years on the coast, and
knew the signs of the weather. We soon had the topsails loosed; and one
hand remaining, as usual, in each top, to overhaul the rigging and light
the sail out, the rest of us came down to man the sheets. While sheeting
home, we saw the Ayacucho standing athwart our hawse, sharp upon the wind,
cutting through the head seas like a knife, with her raking masts, and her
sharp bows running up like the head of a greyhound. It was a beautiful sight.
She was like a bird which had been frightened and had spread her wings in
flight. After our topsails had been sheeted home, the head yards
braced aback, the fore-topmast staysail hoisted, and the buoys
streamed, and all ready forward for slipping, we went aft and manned
the slip-rope which came through the stern port with a turn round
the timberheads. ``All ready forward?'' asked the captain. ``Aye,
aye, sir; all ready,'' answered the mate. ``Let go!'' ``All gone, sir'';
and the chain cable grated over the windlass and through the hawse-hole, and
the little vessel's head swinging off from the wind under the force of her
backed head sails brought the strain upon the slip-rope. ``Let go aft!''
Instantly all was gone, and we were under way. As soon as she was well off
from the wind, we filled away the head yards, braced all up sharp, set the
foresail and trysail, and left our anchorage well astern, giving the
point a good berth. ``Nye's off too,'' said the captain to the mate; and,
looking astern, we could just see the little hermaphrodite brig under sail,
standing after us.
It now began to blow fresh; the rain fell fast, and it grew
black; but the captain would not take in sail until we were well clear
of the point. As soon as we left this on our quarter, and were standing
out to sea, the order was given, and we went aloft, double-reefed each
topsail, furled the foresail, and double-reefed the trysail, and were soon
under easy sail. In these cases of slipping for southeasters there is nothing
to be done, after you have got clear of the coast, but to lie-to under easy
sail, and wait for the gale to be over, which seldom lasts more than
two days, and is sometimes over in twelve hours; but the wind never comes
back to the southward until there has a good deal of rain fallen. ``Go below
the watch,'' said the mate; but here was a dispute which watch it should be.
The mate soon settled it by sending his watch below, saying that we should
have our turn the next time we got under way. We remained on deck till
the expiration of the watch, the wind blowing very fresh and the
rain coming down in torrents. When the watch came up, we wore ship,
and stood on the other tack, in towards land. When we came up again, which
was at four in the morning, it was very dark, and there was not much wind,
but it was raining as I thought I had never seen it rain before. We had on
oil-cloth suits and southwester caps, and had nothing to do but to stand bolt
upright and let it pour down upon us. There are no umbrellas, and no sheds to
go under, at sea.
While we were standing about on deck, we saw the little
brig drifting by us, hove to under her fore topsail double reefed; and she
glided by like a phantom. Not a word was spoken, and we saw no one on deck
but the man at the wheel. Toward morning the captain put his head out of the
companion-way and told the second mate, who commanded our watch, to look out
for a change of wind, which usually followed a calm, with heavy rain. It was
well that he did; for in a few minutes it fell dead calm, the vessel lost
her steerage-way, the rain ceased, we hauled up the trysail and courses,
squared the after-yards, and waited for the change, which came in a few
minutes, with a vengeance, from the northwest, the opposite point of the
compass. Owing to our precautions, we were not taken aback, but ran before
the wind with square yards. The captain coming on deck, we braced up a little
and stood back for our anchorage. With the change of wind came a change of
weather, and in two hours the wind moderated into the light steady
breeze, which blows down the coast the greater part of the year, and,
from its regularity, might be called a trade-wind. The sun came up bright,
and we set royals, skysails and studding-sails, and were under fair way for
Santa Barbara. The little Loriotte was astern of us, nearly out of sight; but
we saw nothing of the Ayacucho. In a short time she appeared, standing out
from Santa Rosa Island, under the lee of which she had been hove to all
night. Our captain was eager to get in before her, for it would be a great
credit to us, on the coast, to beat the Ayacucho, which had been called
the best sailer in the North Pacific, in which she had been known as
a trader for six years or more. We had an advantage over her in light
winds, from our royals and skysails which we carried both at the fore and
main, and also from our studding-sails; for Captain Wilson carried nothing
above top-gallant-sails, and always unbent his studding-sails when on the
coast. As the wind was light and fair, we held our own, for some time, when
we were both obliged to brace up and come upon a taut bowline, after rounding
the point; and here he had us on his own ground, and walked away from us,
as you would haul in a line. He afterwards said that we sailed well enough
with the wind free, but that give him a taut bowline, and he would beat us,
if we had all the canvas of the Royal George.
The Ayacucho got to the anchoring ground about half an hour
before us, and was furling her sails when we came to it. This picking
up your cables is a nice piece of work. It requires some seamanship to do
it, and to come-to at your former moorings, without letting go another
anchor. Captain Wilson was remarkable, among the sailors on the coast, for
his skill in doing this; and our captain never let go a second anchor during
all the time that I was with him. Coming a little to windward of our buoy, we
clewed up the light sails, backed our main topsail, and lowered a boat,
which pulled off, and made fast a spare hawser to the buoy on the end
of the slip-rope. We brought the other end to the capstan, and hove in
upon it until we came to the slip-rope, which we took to the windlass, and
walked her up to her chain, occasionally helping her by backing and filling
the sails. The chain is then passed through the hawse-hole and round the
windlass, and bitted, the slip-rope taken round outside and brought into the
stern port, and she is safe in her old berth. After we had got through, the
mate told us that this was a small touch of California, the like of which
we must expect to have through the winter.
After we had furled the sails and got dinner, we saw the
Loriotte nearing, and she had her anchor before night. At sundown we
went ashore again, and found the Loriotte's boat waiting on the beach. The
Sandwich-Islander who could speak English told us that he had been up to the
town; that our agent, Mr. Robinson, and some other passengers, were going to
Monterey with us, and that we were to sail the same night. In a few minutes
Captain Thompson, with two gentlemen and a lady, came down, and we got ready
to go off. They had a good deal of baggage, which we put into the bows of
the boat, and then two of us took the señora in our arms, and waded with
her through the water, and put her down safely in the stern. She appeared
much amused with the transaction, and her husband was perfectly satisfied,
thinking any arrangement good which saved his wetting his feet. I pulled the
after oar, so that I heard the conversation, and learned that one of the men,
who, as well as I could see in the darkness, was a young-looking man, in
the European dress, and covered up in a large cloak, was the agent of the
firm to which our vessel belonged; and the other, who was dressed in the
Spanish dress of the country, was a brother of our captain, who had been many
years a trader on the coast, and that the lady was his wife. She was a
delicate, dark-complexioned young woman, of one of the respectable families
of California. I also found that we were to sail the same night.
As soon as we got on board, the boats were hoisted up, the
sails loosed, the windlass manned, the slip-ropes and gear cast off;
and after about twenty minutes of heaving at the windlass, making sail,
and bracing yards, we were well under way, and going with a fair wind up the
coast to Monterey. The Loriotte got under way at the same time, and was also
bound up to Monterey, but as she took a different course from us, keeping the
land aboard, while we kept well out to sea, we soon lost sight of her. We had
a fair wind, which is something unusual when going up, as the prevailing
wind is the north, which blows directly down the coast; whence
the northern are called the windward, and the southern the
leeward ports.
[1] ``Bear-a-hand'' is to make haste.
CHAPTER XI
We got clear of the islands before sunrise the next morning,
and by twelve o'clock were out of the canal, and off Point Conception, the
place where we first made the land upon our arrival. This is the largest
point on the coast, and is an uninhabited headland, stretching out into the
Pacific, and has the reputation of being very windy. Any vessel does well
which gets by it without a gale, especially in the winter season. We were
going along with studding-sails set on both sides, when, as we came round
the point, we had to haul our wind, and take in the lee studding-sails. As
the brig came more upon the wind, she felt it more, and we doused the
skysails, but kept the weather studding-sails on her, bracing the yards
forward, so that the swinging-boom nearly touched the spritsail yard. She now
lay over to it, the wind was freshening, and the captain was
evidently ``dragging on to her.'' His brother and Mr. Robinson, looking
a little disturbed, said something to him, but he only answered that he
knew the vessel and what she would carry. He was evidently showing off, and
letting them know how he could carry sail. He stood up to windward, holding
on by the backstays, and looking up at the sticks to see how much they would
bear, when a puff came which settled the matter. Then it was ``haul down''
and ``clew up'' royals, flying-jib, and studding-sails, all at once.
There was what the sailors call a ``mess,''—everything let go,
nothing hauled in, and everything flying. The poor Mexican woman came
to the companion-way, looking as pale as a ghost, and nearly frightened to
death. The mate and some men forward were trying to haul in the lower
studding-sail, which had blown over the spritsail yard-arm and round the
guys, while the topmast-studding-sail boom, after buckling up and springing
out again like a piece of whalebone, broke off at the boom-iron. I jumped
aloft to take in the main top-gallant studding-sail, but before I got into
the top the tack parted, and away went the sail, swinging forward of the
top-gallant-sail, and tearing and slatting itself to pieces. The halyards
were at this moment let go by the run, and such a piece of work I never had
before in taking in a sail. After great exertions I got it, or the remains of
it, into the top, and was making it fast, when the captain, looking
up, called out to me, ``Lay aloft there, Dana, and furl that main royal.''
Leaving the studding-sail, I went up to the cross-trees; and here it looked
rather squally. The foot of the top-gallant-mast was working between the
cross and trussel trees, and the mast lay over at a fearful angle with the
topmast below, while everything was working and cracking, strained to the
utmost.
There's nothing for Jack to do but to obey orders, and I went
up upon the yard; and there was a worse mess, if possible, than I had left
below. The braces had been let go, and the yard was swinging about like a
turnpike gate, and the whole sail, having blown out to leeward, the lee leach
was over the yard-arm, and the skysail was all adrift and flying about my
head. I looked down, but it was in vain to attempt to make myself heard, for
every one was busy below, and the wind roared, and sails were flapping in
all directions. Fortunately, it was noon and broad daylight, and the man
at the wheel, who had his eyes aloft, soon saw my difficulty, and after
numberless signs and gestures got some one to haul the necessary ropes taut.
During this interval I took a look below. Everything was in confusion on
deck; the little vessel was tearing through the water as if she had lost her
wits, the seas flying over her, and the masts leaning over at a wide angle
from the vertical. At the other royal-mast-head was Stimson, working
away at the sail, which was blowing from him as fast as he could gather it
in. The top-gallant sail below me was soon clewed up, which relieved the
mast, and in a short time I got my sail furled, and went below; but I lost
overboard a new tarpaulin hat, which troubled me more than anything else. We
worked for about half an hour with might and main; and in an hour from the
time the squall struck us, from having all our flying kites abroad, we came
down to double-reefed topsails and the storm-sails.
The wind had hauled ahead during the squall, and we were
standing directly in for the point. So, as soon as we had got all snug,
we wore round and stood off again, and had the pleasant prospect
of beating up to Monterey, a distance of a hundred miles, against
a violent head wind. Before night it began to rain; and we had five days
of rainy, stormy weather, under close sail all the time, and were blown
several hundred miles off the coast. In the midst of this, we discovered that
our fore topmast was sprung (which no doubt happened in the squall), and were
obliged to send down the fore top-gallant-mast and carry as little sail as
possible forward. Our four passengers were dreadfully sea-sick, so that
we saw little or nothing of them during the five days. On the sixth day it
cleared off, and the sun came out bright, but the wind and sea were still
very high. It was quite like being in mid-ocean again; no land for hundreds
of miles, and the captain taking the sun every day at noon. Our passengers
now made their appearance, and I had for the first time the opportunity of
seeing what a miserable and forlorn creature a sea-sick passenger is. Since
I had got over my own sickness, the third day from Boston, I had seen
nothing but hale, hearty men, with their sea legs on, and able to go anywhere
(for we had no passengers on our voyage out); and I will own there was a
pleasant feeling of superiority in being able to walk the deck, and eat, and
go aloft, and compare one's self with two poor, miserable, pale creatures,
staggering and shuffling about decks, or holding on and looking up with
giddy heads, to see us climbing to the mast-heads, or sitting quietly
at work on the ends of the lofty yards. A well man at sea has
little sympathy with one who is sea-sick; he is apt to be too conscious of
a comparison which seems favorable to his own manhood.
After a few days we made the land at Point Pinos, which is
the headland at the entrance of the bay of Monterey. As we drew in and ran
down the shore, we could distinguish well the face of the country, and found
it better wooded than that to the southward of Point Conception. In fact, as
I afterwards discovered, Point Conception may be made the dividing-line
between two different faces of the country. As you go to the northward of the
point, the country becomes more wooded, has a richer appearance, and
is better supplied with water. This is the case with Monterey, and still
more so with San Francisco; while to the southward of the point, as at Santa
Barbara, San Pedro, and particularly San Diego, there is very little wood,
and the country has a naked, level appearance, though it is still
fertile.
The bay of Monterey is wide at the entrance, being
about twenty-four miles between the two points, Año Nuevo at the
north, and Pinos at the south, but narrows gradually as you approach
the town, which is situated in a bend, or large cove, at the southeastern
extremity, and from the points about eighteen miles, which is the whole depth
of the bay. The shores are extremely well wooded (the pine abounding upon
them), and as it was now the rainy season, everything was as green as nature
could make it,—the grass, the leaves, and all; the birds were singing in
the woods, and great numbers of wild fowl were flying over our heads. Here
we could lie safe from the southeasters. We came to anchor within
two cable lengths of the shore, and the town lay directly before
us, making a very pretty appearance; its houses being of
whitewashed adobe, which gives a much better effect than those of
Santa Barbara, which are mostly left of a mud color. The red tiles,
too, on the roofs, contrasted well with the white sides, and with
the extreme greenness of the lawn upon which the houses—about a hundred
in number—were dotted about, here and there, irregularly. There are in this
place, and in every other town which I saw in California, no streets nor
fences (except that here and there a small patch might be fenced in for a
garden), so that the houses are placed at random upon the green. This, as
they are of one story, and of the cottage form, gives them a pretty
effect when seen from a little distance.
It was a fine Saturday afternoon that we came to anchor, the
sun about an hour high, and everything looking pleasantly. The
Mexican flag was flying from the little square Presidio, and the drums
and trumpets of the soldiers, who were out on parade, sounded over
the water, and gave great life to the scene. Every one was delighted with
the appearance of things. We felt as though we had got into a Christian
(which in the sailor's vocabulary means civilized) country. The first
impression which California had made upon us was very disagreeable,—the
open roadstead of Santa Barbara; anchoring three miles from the shore;
running out to sea before every southeaster; landing in a high surf; with a
little dark-looking town, a mile from the beach; and not a sound to
be heard, nor anything to be seen, but Kanakas, hides, and tallow-bags.
Add to this the gale off Point Conception, and no one can be at a loss to
account for our agreeable disappointment in Monterey. Besides, we soon
learned, which was of no small importance to us, that there was little or no
surf here, and this afternoon the beach was as smooth as a pond.
We landed the agent and passengers, and found several
persons waiting for them on the beach, among whom were some who,
though dressed in the costume of the country, spoke English, and who,
we afterwards learned, were English and Americans who had married
and settled here.
I also connected with our arrival here another circumstance
which more nearly concerns myself; viz., my first act of what the sailors
will allow to be seamanship,—sending down a royal-yard. I had seen it done
once or twice at sea; and an old sailor, whose favor I had taken some pains
to gain, had taught me carefully everything which was necessary to be done,
and in its proper order, and advised me to take the first opportunity when we
were in port, and try it. I told the second mate, with whom I had
been pretty thick when he was before the mast, that I could do it, and got
him to ask the mate to send me up the first time the royal-yards were struck.
Accordingly, I was called upon, and went aloft, repeating the operations over
in my mind, taking care to get each thing in its order, for the slightest
mistake spoils the whole. Fortunately, I got through without any word from
the officer, and heard the ``well done'' of the mate, when the
yard reached the deck, with as much satisfaction as I ever felt
at Cambridge on seeing a ``bene'' at the foot of a Latin
exercise.
CHAPTER XII
The next day being Sunday, which is the liberty-day
among merchantmen, when it is usual to let a part of the crew go
ashore, the sailors had depended upon a holiday, and were
already disputing who should ask to go, when, upon being called in
the morning, we were turned-to upon the rigging, and found that
the top-mast, which had been sprung, was to come down, and a new one to go
up, with top-gallant and royal masts, and the rigging to be set. This was too
bad. If there is anything that irritates sailors, and makes them feel hardly
used, it is being deprived of their Sunday. Not that they would always, or
indeed generally, spend it improvingly, but it is their only day of rest.
Then, too, they are so often necessarily deprived of it by storms,
and unavoidable duties of all kinds, that to take it from them when lying
quietly and safely in port, without any urgent reason, bears the more hardly.
The only reason in this case was, that the captain had determined to have the
custom-house officers on board on Monday, and wished to have his brig in
order. Jack is a slave aboard ship; but still he has many opportunities of
thwarting and balking his master. When there is danger or necessity, or when
he is well used, no one can work faster than he; but the instant he feels
that he is kept at work for nothing, or, as the nautical phrase is,
``humbugged,'' no sloth could make less headway. He must not refuse his duty,
or be in any way disobedient, but all the work that an officer gets out of
him, he may be welcome to. Every man who has been three months at sea knows
how to ``work Tom Cox's traverse''—``three turns round the long-boat, and a
pull at the scuttled butt.'' This morning everything went in this
way. ``Sogering'' was the order of the day. Send a man below to get
a block, and he would capsize everything before finding it, then not bring
it up till an officer had called him twice, and take as much time to put
things in order again. Marline-spikes were not to be found; knives wanted a
prodigious deal of sharpening, and, generally, three or four were waiting
round the grindstone at a time. When a man got to the mast-head, he would
come slowly down again for something he had left; and after the tackles were
got up, six men would pull less than three who pulled ``with a
will.'' When the mate was out of sight, nothing was done. It was
all up-hill work; and at eight o'clock, when we went to breakfast, things
were nearly where they were when we began.
During our short meal the matter was discussed. One
proposed refusing to work; but that was mutiny, and of course was
rejected at once. I remember, too, that one of the men quoted
``Father Taylor'' (as they call the seamen's preacher at Boston), who
told them that, if they were ordered to work on Sunday, they must
not refuse their duty, and the blame would not come upon them.
After breakfast, it leaked out, through the officers, that, if we
would get through work soon, we might have a boat in the afternoon and go
a-fishing. This bait was well thrown, and took with several who were fond of
fishing; and all began to find that as we had one thing to do, and were not
to be kept at work for the day, the sooner we did it the better. Accordingly,
things took a new aspect; and before two o'clock, this work, which was in a
fair way to last two days, was done; and five of us went a-fishing in
the jolly-boat, in the direction of Point Pinos; but leave to go ashore
was refused. Here we saw the Loriotte, which sailed with us from Santa
Barbara, coming slowly in with a light sea-breeze, which sets in towards
afternoon, having been becalmed off the point all the first part of the day.
We took several fish of various kinds, among which cod and perch abounded,
and Foster (the ci-devant second mate), who was of our number, brought up
with his hook a large and beautiful pearl-oyster shell. We
afterwards learned that this place was celebrated for shells, and that
a small schooner had made a good voyage by carrying a cargo of them to the
United States.
We returned by sundown, and found the Loriotte at anchor
within a cable's length of the Pilgrim. The next day we were
``turned-to'' early, and began taking off the hatches, overhauling the
cargo, and getting everything ready for inspection. At eight, the officers
of the customs, five in number, came on board, and began examining the cargo,
manifest, &c. The Mexican revenue laws are very strict, and require the
whole cargo to be landed, examined, and taken on board again; but our agent
had succeeded in compounding for the last two vessels, and saving the trouble
of taking the cargo ashore. The officers were dressed in the costume which
we found prevailed through the country,—broad-brimmed hat, usually of a
black or dark brown color, with a gilt or figured band round the crown, and
lined under the rim with silk; a short jacket of silk, or figured calico (the
European skirted body-coat is never worn); the shirt open in the neck; rich
waistcoat, if any; pantaloons open at the sides below the knee, laced with
gilt, usually of velveteen or broadcloth; or else short breeches and white
stockings. They wear the deer-skin shoe, which is of a dark brown color, and
(being made by Indians) usually a good deal ornamented. They have no
suspenders, but always wear a sash round the waist, which is generally red,
and varying in quality with the means of the wearer. Add to this the
never-failing poncho, or the serapa, and you have the dress of the
Californian. This last garment is always a mark of the rank and wealth of the
owner. The gente de razon, or better sort of people, wear cloaks of black
or dark blue broadcloth, with as much velvet and trimmings as may be; and
from this they go down to the blanket of the Indian, the middle classes
wearing a poncho, something like a large square cloth, with a hole in the
middle for the head to go through. This is often as coarse as a blanket, but
being beautifully woven with various colors, is quite showy at a distance.
Among the Mexicans there is no working class (the Indians being practically
serfs, and doing all the hard work); and every rich man looks like
a grandee, and every poor scamp like a broken-down gentleman. I have often
seen a man with a fine figure and courteous manners, dressed in broadcloth
and velvet, with a noble horse completely covered with trappings, without a
real in his pockets, and absolutely suffering for something to
eat.
CHAPTER XIII
The next day, the cargo having been entered in due form, we
began trading. The trade-room was fitted up in the steerage, and furnished
out with the lighter goods, and with specimens of the rest of the cargo; and
Mellus, a young man who came out from Boston with us before the mast, was
taken out of the forecastle, and made supercargo's clerk. He was well
qualified for this business, having been clerk in a counting-house in Boston;
but he had been troubled for some time with rheumatism, which unfitted him
for the wet and exposed duty of a sailor on the coast. For a week or ten days
all was life on board. The people came off to look and to buy,—men, women,
and children; and we were continually going in the boats, carrying goods and
passengers,— for they have no boats of their own. Everything must dress
itself and come aboard and see the new vessel, if it were only to buy
a paper of pins. The agent and his clerk managed the sales, while we were
busy in the hold or in the boats. Our cargo was an assorted one; that is, it
consisted of everything under the sun. We had spirits of all kinds (sold by
the cask), teas, coffee, sugars, spices, raisins, molasses, hardware,
crockery-ware, tin-ware, cutlery, clothing of all kinds, boots and shoes from
Lynn, calicoes and cotton from Lowell, crapes, silks; also,
shawls, scarfs, necklaces, jewelry, and combs for the women;
furniture; and, in fact, everything that can be imagined, from
Chinese fireworks to English cart-wheels,—of which we had a dozen
pairs with their iron tires on.
The Californians are an idle, thriftless people, and can
make nothing for themselves. The country abounds in grapes, yet they buy,
at a great price, bad wine made in Boston and brought round by us, and retail
it among themselves at a real (12 1/2 cents) by the small wineglass. Their
hides, too, which they value at two dollars in money, they barter for
something which costs seventy-five cents in Boston; and buy shoes (as like as
not made of their own hides, which have been carried twice round Cape Horn)
at three and four dollars, and ``chicken-skin boots'' at fifteen dollars a
pair. Things sell, on an average, at an advance of nearly three
hundred per cent upon the Boston prices. This is partly owing to the
heavy duties which the government, in their wisdom, with an idea,
no doubt, of keeping the silver in the country, has laid upon imports.
These duties, and the enormous expenses of so long a voyage, keep all
merchants but those of heavy capital from engaging in the trade. Nearly two
thirds of all the articles imported into the country from round Cape Horn,
for the last six years, have been by the single house of Bryant, Sturgis,
& Co., to whom our vessel belonged.
This kind of business was new to us, and we liked it very well
for a few days, though we were hard at work every minute from daylight to
dark, and sometimes even later.
By being thus continually engaged in transporting passengers,
with their goods, to and fro, we gained considerable knowledge of
the character, dress, and language of the people. The dress of the men was
as I have before described it. The women wore gowns of various texture,—
silks, crape, calicoes, &c.,—made after the European style, except that
the sleeves were short, leaving the arm bare, and that they were loose about
the waist, corsets not being in use. They wore shoes of kid or satin, sashes
or belts of bright colors, and almost always a necklace and ear-rings.
Bonnets they had none. I only saw one on the coast, and that belonged to
the wife of an American sea-captain who had settled in San Diego, and had
imported the chaotic mass of straw and ribbon, as a choice present to his new
wife. They wear their hair (which is almost invariably black, or a very dark
brown) long in their necks, sometimes loose, and sometimes in long braids;
though the married women often do it up on a high comb. Their only protection
against the sun and weather is a large mantle which they put over
their heads, drawing it close round their faces, when they go out
of doors, which is generally only in pleasant weather. When in the house,
or sitting out in front of it, which they often do in fine weather, they
usually wear a small scarf or neckerchief of a rich pattern. A band, also,
about the top of the head, with a cross, star, or other ornament in front, is
common. Their complexions are various, depending—as well as their dress and
manner—upon the amount of Spanish blood they can lay claim to, which also
settles their social rank. Those who are of pure Spanish blood,
having never intermarried with the aborigines, have clear
brunette complexions, and sometimes even as fair as those of English
women. There are but few of these families in California, being
mostly those in official stations, or who, on the expiration of
their terms of office, have settled here upon property they have acquired;
and others who have been banished for state offences. These form the upper
class, intermarrying, and keeping up an exclusive system in every respect.
They can be distinguished, not only by their complexion, dress, and manners,
but also by their speech; for, calling themselves Castilians, they are
very ambitious of speaking the pure Castilian, while all Spanish is spoken
in a somewhat corrupted dialect by the lower classes. From this upper class,
they go down by regular shades, growing more and more dark and muddy, until
you come to the pure Indian, who runs about with nothing upon him but a small
piece of cloth, kept up by a wide leather strap drawn round his waist.
Generally speaking, each person's caste is decided by the quality of the
blood, which shows itself, too plainly to be concealed, at first sight. Yet
the least drop of Spanish blood, if it be only of quadroon or octoroon, is
sufficient to raise one from the position of a serf, and entitle him to wear
a suit of clothes,—boots, hat, cloak, spurs, long knife, all complete,
though coarse and dirty as may be,—and to call himself Español, and to hold
property, if he can get any.
The fondness for dress among the women is excessive, and
is sometimes their ruin. A present of a fine mantle, or of a necklace or
pair of ear-rings, gains the favor of the greater part. Nothing is more
common than to see a woman living in a house of only two rooms, with the
ground for a floor, dressed in spangled satin shoes, silk gown, high comb,
and gilt, if not gold, ear-rings and necklace. If their husbands do not dress
them well enough, they will soon receive presents from others. They used to
spend whole days on board our vessel, examining the fine clothes
and ornaments, and frequently making purchases at a rate which would have
made a seamstress or waiting-maid in Boston open her eyes.
Next to the love of dress, I was most struck with the fineness
of the voices and beauty of the intonations of both sexes. Every common
ruffian-looking fellow, with a slouched hat, blanket cloak, dirty
under-dress, and soiled leather leggins, appeared to me to be speaking
elegant Spanish. It was a pleasure simply to listen to the sound of the
language, before I could attach any meaning to it. They have a good deal of
the Creole drawl, but it is varied by an occasional extreme rapidity of
utterance, in which they seem to skip from consonant to consonant, until,
lighting upon a broad, open vowel, they rest upon that to restore the balance
of sound. The women carry this peculiarity of speaking to a much
greater extreme than the men, who have more evenness and stateliness
of utterance. A common bullock-driver, on horseback, delivering a message,
seemed to speak like an ambassador at a royal audience. In fact, they
sometimes appeared to me to be a people on whom a curse had fallen, and
stripped them of everything but their pride, their manners, and their
voices.
Another thing that surprised me was the quantity of silver
in circulation. I never, in my life, saw so much silver at one time, as
during the week that we were at Monterey. The truth is, they have no credit
system, no banks, and no way of investing money but in cattle. Besides
silver, they have no circulating medium but hides, which the sailors call
``California bank-notes.'' Everything that they buy they must pay for by one
or the other of these means. The hides they bring down dried and doubled,
in clumsy ox-carts, or upon mules' backs, and the money they carry tied up
in a handkerchief, fifty or a hundred dollars and half-dollars.
I had not studied Spanish at college, and could not speak a
word when at Juan Fernandez; but, during the latter part of the
passage out, I borrowed a grammar and dictionary from the cabin, and by
a continual use of these, and a careful attention to every word that I
heard spoken, I soon got a vocabulary together, and began talking for myself.
As I soon knew more Spanish than any of the crew (who, indeed, knew none at
all), and had studied Latin and French, I got the name of a great linguist,
and was always sent by the captain and officers for provisions, or to take
letters and messages to different parts of the town. I was often sent
for something which I could not tell the name of to save my life; but I
liked the business, and accordingly never pleaded ignorance. Sometimes I
managed to jump below and take a look at my dictionary before going ashore;
or else I overhauled some English resident on my way, and learned the word
from him; and then, by signs, and by giving a Latin or French word a twist at
the end, contrived to get along. This was a good exercise for me, and no
doubt taught me more than I should have learned by months of study and
reading; it also gave me opportunities of seeing the customs, characters,
and domestic arrangements of the people, beside being a great relief from
the monotony of a day spent on board ship.
Monterey, as far as my observation goes, is decidedly
the pleasantest and most civilized-looking place in California. In
the centre of it is an open square, surrounded by four lines of one-story
buildings, with half a dozen cannon in the centre; some mounted, and others
not. This is the Presidio, or fort. Every town has a presidio in its centre;
or rather every presidio has a town built around it; for the forts were first
built by the Mexican government, and then the people built near them, for
protection. The presidio here was entirely open and unfortified. There
were several officers with long titles, and about eighty soldiers,
but they were poorly paid, fed, clothed, and disciplined.
The governor-general, or, as he is commonly called, the ``general,'' lives
here, which makes it the seat of government. He is appointed by the central
government at Mexico, and is the chief civil and military officer. In
addition to him, each town has a commandant who is its chief officer, and has
charge of the fort, and of all transactions with foreigners and foreign
vessels; while two or three alcaldes and corregidores, elected by the
inhabitants, are the civil officers. Courts strictly of law, with a system
of jurisprudence, they have not. Small municipal matters are regulated by
the alcaldes and corregidores, and everything relating to the general
government, to the military, and to foreigners, by the commandants, acting
under the governor-general. Capital cases are decided by the latter, upon
personal inspection, if near; or upon minutes sent him by the proper
officers, if the offender is at a distant place. No Protestant has any
political rights, nor can he hold property, or, indeed, remain more than
a few weeks on shore, unless he belong to a foreign vessel. Consequently,
Americans and English, who intend to reside here, become Papists,—the
current phrase among them being, ``A man must leave his conscience at Cape
Horn.''
But, to return to Monterey. The houses here, as everywhere
else in California, are of one story, built of adobes, that is, clay
made into large bricks, about a foot and a half square, and three or four
inches thick, and hardened in the sun. These are joined together by a cement
of the same material, and the whole are of a common dirt-color. The floors
are generally of earth, the windows grated and without glass; and the doors,
which are seldom shut, open directly into the common room, there being no
entries. Some of the more wealthy inhabitants have glass to their windows
and board floors; and in Monterey nearly all the houses are whitewashed on
the outside. The better houses, too, have red tiles upon the roofs. The
common ones have two or three rooms which open into each other, and are
furnished with a bed or two, a few chairs and tables, a looking-glass, a
crucifix, and small daubs of paintings enclosed in glass, representing some
miracle or martyrdom. They have no chimneys or fireplaces in the houses,
the climate being such as to make a fire unnecessary; and all
their cooking is done in a small kitchen, separated from the house.
The Indians, as I have said before, do all the hard work, two or
three being attached to the better house; and the poorest persons are able
to keep one, at least, for they have only to feed them, and give them a small
piece of coarse cloth and a belt for the men, and a coarse gown, without
shoes or stockings, for the women.
In Monterey there are a number of English and Americans
(English or Ingles all are called who speak the English language) who
have married Californians, become united to the Roman Church, and acquired
considerable property. Having more industry, frugality, and enterprise than
the natives, they soon get nearly all the trade into their hands. They
usually keep shops, in which they retail the goods purchased in larger
quantities from our vessels, and also send a good deal into the interior,
taking hides in pay, which they again barter with our ships. In every town on
the coast there are foreigners engaged in this kind of trade, while
I recollect but two shops kept by natives. The people are
naturally suspicious of foreigners, and they would not be allowed to
remain, were it not that they conform to the Church, and by
marrying natives, and bringing up their children as Roman Catholics
and Mexicans, and not teaching them the English language, they
quiet suspicion, and even become popular and leading men. The
chief alcaldes in Monterey and Santa Barbara were Yankees by
birth.
The men in Monterey appeared to me to be always on
horseback. Horses are as abundant here as dogs and chickens were in
Juan Fernandez. There are no stables to keep them in, but they are allowed
to run wild and graze wherever they please, being branded, and having long
leather ropes, called lassos, attached to their necks and dragging along
behind them, by which they can be easily taken. The men usually catch one in
the morning, throw a saddle and bridle upon him, and use him for the day, and
let him go at night, catching another the next day. When they go on
long journeys, they ride one horse down, and catch another, throw
the saddle and bridle upon him, and, after riding him down, take a third,
and so on to the end of the journey. There are probably no better riders in
the world. They are put upon a horse when only four or five years old, their
little legs not long enough to come half-way over his sides, and may almost
be said to keep on him until they have grown to him. The stirrups are covered
or boxed up in front, to prevent their catching when riding through the
woods; and the saddles are large and heavy, strapped very tight upon
the horse, and have large pommels, or loggerheads, in front, round which
the lasso is coiled when not in use. They can hardly go from one house to
another without mounting a horse, there being generally several standing tied
to the door-posts of the little cottages. When they wish to show their
activity, they make no use of their stirrups in mounting, but, striking the
horse, spring into the saddle as he starts, and, sticking their long spurs
into him, go off on the full run. Their spurs are cruel things,
having four or five rowels, each an inch in length, dull and rusty.
The flanks of the horses are often sore from them, and I have seen
men come in from chasing bullocks, with their horses' hind legs
and quarters covered with blood. They frequently give exhibitions of their
horsemanship in races, bull-baitings, &c.; but as we were not ashore
during any holiday, we saw nothing of it. Monterey is also a great place for
cock-fighting, gambling of all sorts, fandangos, and various kinds of
amusement and knavery. Trappers and hunters, who occasionally arrive here
from over the Rocky Mountains, with their valuable skins and furs, are
often entertained with amusements and dissipation, until they have wasted
their opportunities and their money, and then go back, stripped of
everything.
Nothing but the character of the people prevents Monterey
from becoming a large town. The soil is as rich as man could wish, climate
as good as any in the world, water abundant, and situation extremely
beautiful. The harbor, too, is a good one, being subject only to one bad
wind, the north; and though the holding-ground is not the best, yet I heard
of but one vessel's being driven ashore here. That was a Mexican brig, which
went ashore a few months before our arrival, and was a total wreck, all the
crew but one being drowned. Yet this was owing to the carelessness or
ignorance of the captain, who paid out all his small cable before he let
go his other anchor. The ship Lagoda, of Boston, was there at the time,
and rode out the gale in safety, without dragging at all, or finding it
necessary to strike her top-gallant-masts.
The only vessel in port with us was the little Loriotte.
I frequently went on board her, and became well acquainted with
her Sandwich Island crew. One of them could speak a little English, and
from him I learned a good deal about them. They were well formed and active,
with black eyes, intelligent countenances, dark olive, or, I should rather
say, copper complexions, and coarse black hair, but not woolly, like the
negroes. They appeared to be talking continually. In the forecastle there was
a complete Babel. Their language is extremely guttural, and not pleasant at
first, but improves as you hear it more; and it is said to
have considerable capacity. They use a good deal of gesticulation, and are
exceedingly animated, saying with their might what their tongues find to say.
They are complete water-dogs, and therefore very good in boating. It is for
this reason that there are so many of them on the coast of California, they
being very good hands in the surf. They are also ready and active in the
rigging, and good hands in warm weather; but those who have been with them
round Cape Horn, and in high latitudes, say that they are of little use in
cold weather. In their dress, they are precisely like our sailors. In
addition to these Islanders, the Loriotte had two English sailors, who acted
as boatswains over the Islanders, and took care of the rigging. One of them I
shall always remember as the best specimen of the thoroughbred English sailor
that I ever saw. He had been to sea from a boy, having served a
regular apprenticeship of seven years, as English sailors are obliged
to do, and was then about four or five and twenty. He was tall; but you
only perceived it when he was standing by the side of others, for the great
breadth of his shoulders and chest made him appear but little above the
middle height. His chest was as deep as it was wide, his arm like that of
Hercules, and his hand ``the fist of a tar—every hair a rope-yarn.'' With
all this, he had one of the pleasantest smiles I ever saw. His cheeks were of
a handsome brown, his teeth brilliantly white, and his hair, of a
raven black, waved in loose curls all over his head and fine,
open forehead; and his eyes he might have sold to a duchess at the price
of diamonds, for their brilliancy. As for their color, every change of
position and light seemed to give them a new hue; but their prevailing color
was black, or nearly so. Take him with his well-varnished black tarpaulin,
stuck upon the back of his head, his long locks coming down almost into his
eyes, his white duck trousers and shirt, blue jacket, and black kerchief,
tied loosely round his neck, and he was a fine specimen of manly beauty. On
his broad chest was stamped with India ink ``Parting moments,''—a ship
ready to sail, a boat on the beach, and a girl and her sailor lover taking
their farewell. Underneath were printed the initials of his own name, and two
other letters, standing for some name which he knew better than I. The
printing was very well done, having been executed by a man who made it his
business to print with India ink, for sailors, at Havre. On one of his broad
arms he had a crucifix, and on the other, the sign of the ``foul
anchor.''
He was fond of reading, and we lent him most of the books
which we had in the forecastle, which he read and returned to us the
next time we fell in with him. He had a good deal of information, and his
captain said he was a perfect seaman, and worth his weight in gold on board a
vessel, in fair weather and in foul. His strength must have been great, and
he had the sight of a vulture. It is strange that one should be so minute in
the description of an unknown, outcast sailor, whom one may never see again,
and whom no one may care to hear about; yet so it is. Some persons we
see under no remarkable circumstances, but whom, for some reason or other,
we never forget. He called himself Bill Jackson; and I know no one of all my
accidental acquaintances to whom I would more gladly give a shake of the hand
than to him. Whoever falls in with him will find a handsome, hearty fellow,
and a good shipmate.
Sunday came again while we were at Monterey; but, as before,
it brought us no holiday. The people on shore dressed and came off
in greater numbers than ever, and we were employed all day in boating and
breaking out cargo, so that we had hardly time to eat. Our former second
mate, who was determined to get liberty if it was to be had, dressed himself
in a long coat and black hat, and polished his shoes, and went aft, and asked
to go ashore. He could not have done a more imprudent thing; for he knew that
no liberty would be given; and besides, sailors, however sure they may be of
having liberty granted them, always go aft in their working clothes,
to appear as though they had no reason to expect anything, and then wash,
dress, and shave after the matter is settled. But this poor fellow was always
getting into hot water, and if there was a wrong way of doing a thing, was
sure to hit upon it. We looked to see him go aft, knowing pretty well what
his reception would be. The captain was walking the quarter-deck, smoking his
morning cigar, and Foster went as far as the break of the deck, and there
waited for him to notice him. The captain took two or three turns,
and then, walking directly up to him, surveyed him from head to foot, and,
lifting up his forefinger, said a word or two, in a tone too low for us to
hear, but which had a magical effect upon poor Foster. He walked forward,
jumped down into the forecastle, and in a moment more made his appearance in
his common clothes, and went quietly to work again. What the captain said to
him, we never could get him to tell, but it certainly changed him outwardly
and inwardly in a surprising manner.
CHAPTER XIV
After a few days, finding the trade beginning to slacken, we
hove our anchor up, set our topsails, ran the stars and stripes up to the
peak, fired a gun, which was returned from the presidio, and left the little
town astern, standing out of the bay, and bearing down the coast again for
Santa Barbara. As we were now going to leeward, we had a fair wind, and a
plenty of it. After doubling Point Pinos, we bore up, set studding-sails alow
and aloft, and were walking off at the rate of eight or nine knots, promising
to traverse in twenty-four hours the distance which we were nearly three
weeks in traversing on the passage up. We passed Point Conception at a flying
rate, the wind blowing so that it would have seemed half a gale to us if we
had been going the other way and close hauled. As we drew near the islands of
Santa Barbara, it died away a little, but we came-to at our old anchoring
ground in less than thirty hours from the time of leaving
Monterey.
Here everything was pretty much as we left it,—the large
bay without a vessel in it, the surf roaring and rolling in upon
the beach, the white Mission, the dark town, and the high,
treeless mountains. Here, too, we had our southeaster tacks aboard
again,— slip-ropes, buoy-ropes, sails furled with reefs in them,
and rope-yarns for gaskets. We lay at this place about a
fortnight, employed in landing goods and taking off hides, occasionally,
when the surf was not high; but there did not appear to be one half
the business doing here that there was in Monterey. In fact, so far as we
were concerned, the town might almost as well have been in the middle of the
Cordilleras. We lay at a distance of three miles from the beach, and the town
was nearly a mile farther, so that we saw little or nothing of it.
Occasionally we landed a few goods, which were taken away by Indians in
large, clumsy ox-carts, with the bow of the yoke on the ox's neck instead of
under it, and with small solid wheels. A few hides were brought down, which
we carried off in the California style. This we had now got pretty well
accustomed to, and hardened to also; for it does require a little hardening,
even to the toughest.
The hides are brought down dry, or they will not be received.
When they are taken from the animal, they have holes cut in the ends, and
are staked out, and thus dried in the sun without shrinking. They are then
doubled once, lengthwise, with the hair side usually in, and sent down upon
mules or in carts, and piled above high-water mark; and then we take them
upon our heads, one at a time, or two, if they are small, and wade out with
them and throw them into the boat, which, as there are no wharves, we
usually kept anchored by a small kedge, or keelek, just outside of
the surf. We all provided ourselves with thick Scotch caps, which would be
soft to the head, and at the same time protect it; for we soon learned that,
however it might look or feel at first, the ``head-work'' was the only system
for California. For besides that the seas, breaking high, often obliged us to
carry the hides so, in order to keep them dry, we found that, as they were
very large and heavy, and nearly as stiff as boards, it was the only way
that we could carry them with any convenience to ourselves. Some of
the crew tried other expedients, saying that that looked too much
like West India negroes; but they all came to it at last. The great art is
in getting them on the head. We had to take them from the ground, and as they
were often very heavy, and as wide as the arms could stretch, and were easily
taken by the wind, we used to have some trouble with them. I have often been
laughed at myself, and joined in laughing at others, pitching ourselves down
in the sand, in trying to swing a large hide upon our heads, or nearly
blown over with one in a little gust of wind. The captain made it
harder for us, by telling us that it was ``California fashion'' to
carry two on the head at a time; and as he insisted upon it, and we
did not wish to be outdone by other vessels, we carried two for the first
few months; but after falling in with a few other ``hide droghers,'' and
finding that they carried only one at a time, we ``knocked off'' the extra
one, and thus made our duty somewhat easier.
After our heads had become used to the weight, and we had
learned the true California style of tossing a hide, we could carry
off two or three hundred in a short time, without much trouble; but it was
always wet work, and, if the beach was stony, bad for our feet; for we, of
course, went barefooted on this duty, as no shoes could stand such constant
wetting with salt water. And after this, we had a pull of three miles, with a
loaded boat, which often took a couple of hours.
We had now got well settled down into our harbor duties,
which, as they are a good deal different from those at sea, it may be
well enough to describe. In the first place, all hands are called
at daylight, or rather—especially if the days are short—
before daylight, as soon as the first gray of the morning. The cook
makes his fire in the galley; the steward goes about his work in
the cabin; and the crew rig the head pump, and wash down the decks. The
chief mate is always on deck, but takes no active part, all the duty coming
upon the second mate, who has to roll up his trousers and paddle about decks
barefooted, like the rest of the crew. The washing, swabbing, squilgeeing,
&c. lasts, or is made to last, until eight o'clock, when breakfast is
ordered, fore and aft. After breakfast, for which half an hour is allowed,
the boats are lowered down, and made fast astern, or out to the
swinging booms by geswarps, and the crew are turned-to upon their
day's work. This is various, and its character depends upon circumstances.
There is always more or less of boating, in small boats; and if heavy goods
are to be taken ashore, or hides are brought down to the beach for us, then
all hands are sent ashore with an officer in the long-boat. Then there is a
good deal to be done in the hold,—goods to be broken out, and cargo to
be shifted, to make room for hides, or to keep the trim of the vessel. In
addition to this, the usual work upon the rigging must be going on. There is
much of the latter kind of work which can only be done when the vessel is in
port. Everything, too, must be kept taut and in good order,—spun-yarn made,
chafing gear repaired, and all the other ordinary work. The great
difference between sea and harbor duty is in the division of time. Instead
of having a watch on deck and a watch below, as at sea, all hands are at
work together, except at mealtimes, from daylight till dark; and at night an
``anchor watch'' is kept, which, with us, consisted of only two at a time,
all the crew taking turns. An hour is allowed for dinner, and at dark the
decks are cleared up, the boats hoisted, supper ordered; and at eight the
lights are put out, except in the binnacle, where the glass stands; and
the anchor watch is set. Thus, when at anchor, the crew have more time at
night (standing watch only about two hours), but have no time to themselves
in the day; so that reading, mending clothes, &c., has to be put off
until Sunday, which is usually given. Some religious captains give their
crews Saturday afternoons to do their washing and mending in, so that they
may have their Sundays free. This is a good arrangement, and goes far to
account for the preference sailors usually show for vessels under such
command. We were well satisfied if we got even Sunday to ourselves; for,
if any hides came down on that day, as was often the case when they were
brought from a distance, we were obliged to take them off, which usually
occupied half a day; besides, as we now lived on fresh beef, and ate one
bullock a week, the animal was almost always brought down on Sunday, and we
had to go ashore, kill it, dress it, and bring it aboard, which was another
interruption. Then, too, our common day's work was protracted and made
more fatiguing by hides coming down late in the afternoon, which sometimes
kept us at work in the surf by starlight, with the prospect of pulling on
board, and stowing them all away, before supper.
But all these little vexations and labors would have been
nothing,— they would have been passed by as the common evils of a
sea life, which every sailor, who is a man, will go through
without complaint,—were it not for the uncertainty, or worse
than uncertainty, which hung over the nature and length of our
voyage. Here we were, in a little vessel, with a small crew, on
a half-civilized coast, at the ends of the earth, and with a prospect of
remaining an indefinite period,—two or three years at the least. When we
left Boston, we supposed that ours was to be a voyage of eighteen months, or
two years, at most; but, upon arriving on the coast, we learned something
more of the trade, and found that, in the scarcity of hides, which was yearly
greater and greater, it would take us a year, at least, to collect our
own cargo, beside the passage out and home; and that we were also
to collect a cargo for a large ship belonging to the same firm, which was
soon to come on the coast, and to which we were to act as tender. We had
heard rumors of such a ship to follow us, which had leaked out from the
captain and mate, but we passed them by as mere ``yarns,'' till our arrival,
when they were confirmed by the letters which we brought from the owners to
their agent. The ship California, belonging to the same firm, had been nearly
two years on the coast getting a full cargo, and was now at San Diego,
from which port she was expected to sail in a few weeks for Boston; and we
were to collect all the hides we could, and deposit them at San Diego, when
the new ship, which would carry forty thousand, was to be filled and sent
home; and then we were to begin anew upon our own cargo. Here was a gloomy
prospect indeed. The Lagoda, a smaller ship than the California, carrying
only thirty-one or thirty-two thousand, had been two years getting her cargo;
and we were to collect a cargo of forty thousand beside our own,
which would be twelve or fifteen thousand; and hides were said to
be growing scarcer. Then, too, this ship, which had been to us a worse
phantom than any flying Dutchman, was no phantom, or ideal thing, but had
been reduced to a certainty; so much so that a name was given her, and it was
said that she was to be the Alert, a well-known Indiaman, which was expected
in Boston in a few months, when we sailed. There could be no doubt, and all
looked black enough. Hints were thrown out about three years and four
years; the older sailors said they never should see Boston again,
but should lay their bones in California; and a cloud seemed to hang over
the whole voyage. Besides, we were not provided for so long a voyage, and
clothes, and all sailors' necessaries, were excessively dear,—three or four
hundred per cent advance upon the Boston prices. This was bad enough for the
crew; but still worse was it for me, who did not mean to be a sailor for
life, having intended only to be gone eighteen months or two years. Three
or four years might make me a sailor in every respect, mind and habits, as
well as body, nolens volens, and would put all my companions so far ahead of
me that a college degree and a profession would be in vain to think of; and I
made up my mind that, feel as I might, a sailor I might have to be, and to
command a merchant vessel might be the limit of my ambition.
Beside the length of the voyage, and the hard and exposed
life, we were in the remote parts of the earth, on an almost desert
coast, in a country where there is neither law nor gospel, and
where sailors are at their captain's mercy, there being no
American consul, or any one to whom a complaint could be made. We lost
all interest in the voyage, cared nothing about the cargo, which we were
only collecting for others, began to patch our clothes, and felt as though
our fate was fixed beyond all hope of change.
In addition to, and perhaps partly as a consequence of, this
state of things, there was trouble brewing on board the vessel. Our
mate (as the first mate is always called, par excellence) was a
worthy man.—a more honest, upright, and kind-hearted man I never
saw,— but he was too easy and amiable for the mate of a merchantman.
He was not the man to call a sailor a ``son of a bitch,'' and knock him
down with a handspike. Perhaps he really lacked the energy and spirit for
such a voyage as ours, and for such a captain. Captain Thompson was a
vigorous, energetic fellow. As sailors say, ``he hadn't a lazy bone in him.''
He was made of steel and whalebone. He was a man to ``toe the mark,'' and to
make every one else step up to it. During all the time that I was with him, I
never saw him sit down on deck. He was always active and driving, severe in
his discipline, and expected the same of his officers. The mate not being
enough of a driver for him, he was dissatisfied with him, became suspicious
that discipline was getting relaxed, and began to interfere in everything. He
drew the reins tighter; and as, in all quarrels between officers, the sailors
side with the one who treats them best, he became suspicious of the crew. He
saw that things went wrong,—that nothing was done ``with a will''; and
in his attempt to remedy the difficulty by severity he made everything
worse. We were in all respects unfortunately situated,— captain, officers,
and crew, entirely unfitted for one another; and every circumstance and event
was like a two-edged sword, and cut both ways. The length of the voyage,
which made us dissatisfied, made the captain, at the same time, see
the necessity of order and strict discipline; and the nature of
the country, which caused us to feel that we had nowhere to go
for redress, but were at the mercy of a hard master, made the
captain understand, on the other hand, that he must depend entirely
upon his own resources. Severity created discontent, and signs
of discontent provoked severity. Then, too, ill-treatment
and dissatisfaction are no ``linimenta laborum''; and many a time have I
heard the sailors say that they should not mind the length of the voyage, and
the hardships, if they were only kindly treated, and if they could feel that
something was done to make work lighter and life easier. We felt as though
our situation was a call upon our superiors to give us occasional
relaxations, and to make our yoke easier. But the opposite policy was
pursued. We were kept at work all day when in port; which, together with a
watch at night, made us glad to turn-in as soon as we got below. Thus
we had no time for reading, or—which was of more importance to us— for
washing and mending our clothes. And then, when we were at sea, sailing from
port to port, instead of giving us ``watch and watch,'' as was the custom on
board every other vessel on the coast, we were all kept on deck and at work,
rain or shine, making spun-yarn and rope, and at other work in good weather,
and picking oakum, when it was too wet for anything else. All hands
were called to ``come up and see it rain,'' and kept on deck hour
after hour in a drenching rain, standing round the deck so far apart so as
to prevent our talking with one another, with our tarpaulins and oil-cloth
jackets on, picking old rope to pieces, or laying up gaskets and robands.
This was often done, too, when we were lying in port with two anchors down,
and no necessity for more than one man on deck as a lookout. This is what is
called ``hazing'' a crew, and ``working their old iron up.''
While lying at Santa Barbara, we encountered another
southeaster; and, like the first, it came on in the night; the great
black clouds moving round from the southward, covering the mountain,
and hanging down over the town, appearing almost to rest upon the roofs of
the houses. We made sail, slipped our cable, cleared the point, and beat
about for four days in the offing, under close sail, with continual rain and
high seas and winds. No wonder, thought we, they have no rain in the other
seasons, for enough seemed to have fallen in those four days to last through
a common summer. On the fifth day it cleared up, after a few hours, as
is usual, of rain coming down like a four hours' shower-bath, and we found
ourselves drifted nearly ten leagues from the anchorage; and, having light
head winds, we did not return until the sixth day. Having recovered our
anchor, we made preparations for getting under way to go down to leeward. We
had hoped to go directly to San Diego, and thus fall in with the California
before she sailed for Boston; but our orders were to stop at an intermediate
port called San Pedro; and, as we were to lie there a week or two, and the
California was to sail in a few days, we lost the opportunity. Just before
sailing, the captain took on board a short, red-haired, round-shouldered,
vulgar-looking fellow, who had lost one eye and squinted with the other, and,
introducing him as Mr. Russell, told us that he was an officer on board. This
was too bad. We had lost overboard, on the passage, one of the best of
our number, another had been taken from us and appointed clerk, and thus
weakened and reduced, instead of shipping some hands to make our work easier,
he had put another officer over us, to watch and drive us. We had now four
officers, and only six in the forecastle. This was bringing her too much down
by the stern for our comfort.
Leaving Santa Barbara, we coasted along down, the
country appearing level or moderately uneven, and, for the most
part, sandy and treeless; until, doubling a high sandy point, we let
go our anchor at a distance of three or three and a half miles from shore.
It was like a vessel bound to St. John's, Newfoundland, coming to anchor on
the Grand Banks; for the shore, being low, appeared to be at a greater
distance than it actually was, and we thought we might as well have stayed at
Santa Barbara, and sent our boat down for the hides. The land was of a clayey
quality, and, as far as the eye could reach, entirely bare of trees
and even shrubs; and there was no sign of a town,—not even a house to be
seen. What brought us into such a place, we could not conceive. No sooner had
we come to anchor, than the slip-rope, and the other preparations for
southeasters, were got ready; and there was reason enough for it, for we lay
exposed to every wind that could blow, except the northerly winds, and they
came over a flat country with a rake of more than a league of water. As soon
as everything was snug on board, the boat was lowered, and we
pulled ashore, our new officer, who had been several times in the
port before, taking the place of steersman. As we drew in, we found
the tide low, and the rocks and stones, covered with kelp and
seaweed, lying bare for the distance of nearly an eighth of a mile.
Leaving the boat, and picking our way barefooted over these, we came
to what is called the landing-place, at high-water mark. The soil was, at
it appeared at first, loose and clayey, and, except the stalks of the mustard
plant, there was no vegetation. Just in front of the landing, and immediately
over it, was a small hill, which, from its being not more than thirty or
forty feet high, we had not perceived from our anchorage. Over this hill we
saw three men coming down, dressed partly like sailors and partly
like Californians; one of them having on a pair of untanned
leather trousers and a red baize shirt. When they reached us, we
found that they were Englishmen. They told us that they had belonged to a
small Mexican brig which had been driven ashore here in a southeaster, and
now lived in a small house just over the hill. Going up this hill with them,
we saw, close behind it, a small, low building, with one room, containing a
fireplace, cooking-apparatus, &c., and the rest of it unfinished, and
used as a place to store hides and goods. This, they told us, was built
by some traders in the Pueblo (a town about thirty miles in the interior,
to which this was the port), and used by them as a storehouse, and also as a
lodging-place when they came down to trade with the vessels. These three men
were employed by them to keep the house in order, and to look out for the
things stored in it. They said that they had been there nearly a year; had
nothing to do most of the time, living upon beef, hard bread,
and fríjoles, a peculiar kind of bean, very abundant in California. The
nearest house, they told us, was a Rancho, or cattle-farm, about three miles
off; and one of them went there, at the request of our officer, to order a
horse to be sent down, with which the agent, who was on board, might go up to
the Pueblo. From one of them, who was an intelligent English sailor, I
learned a good deal, in a few minutes' conversation, about the place, its
trade, and the news from the southern ports. San Diego, he said, was about
eighty miles to the leeward of San Pedro; that they had heard from there, by
a Mexican who came up on horseback, that the California had sailed for
Boston, and that the Lagoda, which had been in San Pedro only a few weeks
before, was taking in her cargo for Boston. The Ayacucho was also there,
loading for Callao; and the little Loriotte, which had run directly down from
Monterey, where we left her. San Diego, he told me, was a small, snug
place, having very little trade, but decidedly the best harbor on
the coast, being completely land-locked, and the water as smooth as
a duck-pond. This was the depot for all the vessels engaged in the trade;
each one having a large house there, built of rough boards, in which they
stowed their hides as fast as they collected them in their trips up and down
the coast, and when they had procured a full cargo, spent a few weeks there
taking it in, smoking ship, laying in wood and water, and making other
preparations for the voyage home. The Lagoda was now about this business.
When we should be about it was more than I could tell,—two years,
at least, I thought to myself.
I also learned, to my surprise, that the desolate-looking
place we were in furnished more hides than any port on the coast. It
was the only port for a distance of eighty miles, and about thirty miles
in the interior was a fine plane country, filled with herds of cattle, in the
centre of which was the Pueblo de los Angeles,— the largest town in
California,—and several of the wealthiest missions; to all of which San
Pedro was the seaport.
Having made arrangements for a horse to take the agent to
the Pueblo the next day, we picked our way again over the green, slippery
rocks, and pulled toward the brig, which was so far off that we could hardly
see her, in the increasing darkness; and when we got on board the boats were
hoisted up, and the crew at supper. Going down into the forecastle, eating
our supper, and lighting our cigars and pipes, we had, as usual, to tell what
we had seen or heard ashore. We all agreed that it was the worst place we
had seen yet, especially for getting off hides, and our lying off at so
great a distance looked as though it was bad for southeasters. After a few
disputes as to whether we should have to carry our goods up the hill, or not,
we talked of San Diego, the probability of seeing the Lagoda before she
sailed, &c., &c.
The next day we pulled the agent ashore, and he went up to
visit the Pueblo and the neighboring missions; and in a few days, as
the result of his labors, large ox-carts, and droves of mules, loaded with
hides, were seen coming over the flat country. We loaded our long-boat with
goods of all kinds, light and heavy, and pulled ashore. After landing and
rolling them over the stones upon the beach, we stopped, waiting for the
carts to come down the hill and take them; but the captain soon settled the
matter by ordering us to carry them all up to the top, saying that that was
``California fashion.'' So, what the oxen would not do, we were obliged to
do. The hill was low, but steep, and the earth, being clayey and wet with
the recent rains, was but bad holding ground for our feet. The heavy barrels
and casks we rolled up with some difficulty, getting behind and putting our
shoulders to them; now and then our feet, slipping, added to the danger of
the casks rolling back upon us. But the greatest trouble was with the large
boxes of sugar. These we had to place upon oars, and, lifting them up, rest
the oars upon our shoulders, and creep slowly up the hill with the gait of
a funeral procession. After an hour or two of hard work, we got them all up,
and found the carts standing full of hides, which we had to unload, and to
load the carts again with our own goods; the lazy Indians, who came down with
them, squatting on their hams, looking on, doing nothing, and when we asked
them to help us, only shaking their heads, or drawling out ``no
quiero.''
Having loaded the carts, we started up the Indians, who went
off, one on each side of the oxen, with long sticks, sharpened at the end,
to punch them with. This is one of the means of saving labor in California,—
two Indians to two oxen. Now, the hides were to be got down; and for this
purpose we brought the boat round to a place where the hill was steeper, and
threw them off, letting them slide over the slope. Many of them lodged, and
we had to let ourselves down and set them a-going again, and in this way
became covered with dust, and our clothes torn. After we had the hides all
down, we were obliged to take them on our heads, and walk over the stones,
and through the water, to the boat. The water and the stones together would
wear out a pair of shoes a day, and as shoes were very scarce and very dear,
we were compelled to go barefooted. At night we went on board, having had the
hardest and most disagreeable day's work that we had yet experienced.
For several days we were employed in this manner, until we had
landed forty or fifty tons of goods, and brought on board about
two thousand hides, when the trade began to slacken, and we were kept at
work on board during the latter part of the week, either in the hold or upon
the rigging. On Thursday night there was a violent blow from the northward;
but as this was off-shore, we had only to let go our other anchor and hold
on. We were called up at night to send down the royal-yards. It was as dark
as a pocket, and the vessel pitching at her anchors. I went up to the fore,
and Stimson to the main, and we soon had them down ``ship-shape and
Bristol fashion''; for, as we had now become used to our duty
aloft, everything above the cross-trees was left to us, who were
the youngest of the crew, except one boy.
CHAPTER XV
For several days the captain seemed very much out of
humor. Nothing went right, or fast enough for him. He quarrelled with
the cook, and threatened to flog him for throwing wood on deck, and had a
dispute with the mate about reeving a Spanish burton; the mate saying that he
was right, and had been taught how to do it by a man who was a sailor! This
the captain took in dudgeon, and they were at swords' points at once. But his
displeasure was chiefly turned against a large, heavy-moulded fellow from the
Middle States, who was called Sam. This man hesitated in his speech,
was rather slow in his motions, and was only a tolerably good sailor, but
usually seemed to do his best; yet the captain took a dislike to him, thought
he was surly and lazy, and ``if you once give a dog a bad name,''—as the
sailor-phrase is,—``he may as well jump overboard.'' The captain found
fault with everything this man did, and hazed him for dropping a
marline-spike from the main-yard, where he was at work. This, of course, was
an accident, but it was set down against him. The captain was on board all
day Friday, and everything went on hard and disagreeably. ``The more you
drive a man, the less he will do,'' was as true with us as with any other
people. We worked late Friday night, and were turned-to early Saturday
morning. About ten o'clock the captain ordered our new officer, Russell, who
by this time had become thoroughly disliked by all the crew, to get the gig
ready to take him ashore. John, the Swede, was sitting in the boat
alongside, and Mr. Russell and I were standing by the main hatchway,
waiting for the captain, who was down in the hold, where the crew were
at work, when we heard his voice raised in violent dispute with somebody,
whether it was with the mate or one of the crew I could not tell, and then
came blows and scuffling. I ran to the side and beckoned to John, who came
aboard, and we leaned down the hatchway, and though we could see no one, yet
we knew that the captain had the advantage, for his voice was loud and
clear:--
``You see your condition! You see your condition! Will you
ever give me any more of your jaw?'' No answer; and then came
wrestling and heaving, as though the man was trying to turn him. ``You
may as well keep still, for I have got you,'' said the captain. Then came
the question, ``Will you ever give me any more of your jaw?''
``I never gave you any, sir,'' said Sam; for it was his voice
that we heard, though low and half choked.
``That's not what I ask you. Will you ever be impudent to
me again?''
``I never have been, sir,'' said Sam.
``Answer my question, or I'll make a spread eagle of you!
I'll flog you, by G---d.''
``I'm no negro slave,'' said Sam.
``Then I'll make you one,'' said the captain; and he came to
the hatchway, and sprang on deck, threw off his coat, and, rolling up his
sleeves, called out to the mate: ``Seize that man up, Mr. Amerzene! Seize him
up! Make a spread eagle of him! I'll teach you all who is master
aboard!''
The crew and officers followed the captain up the hatchway;
but it was not until after repeated orders that the mate laid hold of Sam,
who made no resistance, and carried him to the gangway.
``What are you going to flog that man for, sir?'' said John,
the Swede, to the captain.
Upon hearing this, the captain turned upon John; but, knowing
him to be quick and resolute, he ordered the steward to bring the irons,
and, calling upon Russell to help him, went up to John.
``Let me alone,'' said John. ``I'm willing to be put in irons.
You need not use any force''; and, putting out his hands, the
captain slipped the irons on, and sent him aft to the quarter-deck.
Sam, by this time, was seized up, as it is called, that is, placed against
the shrouds, with his wrists made fast to them, his jacket off, and his back
exposed. The captain stood on the break of the deck, a few feet from him, and
a little raised, so as to have a good swing at him, and held in his hand the
end of a thick, strong rope. The officers stood round, and the crew grouped
together in the waist. All these preparations made me feel sick and
almost faint, angry and excited as I was. A man—a human being, made
in God's likeness—fastened up and flogged like a beast! A man, too, whom
I had lived with, eaten with, and stood watch with for months, and knew so
well! If a thought of resistance crossed the minds of any of the men, what
was to be done? Their time for it had gone by. Two men were fast, and there
were left only two men besides Stimson and myself, and a small boy of ten or
twelve years of age; and Stimson and I would not have joined the men in
a mutiny, as they knew. And then, on the other side, there were (beside
the captain) three officers, steward, agent, and clerk, and the cabin
supplied with weapons. But beside the numbers, what is there for sailors to
do? If they resist, it is mutiny; and if they succeed, and take the vessel,
it is piracy. If they ever yield again, their punishment must come; and if
they do not yield, what are they to be for the rest of their lives? If a
sailor resist his commander, he resists the law, and piracy or
submission is his only alternative. Bad as it was, they saw it must be
borne. It is what a sailor ships for. Swinging the rope over his head, and
bending his body so as to give it full force, the captain brought it down
upon the poor fellow's back. Once, twice,—six times. ``Will you ever give
me any more of your jaw?'' The man writhed with pain, but said not a word.
Three times more. This was too much, and he muttered something which I could
not hear; this brought as many more as the man could stand, when the
captain ordered him to be cut down, and to go forward.
``Now for you,'' said the captain, making up to John, and
taking his irons off. As soon as John was loose, he ran forward to
the forecastle. ``Bring that man aft!'' shouted the captain. The second
mate, who had been in the forecastle with these men the early part of the
voyage, stood still in the waist, and the mate walked slowly forward; but our
third officer, anxious to show his zeal, sprang forward over the windlass,
and laid hold of John; but John soon threw him from him. The captain stood on
the quarter-deck, bareheaded, his eyes flashing with rage, and his face as
red as blood, swinging the rope, and calling out to his officers: ``Drag him
aft!—Lay hold of him! I'll sweeten him!'' &c., &c. The mate now
went forward, and told John quietly to go aft; and he, seeing resistance
vain, threw the blackguard third mate from him, said he would go aft of
himself, that they should not drag him, and went up to the gangway and held
out his hands; but as soon as the captain began to make him fast, the
indignity was too much, and he struggled; but, the mate and Russell
holding him, he was soon seized up. When he was made fast, he turned
to the captain, who stood rolling up his sleeves and getting ready for the
blow, and asked him what he was to be flogged for. ``Have I ever refused my
duty, sir? Have you ever known me to hang back, or to be insolent, or not to
know my work?''
``No,'' said the captain, ``it is not that that I flog you
for; I flog you for your interference, for asking questions.''
``Can't a man ask a question here without being
flogged?''
``No,'' shouted the captain; ``nobody shall open his mouth
aboard this vessel but myself,'' and began laying the blows upon his back,
swinging half round between each blow, to give it full effect. As he went on,
his passion increased, and he danced about the deck, calling out, as he swung
the rope: ``If you want to know what I flog you for, I'll tell you. It's
because I like to do it!— because I like to do it!—It suits me! That's
what I do it for!''
The man writhed under the pain until he could endure it no
longer, when he called out, with an exclamation more common
among foreigners than with us: ``O Jesus Christ! O Jesus
Christ!''
``Don't call on Jesus Christ,'' shouted the captain; ``he
can't help you. Call on Frank Thompson! He's the man! He can help
you! Jesus Christ can't help you now!''
At these words, which I never shall forget, my blood ran cold.
I could look on no longer. Disgusted, sick, I turned away, and leaned over
the rail, and looked down into the water. A few rapid thoughts, I don't know
what,—our situation, a resolution to see the captain punished when we got
home,—crossed my mind; but the falling of the blows and the cries of the
man called me back once more. At length they ceased, and, turning round, I
found that the mate, at a signal from the captain, had cast him loose.
Almost doubled up with pain, the man walked slowly forward, and went
down into the forecastle. Every one else stood still at his post,
while the captain, swelling with rage, and with the importance of
his achievement, walked the quarter-deck, and at each turn, as he
came forward, calling out to us: ``You see your condition! You see where
I've got you all, and you know what to expect!''—``You've been mistaken in
me; you didn't know what I was! Now you know what I am!''—``I'll make you
toe the mark, every soul of you, or I'll flog you all, fore and aft, from the
boy up!''—``You've got a driver over you! Yes, a slave-driver,—a
nigger-driver! I'll see who'll tell me he isn't a NIGGER slave!'' With this
and the like matter, equally calculated to quiet us, and to allay
any apprehensions of future trouble, he entertained us for about
ten minutes, when he went below. Soon after, John came aft, with his bare
back covered with stripes and wales in every direction, and dreadfully
swollen, and asked the steward to ask the captain to let him have some salve,
or balsam, to put upon it. ``No,'' said the captain, who heard him from
below; ``tell him to put his shirt on; that's the best thing for him, and
pull me ashore in the boat. Nobody is going to lay-up on board this vessel.''
He then called to Mr. Russell to take those two men and two others in the
boat, and pull him ashore. I went for one. The two men could hardly
bend their backs, and the captain called to them to ``give way,'' ``give
way!'' but, finding they did their best, he let them alone. The agent was in
the stern sheets, but during the whole pull—a league or more—not a word
was spoken. We landed; the captain, agent, and officer went up to the house,
and left us with the boat. I, and the man with me, stayed near the boat,
while John and Sam walked slowly away, and sat down on the rocks. They
talked some time together, but at length separated, each sitting alone.
I had some fears of John. He was a foreigner, and violently tempered, and
under suffering; and he had his knife with him, and the captain was to come
down alone to the boat. But nothing happened; and we went quietly on board.
The captain was probably armed, and if either of them had lifted a hand
against him, they would have had nothing before them but flight, and
starvation in the woods of California, or capture by the soldiers and
Indians, whom the offer of twenty dollars would have set upon
them.
After the day's work was done, we went down into the
forecastle, and ate our plain supper; but not a word was spoken. It
was Saturday night; but there was no song,—no ``sweethearts and wives.''
A gloom was over everything. The two men lay in their berths, groaning with
pain, and we all turned in, but, for myself, not to sleep. A sound coming now
and then from the berths of the two men showed that they were awake, as awake
they must have been, for they could hardly lie in one posture long; the dim,
swinging lamp shed its light over the dark hole in which we lived, and
many and various reflections and purposes coursed through my mind. I had
no apprehension that the captain would try to lay a hand on me; but our
situation, living under a tyranny, with an ungoverned, swaggering fellow
administering it; of the character of the country we were in; the length of
the voyage; the uncertainty attending our return to America; and then, if we
should return, the prospect of obtaining justice and satisfaction for these
poor men; and I vowed that, if God should ever give me the means, I would
do something to redress the grievances and relieve the sufferings of that
class of beings with whom my lot had so long been cast.
The next day was Sunday. We worked, as usual, washing decks,
&c., until breakfast-time. After breakfast we pulled the
captain ashore, and, finding some hides there which had been brought
down the night before, he ordered me to stay ashore and watch them, saying
that the boat would come again before night. They left me, and I spent a
quiet day on the hill, eating dinner with the three men at the little house.
Unfortunately they had no books; and, after talking with them, and walking
about, I began to grow tired of doing nothing. The little brig, the home of
so much hardship and suffering, lay in the offing, almost as far as one could
see; and the only other thing which broke the surface of the great bay was
a small, dreary-looking island, steep and conical, of a clayey soil, and
without the sign of vegetable life upon it, yet which had a peculiar and
melancholy interest, for on the top of it were buried the remains of an
Englishman, the commander of a small merchant brig, who died while lying in
this port. It was always a solemn and affecting spot to me. There it stood,
desolate, and in the midst of desolation; and there were the remains of one
who died and was buried alone and friendless. Had it been a
common burying-place, it would have been nothing. The single
body corresponded well with the solitary character of everything around.
It was the only spot in California that impressed me with anything like
poetic interest. Then, too, the man died far from home, without a friend near
him,—by poison, it was suspected, and no one to inquire into it,—and
without proper funeral rites; the mate (as I was told), glad to have him out
of the way, hurrying him up the hill and into the ground, without a word or
a prayer.
I looked anxiously for a boat, during the latter part of
the afternoon, but none came; until toward sundown, when I saw a speck on
the water, and as it drew near I found it was the gig, with the captain. The
hides, then, were not to go off. The captain came up the hill, with a man,
bringing my monkey jacket and a blanket. He looked pretty black, but inquired
whether I had enough to eat; told me to make a house out of the hides, and
keep myself warm, as I should have to sleep there among them, and to keep
good watch over them. I got a moment to speak to the man who brought
my jacket.
``How do things go aboard?'' said I.
``Bad enough,'' said he; ``hard work and not a kind word
spoken.''
``What!'' said I, ``have you been at work all
day?''
``Yes! no more Sunday for us. Everything has been moved in
the hold, from stem to stern, and from the water-ways to
the keelson.''
I went up to the house to supper. We had fríjoles (the
perpetual food of the Californians, but which, when well cooked, are
the best bean in the world), coffee made of burnt wheat, and hard bread.
After our meal, the three men sat down by the light of a tallow candle, with
a pack of greasy Spanish cards, to the favorite game of ``treinte uno,'' a
sort of Spanish ``everlasting.'' I left them and went out to take up my
bivouac among the hides. It was now dark; the vessel was hidden
from sight, and except the three men in the house there was not a living
soul within a league. The coyotes (a wild animal of a nature and appearance
between that of the fox and the wolf) set up their sharp, quick bark, and two
owls, at the end of two distant points running out into the bay, on different
sides of the hill where I lay, kept up their alternate dismal notes. I had
heard the sound before at night, but did not know what it was, until one
of the men, who came down to look at my quarters, told me it was the owl.
Mellowed by the distance, and heard alone, at night, it was a most melancholy
and boding sound. Through nearly all the night they kept it up, answering one
another slowly at regular intervals. This was relieved by the noisy coyotes,
some of which came quite near to my quarters, and were not very
pleasant neighbors. The next morning, before sunrise, the long-boat
came ashore, and the hides were taken off.
We lay at San Pedro about a week, engaged in taking off hides
and in other labors, which had now become our regular duties. I spent one
more day on the hill, watching a quantity of hides and goods, and this time
succeeded in finding a part of a volume of Scott's Pirate in a corner of the
house; but it failed me at a most interesting moment, and I betook myself to
my acquaintances on shore, and from them learned a good deal about the
customs of the country, the harbors, &c. This, they told me, was a worse
harbor than Santa Barbara for southeasters, the bearing of the
headland being a point and a half more to windward, and it being so
shallow that the sea broke often as far out as where we lay at anchor.
The gale for which we slipped at Santa Barbara had been so bad a one here,
that the whole bay, for a league out, was filled with the foam of the
breakers, and seas actually broke over the Dead Man's Island. The Lagoda was
lying there, and slipped at the first alarm, and in such haste that she was
obliged to leave her launch behind her at anchor. The little boat rode it out
for several hours, pitching at her anchor, and standing with her stern
up almost perpendicularly. The men told me that they watched her
till towards night, when she snapped her cable and drove up over
the breakers high and dry upon the beach.
On board the Pilgrim everything went on regularly, each one
trying to get along as smoothly as possible; but the comfort of the voyage
was evidently at an end. ``That is a long lane which has no turning,''
``Every dog must have his day, and mine will come by and by,'' and the like
proverbs, were occasionally quoted; but no one spoke of any probable end to
the voyage, or of Boston, or anything of the kind; or, if he did, it was only
to draw out the perpetual surly reply from his shipmate: ``Boston, is it? You
may thank your stars if you ever see that place. You had better have your
back sheathed, and your head coppered, and your feet shod, and make out your
log for California for life!'' or else something of this kind: ``Before you
get to Boston, the hides will wear all the hair off your head, and you'll
take up all your wages in clothes, and won't have enough left to buy a wig
with!''
The flogging was seldom, if ever, alluded to by us in
the forecastle. If any one was inclined to talk about it, the others, with
a delicacy which I hardly expected to find among them, always stopped him, or
turned the subject. But the behavior of the two men who were flogged toward
one another showed a consideration which would have been worthy of admiration
in the highest walks of life. Sam knew John had suffered solely on his
account; and in all his complaints he said that, if he alone had been
flogged, it would have been nothing; but he never could see him
without thinking that he had been the means of bringing this disgrace
upon him; and John never, by word or deed, let anything escape him
to remind the other that it was by interfering to save his shipmate that
he had suffered. Neither made it a secret that they thought the Dutchman Bill
and Foster might have helped them; but they did not expect it of Stimson or
me. While we showed our sympathy for their suffering, and our indignation at
the captain's violence, we did not feel sure that there was only one side to
the beginning of the difficulty, and we kept clear of any engagement with
them, except our promise to help them when they got home.[1]
Having got all our spare room filled with hides, we hove up
our anchor, and made sail for San Diego. In no operation can
the disposition of a crew be better discovered than in getting under way.
Where things are done ``with a will,'' every one is like a cat aloft; sails
are loosed in an instant; each one lays out his strength on his handspike,
and the windlass goes briskly round with the loud cry of ``Yo heave ho! Heave
and pawl! Heave hearty, ho!'' and the chorus of ``Cheerly, men!'' cats the
anchor. But with us, at this time, it was all dragging work. No one went
aloft beyond his ordinary gait, and the chain came slowly in over
the windlass. The mate, between the knight-heads, exhausted all
his official rhetoric in calls of ``Heave with a will!''—``Heave hearty,
men!—heave hearty!''—``Heave, and raise the dead!''— ``Heave, and
away!'' &c., &c.; but it would not do. Nobody broke his back or his
handspike by his efforts. And when the cat-tackle-fall was strung along, and
all hands—cook, steward, and all—laid hold, to cat the anchor, instead of
the lively song of ``Cheerly, men!'' in which all hands join in the chorus,
we pulled a long, heavy, silent pull, and, as sailors say a song is as
good as ten men, the anchor came to the cat-head pretty slowly. ``Give us
`Cheerly!''' said the mate; but there was no ``cheerly'' for us, and we did
without it. The captain walked the quarter-deck, and said not a word. He must
have seen the change, but there was nothing which he could notice
officially.
We sailed leisurely down the coast before a light, fair
wind, keeping the land well aboard, and saw two other missions,
looking like blocks of white plaster, shining in the distance; one
of which, situated on the top of a high hill, was San Juan Capistrano,
under which vessels sometimes come to anchor, in the summer season, and take
off hides. At sunset on the second day we had a large and well-wooded
headland directly before us, behind which lay the little harbor of San Diego.
We were becalmed off this point all night, but the next morning, which was
Saturday, the 14th of March, having a good breeze, we stood round the
point, and, hauling our wind, brought the little harbor, which is
rather the outlet of a small river, right before us. Every one
was desirous to get a view of the new place. A chain of high
hills, beginning at the point (which was on our larboard hand coming
in), protected the harbor on the north and west, and ran off into
the interior, as far as the eye could reach. On the other sides the land
was low and green, but without trees. The entrance is so narrow as to admit
but one vessel at a time, the current swift, and the channel runs so near to
a low, stony point that the ship's sides appeared almost to touch it. There
was no town in sight, but on the smooth sand beach, abreast, and within a
cable's length of which three vessels lay moored, were four large houses,
built of rough boards, and looking like the great barns in which ice
is stored on the borders of the large ponds near Boston, with piles of
hides standing round them, and men in red shirts and large straw hats walking
in and out of the doors. These were the Hide Houses. Of the vessels: one, a
short, clumsy little hermaphrodite brig, we recognized as our old
acquaintance, the Loriotte; another, with sharp bows and raking masts, newly
painted and tarred, and glittering in the morning sun, with the
blood-red banner and cross of St. George at her peak, was the
handsome Ayacucho. The third was a large ship, with
top-gallant-masts housed and sails unbent, and looking as rusty and worn as
two years' ``hide droghing'' could make her. This was the Lagoda. As we
drew near, carried rapidly along by the current, we overhauled our chain, and
clewed up the topsails. ``Let go the anchor!'' said the captain; but either
there was not chain enough forward of the windlass, or the anchor went down
foul, or we had too much headway on, for it did not bring us up. ``Pay out
chain!'' shouted the captain; and we gave it to her; but it would not do.
Before the other anchor could be let go, we drifted down, broadside on,
and went smash into the Lagoda. Her crew were at breakfast in
the forecastle, and her cook, seeing us coming, rushed out of his galley,
and called up the officers and men.
Fortunately, no great harm was done. Her jib-boom passed
between our fore and main masts, carrying away some of our rigging,
and breaking down the rail. She lost her martingale. This brought us up,
and, as they paid out chain, we swung clear of them, and let go the other
anchor; but this had as bad luck as the first, for, before any one perceived
it, we were drifting down upon the Loriotte. The captain now gave out his
orders rapidly and fiercely, sheeting home the topsails, and backing and
filling the sails, in hope of starting or clearing the anchors; but it was
all in vain, and he sat down on the rail, taking it very leisurely, and
calling out to Captain Nye that he was coming to pay him a visit. We drifted
fairly into the Loriotte, her larboard bow into our starboard quarter,
carrying away a part of our starboard quarter railing, and breaking off her
larboard bumpkin, and one or two stanchions above the deck. We saw our
handsome sailor, Jackson, on the forecastle, with the Sandwich-Islanders,
working away to get us clear. After paying out chain, we swung clear,
but our anchors were, no doubt, afoul of hers. We manned the windlass, and
hove, and hove away, but to no purpose. Sometimes we got a little upon the
cable, but a good surge would take it all back again. We now began to drift
down toward the Ayacucho; when her boat put off, and brought her commander,
Captain Wilson, on board. He was a short, active, well-built man, about fifty
years of age; and being some twenty years older than our captain, and a
thorough seaman, he did not hesitate to give his advice, and, from
giving advice, he gradually came to taking the command; ordering us
when to heave and when to pawl, and backing and filling the
topsails, setting and taking in jib and trysail, whenever he thought
best. Our captain gave a few orders, but as Wilson generally countermanded
them, saying, in an easy, fatherly kind of way, ``O no! Captain Thompson, you
don't want the jib on her,'' or ``It isn't time yet to heave!'' he soon gave
it up. We had no objections to this state of things, for Wilson was a kind
man, and had an encouraging and pleasant way of speaking to us, which
made everything go easily. After two or three hours of constant labor at
the windlass, heaving and yo-ho-ing with all our might, we brought up an
anchor, with the Loriotte's small bower fast to it. Having cleared this, and
let it go, and cleared our hawse, we got our other anchor, which had dragged
half over the harbor. ``Now,'' said Wilson, ``I'll find you a good berth'';
and, setting both the topsails, he carried us down, and brought us to anchor,
in handsome style, directly abreast of the hide-house which we were to
use. Having done this, he took his leave, while we furled the sails, and got
our breakfast, which was welcome to us, for we had worked hard, and eaten
nothing since yesterday afternoon, and it was nearly twelve o'clock. After
breakfast, and until night, we were employed in getting out the boats and
mooring ship.
After supper, two of us took the captain on board the Lagoda.
As he came alongside, he gave his name, and the mate, in the
gangway, called out to Captain Bradshaw, down the companion-way,
``Captain Thompson has come aboard, sir!'' ``Has he brought his brig
with him?'' asked the rough old fellow, in a tone which made itself heard
fore and aft. This mortified our captain not a little, and it became a
standing joke among us, and, indeed, over the coast, for the rest of the
voyage. The captain went down into the cabin, and we walked forward and put
our heads down the forecastle, where we found the men at supper. ``Come down,
shipmates![2] come down!'' said they, as soon as they saw us; and we went
down, and found a large, high forecastle, well lighted, and a crew of twelve
or fourteen men eating out of their kids and pans, and drinking their tea,
and talking and laughing, all as independent and easy as so many
``woodsawyer's clerks.'' This looked like comfort and enjoyment, compared
with the dark little forecastle, and scanty, discontented crew of the brig.
It was Saturday night; they had got through their work for the week, and,
being snugly moored, had nothing to do until Monday again. After two years'
hard service, they had seen the worst, and all, of California; had got
their cargo nearly stowed, and expected to sail, in a week or two,
for Boston.
We spent an hour or more with them, talking over
California matters, until the word was passed,—``Pilgrims, away!'' and
we went back to our brig. The Lagodas were a hardy, intelligent set, a
little roughened, and their clothes patched and old, from California wear;
all able seamen, and between the ages of twenty and thirty-five or forty.
They inquired about our vessel, the usage on board, &c., and were not a
little surprised at the story of the flogging. They said there were often
difficulties in vessels on the coast, and sometimes knock-downs and
fightings, but they had never heard before of a regular seizing-up and
flogging. ``Spread eagles'' were a new kind of bird in
California.
Sunday, they said, was always given in San Diego, both at
the hide-houses and on board the vessels, a large number usually going up
to the town, on liberty. We learned a good deal from them about the curing
and stowing of hides, &c., and they were desirous to have the latest news
(seven months old) from Boston. One of their first inquiries was for Father
Taylor, the seamen's preacher in Boston. Then followed the usual strain of
conversation, inquiries, stories, and jokes, which one must always hear in a
ship's forecastle, but which are, perhaps, after all, no worse,
though more gross and coarse, than those one may chance to hear from
some well dressed gentlemen around their tables.
[1] Owing to the change of vessels that afterwards took
place, Captain Thompson arrived in Boston nearly a year before
the Pilgrim, and was off on another voyage, and beyond the reach of these
men. Soon after the publication of the first edition of this book, in 1841, I
received a letter from Stimson, dated at Detroit, Michigan, where he had
reentered mercantile life, from which I make this extract: ``As to your
account of the flogging scene, I think you have given a fair history of it,
and, if anything, been too lenient towards Captain Thompson for his brutal,
cowardly treatment of those men. As I was in the hold at the time
the affray commenced, I will give you a short history of it as near as I
can recollect. We were breaking out goods in the fore hold, and, in order to
get at them, we had to shift our hides from forward to aft. After having
removed part of them, we came to the boxes, and attempted to get them out
without moving any more of the hides. While doing so, Sam accidentally hurt
his hand, and, as usual, began swearing about it, and was not sparing of his
oaths, although I think he was not aware that Captain Thompson was so near
him at the time. Captain Thompson asked him, in no moderate way, what was the
matter with him. Sam, on account of the impediment in his speech, could not
answer immediately, although he endeavored to, but as soon as possible
answered in a manner that almost any one would, under the like circumstances,
yet, I believe, not with the intention of giving a short answer; but being
provoked, and suffering pain from the injured hand, he perhaps answered
rather short, or sullenly. Thus commenced the scene you have so vividly
described, and which seems to me exactly the history of the whole affair
without any exaggeration.''
[2] ``Shipmate'' is the term by which sailors address one
another when not acquainted.
CHAPTER XVI
The next day being Sunday, after washing and clearing decks,
and getting breakfast, the mate came forward with leave for one watch to
go ashore, on liberty. We drew lots, and it fell to the larboard, which I was
in. Instantly all was preparation. Buckets of fresh water (which we were
allowed in port), and soap, were put in use; go-ashore jackets and trousers
got out and brushed; pumps, neckerchiefs, and hats overhauled, one lending to
another; so that among the whole each got a good fit-out. A boat was called
to pull the ``liberty-men'' ashore, and we sat down in the stern
sheets, ``as big as pay-passengers,'' and, jumping ashore, set out on
our walk for the town, which was nearly three miles off.
It is a pity that some other arrangement is not made in
merchant vessels with regard to the liberty-day. When in port, the
crews are kept at work all the week, and the only day they are allowed for
rest or pleasure is Sunday; and unless they go ashore on that day, they
cannot go at all. I have heard of a religious captain who gave his crew
liberty on Saturdays, after twelve o'clock. This would be a good plan, if
shipmasters would bring themselves to give their crews so much time. For
young sailors especially, many of whom have been brought up with a regard for
the sacredness of the day, this strong temptation to break it is
exceedingly injurious. As it is, it can hardly be expected that a crew, on
a long and hard voyage, will refuse a few hours of freedom from toil and
the restraints of a vessel, and an opportunity to tread the ground and see
the sights of society and humanity, because it is a Sunday. They feel no
objection to being drawn out of a pit on the Sabbath day.
I shall never forget the delightful sensation of being in the
open air, with the birds singing around me, and escaped from
the confinement, labor, and strict rule of a vessel,—of being once more
in my life, though only for a day, my own master. A sailor's liberty is but
for a day; yet while it lasts it is entire. He is under no one's eye, and can
do whatever, and go wherever, he pleases. This day, for the first time, I may
truly say, in my whole life, I felt the meaning of a term which I had often
heard,— the sweets of liberty. Stimson was with me, and, turning
our backs upon the vessels, we walked slowly along, talking of
the pleasure of being our own masters, of the times past, when we
were free and in the midst of friends, in America, and of the prospect of
our return; and planning where we would go, and what we would do, when we
reached home. It was wonderful how the prospect brightened, and how short and
tolerable the voyage appeared, when viewed in this new light. Things looked
differently from what they did when we talked them over in the little dark
forecastle, the night after the flogging, at San Pedro. It is not the least
of the advantages of allowing sailors occasionally a day of liberty,
that it gives them a spring, and makes them feel cheerful and independent,
and leads them insensibly to look on the bright side of everything for some
time after.
Stimson and I determined to keep as much together as
possible, though we knew that it would not do to cut our shipmates;
for, knowing our birth and education, they were a little suspicious that
we would try to put on the gentleman when we got ashore, and would be ashamed
of their company; and this won't do with Jack. When the voyage is at an end,
you do as you please; but so long as you belong to the same vessel, you must
be a shipmate to him on shore, or he will not be a shipmate to you on board.
Being forewarned of this before I went to sea, I took no ``long
togs'' with me; and being dressed like the rest, in white duck
trousers, blue jacket, and straw hat, which would prevent my going
into better company, and showing no disposition to avoid them, I set all
suspicion at rest. Our crew fell in with some who belonged to the other
vessels, and, sailor-like, steered for the first grog-shop. This was a small
adobe building, of only one room, in which were liquors, ``dry-goods,'' West
India goods, shoes, bread, fruits, and everything which is vendible in
California. It was kept by a Yankee, a one-eyed man, who belonged formerly to
Fall River, came out to the Pacific in a whale-ship, left her at
the Sandwich Islands, and came to California and set up a
pulpería. Stimson and I followed in our shipmates' wake, knowing that
to refuse to drink with them would be the highest affront, but determining
to slip away at the first opportunity. It is the universal custom with
sailors for each one, in his turn, to treat the whole, calling for a glass
all round, and obliging every one who is present, even to the keeper of the
shop, to take a glass with him. When we first came in, there was some dispute
between our crew and the others, whether the newcomers or the
old California rangers should treat first; but it being settled in favor
of the latter, each of the crews of the other vessels treated all round in
their turn, and as there were a good many present (including some ``loafers''
who had dropped in, knowing what was going on, to take advantage of Jack's
hospitality), and the liquor was a real (12 1/2 cents) a glass, it made
somewhat of a hole in their lockers. It was now our ship's turn, and Stimson
and I, desirous to get away, stepped up to call for glasses; but we soon
found that we must go in order,—the oldest first, for the old sailors did
not choose to be preceded by a couple of youngsters; and bon gré, mal gré, we
had to wait our turn, with the twofold apprehension of being too late for our
horses, and of getting too much; for drink you must, every time; and if you
drink with one, and not with another, it is always taken as an
insult.
Having at length gone through our turns and acquitted
ourselves of all obligations, we slipped out, and went about among the
houses, endeavoring to find horses for the day, so that we might
ride round and see the country. At first we had but little success,
all that we could get out of the lazy fellows, in reply to our questions,
being the eternal drawling Quien sabe? (``Who knows?'') which is an answer to
all questions. After several efforts, we at length fell in with a little
Sandwich Island boy, who belonged to Captain Wilson, of the Ayacucho, and was
well acquainted in the place; and he, knowing where to go, soon procured us
two horses, ready saddled and bridled, each with a lasso coiled over
the pommel. These we were to have all day, with the privilege of riding
them down to the beach at night, for a dollar, which we had to pay in
advance. Horses are the cheapest thing in California; very fair ones not
being worth more than ten dollars apiece, and the poorer being often sold for
three and four. In taking a day's ride, you pay for the use of the saddle,
and for the labor and trouble of catching the horses. If you bring the saddle
back safe, they care but little what becomes of the horse. Mounted on
our horses, which were spirited beasts (and which, by the way, in
this country, are always steered in the cavalry fashion, by pressing the
contrary rein against the neck, and not by pulling on the bit), we started
off on a fine run over the country. The first place we went to was the old
ruinous presidio, which stands on a rising ground near the village, which it
overlooks. It is built in the form of an open square, like all the other
presidios, and was in a most ruinous state, with the exception of one side,
in which the commandant lived, with his family. There were only two
guns, one of which was spiked, and the other had no carriage.
Twelve half-clothed and half-starved looking fellows composed
the garrison; and they, it was said, had not a musket apiece. The small
settlement lay directly below the fort, composed of about forty dark brown
looking huts, or houses, and three or four larger ones, whitewashed, which
belonged to the ``gente de razon.'' This town is not more than half as large
as Monterey, or Santa Barbara, and has little or no business. From the
presidio, we rode off in the direction of the Mission, which we were told was
three miles distant. The country was rather sandy, and there was nothing
for miles which could be called a tree, but the grass grew green and rank,
there were many bushes and thickets, and the soil is said to be good. After a
pleasant ride of a couple of miles, we saw the white walls of the Mission,
and, fording a small stream, we came directly before it. The Mission is built
of adobe and plastered. There was something decidedly striking in its
appearance: a number of irregular buildings, connected with one another, and,
disposed in the form of a hollow square, with a church at one end,
rising above the rest, with a tower containing five belfries, in each
of which hung a large bell, and with very large rusty iron crosses at the
tops. Just outside of the buildings, and under the walls, stood twenty or
thirty small huts, built of straw and of the branches of trees, grouped
together, in which a few Indians lived, under the protection and in the
service of the Mission.
Entering a gateway, we drove into the open square, in which
the stillness of death reigned. On one side was the church; on another, a
range of high buildings with grated windows; a third was a range of smaller
buildings, or offices, and the fourth seemed to be little more than a high
connecting wall. Not a living creature could we see. We rode twice round the
square, in the hope of waking up some one; and in one circuit saw a tall
monk, with shaven head, sandals, and the dress of the Gray Friars,
pass rapidly through a gallery, but he disappeared without noticing
us. After two circuits, we stopped our horses, and at last a man showed
himself in front of one of the small buildings. We rode up to him, and found
him dressed in the common dress of the country, with a silver chain round his
neck, supporting a large bunch of keys. From this, we took him to be the
steward of the Mission, and, addressing him as ``Mayor-domo,'' received a low
bow and an invitation to walk into his room. Making our horses fast, we
went in. It was a plain room, containing a table, three or four chairs, a
small picture or two of some saint, or miracle, or martyrdom, and a few
dishes and glasses. ``Hay alguna cosa de comer?'' said I, from my grammar.
``Si, Señor!'' said he. ``Que gusta usted?'' Mentioning fríjoles, which I
knew they must have if they had nothing else, and beef and bread, with a hint
for wine, if they had any, he went off to another building across the court,
and returned in a few minutes with a couple of Indian boys bearing dishes
and a decanter of wine. The dishes contained baked meats, fríjoles stewed
with peppers and onions, boiled eggs, and California flour baked into a kind
of macaroni. These, together with the wine, made the most sumptuous meal we
had eaten since we left Boston; and, compared with the fare we had lived upon
for seven months, it was a regal banquet. After despatching it, we took
out some money and asked him how much we were to pay. He shook his head, and
crossed himself, saying that it was charity,— that the Lord gave it to us.
Knowing the amount of this to be that he did not sell, but was willing to
receive a present, we gave him ten or twelve reals, which he pocketed with
admirable nonchalance, saying, ``Dios se lo pague.'' Taking leave of him, we
rode out to the Indians' huts. The little children were running about
among the huts, stark naked, and the men were not much more; but the women
had generally coarse gowns of a sort of tow cloth. The men are employed, most
of the time, in tending the cattle of the Mission, and in working in the
garden, which is a very large one, including several acres, and filled, it is
said, with the best fruits of the climate. The language of these people,
which is spoken by all the Indians of California, is the most
brutish, without any exception, that I ever heard, or that could well
be conceived of. It is a complete slabber. The words fall off of the ends
of their tongues, and a continual slabbering sound is made in the cheeks,
outside of the teeth. It cannot have been the language of Montezuma and the
independent Mexicans.
Here, among the huts, we saw the oldest man that I had ever
met with; and, indeed, I never supposed that a person could retain life
and exhibit such marks of age. He was sitting out in the sun, leaning against
the side of a hut; and his legs and arms, which were bare, were of a dark red
color, the skin withered and shrunk up like burnt leather, and the limbs not
larger round than those of a boy of five years. He had a few gray hairs,
which were tied together at the back of his head, and he was so feeble that,
when we came up to him, he raised his hands slowly to his face,
and, taking hold of his lids with his fingers, lifted them up to look at
us; and, being satisfied, let them drop again. All command over the lids
seemed to have gone. I asked his age, but could get no answer but ``Quien
sabe?'' and they probably did not know it.
Leaving the Mission, we returned to the village, going nearly
all the way on a full run. The California horses have no medium
gait, which is pleasant, between walking and running; for as there are no
streets and parades, they have no need of the genteel trot, and their riders
usually keep them at the top of their speed until they are tired, and then
let them rest themselves by walking. The fine air of the afternoon, the rapid
gait of the animals, who seemed almost to fly over the ground, and the
excitement and novelty of the motion to us, who had been so long confined
on shipboard, were exhilarating beyond expression, and we felt willing to
ride all day long. Coming into the village, we found things looking very
lively. The Indians, who always have a holiday on Sunday, were engaged at
playing a kind of running game of ball, on a level piece of ground, near the
houses. The old ones sat down in a ring, looking on, while the young ones—
men, boys, and girls— were chasing the ball, and throwing it with all their
might. Some of the girls ran like greyhounds. At every accident,
or remarkable feat, the old people set up a deafening screaming
and clapping of hands. Several blue jackets were reeling about among the
houses, which showed that the pulperías had been well patronized. One or two
of the sailors had got on horseback, but being rather indifferent horsemen,
and the Mexicans having given them vicious beasts, they were soon thrown,
much to the amusement of the people. A half-dozen Sandwich-Islanders, from
the hide-houses and the two brigs, bold riders, were dashing about on the
full gallop, hallooing and laughing like so many wild men.
It was now nearly sundown, and Stimson and I went into a house
and sat quietly down to rest ourselves before going to the beach. Several
people soon collected to see ``los marineros ingleses,'' and one of them, a
young woman, took a great fancy to my pocket-handkerchief, which was a large
silk one that I had before going to sea, and a handsomer one than they had
been in the habit of seeing. Of course, I gave it to her, which brought me
into high favor; and we had a present of some pears and other fruits,
which we took down to the beach with us. When we came to leave the house,
we found that our horses, which we had tied at the door, were both gone. We
had paid for them to ride down to the beach, but they were not to be found.
We went to the man of whom we hired them, but he only shrugged his shoulders,
and to our question, ``Where are the horses?'' only answered, ``Quien sabe?''
but as he was very easy, and made no inquiries for the saddles, we saw
that he knew very well where they were. After a little trouble, determined
not to walk to the beach,—a distance of three miles,— we procured two, at
four reals more apiece, with two Indian boys to run behind and bring them
back. Determined to have ``the go'' out of the horses, for our trouble, we
went down at full speed, and were on the beach in a few minutes. Wishing to
make our liberty last as long as possible, we rode up and down among
the hide-houses, amusing ourselves with seeing the men as they arrived (it
was now dusk), some on horseback and others on foot. The Sandwich-Islanders
rode down, and were in ``high snuff.'' We inquired for our shipmates, and
were told that two of them had started on horseback, and been thrown, or had
fallen off, and were seen heading for the beach, but steering pretty wild,
and, by the looks of things, would not be down much before
midnight.
The Indian boys having arrived, we gave them our horses,
and, having seen them safely off, hailed for a boat, and went aboard. Thus
ended our first liberty-day on shore. We were well tired, but had had a good
time, and were more willing to go back to our old duties. About midnight we
were waked up by our two watch-mates, who had come aboard in high dispute. It
seems they had started to come down on the same horse, double-backed; and
each was accusing the other of being the cause of his fall. They soon,
however, turned-in and fell asleep, and probably forgot all about it,
for the next morning the dispute was not renewed.
CHAPTER XVII
The next sound that we heard was ``All hands ahoy!'' and,
looking up the scuttle, saw that it was just daylight. Our liberty had
now truly taken flight, and with it we laid away our pumps,
stockings, blue jackets, neckerchiefs, and other go-ashore paraphernalia,
and putting on old duck trousers, red shirts, and Scotch caps,
began taking out and landing our hides. For three days we were hard
at work in this duty, from the gray of the morning until starlight, with
the exception of a short time allowed for meals. For landing and taking on
board hides, San Diego is decidedly the best place in California. The harbor
is small and land-locked; there is no surf; the vessels lie within a cable's
length of the beach, and the beach itself is smooth, hard sand, without rocks
or stones. For these reasons, it is used by all the vessels in the trade as
a depot; and, indeed, it would be impossible, when loading with the cured
hides for the passage home, to take them on board at any of the open ports,
without getting them wet in the surf, which would spoil them. We took
possession of one of the hide-houses, which belonged to our firm, and had
been used by the California. It was built to hold forty thousand hides, and
we had the pleasing prospect of filling it before we could leave the coast;
and toward this our thirty-five hundred, which we brought down with us,
would do but little. There was scarce a man on board who did not go often
into the house, looking round, reflecting, and making some calculation of the
time it would require.
The hides, as they come rough and uncured from the vessels,
are piled up outside of the houses, whence they are taken and
carried through a regular process of pickling, drying, and cleaning,
and stowed away in the house, ready to be put on board. This process is
necessary in order that they may keep during a long voyage and in warm
latitudes. For the purpose of curing and taking care of them, an officer and
a part of the crew of each vessel are usually left ashore; and it was for
this business, we found, that our new officer had joined us. As soon as the
hides were landed, he took charge of the house, and the captain intended to
leave two or three of us with him, hiring Sandwich-Islanders in our places
on board; but he could not get any Sandwich-Islanders to go, although he
offered them fifteen dollars a month; for the report of the flogging had got
among them, and he was called ``aole maikai'' (no good); and that was an end
of the business. They were, however, willing to work on shore, and four of
them were hired and put with Mr. Russell to cure the hides.
After landing our hides, we next sent ashore our spare spars
and rigging, all the stores which we did not need in the course of
one trip to windward, and, in fact, everything which we could spare, so as
to make room on board for hides; among other things, the pigsty, and with it
``old Bess.'' This was an old sow that we had brought from Boston, and who
lived to get round Cape Horn, where all the other pigs died from cold and
wet. Report said that she had been a Canton voyage before. She had been the
pet of the cook during the whole passage, and he had fed her with the best
of everything, and taught her to know his voice, and to do a number of
strange tricks for his amusement. Tom Cringle says that no one can fathom a
negro's affection for a pig; and I believe he is right, for it almost broke
our poor darky's heart when he heard that Bess was to be taken ashore, and
that he was to have the care of her no more. He had depended upon her as a
solace, during the long trips up and down the coast. ``Obey orders, if you
break owners!'' said he,—``break hearts,'' he might have said,—
and lent a hand to get her over the side, trying to make it as easy for
her as possible. We got a whip on the main-yard, and, hooking it to a strap
round her body, swayed away, and, giving a wink to one another, ran her chock
up to the yard-arm. ``'Vast there! 'vast!'' said the mate; ``none of your
skylarking! Lower away!'' But he evidently enjoyed the joke. The pig squealed
like the ``crack of doom,'' and tears stood in the poor darky's eyes;
and he muttered something about having no pity on a dumb beast.
``Dumb beast!'' said Jack, ``if she's what you call a dumb beast, then
my eyes a'n't mates.'' This produced a laugh from all but the cook. He was
too intent upon seeing her safe in the boat. He watched her all the way
ashore, where, upon her landing, she was received by a whole troop of her
kind, who had been set ashore from the other vessels, and had multiplied and
formed a large commonwealth. From the door of his galley the cook used to
watch them in their manoeuvres, setting up a shout and clapping his hands
whenever Bess came off victorious in the struggles for pieces of raw
hide and half-picked bones which were lying about the beach. During
the day, he saved all the nice things, and made a bucket of swill,
and asked us to take it ashore in the gig, and looked quite disconcerted
when the mate told him that he would pitch the swill overboard, and him after
it, if he saw any of it go into the boats. We told him that he thought more
about the pig than he did about his wife, who lived down in Robinson's Alley;
and, indeed, he could hardly have been more attentive, for he actually,
on several nights, after dark, when he thought he would not be
seen, sculled himself ashore in a boat, with a bucket of nice swill,
and returned like Leander from crossing the Hellespont.
The next Sunday the other half of our crew went ashore on
liberty, and left us on board, to enjoy the first quiet Sunday we had
had upon the coast. Here were no hides to come off, and no southeasters to
fear. We washed and mended our clothes in the morning, and spent the rest of
the day in reading and writing. Several of us wrote letters to send home by
the Lagoda. At twelve o'clock, the Ayacucho dropped her fore topsail, which
was a signal for her sailing. She unmoored and warped down into the bight,
from which she got under way. During this operation her crew were a long
time heaving at the windlass, and I listened to the musical notes of a
Sandwich-Islander named Mahanna, who ``sang out'' for them. Sailors, when
heaving at a windlass, in order that they may heave together, always have one
to sing out, which is done in high and long-drawn notes, varying with the
motion of the windlass. This requires a clear voice, strong lungs, and much
practice, to be done well. This fellow had a very peculiar, wild sort of
note, breaking occasionally into a falsetto. The sailors thought that
it was too high, and not enough of the boatswain hoarseness about it; but
to me it had a great charm. The harbor was perfectly still, and his voice
rang among the hills as though it could have been heard for miles. Toward
sundown, a good breeze having sprung up, the Ayacucho got under way, and with
her long, sharp head cutting elegantly through the water on a taut bowline,
she stood directly out of the harbor, and bore away to the southward. She was
bound to Callao, and thence to the Sandwich Islands, and expected to be on
the coast again in eight or ten months.
At the close of the week we were ready to sail, but were
delayed a day or two by the running away of Foster, the man who had been
our second mate and was turned forward. From the time that he
was ``broken,'' he had had a dog's berth on board the vessel,
and determined to run away at the first opportunity. Having shipped for an
officer when he was not half a seaman, he found little pity with the crew,
and was not man enough to hold his ground among them. The captain called him
a ``soger,''[1] and promised to ``ride him down as he would the main tack'';
and when officers are once determined to ``ride a man down,'' it is a gone
case with him. He had had several difficulties with the captain, and asked
leave to go home in the Lagoda; but this was refused him. One night he
was insolent to an officer on the beach, and refused to come aboard in the
boat. He was reported to the captain; and, as he came aboard,— it being past
the proper hour—he was called aft, and told that he was to have a flogging.
Immediately he fell down on deck, calling out, ``Don't flog me, Captain
Thompson, don't flog me!'' and the captain, angry and disgusted with him,
gave him a few blows over the back with a rope's end, and sent him forward.
He was not much hurt, but a good deal frightened, and made up his mind to
run away that night. This was managed better than anything he ever did in his
life, and seemed really to show some spirit and forethought. He gave his
bedding and mattress to one of the Lagoda's crew, who promised to keep it for
him, and took it aboard his ship as something which he had bought. He then
unpacked his chest, putting all his valuable clothes into a large canvas
bag, and told one of us who had the watch to call him at midnight. Coming
on deck at midnight, and finding no officer on deck, and all still aft, he
lowered his bag into a boat, got softly down into it, cast off the painter,
and let it drop down silently with the tide until he was out of hearing, when
he sculled ashore.
The next morning, when all hands were mustered, there was a
great stir to find Foster. Of course, we would tell nothing, and all they
could discover was that he had left an empty chest behind him, and that he
went off in a boat; for they saw the boat lying high and dry on the beach.
After breakfast, the captain went up to the town, and offered a reward of
twenty dollars for him; and for a couple of days the soldiers, Indians, and
all others who had nothing to do, were scouring the country for him, on
horseback, but without effect; for he was safely concealed, all the
time, within fifty rods of the hide-houses. As soon as he had landed,
he went directly to the Lagoda's hide-house, and a part of her crew, who
were living there on shore, promised to conceal him and his traps until the
Pilgrim should sail, and then to intercede with Captain Bradshaw to take him
on board his ship. Just behind the hide-houses, among the thickets and
underwood, was a small cave, the entrance to which was known only to two men
on the beach, and which was so well concealed that though, when I afterwards
came to live on shore, it was shown to me two or three times, I was
never able to find it alone. To this cave he was carried before
daybreak in the morning, and supplied with bread and water, and
there remained until he saw us under way and well round the
point.
Friday, March 27th. The captain having given up all hope
of finding Foster, and being unwilling to delay any longer, gave orders
for unmooring ship, and we made sail, dropping slowly down with the tide and
light wind. We left letters with Captain Bradshaw to take to Boston, and were
made miserable by hearing him say that he should be back again before we left
the coast. The wind, which was very light, died away soon after we doubled
the point, and we lay becalmed for two days, not moving three miles the
whole time, and a part of the second day were almost within sight of the
vessels. On the third day, about noon, a cool sea-breeze came rippling and
darkening the surface of the water, and by sundown we were off San Juan,
which is about forty miles from San Diego, and is called half-way to San
Pedro, where we were bound. Our crew was now considerably weakened. One man
we had lost overboard, another had been taken aft as clerk, and a third
had run away; so that, beside Stimson and myself, there were only three
able seamen and one boy of twelve years of age. With this diminished and
discontented crew, and in a small vessel, we were now to battle the watch
through a couple of years of hard service; yet there was not one who was not
glad that Foster had escaped; for, shiftless and good for nothing as he was,
no one could wish to see him dragging on a miserable life, cowed down
and disheartened; and we were all rejoiced to hear, upon our return to San
Diego, about two months afterwards, that he had been immediately taken aboard
the Lagoda, and had gone home in her, on regular seaman's wages.
After a slow passage of five days, we arrived on Wednesday,
the first of April, at our old anchoring-ground at San Pedro. The bay was
as deserted and looked as dreary as before, and formed no pleasing contrast
with the security and snugness of San Diego, and the activity and interest
which the loading and unloading of four vessels gave to that scene. In a few
days the hides began to come slowly down, and we got into the old business of
rolling goods up the hill, pitching hides down, and pulling our long league
off and on. Nothing of note occurred while we were lying here, except
that an attempt was made to repair the small Mexican brig which had been
cast away in a southeaster, and which now lay up, high and dry, over one reef
of rocks and two sand-banks. Our carpenter surveyed her, and pronounced her
capable of being refitted, and in a few days the owners came down from the
Pueblo, and having waited for the high spring tides, with the help of our
cables, kedges, and crew, hauled her off after several trials. The three men
at the house on shore, who had formerly been a part of her crew,
now joined her, and seemed glad enough at the prospect of getting off the
coast.
On board our own vessel, things went on in the common
monotonous way. The excitement which immediately followed the flogging
scene had passed off, but the effect of it upon the crew, and
especially upon the two men themselves, remained. The different manner
in which these men were affected, corresponding to their
different characters, was not a little remarkable. John was a foreigner
and high-tempered, and though mortified, as any one would be at having had
the worst of an encounter, yet his chief feeling seemed to be anger; and he
talked much of satisfaction and revenge, if he ever got back to Boston. But
with the other it was very different. He was an American, and had had some
education; and this thing coming upon him seemed completely to break him
down. He had a feeling of the degradation that had been inflicted upon him,
which the other man was incapable of. Before that, he had a good deal of fun
in him, and amused us often with queer negro stories (he was from a Slave
State); but afterwards he seldom smiled, seemed to lose all life and
elasticity, and appeared to have but one wish, and that was for the voyage to
be at an end. I have often known him to draw a long sigh when he was alone,
and he took but little part or interest in John's plans of satisfaction and
retaliation.
After a stay of about a fortnight, during which we slipped for
one southeaster, and were at sea two days, we got under way for
Santa Barbara. It was now the middle of April, the southeaster season was
nearly over, and the light, regular winds, which blow down the coast, began
to set steadily in, during the latter part of each day. Against these we beat
slowly up to Santa Barbara—a distance of about ninety miles—in three
days. There we found, lying at anchor, the large Genoese ship which we saw in
the same place on the first day of our coming upon the coast. She had been up
to San Francisco, or, as it is called, ``chock up to windward,''
had stopped at Monterey on her way down, and was shortly to proceed to San
Pedro and San Diego, and thence, taking in her cargo, to sail for Valparaiso
and Cadiz. She was a large, clumsy ship, and, with her topmasts stayed
forward, and high poop-deck, looked like an old woman with a crippled back.
It was now the close of Lent, and on Good Friday she had all her yards
a'-cock-bill, which is customary among Catholic vessels. Some also have an
effigy of Judas, which the crew amuse themselves with keel-hauling
and hanging by the neck from the yard-arms.
[1] Soger (soldier) is the worst term of reproach that can
be applied to a sailor. It signifies a skulk, a shirk,—one who is always
trying to get clear of work, and is out of the way, or hanging back, when
duty is to be done. ``Marine'' is the term applied more particularly to a man
who is ignorant and clumsy about seaman's work,—a greenhorn, a land-lubber.
To make a sailor shoulder a handspike, and walk fore and aft the deck,
like a sentry, is as ignominious a punishment as can be put upon him. Such
a punishment inflicted upon an able seaman in a vessel of war might break
down his spirit more than a flogging.
CHAPTER XVIII
The next Sunday was Easter, and as there had been no liberty
at San Pedro, it was our turn to go ashore and misspend another Sunday.
Soon after breakfast, a large boat, filled with men in blue jackets, scarlet
caps, and various-colored under-clothes, bound ashore on liberty, left the
Italian ship, and passed under our stern, the men singing beautiful Italian
boat-songs all the way, in fine, full chorus. Among the songs I recognized
the favorite, ``O Pescator dell' onda.'' It brought back to my
mind piano-fortes, drawing-rooms, young ladies singing, and a
thousand other things which as little befitted me, in my situation, to
be thinking upon. Supposing that the whole day would be too long a time to
spend ashore, as there was no place to which we could take a ride, we
remained quietly on board until after dinner. We were then pulled ashore in
the stern of the boat,—for it is a point with liberty-men to be pulled off
and back as passengers by their shipmates,—and, with orders to be on the
beach at sundown, we took our way for the town. There, everything wore the
appearance of a holiday. The people were dressed in their best; the
men riding about among the houses, and the women sitting on carpets before
the doors. Under the piazza of a pulpería two men were seated, decked out
with knots of ribbons and bouquets, and playing the violin and the Spanish
guitar. These are the only instruments, with the exception of the drums and
trumpets at Monterey, that I ever heard in California; and I suspect they
play upon no others, for at a great fandango at which I was afterwards
present, and where they mustered all the music they could find, there
were three violins and two guitars, and no other instruments. As it
was now too near the middle of the day to see any dancing, and
hearing that a bull was expected down from the country, to be baited
in the presidio square, in the course of an hour or two, we took a stroll
among the houses. Inquiring for an American who, we had been told, had
married in the place, and kept a shop, we were directed to a long, low
building, at the end of which was a door, with a sign over it, in Spanish.
Entering the shop, we found no one in it, and the whole had an empty,
deserted air. In a few minutes the man made his appearance, and apologized
for having nothing to entertain us with, saying that he had had a fandango
at his house the night before, and the people had eaten and drunk
up everything.
``O yes!'' said I, ``Easter holidays!''
``No!'' said he, with a singular expression on his face; ``I
had a little daughter die the other day, and that's the custom of
the country.''
At this I felt somewhat awkwardly, not knowing what to say,
and whether to offer consolation or not, and was beginning to retire, when
he opened a side-door and told us to walk in. Here I was no less astonished;
for I found a large room, filled with young girls, from three or four years
of age up to fifteen and sixteen, dressed all in white, with wreaths of
flowers on their heads, and bouquets in their hands. Following our conductor
among these girls, who were playing about in high spirits, we came to a
table, at the end of the room, covered with a white cloth, on which lay
a coffin, about three feet long, with the body of his child. The coffin
was covered with white cloth, and lined with white satin, and was strewn with
flowers. Through an open door, we saw, in another room, a few elderly people
in common dresses; while the benches and tables thrown up in a corner, and
the stained walls, gave evident signs of the last night's ``high go.''
Feeling, like Garrick, between Tragedy and Comedy, an uncertainty of purpose,
I asked the man when the funeral would take place, and being told that it
would move toward the Mission in about an hour, took my leave.
To pass away the time, we hired horses and rode to the beach,
and there saw three or four Italian sailors, mounted, and riding up and
down on the hard sand at a furious rate. We joined them, and found it fine
sport. The beach gave us a stretch of a mile or more, and the horses flew
over the smooth, hard sand, apparently invigorated and excited by the salt
sea-breeze, and by the continual roar and dashing of the breakers. From the
beach we returned to the town, and, finding that the funeral procession
had moved, rode on and overtook it, about half-way to the Mission. Here
was as peculiar a sight as we had seen before in the house, the one looking
as much like a funeral procession as the other did like a house of mourning.
The little coffin was borne by eight girls, who were continually relieved by
others running forward from the procession and taking their places. Behind it
came a straggling company of girls, dressed, as before, in white
and flowers, and including, I should suppose by their numbers, nearly all
the girls between five and fifteen in the place. They played along on the
way, frequently stopping and running all together to talk to some one, or to
pick up a flower, and then running on again to overtake the coffin. There
were a few elderly women in common colors; and a herd of young men and boys,
some on foot and others mounted, followed them, or walked or rode by their
side, frequently interrupting them by jokes and questions. But the
most singular thing of all was, that two men walked, one on each side of
the coffin, carrying muskets in their hands, which they continually loaded,
and fired into the air. Whether this was to keep off the evil spirits or not,
I do not know. It was the only interpretation that I could put upon
it.
As we drew near the Mission, we saw the great gate thrown
open, and the padre standing on the steps, with a crucifix in his
hand. The Mission is a large and deserted-looking place, the out-buildings
going to ruin, and everything giving one the impression of decayed grandeur.
A large stone fountain threw out pure water, from four mouths, into a basin,
before the church door; and we were on the point of riding up to let our
horses drink, when it occurred to us that it might be consecrated, and
we forebore. Just at this moment, the bells set up their harsh, discordant
clangor, and the procession moved into the court. I wished to follow, and see
the ceremony, but the horse of one of my companions had become frightened,
and was tearing off toward the town; and, having thrown his rider, and got
one of his hoofs caught in the tackling of the saddle, which had slipped, was
fast dragging and ripping it to pieces. Knowing that my shipmate could not
speak a word of Spanish, and fearing that he would get into difficulty, I was
obliged to leave the ceremony and ride after him. I soon overtook him,
trudging along, swearing at the horse, and carrying the remains of the
saddle, which he had picked up on the road. Going to the owner of the horse,
we made a settlement with him, and found him surprisingly liberal. All parts
of the saddle were brought back, and, being capable of repair, he
was satisfied with six reals. We thought it would have been a few dollars.
We pointed to the horse, which was now half-way up one of the mountains; but
he shook his head, saying, ``No importa!'' and giving us to understand that
he had plenty more.
Having returned to the town, we saw a crowd collected in
the square before the principal pulpería, and, riding up, found that all
these people—men, women, and children—had been drawn together by a couple
of bantam cocks. The cocks were in full tilt, springing into one another, and
the people were as eager, laughing and shouting, as though the combatants had
been men. There had been a disappointment about the bull; he had broken his
bail, and taken himself off, and it was too late to get another, so
the people were obliged to put up with a cock-fight. One of the bantams
having been knocked in the head, and having an eye put out, gave in, and two
monstrous prize-cocks were brought on. These were the object of the whole
affair; the bantams having been merely served up as a first course, to
collect the people together. Two fellows came into the ring holding the cocks
in their arms, and stroking them, and running about on
all-fours, encouraging and setting them on. Bets ran high, and, like
most other contests, it remained for some time undecided. Both
cocks showed great pluck, and fought probably better and longer than their
masters would have done. Whether, in the end, it was the white or the red
that beat, I do not recollect, but whichever it was, he strutted off with the
true veni-vidi-vici look, leaving the other lying panting on his
beam-ends.
This matter having been settled, we heard some talk
about ``caballos'' and ``carrera,'' and seeing the people streaming off in
one direction, we followed, and came upon a level piece of ground, just out
of the town, which was used as a race-course. Here the crowd soon became
thick again, the ground was marked off, the judges stationed, and the horses
led up to one end. Two fine-looking old gentlemen—Don Carlos and Don
Domingo, so called— held the stakes, and all was now ready. We waited some
time, during which we could just see the horses twisting round
and turning, until, at length, there was a shout along the lines, and on
they came, heads stretched out and eyes starting,—working all over, both
man and beast. The steeds came by us like a couple of chain shot,—neck and
neck; and now we could see nothing but their backs and their hind hoofs
flying in the air. As fast as the horses passed, the crowd broke up behind
them, and ran to the goal. When we got there, we found the horses returning
on a slow walk, having run far beyond the mark, and heard that the
long, bony one had come in head and shoulders before the other. The riders
were light-built men, had handkerchiefs tied round their heads, and were
bare-armed and bare-legged. The horses were noble-looking beasts, not so
sleek and combed as our Boston stable horses, but with fine limbs and
spirited eyes. After this had been settled, and fully talked over, the crowd
scattered again, and flocked back to the town.
Returning to the large pulpería, we heard the violin and
guitar screaming and twanging away under the piazza, where they had
been all day. As it was now sundown, there began to be some dancing. The
Italian sailors danced, and one of our crew exhibited himself in a sort of
West India shuffle, much to the amusement of the bystanders, who cried out,
``Bravo!'' ``Otra vez!'' and ``Vivan los marineros!'' but the dancing did not
become general, as the women and the ``gente de razon'' had not yet made
their appearance. We wished very much to stay and see the style
of dancing; but, although we had had our own way during the day, yet we
were, after all, but 'fore-mast Jacks; and, having been ordered to be on the
beach by sunset, did not venture to be more than an hour behind the time, so
we took our way down. We found the boat just pulling ashore through the
breakers, which were running high, there having been a heavy fog outside,
which, from some cause or other, always brings on, or precedes, a heavy sea.
Liberty-men are privileged from the time they leave the vessel until they
step on board again; so we took our places in the stern sheets, and
were congratulating ourselves upon getting off dry, when a great
comber broke fore and aft the boat, and wet us through and
through, filling the boat half full of water. Having lost her buoyancy
by the weight of the water, she dropped heavily into every sea that struck
her, and by the time we had pulled out of the surf into deep water, she was
but just afloat, and we were up to our knees. By the help of a small bucket
and our hats, we bailed her out, got on board, hoisted the boats, eat our
supper, changed our clothes, gave (as is usual) the whole history of our
day's adventures to those who had stayed on board, and, having taken a
night-smoke, turned in. Thus ended our second day's liberty on
shore.
On Monday morning, as an offset to our day's sport, we were
all set to work ``tarring down'' the rigging. Some got girt-lines up for
riding down the stays and back-stays, and others tarred the shrouds, lifts,
&c., laying out on the yards, and coming down the rigging. We overhauled
our bags, and took out our old tarry trousers and frocks, which we had used
when we tarred down before, and were all at work in the rigging by sunrise.
After breakfast, we had the satisfaction of seeing the Italian ship's boat
go ashore, filled with men, gayly dressed, as on the day before,
and singing their barcarollas. The Easter holidays are kept up on shore
for three days; and, being a Catholic vessel, her crew had the advantage of
them. For two successive days, while perched up in the rigging, covered with
tar and engaged in our disagreeable work, we saw these fellows going ashore
in the morning, and coming off again at night, in high spirits. So much for
being Protestants. There's no danger of Catholicism's spreading in
New England, unless the Church cuts down her holidays; Yankees
can't afford the time. American shipmasters get nearly three weeks'
more labor out of their crews, in the course of a year, than the masters
of vessels from Catholic countries. As Yankees don't usually keep Christmas,
and shipmasters at sea never know when Thanksgiving comes, Jack has no
festival at all.
About noon, a man aloft called out ``Sail ho!'' and, looking
off, we saw the head sails of a vessel coming round the point. As she drew
round, she showed the broadside of a full-rigged brig, with the Yankee ensign
at her peak. We ran up our stars and stripes, and, knowing that there was no
American brig on the coast but ours, expected to have news from home. She
rounded-to and let go her anchor; but the dark faces on her yards, when they
furled the sails, and the Babel on deck, soon made known that she was
from the Islands. Immediately afterwards, a boat's crew came
aboard, bringing her skipper, and from them we learned that she was
from Oahu, and was engaged in the same trade with the Ayacucho
and Loriotte, between the coast, the Sandwich Islands, and the
leeward coast of Peru and Chili. Her captain and officers were
Americans, and also a part of her crew; the rest were Islanders. She
was called the Catalina, and, like the vessels in that trade, except the
Ayacucho, her papers and colors were from Uncle Sam. They, of course, brought
us no news, and we were doubly disappointed, for we had thought, at first, it
might be the ship which we were expecting from Boston.
After lying here about a fortnight, and collecting all the
hides the place afforded, we set sail again for San Pedro. There we found
the brig which we had assisted in getting off lying at anchor, with a mixed
crew of Americans, English, Sandwich-Islanders, Spaniards, and Spanish
Indians; and though much smaller than we, yet she had three times the number
of men; and she needed them, for her officers were Californians.
No vessels in the world go so sparingly manned as American and English;
and none do so well. A Yankee brig of that size would have had a crew of four
men, and would have worked round and round her. The Italian ship had a crew
of thirty men, nearly three times as many as the Alert, which was afterwards
on the coast, and was of the same size; yet the Alert would get under way and
come-to in half the time, and get two anchors, while they were all talking
at once,—jabbering like a parcel of ``Yahoos,'' and running about decks
to find their cat-block.
There was only one point in which they had the advantage over
us, and that was in lightening their labors in the boats by their songs.
The Americans are a time and money saving people, but have not yet, as a
nation, learned that music may be ``turned to account.'' We pulled the long
distances to and from the shore, with our loaded boats, without a word
spoken, and with discontented looks, while they not only lightened the labor
of rowing, but actually made it pleasant and cheerful, by their music. So
true is it, that:--
``For the tired slave, song lifts the languid
oar, And bids it aptly fall, with chime That beautifies the fairest
shore, And mitigates the harshest
clime.''
After lying about a week in San Pedro, we got under way for
San Diego, intending to stop at San Juan, as the southeaster season was
nearly over, and there was little or no danger.
This being the spring season, San Pedro, as well as all the
other open ports upon the coast, was filled with whales, that had come in
to make their annual visit upon soundings. For the first few days that we
were here and at Santa Barbara, we watched them with great interest, calling
out ``There she blows!'' every time we saw the spout of one breaking the
surface of the water; but they soon became so common that we took little
notice of them. They often ``broke'' very near us, and one thick, foggy
night, during a dead calm, while I was standing anchor-watch, one of them
rose so near that he struck our cable, and made all surge again. He did
not seem to like the encounter much himself, for he sheered off,
and spouted at a good distance. We once came very near running one down in
the gig, and should probably have been knocked to pieces or thrown sky-high.
We had been on board the little Spanish brig, and were returning, stretching
out well at our oars, the little boat going like a swallow; our faces were
turned aft (as is always the case in pulling), and the captain, who was
steering, was not looking out when, all at once, we heard the spout of a
whale directly ahead. ``Back water! back water, for your lives!'' shouted
the captain; and we backed our blades in the water, and brought the boat to
in a smother of foam. Turning our heads, we saw a great, rough, hump-backed
whale slowly crossing our fore foot, within three or four yards of the boat's
stem. Had we not backed water just as we did, we should inevitably have gone
smash upon him, striking him with our stem just about amidships. He
took no notice of us, but passed slowly on, and dived a few yards beyond
us, throwing his tail high in the air. He was so near that we had a perfect
view of him, and, as may be supposed, had no desire to see him nearer. He was
a disgusting creature, with a skin rough, hairy, and of an iron-gray color.
This kind differs much from the sperm, in color and skin, and is said to be
fiercer. We saw a few sperm whales; but most of the whales that come
upon the coast are fin-backs and hump-backs, which are more difficult to
take, and are said not to give oil enough to pay for the trouble. For this
reason, whale-ships do not come upon the coast after them. Our captain,
together with Captain Nye of the Loriotte, who had been in a whale-ship,
thought of making an attempt upon one of them with two boats' crews; but as
we had only two harpoons, and no proper lines, they gave it up.
During the months of March, April, and May, these whales
appear in great numbers in the open ports of Santa Barbara, San Pedro,
&c., and hover off the coast, while a few find their way into the
close harbors of San Diego and Monterey. They are all off again
before midsummer, and make their appearance on the ``off-shore
ground.'' We saw some fine ``schools'' of sperm whales, which are
easily distinguished by their spout, blowing away, a few miles
to windward, on our passage to San Juan.
Coasting along on the quiet shore of the Pacific, we came
to anchor in twenty fathoms' water, almost out at sea, as it were, and
directly abreast of a steep hill which overhung the water, and was twice as
high as our royal-mast-head. We had heard much of this place from the
Lagoda's crew, who said it was the worst place in California. The shore is
rocky, and directly exposed to the southeast, so that vessels are obliged to
slip and run for their lives on the first sign of a gale; and late as it was
in the season, we got up our slip-rope and gear, though we meant to
stay only twenty-four hours. We pulled the agent ashore, and were ordered
to wait for him, while he took a circuitous way round the hill to the
Mission, which was hidden behind it. We were glad of the opportunity to
examine this singular place, and hauling the boat up, and making her well
fast, took different directions up and down the beach, to explore
it.
San Juan is the only romantic spot on the coast. The country
here for several miles is high table-land, running boldly to the
shore, and breaking off in a steep cliff, at the foot of which the
waters of the Pacific are constantly dashing. For several miles the
water washes the very base of the hill, or breaks upon ledges
and fragments of rocks which run out into the sea. Just where we landed
was a small cove, or bight, which gave us, at high tide, a few square feet of
sand-beach between the sea and the bottom of the hill. This was the only
landing-place. Directly before us rose the perpendicular height of four or
five hundred feet. How we were to get hides down, or goods up, upon the
table-land on which the Mission was situated, was more than we could tell.
The agent had taken a long circuit, and yet had frequently to jump over
breaks, and climb steep places, in the ascent. No animal but a man or
a monkey could get up it. However, that was not our lookout; and, knowing
that the agent would be gone an hour or more, we strolled about, picking up
shells, and following the sea where it tumbled in, roaring and spouting,
among the crevices of the great rocks. What a sight, thought I, must this be
in a southeaster! The rocks were as large as those of Nahant or Newport, but,
to my eye, more grand and broken. Beside, there was a grandeur in
everything around, which gave a solemnity to the scene, a silence
and solitariness which affected every part! Not a human being
but ourselves for miles, and no sound heard but the pulsations of
the great Pacific! and the great steep hill rising like a wall,
and cutting us off from all the world, but the ``world of waters'' ! I
separated myself from the rest, and sat down on a rock, just where the sea
ran in and formed a fine spouting horn. Compared with the plain, dull
sand-beach of the rest of the coast, this grandeur was as refreshing as a
great rock in a weary land. It was almost the first time that I had been
positively alone—free from the sense that human beings were at my elbow, if
not talking with me—since I had left home. My better nature returned strong
upon me. Everything was in accordance with my state of feeling, and
I experienced a glow of pleasure at finding that what of poetry
and romance I ever had in me had not been entirely deadened by
the laborious life, with its paltry, vulgar associations, which I had been
leading. Nearly an hour did I sit, almost lost in the luxury of this entire
new scene of the play in which I had been so long acting, when I was aroused
by the distant shouts of my companions, and saw that they were collecting
together, as the agent had made his appearance, on his way back to our
boat.
We pulled aboard, and found the long-boat hoisted out, and
nearly laden with goods; and, after dinner, we all went on shore in
the quarter-boat, with the long-boat in tow. As we drew in, we descried an
ox-cart and a couple of men standing directly on the brow of the hill; and
having landed, the captain took his way round the hill, ordering me and one
other to follow him. We followed, picking our way out, and jumping and
scrambling up, walking over briers and prickly pears, until we came to the
top. Here the country stretched out for miles, as far as the eye
could reach, on a level, table surface, and the only habitation in
sight was the small white mission of San Juan Capistrano, with a
few Indian huts about it, standing in a small hollow, about a mile from
where we were. Reaching the brow of the hill, where the cart stood, we found
several piles of hides, and Indians sitting round them. One or two other
carts were coming slowly on from the Mission, and the captain told us to
begin and throw the hides down. This, then, was the way they were to be got
down,—thrown down, one at a time, a distance of four hundred feet! This
was doing the business on a great scale. Standing on the edge of the hill,
and looking down the perpendicular height, the sailors
``That walked upon the beach Appeared like mice; and
our tall anchoring bark Diminished to her cock; her
cock a buoy Almost too small for
sight.''
Down this height we pitched the hides, throwing them as far
out into the air as we could; and as they were all large, stiff,
and doubled, like the cover of a book, the wind took them, and they swayed
and eddied about, plunging and rising in the air, like a kite when it has
broken its string. As it was now low tide, there was no danger of their
falling into the water; and, as fast as they came to ground, the men below
picked them up, and, taking them on their heads, walked off with them to the
boat. It was really a picturesque sight: the great height, the scaling of
the hides, and the continual walking to and fro of the men, who
looked like mites, on the beach. This was the romance of hide
droghing!
Some of the hides lodged in cavities under the bank and out of
our sight, being directly under us; but by pitching other hides in
the same direction, we succeeded in dislodging them. Had they
remained there, the captain said he should have sent on board for a
couple of pairs of long halyards, and got some one to go down for them. It
was said that one of the crew of an English brig went down in the same way, a
few years before. We looked over, and thought it would not be a welcome task,
especially for a few paltry hides; but no one knows what he will do until he
is called upon; for, six months afterwards, I descended the same place by a
pair of top-gallant studding-sail halyards, to save half a dozen
hides which had lodged there.
Having thrown them all over, we took our way back again, and
found the boat loaded and ready to start. We pulled off, took the
hides all aboard, hoisted in the boats, hove up our anchor, made sail, and
before sundown were on our way to San Diego.
Friday, May 8th, 1835. Arrived at San Diego. We found the
little harbor deserted. The Lagoda, Ayacucho, Loriotte, all had
sailed from the coast, and we were left alone. All the hide-houses on
the beach but ours were shut up, and the Sandwich-Islanders, a dozen or
twenty in number, who had worked for the other vessels, and been paid off
when they sailed, were living on the beach, keeping up a grand carnival.
There was a large oven on the beach, which, it seems, had been built by a
Russian discovery-ship, that had been on the coast a few years ago, for
baking her bread. This the Sandwich-Islanders took possession of, and had
kept ever since, undisturbed. It was big enough to hold eight or ten men, and
had a door at the side, and a vent-hole at top. They covered the
floor with Oahu mats for a carpet, stopped up the vent-hole in
bad weather, and made it their head-quarters. It was now inhabited by as
many as a dozen or twenty men, crowded together, who lived there in complete
idleness,—drinking, playing cards, and carousing in every way. They bought
a bullock once a week, which kept them in meat, and one of them went up to
the town every day to get fruit, liquor, and provisions. Besides this, they
had bought a cask of ship-bread, and a barrel of flour from the Lagoda,
before she sailed. There they lived, having a grand time, and caring for
nobody. Captain Thompson wished to get three or four of them to come on board
the Pilgrim, as we were so much diminished in numbers, and went up to the
oven, and spent an hour or two trying to negotiate with them. One of them,—
a finely built, active, strong, and intelligent fellow,—who was a sort
of king among them, acted as spokesman. He was called Mannini,—
or rather, out of compliment to his known importance and influence, Mr.
Mannini,—and was known all over California. Through him, the captain
offered them fifteen dollars a month, and one month's pay in advance; but it
was like throwing pearls before swine, or, rather, carrying coals to
Newcastle. So long as they had money, they would not work for fifty dollars a
month, and when their money was gone, they would work for ten.
``What do you do here, Mr. Mannini?''[1] said the
captain.
``Oh! we play cards, get drunk, smoke,—do anything we're a
mind to.''
``Don't you want to come aboard and work?''
``Aole! aole make make makou i ka hana. Now, got plenty money;
no good, work. Mamule, money pau—all gone. Ah! very good,
work!— maikai, hana hana nui!''
``But you'll spend all your money in this way,'' said the
captain.
``Aye! me know that. By-'em-by money pau—all gone; then
Kanaka work plenty.''
This was a hopeless case, and the captain left them, to
wait patiently until their money was gone.
We discharged our hides and tallow, and in about a week were
ready to set sail again for the windward. We unmoored, and got everything
ready, when the captain made another attempt upon the oven. This time he had
more regard to the ``mollia tempora fandi,'' and succeeded very well. He won
over Mr. Mannini to his interest, and as the shot was getting low in the
locker at the oven, prevailed upon him and three others to come on board
with their chests and baggage, and sent a hasty summons to me and the boy
to come ashore with our things, and join the gang at the hide-house. This was
unexpected to me; but anything in the way of variety I liked; so we made
ready, and were pulled ashore. I stood on the beach while the brig got under
way, and watched her until she rounded the point, and then went to the
hide-house to take up my quarters for a few months.
[1] The vowels in the Sandwich Island language have the sound
of those in the languages of Continental Europe.
CHAPTER XIX
Here was a change in my life as complete as it had been
sudden. In the twinkling of an eye I was transformed from a sailor into
a ``beach-comber'' and a hide-curer; yet the novelty and the comparative
independence of the life were not unpleasant. Our hide-house was a large
building, made of rough boards, and intended to hold forty thousand hides. In
one corner of it a small room was parted off, in which four berths were made,
where we were to live, with mother earth for our floor. It contained a table,
a small locker for pots, spoons, plates, &c., and a small hole cut to
let in the light. Here we put our chests, threw our bedding into the berths,
and took up our quarters. Over our heads was another small room, in which Mr.
Russell lived, who had charge of the hide-house, the same man who was for a
time an officer of the Pilgrim. There he lived in solitary grandeur, eating
and sleeping alone (and these were his principal occupations), and
communing with his own dignity. The boy, a Marblehead hopeful, whose
name was Sam, was to act as cook; while I, a giant of a Frenchman
named Nicholas, and four Sandwich-Islanders were to cure the hides.
Sam, Nicholas, and I lived together in the room, and the
four Sandwich-Islanders worked and ate with us, but generally slept at the
oven. My new messmate, Nicholas, was the most immense man that I had ever
seen. He came on the coast in a vessel which was afterwards wrecked, and now
let himself out to the different houses to cure hides. He was considerably
over six feet, and of a frame so large that he might have been shown for a
curiosity. But the most remarkable thing about him was his feet. They were
so large that he could not find a pair of shoes in California to fit him,
and was obliged to send to Oahu for a pair; and when he got them, he was
compelled to wear them down at the heel. He told me once that he was wrecked
in an American brig on the Goodwin Sands, and was sent up to London, to the
charge of the American consul, with scant clothing to his back and no shoes
to his feet, and was obliged to go about London streets in his stocking-feet
three or four days, in the month of January, until the consul could have
a pair of shoes made for him. His strength was in proportion to his size,
and his ignorance to his strength,—``strong as an ox, and ignorant as
strong.'' He knew how neither to read nor to write. He had been to sea from a
boy, had seen all kinds of service, and been in all sorts of vessels,—
merchantmen, men-of-war, privateers, and slavers; and from what I could
gather from his accounts of himself, and from what he once told me, in
confidence, after we had become better acquainted, he had been in even
worse business than slave-trading. He was once tried for his life
in Charleston, South Carolina, and, though acquitted, was so frightened
that he never would show himself in the United States again. I was not able
to persuade him that he could not be tried a second time for the same
offence. He said he had got safe off from the breakers, and was too good a
sailor to risk his timbers again.
Though I knew what his life had been, yet I never had
the slightest fear of him. We always got along very well together, and,
though so much older, stronger, and larger than I, he showed a marked respect
for me, on account of my education, and of what he had heard of my situation
before coming to sea, such as may be expected from a European of the humble
class. ``I'll be good friends with you,'' he used to say, ``for by and by
you'll come out here captain, and then you'll haze me well!'' By
holding together, we kept the officer in good order, for he was
evidently afraid of Nicholas, and never interfered with us, except
when employed upon the hides. My other companions, the Sandwich-Islanders,
deserve particular notice.
A considerable trade has been carried on for several years
between California and the Sandwich Islands, and most of the vessels
are manned with Islanders, who, as they for the most part sign
no articles, leave whenever they chose, and let themselves out to cure
hides at San Diego, and to supply the places of the men left ashore from the
American vessels while on the coast. In this way a little colony of them had
become settled at San Diego, as their head-quarters. Some of these had
recently gone off in the Ayacucho and Loriotte, and the Pilgrim had taken Mr.
Mannini and three others, so that there were not more than twenty left. Of
these, four were on pay at the Ayacucho's house, four more working
with us, and the rest were living at the oven in a quiet way; for
their money was nearly gone, and they must make it last until some
other vessel came down to employ them.
During the four months that I lived here, I got well
acquainted with all of them, and took the greatest pains to become
familiar with their language, habits, and characters. Their language
I could only learn orally, for they had not any books among them, though
many of them had been taught to read and write by the missionaries at home.
They spoke a little English, and, by a sort of compromise, a mixed language
was used on the beach, which could be understood by all. The long name of
Sandwich-Islanders is dropped, and they are called by the whites, all over
the Pacific Ocean, ``Kanakas,'' from a word in their own
language,— signifying, I believe, man, human being,—which they apply
to themselves, and to all South-Sea-Islanders, in distinction from whites,
whom they call ``Haole.'' This name, ``Kanaka,'' they answer to, both
collectively and individually. Their proper names in their own language being
difficult to pronounce and remember, they are called by any names which the
captains or crews may choose to give them. Some are called after the vessel
they are in; others by our proper names, as Jack, Tom, Bill; and some
have fancy names, as Ban-yan, Fore-top, Rope-yarn, Pelican, &c., &c.
Of the four who worked at our house, one was named ``Mr. Bingham,'' after
the missionary at Oahu; another, Hope, after a vessel that he had been in; a
third, Tom Davis, the name of his first captain; and the fourth, Pelican,
from his fancied resemblance to that bird. Then there was Lagoda-Jack,
California-Bill, &c., &c. But by whatever names they might be called,
they were the most interesting, intelligent, and kind-hearted people that I
ever fell in with. I felt a positive attachment for almost all of them;
and many of them I have, to this day, a feeling for, which would lead me
to go a great way for the pleasure of seeing them, and which will always make
me feel a strong interest in the mere name of
a Sandwich-Islander.
Tom Davis knew how to read, write, and cipher in
common arithmetic; had been to the United States, and spoke English
quite well. His education was as good as that of three quarters of
the Yankees in California, and his manners and principles a good
deal better; and he was so quick of apprehension that he might have been
taught navigation, and the elements of many of the sciences, with ease. Old
``Mr. Bingham'' spoke very little English,—almost none, and could neither
read nor write; but he was the best-hearted old fellow in the world. He must
have been over fifty years of age. He had two of his front teeth knocked out,
which was done by his parents as a sign of grief at the death of
Kamehameha, the great king of the Sandwich Islands. We used to tell him
that he ate Captain Cook, and lost his teeth in that way. That was
the only thing that ever made him angry. He would always be quite excited
at that, and say: ``Aole!'' (No.) ``Me no eatee Cap'nee Cook! Me pickaninny—
small—so high—no more! My fader see Cap'nee Cook! Me—no!'' None of them
liked to have anything said about Captain Cook, for the sailors all believe
that he was eaten, and that they cannot endure to be taunted with. ``New
Zealand Kanaka eatee white man; Sandwich Island Kanaka,—no.
Sandwich Island Kanaka ua like pu na haole,—all 'e same a'
you!''
Mr. Bingham was a sort of patriarch among them, and was
treated with great respect, though he had not the education and
energy which gave Mr. Mannini his power over them. I have spent hours
in talking with this old fellow about Kamehameha, the Charlemagne of the
Sandwich Islands; his son and successor, Riho Riho, who died in England, and
was brought to Oahu in the frigate Blonde, Captain Lord Byron, and whose
funeral he remembered perfectly; and also about the customs of his boyhood,
and the changes which had been made by the missionaries. He never would allow
that human beings had been eaten there; and, indeed, it always seemed an
insult to tell so affectionate, intelligent, and civilized a class of
men that such barbarities had been practised in their own country within
the recollection of many of them. Certainly, the history of no people on the
globe can show anything like so rapid an advance from barbarism. I would have
trusted my life and all I had in the hands of any one of these people; and
certainly, had I wished for a favor or act of sacrifice, I would have gone to
them all, in turn, before I should have applied to one of my own countrymen
on the coast, and should have expected to see it done, before my
own countrymen had got half through counting the cost. Their customs, and
manner of treating one another, show a simple, primitive generosity which is
truly delightful, and which is often a reproach to our own people. Whatever
one has they all have. Money, food, clothes, they share with one another,
even to the last piece of tobacco to put in their pipes. I once heard old Mr.
Bingham say, with the highest indignation, to a Yankee trader who
was trying to persuade him to keep his money to himself, ``No! we no all
'e same a' you!—Suppose one got money, all got money. You,— suppose one
got money—lock him up in chest.-- No good!''— ``Kanaka all 'e same
a' one!'' This principle they carry so far that none of them will eat
anything in sight of others without offering it all round. I have seen one of
them break a biscuit, which had been given him, into five parts, at a time
when I knew he was on a very short allowance, as there was but little to
eat on the beach.
My favorite among all of them, and one who was liked by
both officers and men, and by whomever he had anything to do with,
was Hope. He was an intelligent, kind-hearted little fellow, and I never
saw him angry, though I knew him for more than a year, and have seen him
imposed upon by white people, and abused by insolent mates of vessels. He was
always civil, and always ready, and never forgot a benefit. I once took care
of him when he was ill, getting medicines from the ship's chests, when no
captain or officer would do anything for him, and he never forgot it. Every
Kanaka has one particular friend, whom he considers himself bound to
do everything for, and with whom he has a sort of contract,—an alliance
offensive and defensive,—and for whom he will often make the greatest
sacrifices. This friend they call aikane; and for such did Hope adopt me. I
do not believe I could have wanted anything which he had, that he would not
have given me. In return for this, I was his friend among the Americans, and
used to teach him letters and numbers; for he left home before he had
learned how to read. He was very curious respecting Boston (as they
called the United States), asking many questions about the houses,
the people, &c., and always wished to have the pictures in
books explained to him. They were all astonishingly quick in catching
at explanations, and many things which I had thought it utterly impossible
to make them understand they often seized in an instant, and asked questions
which showed that they knew enough to make them wish to go farther. The
pictures of steamboats and railroad cars, in the columns of some newspapers
which I had, gave me great difficulty to explain. The grading of the road,
the rails, the construction of the carriages, they could
easily understand, but the motion produced by steam was a little
too refined for them. I attempted to show it to them once by an experiment
upon the cook's coppers, but failed,—probably as much from my own ignorance
as from their want of apprehension, and, I have no doubt, left them with
about as clear an idea of the principle as I had myself. This difficulty, of
course, existed in the same force with respect to the steamboats; and all I
could do was to give them some account of the results, in the shape
of speed; for, failing in the reason, I had to fall back upon the fact. In
my account of the speed, I was supported by Tom, who had been to Nantucket,
and seen a little steamboat which ran over to New Bedford. And, by the way,
it was strange to hear Tom speak of America, when the poor fellow had been
all the way round Cape Horn and back, and had seen nothing but
Nantucket.
A map of the world, which I once showed them, kept their
attention for hours; those who knew how to read pointing out the places
and referring to me for the distances. I remember being much amused with a
question which Hope asked me. Pointing to the large, irregular place which is
always left blank round the poles, to denote that it is undiscovered, he
looked up and asked, ``Pau?'' (Done? ended?)
The system of naming the streets and numbering the houses
they easily understood, and the utility of it. They had a great desire to
see America, but were afraid of doubling Cape Horn, for they suffer much in
cold weather, and had heard dreadful accounts of the Cape from those of their
number who had been round it.
They smoke a great deal, though not much at a time, using
pipes with large bowls, and very short stems, or no stems at all.
These they light, and, putting them to their mouths, take a long draught,
getting their mouths as full as they can hold of smoke, and their cheeks
distended, and then let it slowly out through their mouths and nostrils. The
pipe is then passed to others, who draw in the same manner,—one pipe-full
serving for half a dozen. They never take short, continuous draughts, like
Europeans, but one of these ``Oahu puffs,'' as the sailors call them, serves
for an hour or two, until some one else lights his pipe, and it is passed
round in the same manner. Each Kanaka on the beach had a pipe, flint, steel,
tinder, a hand of tobacco, and a jack-knife, which he always carried about
with him.[1]
That which strikes a stranger most peculiarly is their style
of singing. They run on, in a low, guttural, monotonous sort of chant,
their lips and tongues seeming hardly to move, and the sounds apparently
modulated solely in the throat. There is very little tune to it, and the
words, so far as I could learn, are extempore. They sing about persons and
things which are around them, and adopt this method when they do not wish to
be understood by any but themselves; and it is very effectual, for with the
most careful attention I never could detect a word that I knew. I
have often heard Mr. Mannini, who was the most noted improvisatore among
them, sing for an hour together, when at work in the midst of Americans and
Englishmen; and, by the occasional shouts and laughter of the Kanakas, who
were at a distance, it was evident that he was singing about the different
men that he was at work with. They have great powers of ridicule, and are
excellent mimics, many of them discovering and imitating the
peculiarities of our own people before we had observed them
ourselves.
These were the people with whom I was to spend a few months,
and who, with the exception of the officer, Nicholas, the Frenchman, and
the boy, made the whole population of the beach. I ought, perhaps, to except
the dogs, for they were an important part of our settlement. Some of the
first vessels brought dogs out with them, who, for convenience, were left
ashore, and there multiplied, until they came to be a great people. While I
was on the beach, the average number was about forty, and probably
an equal, or greater, number are drowned, or killed in some other way,
every year. They are very useful in guarding the beach, the Indians being
afraid to come down at night; for it was impossible for any one to get within
half a mile of the hide-houses without a general alarm. The father of the
colony, old Sachem, so called from the ship in which he was brought out, died
while I was there, full of years, and was honorably buried. Hogs and a few
chickens were the rest of the animal tribe, and formed, like the dogs,
a common company, though they were all known, and usually fed at
the houses to which they belonged.
I had been but a few hours on the beach, and the Pilgrim
was hardly out of sight, when the cry of ``Sail ho!'' was raised, and a
small hermaphrodite brig rounded the point, bore up into the harbor, and came
to anchor. It was the Mexican brig Fazio, which we had left at San Pedro, and
which had come down to land her tallow, try it all over, and make new bags,
and then take it in and leave the coast. They moored ship, erected their
try-works on shore, put up a small tent, in which they all lived, and
commenced operations. This addition gave a change and variety to
our society, and we spent many evenings in their tent, where, amid
the Babel of English, Spanish, French, Indian, and Kanaka, we found some
words that we could understand in common.
The morning after my landing, I began the duties of
hide-curing. In order to understand these, it will be necessary to give
the whole history of a hide, from the time it is taken from a
bullock until it is put on board the vessel to be carried to Boston.
When the hide is taken from the bullock, holes are cut round it, near the
edge, by which it is staked out to dry. In this manner it dries without
shrinking. After the hides are thus dried in the sun, and doubled with the
skin out, they are received by the vessels at the different ports on the
coast, and brought down to the depot at San Diego. The vessels land them, and
leave them in large piles near the houses. Then begins the hide-curer's
duty.
The first thing is to put them in soak. This is done by
carrying them down at low tide, and making them fast, in small piles,
by ropes, and letting the tide come up and cover them. Every day we put in
soak twenty-five for each man, which, with us, made a hundred and fifty.
There they lie forty-eight hours, when they are taken out, and rolled up, in
wheelbarrows, and thrown into the vats. These vats contain brine, made very
strong,—being sea-water, with great quantities of salt thrown in. This
pickles the hides, and in this they lie forty-eight hours; the use of
the sea-water, into which they are first put, being merely to soften and
clean them. From these vats they are taken, and lie on a platform for
twenty-four hours, and then are spread upon the ground, and carefully
stretched and staked out, with the skin up, that they may dry smooth. After
they had been staked, and while yet wet and soft, we used to go upon them
with our knives, and carefully cut off all the bad parts,—the pieces of
meat and fat, which would corrupt and infect the whole if stowed away in
a vessel for many months, the large flippers, the ears, and all other
parts which would prevent close stowage. This was the most difficult part of
our duty, as it required much skill to take off everything that ought to come
off, and not to cut or injure the hide. It was also a long process, as six of
us had to clean a hundred and fifty, most of which required a great deal to
be done to them, as the Spaniards are very careless in skinning
their cattle. Then, too, as we cleaned them while they were staked out, we
were obliged to kneel down upon them, which always gives beginners the
back-ache. The first day I was so slow and awkward that I cleaned only eight;
at the end of a few days I doubled my number; and, in a fortnight or three
weeks, could keep up with the others, and clean my twenty-five.
This cleaning must be got through with before noon, for by
that time the hides get too dry. After the sun has been upon them a
few hours, they are carefully gone over with scrapers, to get off all the
grease which the sun brings out. This being done, the stakes are pulled up,
and the hides carefully doubled, with the hair side out, and left to dry.
About the middle of the afternoon they are turned over, for the other side to
dry, and at sundown piled up and covered over. The next day they are spread
out and opened again, and at night, if fully dry, are thrown upon a
long, horizontal pole, five at a time, and beaten with flails. This takes
all the dust from them. Then, having been salted, scraped, cleaned, dried,
and beaten, they are stowed away in the house. Here ends their history,
except that they are taken out again when the vessel is ready to go home,
beaten, stowed away on board, carried to Boston, tanned, made into shoes and
other articles for which leather is used, and many of them, very probably, in
the end, brought back again to California in the shape of shoes, and worn
out in pursuit of other bullocks, or in the curing of
other hides.
By putting a hundred and fifty in soak every day, we had the
same number at each stage of curing on each day; so that we had,
every day, the same work to do upon the same number,—a hundred and fifty
to put in soak, a hundred and fifty to wash out and put in the vat, the same
number to haul from the vat and put on the platform to drain, the same number
to spread, and stake out, and clean, and the same number to beat and stow
away in the house. I ought to except Sunday; for, by a prescription which no
captain or agent has yet ventured to break in upon, Sunday has been a day
of leisure on the beach for years. On Saturday night, the hides, in every
stage of progress, are carefully covered up, and not uncovered until Monday
morning. On Sundays we had absolutely no work to do, unless it might be to
kill a bullock, which was sent down for our use about once a week, and
sometimes came on Sunday. Another advantage of the hide-curing life was, that
we had just so much work to do, and when that was through, the time was our
own. Knowing this, we worked hard, and needed no driving. We
``turned out'' every morning with the first signs of daylight, and
allowing a short time, at about eight o'clock, for breakfast, generally
got through our labor between one and two o'clock, when we dined, and had
the rest of the time to ourselves, until just before sundown, when we beat
the dry hides and put them in the house, and covered over all the others. By
this means we had about three hours to ourselves every afternoon, and at
sundown we had our supper, and our work was done for the day. There was no
watch to stand, and no topsails to reef. The evenings we generally spent at
one another's houses, and I often went up and spent an hour or so at the
oven, which was called the ``Kanaka Hotel,'' and the ``Oahu Coffeehouse.''
Immediately after dinner we usually took a short siesta, to make up for our
early rising, and spent the rest of the afternoon according to our own
fancies. I generally read, wrote, and made or mended clothes; for necessity,
the mother of invention, had taught me these two latter arts. The Kanakas
went up to the oven, and spent the time in sleeping, talking, and smoking,
and my messmate, Nicholas, who neither knew how to read nor write, passed
away the time by a long siesta, two or three smokes with his pipe, and a
paseo to the other houses. This leisure time is never interfered with, for
the captains know that the men earn it by working hard and fast, and that, if
they interfered with it, the men could easily make their twenty-five hides
apiece last through the day. We were pretty independent, too, for the master
of the house—``capitan de la casa''—had nothing to say to us, except when
we were at work on the hides; and although we could not go up to the town
without his permission, this was seldom or never refused.
The great weight of the wet hides, which we were obliged to
roll about in wheelbarrows; the continual stooping upon those which were
pegged out to be cleaned; and the smell of the nasty vats, into which we were
often obliged to wade, knee-deep, to press down the hides,—all made the
work disagreeable and fatiguing; but we soon became hardened to it, and the
comparative independence of our life reconciled us to it, for there was
nobody to haze us and find fault; and when we were through for the day, we
had only to wash and change our clothes, and our time was our own. There
was, however, one exception to the time's being our own, which was, that
on two afternoons of every week we were obliged to go off for wood for the
cook to use in the galley. Wood is very scarce in the vicinity of San Diego,
there being no trees of any size for miles. In the town, the inhabitants burn
the small wood which grows in thickets, and for which they send out Indians,
in large numbers, every few days. Fortunately, the climate is so fine that
they have no need of a fire in their houses, and only use it for
cooking. With us, the getting of wood was a great trouble; for all that
in the vicinity of the houses had been cut down, and we were obliged to go
off a mile or two, and to carry it some distance on our backs, as we could
not get the hand-cart up the hills and over the uneven places. Two afternoons
in the week, generally Monday and Thursday, as soon as we were through
dinner, we started off for the bush, each of us furnished with a hatchet and
a long piece of rope, and dragging the hand-cart behind us, and followed by
the whole colony of dogs, who were always ready for the bush, and
were half mad whenever they saw our preparations. We went with
the hand-cart as far as we could conveniently drag it, and, leaving it in
an open, conspicuous place, separated ourselves, each taking his own course,
and looking about for some good place to begin upon. Frequently, we had to go
nearly a mile from the hand-cart before we could find any fit place. Having
lighted upon a good thicket, the next thing was to clear away the underbrush,
and have fair play at the trees. These trees are seldom more than five
or six feet high, and the highest that I ever saw in these expeditions
could not have been more than twelve, so that, with lopping off the branches
and clearing away the underwood, we had a good deal of cutting to do for a
very little wood. Having cut enough for a ``back-load,'' the next thing was
to make it well fast with the rope, and heaving the bundle upon our backs,
and taking the hatchet in hand, to walk off, up hill and down dale, to the
hand-cart. Two good back-loads apiece filled the hand-cart, and that was each
one's proportion. When each had brought down his second load, we filled the
hand-cart, and took our way again slowly back to the beach. It was generally
sundown when we got back; and unloading, covering the hides for the night,
and, getting our supper, finished the day's work.
These wooding excursions had always a mixture of something
rather pleasant in them. Roaming about in the woods with hatchet in
hand, like a backwoodsman, followed by a troop of dogs, starting up birds,
snakes, hares, and foxes, and examining the various kinds of trees, flowers,
and birds'-nests, was, at least, a change from the monotonous drag and pull
on shipboard. Frequently, too, we had some amusement and adventure. The
coyotes, of which I have before spoken,—a sort of mixture of the fox and
wolf breeds,—fierce little animals, with bushy tails and large heads, and a
quick, sharp bark, abound here, as in all other parts of California. These
the dogs were very watchful for, and, whenever they saw them, started off in
full run after them. We had many fine chases; yet, although our dogs ran
fast, the rascals generally escaped. They are a match for the dog,—one to
one,—but as the dogs generally went in squads, there was seldom a fair
fight. A smaller dog, belonging to us, once attacked a coyote single, and
was considerably worsted, and might, perhaps, have been killed, had we not
come to his assistance. We had, however, one dog which gave them a good deal
of trouble and many hard runs. He was a fine, tall fellow, and united
strength and agility better than any dog that I have ever seen. He was born
at the Islands, his father being an English mastiff and his mother a
greyhound. He had the high head, long legs, narrow body, and springing gait
of the latter, and the heavy jaw, thick jowls, and strong fore-quarters of
the mastiff. When he was brought to San Diego, an English sailor said that he
looked, about the face, like the Duke of Wellington, whom he had once seen at
the Tower; and, indeed, there was something about him which resembled the
portraits of the Duke. From this time he was christened ``Welly,'' and became
the favorite and bully of the beach. He always led the dogs by
several yards in the chase, and had killed two coyotes at different
times in single combats. We often had fine sport with these fellows.
A quick, sharp bark from a coyote, and in an instant every dog was at the
height of his speed. A few minutes made up for an unfair start, and gave each
dog his right place. Welly, at the head, seemed almost to skim over the
bushes, and after him came Fanny, Feliciana, Childers, and the other fleet
ones,—the spaniels and terriers; and then, behind, followed the heavy
corps,—bull-dogs, &c., for we had every breed. Pursuit by us was in
vain, and in about half an hour the dogs would begin to come panting
and straggling back.
Beside the coyotes, the dogs sometimes made prizes of rabbits
and hares, which are plentiful here, and numbers of which we often shot
for our dinners. Among the other animals there was a reptile I was not so
much disposed to find amusement from, the rattlesnake. These snakes are very
abundant here, especially during the spring of the year. The latter part of
the time that I was on shore, I did not meet with so many, but for the first
two months we seldom went into ``the bush'' without one of our
number starting some of them. I remember perfectly well the first one that
I ever saw. I had left my companions, and was beginning to clear away a fine
clump of trees, when, just in the midst of the thicket, but a few yards from
me, one of these fellows set up his hiss. It is a sharp, continuous sound,
and resembles very much the letting off of the steam from the small pipe of a
steamboat, except that it is on a smaller scale. I knew, by the sound of
an axe, that one of my companions was near, and called out to him, to let
him know what I had fallen upon. He took it very lightly, and as he seemed
inclined to laugh at me for being afraid, I determined to keep my place. I
knew that so long as I could hear the rattle I was safe, for these snakes
never make a noise when they are in motion. Accordingly I continued my work,
and the noise which I made with cutting and breaking the trees kept him
in alarm; so that I had the rattle to show me his whereabouts. Once or
twice the noise stopped for a short time, which gave me a little uneasiness,
and, retreating a few steps, I threw something into the bush, at which he
would set his rattle agoing, and, finding that he had not moved from his
first place, I was easy again. In this way I continued at my work until I had
cut a full load, never suffering him to be quiet for a moment. Having cut
my load, I strapped it together, and got everything ready for starting. I
felt that I could now call the others without the imputation of being afraid,
and went in search of them. In a few minutes we were all collected, and began
an attack upon the bush. The big Frenchman, who was the one that I had called
to at first, I found as little inclined to approach the snake as I had
been. The dogs, too, seemed afraid of the rattle, and kept up a barking at
a safe distance; but the Kanakas showed no fear, and, getting long sticks,
went into the bush, and, keeping a bright lookout, stood within a few feet of
him. One or two blows struck near him, and a few stones thrown started him,
and we lost his track, and had the pleasant consciousness that he might be
directly under our feet. By throwing stones and chips in different
directions, we made him spring his rattle again, and began another attack.
This time we drove him into the clear ground, and saw him gliding
off, with head and tail erect, when a stone, well aimed, knocked him over
the bank, down a declivity of fifteen or twenty feet, and stretched him at
his length. Having made sure of him by a few more stones, we went down, and
one of the Kanakas cut off his rattle. These rattles vary in number, it is
said, according to the age of the snake; though the Indians think they
indicate the number of creatures they have killed. We always preserved them
as trophies, and at the end of the summer had a considerable collection.
None of our people were bitten by them, but one of our dogs died of
a bite, and another was supposed to have been bitten, but recovered. We
had no remedy for the bite, though it was said that the Indians of the
country had, and the Kanakas professed to have an herb which would cure it,
but it was fortunately never brought to the test.
Hares and rabbits, as I said before, were abundant, and,
during the winter months, the waters are covered with wild ducks
and geese. Crows, too, abounded, and frequently alighted in great numbers
upon our hides, picking at the pieces of dried meat and fat. Bears and wolves
are numerous in the upper parts of the coast, and in the interior (and,
indeed, a man was killed by a bear within a few miles of San Pedro, while we
were there), but there were none in our immediate neighborhood. The only
other animals were horses. More than a dozen of these were owned by men on
the beach, and were allowed to run loose among the hills, with a long lasso
attached to them, to pick up feed wherever they could find it. We were sure
of seeing them once a day, for there was no water among the hills, and they
were obliged to come down to the well which had been dug upon the beach.
These horses were bought at from two to six and eight dollars apiece, and
were held very much as common property. We generally kept one fast to one of
the houses, so that we could mount him and catch any of the others. Some
of them were really fine animals, and gave us many good runs up to the
presidio and over the country.
[1] Matches had not come into use then. I think there were
none on board any vessel on the coast. We used the tinder box in
our forecastle.
CHAPTER XX
After we had been a few weeks on shore, and had begun to
feel broken into the regularity of our life, its monotony was interrupted
by the arrival of two vessels from the windward. We were sitting at dinner in
our little room, when we heard the cry of ``Sail ho!'' This, we had learned,
did not always signify a vessel, but was raised whenever a woman was seen
coming down from the town, or an ox-cart, or anything unusual, hove in sight
upon the road; so we took no notice of it. But it soon became so loud and
general from all parts of the beach that we were led to go to the door; and
there, sure enough, were two sails coming round the point, and leaning over
from the strong northwest wind, which blows down the coast every afternoon.
The headmost was a ship, and the other a brig. Everybody was alive on the
beach, and all manner of conjectures were abroad. Some said it was the
Pilgrim, with the Boston ship, which we were expecting; but we soon saw that
the brig was not the Pilgrim, and the ship, with her
stump top-gallant-masts and rusty sides, could not be a dandy
Boston Indiaman. As they drew nearer, we discovered the high poop,
and top-gallant forecastle, and other marks of the Italian ship Rosa, and
the brig proved to be the Catalina, which we saw at Santa Barbara, just
arrived from Valparaiso. They came to anchor, moored ship, and began
discharging hides and tallow. The Rosa had purchased the house occupied by
the Lagoda, and the Catalina took the other spare one between ours and the
Ayacucho's, so that now each house was occupied, and the beach, for several
days, was all animation. The Catalina had several Kanakas on board, who
were immediately laid hold of by the others, and carried up to the oven,
where they had a long pow-wow and a smoke. Two Frenchmen, who belonged to the
Rosa's crew, came in every evening to see Nicholas; and from them we learned
that the Pilgrim was at San Pedro, and was the only vessel from the United
States now on the coast. Several of the Italians slept on shore at their
hide-house; and there, and at the tent in which the Fazio's crew lived, we
had some singing almost every evening. The Italians sang a variety
of songs,—barcarollas, provincial airs, &c.; in several of which
I recognized parts of our favorite operas and sentimental songs. They
often joined in a song, taking the different parts, which produced a fine
effect, as many of them had good voices, and all sang with spirit. One young
man, in particular, had a falsetto as clear as a clarionet.
The greater part of the crews of the vessels came ashore
every evening, and we passed the time in going about from one house
to another, and listening to all manner of languages. The Spanish was the
common ground upon which we all met; for every one knew more or less of that.
We had now, out of forty or fifty, representatives from almost every nation
under the sun,—two Englishmen, three Yankees, two Scotchmen, two Welshmen,
one Irishman, three Frenchmen (two of whom were Normans, and the
third from Gascony), one Dutchman, one Austrian, two or three
Spaniards (from old Spain), half a dozen Spanish-Americans and
half-breeds, two native Indians from Chili and the Island of Chiloe, one
negro, one mulatto, about twenty Italians, from all parts of Italy,
as many more Sandwich-Islanders, one Tahitian, and one Kanaka from the
Marquesas Islands.
The night before the vessels were ready to sail, all the
Europeans united and had an entertainment at the Rosa's hide-house, and
we had songs of every nation and tongue. A German gave us ``Ach!
mein lieber Augustin!'' the three Frenchmen roared through the Marseilles
Hymn; the English and Scotchmen gave us ``Rule Britannia,'' and ``Wha'll be
King but Charlie?'' the Italians and Spaniards screamed through some national
affairs, for which I was none the wiser; and we three Yankees made an attempt
at the ``Star-spangled Banner.'' After these national tributes had
been paid, the Austrian gave us a pretty little love-song, and
the Frenchmen sang a spirited thing,—``Sentinelle! O prenez garde
à vous!''—and then followed the mélange which might have been expected.
When I left them, the aguardiente and annisou were pretty well in their
heads, they were all singing and talking at once, and their peculiar national
oaths were getting as plenty as pronouns.
The next day, the two vessels got under way for the windward,
and left us in quiet possession of the beach. Our numbers were somewhat
enlarged by the opening of the new houses, and the society of the beach was a
little changed. In charge of the Catalina's house was an old Scotchman,
Robert, who, like most of his countrymen, had some education, and, like many
of them, was rather pragmatical, and had a ludicrously solemn conceit
of himself. He employed his time in taking care of his pigs, chickens,
turkeys, dogs, &c., and in smoking his long pipe. Everything was as neat
as a pin in the house, and he was as regular in his hours as a chronometer,
but, as he kept very much by himself, was not a great addition to our
society. He hardly spent a cent all the time he was on the beach, and the
others said he was no shipmate. He had been a petty officer on board
the British frigate Dublin, Captain Lord James Townshend, and had great
ideas of his own importance. The man in charge of the Rosa's house, Schmidt,
was an Austrian, but spoke, read, and wrote four languages with ease and
correctness. German was his native tongue, but being born near the borders of
Italy, and having sailed out of Genoa, the Italian was almost as familiar to
him as his own language. He was six years on board of an English
man-of-war, where he learned to speak our language easily, and also to
read and write it. He had been several years in Spanish vessels, and had
acquired that language so well that he could read books in it. He was between
forty and fifty years of age, and was a singular mixture of the
man-of-war's-man and Puritan. He talked a great deal about propriety and
steadiness, and gave good advice to the youngsters and Kanakas, but seldom
went up to the town without coming down ``three sheets in the wind.'' One
holiday, he and old Robert (the Scotchman from the Catalina) went up to the
town, and got so cosey, talking over old stories and giving each other
good advice, that they came down, double-backed, on a horse, and
both rolled off into the sand as soon as the horse stopped. This put
an end to their pretensions, and they never heard the last of it from the
rest of the men. On the night of the entertainment at the Rosa's house, I saw
old Schmidt (that was the Austrian's name) standing up by a hogshead, holding
on by both hands, and calling out to himself: ``Hold on, Schmidt! hold on, my
good fellow, or you'll be on your back!'' Still, he was an
intelligent, good-natured old fellow, and had a chest full of books, which
he willingly lent me to read. In the same house with him were a Frenchman
and an Englishman, the latter a regular-built ``man-o'-war Jack,'' a thorough
seaman, a hearty, generous fellow, and, at the same time, a drunken,
dissolute dog. He made it a point to get drunk every time he went to the
presidio, when he always managed to sleep on the road, and have his money
stolen from him. These, with a Chilian and half a dozen Kanakas,
formed the addition to our company.
In about six weeks from the time when the Pilgrim sailed, we
had all the hides which she left us cured and stowed away; and
having cleared up the ground and emptied the vats, and set everything
in order, had nothing more to do, until she should come down again, but to
supply ourselves with wood. Instead of going twice a week for this purpose,
we determined to give one whole week to getting wood, and then we should have
enough to last us half through the summer. Accordingly we started off every
morning, after an early breakfast, with our hatchets in hand, and cut wood
until the sun was over the point,—which was our mark for noon, as there
was not a watch on the beach,—and then came back to dinner, and after
dinner started off again with our hand-cart and ropes, and carted and
``backed'' it down until sunset. This we kept up for a week, until we had
collected several cords,—enough to last us for six or eight weeks,—when
we ``knocked off'' altogether, much to my joy; for, though I liked straying
in the woods, and cutting, very well, yet the backing the wood for so great a
distance, over an uneven country, was, without exception, the hardest work I
had ever done. I usually had to kneel down, and contrive to heave
the load, which was well strapped together, upon my back, and then rise up
and start off with it, up the hills and down the vales, sometimes through
thickets,—the rough points sticking into the skin and tearing the clothes,
so that, at the end of the week I had hardly a whole shirt to my
back.
We were now through all our work, and had nothing more to do
until the Pilgrim should come down again. We had nearly got through
our provisions too, as well as our work; for our officer had been
very wasteful of them, and the tea, flour, sugar, and molasses were
all gone. We suspected him of sending them up to the town; and he always
treated the squaws with molasses when they came down to the beach. Finding
wheat-coffee and dry bread rather poor living, we clubbed together, and I
went to the town on horseback, with a great salt-bag behind the saddle, and a
few reals in my pocket, and brought back the bag full of onions, beans,
pears, watermelons, and other fruits; for the young woman who tended
the garden, finding that I belonged to the American ship, and that we were
short of provisions, put in a larger portion. With these we lived like
fighting-cocks for a week or two, and had, besides, what the sailors call a
``blow-out on sleep,'' not turning out in the morning until breakfast was
ready. I employed several days in overhauling my chest, and mending up all my
old clothes, until I had put everything in order,—``patch upon patch, like
a sand-barge's mainsail.'' Then I took hold of Bowditch's Navigator, which
I had always with me. I had been through the greater part of it, and now went
carefully over it from beginning to end, working out most of the examples.
That done, and there being no signs of the Pilgrim, I made a descent upon old
Schmidt, and borrowed and read all the books there were upon the beach. Such
a dearth was there of these latter articles, that anything, even a
little child's story-book, or the half of a shipping calendar, seemed
a treasure. I actually read a jest-book through, from beginning to end, in
one day, as I should a novel, and enjoyed it much. At last, when I thought
that there were no more to be had, I found at the bottom of old Schmidt's
chest, ``Mandeville, a Romance, by Godwin, in five volumes.'' This I had
never read, but Godwin's name was enough, and, after the wretched trash I had
devoured, anything bearing the name of an intellectual man was a
prize indeed. I bore it off, and for two days I was up early and
late, reading with all my might, and actually drinking in delight. It
is no extravagance to say that it was like a spring in a desert
land.
From the sublime to the ridiculous—so, with me, from
Mandeville to hide-curing—was but a step; for--
Wednesday, July 18th, brought us the brig Pilgrim from
the windward. As she came in, we found that she was a good deal altered in
her appearance. Her short top-gallant-masts were up, her bowlines all unrove
(except to the courses), the quarter boom-irons off her lower yards, her
jack-cross-trees sent down, several blocks got rid of, running rigging rove
in new places, and numberless other changes of the same character. Then, too,
there was a new voice giving orders, and a new face on the
quarter-deck,— a short, dark-complexioned man, in a green jacket and a
high leather cap. These changes, of course, set the whole beach on
the qui-vive, and we were all waiting for the boat to come ashore, that we
might have things explained. At length, after the sails were furled and the
anchor carried out, her boat pulled ashore, and the news soon flew that the
expected ship had arrived at Santa Barbara, and that Captain Thompson had
taken command of her, and her captain, Faucon, had taken the Pilgrim, and was
the green-jacketed man on the quarter-deck. The boat put directly
off again, without giving us time to ask any more questions, and we were
obliged to wait till night, when we took a little skiff, that lay on the
beach, and paddled off. When I stepped aboard, the second mate called me aft,
and gave me a large bundle, directed to me, and marked ``Ship Alert.'' This
was what I had longed for, yet I refrained from opening it until I went
ashore. Diving down into the forecastle, I found the same old crew, and was
really glad to see them again. Numerous inquiries passed as to the new ship,
the latest news from Boston, &c., &c. Stimson had received
letters from home, and nothing remarkable had happened. The Alert
was agreed on all hands to be a fine ship, and a large one: ``Larger than
the Rosa,''—``Big enough to carry off all the hides in California,''—
``Rail as high as a man's head,''—``A crack ship,''—``A regular dandy,''
&c., &c. Captain Thompson took command of her, and she went directly
up to Monterey; thence she was to go to San Francisco, and probably would not
be in San Diego under two or three months. Some of the Pilgrim's crew found
old shipmates aboard of her, and spent an hour or two in her forecastle
the evening before she sailed. They said her decks were as white as snow,—
holystoned every morning, like a man-of-war's; everything on board
``ship-shape and Bristol fashion''; a fine crew, three mates, a sailmaker and
carpenter, and all complete. ``They've got a man for mate of that ship, and
not a bloody sheep about decks!''—``A mate that knows his duty, and makes
everybody do theirs, and won't be imposed upon by either captain or
crew.'' After collecting all the information we could get on this
point, we asked something about their new captain. He had hardly been
on board long enough for them to know much about him, but he had taken
hold strong, as soon as he took command,—shifting the top-gallant-masts,
and unreeving all the studding-sail gear and half the running rigging, the
very first day.
Having got all the news we could, we pulled ashore; and as
soon as we reached the house, I, as might be supposed, fell directly
to opening my bundle, and found a reasonable supply of duck,
flannel shirts, shoes, &c., and, what was still more valuable, a packet
of eleven letters. These I sat up nearly all night reading, and put them
carefully away, to be re-read again and again at my leisure. Then came half a
dozen newspapers, the last of which gave notice of Thanksgiving, and of the
clearance of ``ship Alert, Edward H. Faucon, master, for Callao and
California, by Bryant, Sturgis, & Co.'' Only those who have been on
distant voyages, and after a long absence received a newspaper from home, can
understand the delight that they give one. I read every part of them,—
the houses to let, things lost or stolen, auction sales, and all. Nothing
carries you so entirely to a place, and makes you feel so perfectly at home,
as a newspaper. The very name of ``Boston Daily Advertiser'' ``sounded
hospitably upon the ear.''
The Pilgrim discharged her hides, which set us at work again,
and in a few days we were in the old routine of dry hides, wet
hides, cleaning, beating, &c. Captain Faucon came quietly up to me, as
I was sitting upon a stretched hide, cutting the meat from it with my
knife, and asked me how I liked California, and repeated,--
``Tityre, tu patulae recubans subtegmine
fagi.''
Very apropos, thought I, and, at the same time, shows that
you have studied Latin. However, it was kind of him, and an attention from
a captain is a thing not to be slighted. Thompson's majesty could not have
bent to it, in the sight of so many mates and men; but Faucon was a man of
education, literary habits, and good social position, and held things at
their right value.
Saturday, July 11th. The Pilgrim set sail for the windward,
and left us to go on in our old way. Having laid in such a supply of wood,
and the days being now long, and invariably pleasant, we had a good deal of
time to ourselves. The duck I received from home I soon made up into trousers
and frocks, and, having formed the remnants of the duck into a cap, I
displayed myself, every Sunday, in a complete suit of my own make, from head
to foot. Reading, mending, sleeping, with occasional excursions into the
bush, with the dogs, in search of coyotes, hares, and rabbits, or
to encounter a rattlesnake, and now and then a visit to the
presidio, filled up our spare time after hide-curing was over for the
day. Another amusement which we sometimes indulged in was ``burning
the water'' for craw-fish. For this purpose we procured a pair of grains,
with a long staff like a harpoon, and, making torches with tarred rope
twisted round a long pine stick, took the only boat on the beach, a small
skiff, and with a torch-bearer in the bow, a steersman in the stern, and one
man on each side with the grains, went off, on dark nights, to burn the
water. This is fine sport. Keeping within a few rods of the shore, where the
water is not more than three or four feet deep, with a clear, sandy bottom,
the torches light everything up so that one could almost have seen a pin
among the grains of sand. The craw-fish are an easy prey, and we used soon to
get a load of them. The other fish were more difficult to catch, yet we
frequently speared a number of them, of various kinds and sizes. The Pilgrim
brought us a supply of fish-hooks, which we had never had before on the
beach, and for several days we went down to the Point, and caught a quantity
of cod and mackerel. On one of these expeditions, we saw a battle between
two Sandwich-Islanders and a shark. ``Johnny'' had been playing about our
boat for some time, driving away the fish, and showing his teeth at our bait,
when we missed him, and in a few minutes heard a great shouting between two
Kanakas who were fishing on the rock opposite to us: ``E hana hana make i ka
ia nui!'' ``E pii mai Aikane!'' &c., &c.; and saw them pulling
away on a stout line, and ``Johnny Shark'' floundering at the other end.
The line soon broke; but the Kanakas would not let him off so easily, and
sprang directly into the water after him. Now came the tug of war. Before he
could get into deep water, one of them seized him by the tail, and ran up
with him upon the beach; but Johnny twisted round, and turning his head under
his body, and showing his teeth in the vicinity of the Kanaka's hand, made
him let go and spring out of the way. The shark now turned tail and made
the best of his way, by flapping and floundering, toward deep water; but here
again, before he was fairly off, the other Kanaka seized him by the tail, and
made a spring toward the beach, his companion at the same time paying away
upon him with stones and a large stick. As soon, however, as the shark could
turn, the man was obliged to let go his hold; but the instant he made
toward deep water, they were both behind him, watching their chance
to seize him. In this way the battle went on for some time, the shark, in
a rage, splashing and twisting about, and the Kanakas, in high excitement,
yelling at the top of their voices. But the shark at last got off, carrying
away a hook and line, and not a few severe bruises.
CHAPTER XXI
We kept up a constant connection with the presidio, and by
the close of the summer I had added much to my vocabulary, beside having
made the acquaintance of nearly everybody in the place, and acquired some
knowledge of the character and habits of the people, as well as of the
institutions under which they live.
California was discovered in 1534 by Ximenes, or in 1536
by Cortes, I cannot settle which, and was subsequently visited by many
other adventurers, as well as commissioned voyagers of the Spanish crown. It
was found to be inhabited by numerous tribes of Indians, and to be in many
parts extremely fertile; to which, of course, were added rumors of gold
mines, pearl fishery, &c. No sooner was the importance of the country
known, than the Jesuits obtained leave to establish themselves in it, to
Christianize and enlighten the Indians. They established missions in various
parts of the country toward the close of the seventeenth century,
and collected the natives about them, baptizing them into the Church, and
teaching them the arts of civilized life. To protect the Jesuits in their
missions, and at the same time to support the power of the crown over the
civilized Indians, two forts were erected and garrisoned,—one at San Diego,
and the other at Monterey. These were called presidios, and divided the
command of the whole country between them. Presidios have since
been established at Santa Barbara, San Francisco, and other
places, dividing the country into large districts, each with its
presidio, and governed by a commandante. The soldiers, for the most
part, married civilized Indians; and thus, in the vicinity of
each presidio, sprung up, gradually, small towns. In the course of time,
vessels began to come into the ports to trade with the missions and received
hides in return; and thus began the great trade of California. Nearly all the
cattle in the country belonged to the missions, and they employed their
Indians, who became, in fact, their serfs, in tending their vast herds. In
the year 1793, when Vancouver visited San Diego, the missions had obtained
great wealth and power, and are accused of having depreciated the country
with the sovereign, that they might be allowed to retain their possessions.
On the expulsion of the Jesuits from the Spanish dominions, the missions
passed into the hands of the Franciscans, though without any essential change
in their management. Ever since the independence of Mexico, the
missions had been going down; until, at last, a law was passed,
stripping them of all their possessions, and confining the priests to
their spiritual duties, at the same time declaring all the Indians
free and independent Rancheros. The change in the condition of the Indians
was, as may be supposed, only nominal; they are virtually serfs, as much as
they ever were. But in the missions the change was complete. The priests have
now no power, except in their religious character, and the great possessions
of the missions are given over to be preyed upon by the harpies of the civil
power, who are sent there in the capacity of administradores, to settle up
the concerns; and who usually end, in a few years, by making themselves
fortunes, and leaving their stewardships worse than they found them. The
dynasty of the priests was much more acceptable to the people of the country,
and, indeed, to every one concerned with the country, by trade or otherwise,
than that of the administradores. The priests were connected permanently to
one mission, and felt the necessity of keeping up its credit. Accordingly
the debts of the missions were regularly paid, and the people were, in the
main, well treated, and attached to those who had spent their whole lives
among them. But the administradores are strangers sent from Mexico, having no
interest in the country; not identified in any way with their charge, and,
for the most part, men of desperate fortunes,—broken-down politicians
and soldiers,—whose only object is to retrieve their condition in
as short a time as possible. The change had been made but a few
years before our arrival upon the coast, yet, in that short time,
the trade was much diminished, credit impaired, and the venerable missions
were going rapidly to decay.
The external political arrangements remain the same. There
are four or more presidios, having under their protection the
various missions, and the pueblos, which are towns formed by the
civil power and containing no mission or presidio. The most
northerly presidio is San Francisco, the next Monterey, the next
Santa Barbara, including the mission of the same, San Luis Obispo,
and Santa Buenaventura, which is said to be the best mission in the whole
country, having fertile soil and rich vineyards. The last, and most
southerly, is San Diego, including the mission of the same, San Juan
Capistrano, the Pueblo de los Angeles, the largest town in California, with
the neighboring mission of San Gabriel. The priests, in spiritual matters,
are subject to the Archbishop of Mexico, and in temporal matters to the
governor-general, who is the great civil and military head of the
country.
The government of the country is an arbitrary democracy,
having no common law, and nothing that we should call a judiciary.
Their only laws are made and unmade at the caprice of the legislature, and
are as variable as the legislature itself. They pass through the form of
sending representatives to the congress at Mexico, but as it takes several
months to go and return, and there is very little communication between the
capital and this distant province, a member usually stays there as permanent
member, knowing very well that there will be revolutions at home before
he can write and receive an answer; and if another member should be sent,
he has only to challenge him, and decide the contested election in that
way.
Revolutions are matters of frequent occurrence in California.
They are got up by men who are at the foot of the ladder and in desperate
circumstances, just as a new political organization may be started by such
men in our own country. The only object, of course, is the loaves and fishes;
and instead of caucusing, paragraphing, libelling, feasting, promising, and
lying, they take muskets and bayonets, and, seizing upon the presidio
and custom-house, divide the spoils, and declare a new dynasty. As
for justice, they know little law but will and fear. A Yankee, who
had been naturalized, and become a Catholic, and had married in
the country, was sitting in his house at the Pueblo de los Angeles, with
his wife and children, when a Mexican, with whom he had had a difficulty,
entered the house, and stabbed him to the heart before them all. The murderer
was seized by some Yankees who had settled there, and kept in confinement
until a statement of the whole affair could be sent to the governor-general.
The governor-general refused to do anything about it, and the countrymen of
the murdered man, seeing no prospect of justice being administered, gave
notice that, if nothing was done, they should try the man themselves. It
chanced that, at this time, there was a company of some thirty or forty
trappers and hunters from the Western States, with their rifles, who had made
their head-quarters at the Pueblo; and these, together with the Americans and
Englishmen in the place, who were between twenty and thirty in number,
took possession of the town, and, waiting a reasonable time, proceeded to
try the man according to the forms in their own country. A judge and jury
were appointed, and he was tried, convicted, sentenced to be shot, and
carried out before the town blindfolded. The names of all the men were then
put into a hat, and each one pledging himself to perform his duty, twelve
names were drawn out, and the men took their stations with their rifles, and,
firing at the word, laid him dead. He was decently buried, and the place
was restored quietly to the proper authorities. A general, with
titles enough for an hidalgo, was at San Gabriel, and issued
a proclamation as long as the fore-top-bowline, threatening destruction to
the rebels, but never stirred from his fort; for forty Kentucky hunters, with
their rifles, and a dozen of Yankees and Englishmen, were a match for a whole
regiment of hungry, drawling, lazy half-breeds. This affair happened while we
were at San Pedro (the port of the Pueblo), and we had the
particulars from those who were on the spot. A few months afterwards,
another man was murdered on the high-road between the Pueblo and San
Luis Rey by his own wife and a man with whom she ran off. The foreigners
pursued and shot them both, according to one story. According to another
version, nothing was done about it, as the parties were natives, and a man
whom I frequently saw in San Diego was pointed out as the murderer. Perhaps
they were two cases, that had got mixed.
When a crime has been committed by Indians, justice, or
rather vengeance, is not so tardy. One Sunday afternoon, while I was
at San Diego, an Indian was sitting on his horse, when another, with whom
he had had some difficulty, came up to him, drew a long knife, and plunged it
directly into the horse's heart. The Indian sprang from his falling horse,
drew out the knife, and plunged it into the other Indian's breast, over his
shoulder, and laid him dead. The fellow was seized at once, clapped into the
calabozo, and kept there until an answer could be received from Monterey.
A few weeks afterwards I saw the poor wretch, sitting on the bare ground,
in front of the calabozo, with his feet chained to a stake, and handcuffs
about his wrists. I knew there was very little hope for him. Although the
deed was done in hot blood, the horse on which he was sitting being his own,
and a favorite with him, yet he was an Indian, and that was enough. In about
a week after I saw him, I heard that he had been shot. These few instances
will serve to give one a notion of the distribution of justice in
California.
In their domestic relations, these people are not better than
in their public. The men are thriftless, proud, extravagant, and very much
given to gaming; and the women have but little education, and a good deal of
beauty, and their morality, of course, is none of the best; yet the instances
of infidelity are much less frequent than one would at first suppose. In
fact, one vice is set over against another; and thus something like a balance
is obtained. If the women have but little virtue, the jealousy of their
husbands is extreme, and their revenge deadly and almost certain. A
few inches of cold steel has been the punishment of many an unwary man,
who has been guilty, perhaps, of nothing more than indiscretion. The
difficulties of the attempt are numerous, and the consequences of discovery
fatal, in the better classes. With the unmarried women, too, great
watchfulness is used. The main object of the parents is to marry their
daughters well, and to this a fair name is necessary. The sharp eyes of a
dueña, and the ready weapons of a father or brother, are a protection which
the characters of most of them—men and women—render by no
means useless; for the very men who would lay down their lives to
avenge the dishonor of their own family would risk the same lives
to complete the dishonor of another.
Of the poor Indians very little care is taken. The
priests, indeed, at the missions, are said to keep them very strictly,
and some rules are usually made by the alcaldes to punish
their misconduct; yet it all amounts to but little. Indeed, to show
the entire want of any sense of morality or domestic duty among them, I
have frequently known an Indian to bring his wife, to whom he was lawfully
married in the church, down to the beach, and carry her back again, dividing
with her the money which she had got from the sailors. If any of the girls
were discovered by the alcalde to be open evil livers, they were whipped, and
kept at work sweeping the square of the presidio, and carrying mud and bricks
for the buildings; yet a few reals would generally buy them
off. Intemperance, too, is a common vice among the Indians. The Mexicans,
on the contrary, are abstemious, and I do not remember ever having seen a
Mexican intoxicated.
Such are the people who inhabit a country embracing four or
five hundred miles of sea-coast, with several good harbors; with
fine forests in the north; the waters filled with fish, and the
plains covered with thousands of herds of cattle; blessed with a
climate than which there can be no better in the world; free from
all manner of diseases, whether epidemic or endemic; and with a soil in
which corn yields from seventy to eighty fold. In the hands of an
enterprising people, what a country this might be! we are ready to say. Yet
how long would a people remain so, in such a country? The Americans (as those
from the United States are called) and Englishmen, who are fast filling up
the principal towns, and getting the trade into their hands, are indeed more
industrious and effective than the Mexicans; yet their children are brought
up Mexicans in most respects, and if the ``California fever'' (laziness)
spares the first generation, it is likely to attack the second.
CHAPTER XXII
Saturday, July 18th. This day sailed the Mexican
hermaphrodite brig Fazio, for San Blas and Mazatlan. This was the brig which
was driven ashore at San Pedro in a southeaster, and had been lying at San
Diego to repair and take in her cargo. The owner of her had had a good deal
of difficulty with the government about the duties, &c., and her sailing
had been delayed for several weeks; but everything having been arranged, she
got under way with a light breeze, and was floating out of the harbor, when
two horsemen came dashing down to the beach at full speed, and tried to
find a boat to put off after her; but there being none then at hand, they
offered a handful of silver to any Kanaka who would swim off and take a
letter on board. One of the Kanakas, an active, well-made young fellow,
instantly threw off everything but his duck trousers, and, putting the letter
into his hat, swam off, after the vessel. Fortunately the wind was very
light, and the vessel was going slowly, so that, although she was nearly a
mile off when he started, he gained on her rapidly. He went through
the water leaving a wake like a small steamboat. I certainly never
saw such swimming before. They saw him coming from the deck, but did not
heave-to, suspecting the nature of his errand; yet, the wind continuing
light, he swam alongside, and got on board, and delivered his letter. The
captain read the letter, told the Kanaka there was no answer, and, giving him
a glass of brandy, left him to jump overboard and find the best of his way to
the shore. The Kanaka swam in for the nearest point of land, and in about an
hour made his appearance at the hide-house. He did not seem at
all fatigued, had made three or four dollars, got a glass of brandy, and
was in high spirits. The brig kept on her course, and the government
officers, who had come down to forbid her sailing, went back, each with
something very like a flea in his ear, having depended upon extorting a
little more money from the owner.
It was now nearly three months since the Alert arrived at
Santa Barbara, and we began to expect her daily. About half a mile behind
the hide-house was a high hill, and every afternoon, as soon as we had done
our work, some one of us walked up to see if there was a sail in sight,
coming down before the regular trades. Day after day we went up the hill, and
came back disappointed. I was anxious for her arrival, for I had been told by
letter, that the owners in Boston, at the request of my friends, had written
to Captain Thompson to take me on board the Alert, in case she returned to
the United States before the Pilgrim; and I, of course, wished to know
whether the order had been received, and what was the destination of the
ship. One year, more or less, might be of small consequence to others, but it
was everything to me. It was now just a year since we sailed from Boston,
and, at the shortest, no vessel could expect to get away under eight
or nine months, which would make our absence two years in all. This would
be pretty long, but would not be fatal. It would not necessarily be decisive
of my future life. But one year more might settle the matter. I might be a
sailor for life; and although I had pretty well made up my mind to it before
I had my letters from home, yet, as soon as an opportunity was held out to me
of returning, and the prospect of another kind of life was opened to me,
my anxiety to return, and, at least, to have the chance of deciding upon my
course for myself, was beyond measure. Beside that, I wished to be ``equal to
either fortune,'' and to qualify myself for an officer's berth, and a
hide-house was no place to learn seamanship in. I had become experienced in
hide-curing, and everything went on smoothly, and I had many opportunities
of becoming acquainted with the people, and much leisure for reading and
studying navigation; yet practical seamanship could only be got on board
ship, therefore I determined to ask to be taken on board the ship when she
arrived. By the first of August we finished curing all our hides, stored them
away, cleaned out our vats (in which latter work we spent two days, up to our
knees in mud and the sediments of six months' hide-curing, in a
stench which would drive a donkey from his breakfast), and got all
in readiness for the arrival of the ship, and had another leisure interval
of three or four weeks. I spent these, as usual, in reading, writing,
studying, making and mending my clothes, and getting my wardrobe in complete
readiness in case I should go on board the ship; and in fishing, ranging the
woods with the dogs, and in occasional visits to the presidio and mission. A
good deal of my time was passed in taking care of a little puppy, which
I had selected from thirty-six that were born within three days of one
another at our house. He was a fine, promising pup, with four white paws, and
all the rest of his body of a dark brown. I built a little kennel for him,
and kept him fastened there, away from the other dogs, feeding and
disciplining him myself. In a few weeks I brought him into complete
subjection, and he grew nicely, was much attached to me, and bade fair to be
one of the leading dogs on the beach. I called him Bravo, and all I regretted
at the thought of leaving the beach was parting from him and the
Kanakas.
Day after day we went up the hill, but no ship was to be seen,
and we began to form all sorts of conjectures as to her whereabouts; and
the theme of every evening's conversation at the different houses, and in our
afternoon's paseo upon the beach, was the ship,— where she could be, had she
been to San Francisco, how many hides she would bring, &c.,
&c.
Tuesday, August 25th. This morning the officer in charge of
our house went off beyond the point a-fishing, in a small canoe, with two
Kanakas; and we were sitting quietly in our room at the hide-house, when,
just before noon, we heard a complete yell of ``Sail ho!'' breaking out from
all parts of the beach at once,— from the Kanakas' oven to the Rosa's
hide-house. In an instant every one was out of his house, and there was a
tall, gallant ship, with royals and skysails set, bending over before the
strong afternoon breeze, and coming rapidly round the point. Her
yards were braced sharp up; every sail was set, and drew well; the
stars and stripes were flying from her mizzen-peak, and, having the
tide in her favor, she came up like a race-horse. It was nearly six months
since a new vessel had entered San Diego, and, of course, every one was wide
awake. She certainly made a fine appearance. Her light sails were taken in,
as she passed the low, sandy tongue of land, and clewing up her head sails,
she rounded handsomely to under her mizzen topsail, and let go her anchor at
about a cable's length from the shore. In a few minutes the topsail yards
were manned, and all three of the topsails furled at once. From the fore
top-gallant yard, the men slid down the stay to furl the jib, and from the
mizzen top-gallant yard, by the stay, into the main-top, and thence to the
yard; and the men on the topsail yards came down the lifts to the yard-arms
of the courses. The sails were furled with great care, the bunts triced up by
jiggers, and the jibs stowed in cloth. The royal-yards were then
struck, tackles got upon the yard-arms and the stay, the long-boat
hoisted out, a large anchor carried astern, and the ship moored. This
was the Alert.
The gig was lowered away from the quarter, and a boat's crew
of fine lads, between the ages of fourteen and eighteen, pulled
the captain ashore. The gig was a light whale-boat, handsomely painted,
and fitted up with cushions and tiller-ropes in the stern sheets. We
immediately attacked the boat's crew, and got very thick with them in a few
minutes. We had much to ask about Boston, their passage out, &c., and
they were very curious to know about the kind of life we were leading upon
the beach. One of them offered to exchange with me, which was just what I
wanted, and we had only to get the permission of the captain.
After dinner the crew began discharging their hides, and, as
we had nothing to do at the hide-houses, we were ordered aboard to help
them. I had now my first opportunity of seeing the ship which I hoped was to
be my home for the next year. She looked as well on board as she did from
without. Her decks were wide and roomy (there being no poop, or house on
deck, which disfigures the after part of most of our vessels), flush fore and
aft, and as white as flax, which the crew told us was from constant use of
holystones. There was no foolish gilding and gingerbread work, to take the
eye of landsmen and passengers, but everything was ``ship-shape.'' There
was no rust, no dirt, no rigging hanging slack, no fag-ends of ropes and
``Irish pendants'' aloft, and the yards were squared ``to a t'' by lifts and
braces. The mate was a hearty fellow, with a roaring voice, and always wide
awake. He was ``a man, every inch of him,'' as the sailors said; and though
``a bit of a horse,'' and ``a hard customer,'' yet he was generally liked by
the crew. There was also a second and third mate, a carpenter,
sailmaker, steward, and cook, and twelve hands before the mast. She had
on board seven thousand hides, which she had collected at the windward,
and also horns and tallow. All these we began discharging from both gangways
at once into the two boats, the second mate having charge of the launch, and
the third mate of the pinnace. For several days we were employed in this way,
until all the hides were taken out, when the crew began taking in
ballast, and we returned to our old work, hide-curing.
Saturday, August 29th. Arrived, brig Catalina, from the
windward.
Sunday, August 30th. This was the first Sunday that the
Alert's crew had been in San Diego, and of course they were all for
going up to see the town. The Indians came down early, with horses to let
for the day, and those of the crew who could obtain liberty went off to the
Presidio and Mission, and did not return until night. I had seen enough of
San Diego, and went on board and spent the day with some of the crew, whom I
found quietly at work in the forecastle, either mending and washing their
clothes, or reading and writing. They told me that the ship stopped at Callao
on the passage out, and lay there three weeks. She had a passage of
a little over eighty days from Boston to Callao, which is one of
the shortest on record. There they left the Brandywine frigate, and some
smaller American ships of war, and the English frigate Blonde, and a French
seventy-four. From Callao they came directly to California, and had visited
every port on the coast, including San Francisco. The forecastle in which
they lived was large, tolerably well lighted by bull's-eyes, and, being kept
perfectly clean, had quite a comfortable appearance; at least, it was
far better than the little, black, dirty hole in which I had lived so many
months on board the Pilgrim. By the regulations of the ship, the forecastle
was cleaned out every morning; and the crew, being very neat, kept it clean
by some regulations of their own, such as having a large spit-box always
under the steps and between the bits, and obliging every man to hang up his
wet clothes, &c. In addition to this, it was holystoned every Saturday
morning. In the after part of the ship was a handsome cabin, a dining-room,
and a trade-room, fitted out with shelves, and furnished with all sorts of
goods. Between these and the forecastle was the ``between-decks,'' as high as
the gun-deck of a frigate, being six feet and a half, under the beams. These
between-decks were holystoned regularly, and kept in the most perfect order;
the carpenter's bench and tools being in one part, the sailmaker's
in another, and boatswain's locker, with the spare rigging, in a third. A
part of the crew slept here, in hammocks swung fore and aft from the beams,
and triced up every morning. The sides of the between-decks were clapboarded,
the knees and stanchions of iron, and the latter made to unship. The crew
said she was as tight as a drum, and a fine sea boat, her only fault being—
that of most fast ships—that she was wet forward. When she was going, as
she sometimes would, eight or nine knots on a wind, there would not be a
dry spot forward of the gangway. The men told great stories of her sailing,
and had entire confidence in her as a ``lucky ship.'' She was seven years
old, had always been in the Canton trade, had never met with an accident of
any consequence, nor made a passage that was not shorter than the average.
The third mate, a young man about eighteen years of age, nephew of one of the
owners, had been in the ship from a small boy, and ``believed in the ship'';
and the chief mate thought as much of her as he would of a wife
and family.
The ship lay about a week longer in port, when, having
discharged her cargo and taken in ballast, she prepared to get under way.
I now made my application to the captain to go on board. He told me that I
could go home in the ship when she sailed (which I knew before); and, finding
that I wished to be on board while she was on the coast, said he had no
objection, if I could find one of my own age to exchange with me for the
time. This I easily accomplished, for they were glad to change the scene by a
few months on shore, and, moreover, escape the winter and
the southeasters; and I went on board the next day, with my chest
and hammock, and found myself once more afloat.
CHAPTER XXIII
Tuesday, September 8th, 1835. This was my first day's duty
on board the ship; and though a sailor's life is a sailor's life wherever
it may be, yet I found everything very different here from the customs of the
brig Pilgrim. After all hands were called at daybreak, three minutes and a
half were allowed for the men to dress and come on deck, and if any were
longer than that, they were sure to be overhauled by the mate, who was always
on deck, and making himself heard all over the ship. The head-pump was
then rigged, and the decks washed down by the second and third mates; the
chief mate walking the quarter-deck, and keeping a general supervision, but
not deigning to touch a bucket or a brush. Inside and out, fore and aft,
upper deck and between-decks, steerage and forecastle, rail, bulwarks, and
water-ways, were washed, scrubbed, and scraped with brooms and canvas, and
the decks were wet and sanded all over, and then holystoned. The holystone is
a large, soft stone, smooth on the bottom, with long ropes attached to
each end, by which the crew keep it sliding fore and aft over the
wet sanded decks. Smaller hand-stones, which the sailors
call ``prayer-books,'' are used to scrub in among the crevices and narrow
places, where the large holystone will not go. An hour or two we were kept at
this work, when the head-pump was manned, and all the sand washed off the
decks and sides. Then came swabs and squilgees; and, after the decks were
dry, each one went to his particular morning job. There were five boats
belonging to the ship,—launch, pinnace, jolly-boat, larboard quarter-boat,
and gig,—each of which had a coxswain, who had charge of it, and
was answerable for the order and cleanness of it. The rest of the cleaning
was divided among the crew; one having the brass and composition work about
the capstan; another the bell, which was of brass, and kept as bright as a
gilt button; a third, the harness-cask; another, the man-rope stanchions;
others, the steps of the forecastle and hatchways, which were hauled up
and holystoned. Each of these jobs must be finished before breakfast; and
in the mean time the rest of the crew filled the scuttled-butt, and the cook
scraped his kids (wooden tubs out of which sailors eat), and polished the
hoops, and placed them before the galley to await inspection. When the decks
were dry, the lord paramount made his appearance on the quarter-deck, and
took a few turns, eight bells were struck, and all hands went to
breakfast. Half an hour was allowed for breakfast, when all hands were
called again; the kids, pots, bread-bags, &c., stowed away; and,
this morning, preparations were made for getting under way. We paid out on
the chain by which we swung, hove in on the other, catted the anchor, and
hove short on the first. This work was done in shorter time than was usual on
board the brig; for though everything was more than twice as large and heavy,
the cat-block being as much as a man could lift, and the chain as large as
three of the Pilgrim's, yet there was a plenty of room to move about in,
more discipline and system, more men, and more good-will. Each
seemed ambitious to do his best. Officers and men knew their duty, and all
went well. As soon as she was hove short, the mate, on the forecastle, gave
the order to loose the sails! and, in an instant all sprung into the rigging,
up the shrouds, and out on the yards, scrambling by one another,—the first
up, the best fellow,—cast off the yard-arm gaskets and bunt gaskets, and
one man remained on each yard, holding the bunt jigger with a turn round the
tye, all ready to let go, while the rest laid down to man the sheets
and halyards. The mate then hailed the yards,—``All ready
forward?''— ``All ready the cross-jack yards?'' &c., &c.; and ``Aye,
aye, sir!'' being returned from each, the word was given to let go; and,
in the twinkling of an eye, the ship, which had shown nothing but her bare
yards, was covered with her loose canvas, from the royal-mast-heads to the
decks. All then came down, except one man in each top, to overhaul the
rigging, and the topsails were hoisted and sheeted home, the three yards
going to the mast-head at once, the larboard watch hoisting the fore, the
starboard watch the main, and five light hands (of whom I was one), picked
from the two watches, the mizzen. The yards were then trimmed, the anchor
weighed, the cat-block hooked on, the fall stretched out, manned by ``all
hands and the cook,'' and the anchor brought to the head with ``cheerly,
men!'' in full chorus. The ship being now under way, the light sails were
set, one after another, and she was under full sail before she had passed the
sandy point. The fore royal, which fell to my lot (as I was in the mate's
watch), was more than twice as large as that of the Pilgrim, and, though
I could handle the brig's easily, I found my hands full with
this, especially as there were no jacks to the ship, everything being for
neatness, and nothing left for Jack to hold on by but
his ``eyelids.''
As soon as we were beyond the point, and all sail out, the
order was given, ``Go below, the watch!'' and the crew said that,
ever since they had been on the coast, they had had ``watch and
watch'' while going from port to port; and, in fact, all things
showed that, though strict discipline was kept, and the utmost
was required of every man in the way of his duty, yet, on the whole, there
was good usage on board. Each one knew that he must be a man, and show
himself such when at his duty, yet all were satisfied with the treatment; and
a contented crew, agreeing with one another, and finding no fault, was a
contrast indeed with the small, hard-used, dissatisfied, grumbling,
desponding crew of the Pilgrim.
It being the turn of our watch to go below, the men set
themselves to work, mending their clothes, and doing other little things
for themselves; and I, having got my wardrobe in complete order at
San Diego, had nothing to do but to read. I accordingly overhauled
the chests of the crew, but found nothing that suited me exactly, until
one of the men said he had a book which ``told all about a great
highwayman,'' at the bottom of his chest, and, producing it, I found, to my
surprise and joy, that it was nothing else than Bulwer's Paul Clifford. I
seized it immediately, and, going to my hammock, lay there, swinging and
reading, until the watch below was out. The between-decks clear, the
hatchways open, a cool breeze blowing through them, the ship under easy
way,—everything was comfortable. I had just got well into the story when
eight bells were struck, and we were all ordered to dinner. After
dinner came our watch on deck for four hours, and at four o'clock I
went below again, turned into my hammock and read until the dog watch. As
lights were not allowed after eight o'clock, there was no reading in the
night watch. Having light winds and calms, we were three days on the passage,
and each watch below, during the daytime, I spent in the same manner, until I
had finished my book. I shall never forget the enjoyment I derived from it.
To come across anything with the slightest claims to literary merit was
so unusual that this was a feast to me. The brilliancy of the book, the
succession of capital hits, and the lively and characteristic sketches, kept
me in a constant state of pleasing sensations. It was far too good for a
sailor. I could not expect such fine times to last long.
While on deck, the regular work of the ship went on. The
sailmaker and carpenter worked between decks, and the crew had their work
to do upon the rigging, drawing yarns, making spun-yarn, &c., as usual
in merchantmen. The night watches were much more pleasant than on board the
Pilgrim. There, there were so few in a watch, that, one being at the wheel
and another on the lookout, there was no one left to talk with; but here we
had seven in a watch, so that we had long yarns in abundance. After two or
three night watches, I became well acquainted with the larboard watch.
The sailmaker was the head man of the watch, and was generally considered
the most experienced seaman on board. He was a thorough-bred old
man-of-war's-man, had been at sea twenty-two years, in all kinds of
vessels,—men-of-war, privateers, slavers, and merchantmen,—everything
except whalers, which a thorough man-of-war or merchant seaman looks down
upon, and will always steer clear of if he can. He had, of course, been in
most parts of the world, and was remarkable for drawing a long bow. His
yarns frequently stretched through a watch, and kept all hands awake. They
were amusing from their improbability, and, indeed, he never expected to be
believed, but spun them merely for amusement; and as he had some humor and a
good supply of man-of-war slang and sailor's salt phrases, he always made
fun. Next to him in age and experience, and, of course, in standing in the
watch, was an Englishman named Harris, of whom I shall have more to
say hereafter. Then came two or three Americans, who had been the common
run of European and South American voyages, and one who had been in a
``spouter,'' and, of course, had all the whaling stories to himself. Last of
all was a broad-backed, thick-headed, Cape Cod[1] boy, who had been in
mackerel schooners, and was making his first voyage in a square-rigged
vessel. He was born in Hingham, and of course was called ``Bucket-maker.''
The other watch was composed of about the same number. A tall, fine-looking
Frenchman, with coal-black whiskers and curly hair, a first-rate
seaman, named John (one name is enough for a sailor), was the head man
of the watch. Then came two Americans (one of whom had been a dissipated
young man of some property and respectable connections, and was reduced to
duck trousers and monthly wages), a German, an English lad, named Ben, who
belonged on the mizzen-topsail yard with me, and was a good sailor for his
years, and two Boston boys just from the public schools. The carpenter
sometimes mustered in the starboard watch, and was an old sea-dog, a Swede by
birth, and accounted the best helmsman in the ship. This was our
ship's company, beside cook and steward, who were blacks, three mates, and
the captain.
The second day out, the wind drew ahead, and we had to beat up
the coast; so that, in tacking ship, I could see the regulations of the
vessel. Instead of going wherever was most convenient, and running from place
to place, wherever work was to be done, each man had his station. A regular
tacking and wearing bill was made out. The chief mate commanded on the
forecastle, and had charge of the head sails and the forward part of the
ship. Two of the best men in the ship, the sailmaker from our watch, and
John, the Frenchman, from the other, worked the forecastle. The third
mate commanded in the waist, and, with the carpenter and one man, worked
the main tack and bowline; the cook, ex officio, the fore sheet, and the
steward the main. The second mate had charge of the after yards, and let go
the lee fore and main braces. I was stationed at the weather cross-jack
braces; three other light hands at the lee; one boy at the spanker-sheet and
guy; a man and a boy at the main topsail, top-gallant, and royal braces; and
all the rest of the crew—men and boys—tallied on to the main brace.
Every one here knew his station, must be there when all hands were called to
put the ship about, and was answerable for the ropes committed to him. Each
man's rope must be let go and hauled in at the order, properly made fast, and
neatly coiled away when the ship was about. As soon as all hands are at
their stations, the captain, who stands on the weather side of
the quarter-deck, makes a sign to the man at the wheel to put it down, and
calls out ``Helm's a lee'!'' ``Helm's a lee'!'' answers the mate on the
forecastle, and the head sheets are let go. ``Raise tacks and sheets!'' says
the captain; ``tacks and sheets!'' is passed forward, and the fore tack and
main sheet are let go. The next thing is to haul taut for a swing. The
weather cross-jack braces and the lee main braces are belayed together upon
two pins, and ready to be let go, and the opposite braces hauled
taut. ``Main topsail haul!'' shouts the captain; the braces are let
go; and if he has chosen his time well, the yards swing round like a top;
but if he is too late, or too soon, it is like drawing teeth. The after yards
are then braced up and belayed, the main sheet hauled aft, the spanker eased
over to leeward, and the men from the braces stand by the head yards. ``Let
go and haul!'' says the captain; the second mate lets go the weather fore
braces, and the men haul in to leeward. The mate, on the forecastle, looks
out for the head yards. ``Well the fore topsail yard!''
``Top-gallant yard's well!'' ``Royal yard too much! Haul in to windward!
So! well that!'' ``Well all!'' Then the starboard watch board the
main tack, and the larboard watch lay forward and board the fore tack and
haul down the jib sheet, clapping a tackle upon it if it blows very fresh.
The after yards are then trimmed, the captain generally looking out for them
himself. ``Well the cross-jack[2] yard!'' ``Small pull the main top-gallant
yard!'' ``Well that!'' ``Well the mizzen topsail yard!'' ``Cross-jack yards
all well!'' ``Well all aft!'' ``Haul taut to windward!'' Everything being
now trimmed and in order, each man coils up the rigging at his
own station, and the order is given, ``Go below the watch!''
During the last twenty-four hours of the passage, we beat off
and on the land, making a tack about once in four hours, so that I
had sufficient opportunity to observe the working of the ship;
and certainly it took no more men to brace about this ship's lower yards,
which were more than fifty feet square, than it did those of the Pilgrim,
which were not much more than half the size; so much depends upon the manner
in which the braces run, and the state of the blocks; and Captain Wilson, of
the Ayacucho, who was afterwards a passenger with us, upon a trip to
windward, said he had no doubt that our ship worked two men lighter than his
brig. This light working of the ship was owing to the attention
and seamanship of Captain Faucon. He had reeved anew nearly all
the running rigging of the ship, getting rid of useless blocks, putting
single blocks for double wherever he could, using pendent blocks, and
adjusting the purchases scientifically.
Friday, September 11th. This morning, at four o'clock, went
below, San Pedro point being about two leagues ahead, and the ship
going on under studding-sails. In about an hour we were waked up by
the hauling of the chain about decks, and in a few minutes ``All
hands ahoy!'' was called; and we were all at work, hauling in and
making up the studding-sails, overhauling the chain forward, and
getting the anchors ready. ``The Pilgrim is there at anchor,'' said
some one, as we were running about decks; and, taking a moment's look over
the rail, I saw my old friend, deeply laden, lying at anchor inside of the
kelp. In coming to anchor, as well as in tacking ship, each one had his
station and duty. The light sails were clewed up and furled, the courses
hauled up, and the jibs down; then came the topsails in the buntlines, and
the anchor let go. As soon as she was well at anchor, all hands lay aloft to
furl the topsails; and this, I soon found, was a great matter on board
this ship; for every sailor knows that a vessel is judged of, a good deal,
by the furl of her sails. The third mate, sailmaker, and the larboard watch,
went upon the fore topsail yard; the second mate, carpenter, and the
starboard watch, upon the main; and I, and the English lad, and the two
Boston boys, and the young Cape Cod man, furled the mizzen topsail. This sail
belonged to us altogether to reef and to furl, and not a man was allowed to
come upon our yard. The mate took us under his special care, frequently
making us furl the sail over three or four times, until we got the bunt up to
a perfect cone, and the whole sail without a wrinkle. As soon as each sail
was hauled up and the bunt made, the jigger was bent on to the slack of the
buntlines, and the bunt triced up, on deck. The mate then took his place
between the knight-heads to ``twig'' the fore, on the windlass to twig the
main, and at the foot of the mainmast for the mizzen; and if anything was
wrong,—too much bunt on one side, clews too taut or too slack, or any sail
abaft the yard,—the whole must be dropped again. When all was right, the
bunts were triced well up, the yard-arm gaskets passed, so as not to leave a
wrinkle forward of the yard—short gaskets, with turns close
together.
From the moment of letting go the anchor, when the captain
ceases his care of things, the chief mate is the great man. With a
voice like a young lion, he was hallooing in all directions,
making everything fly, and, at the same time, doing everything well.
He was quite a contrast to the worthy, quiet, unobtrusive mate of
the Pilgrim, not a more estimable man, perhaps, but a far better mate of a
vessel; and the entire change in Captain Thompson's conduct, since he took
command of the ship, was owing, no doubt, in a great measure, to this fact.
If the chief officer wants force, discipline slackens, everything gets out of
joint, and the captain interferes continually; that makes a difficulty
between them, which encourages the crew, and the whole ends in a
three-sided quarrel. But Mr. Brown (a Marblehead man) wanted no help
from anybody, took everything into his own hands, and was more likely to
encroach upon the authority of the master than to need any spurring. Captain
Thompson gave his directions to the mate in private, and, except in coming to
anchor, getting under way, tacking, reefing topsails, and other
``all-hands-work,'' seldom appeared in person. This is the proper state of
things; and while this lasts, and there is a good understanding aft,
everything will go on well.
Having furled all the sails, the royal yards were next to be
sent down. The English lad and myself sent down the main, which was larger
than the Pilgrim's main top-gallant yard; two more light hands the fore, and
one boy the mizzen. This order we kept while on the coast, sending them up
and down every time we came in and went out of port. They were all tripped
and lowered together, the main on the starboard side, and the fore and mizzen
to port. No sooner was she all snug, than tackles were got up on the yards
and stays, and the long-boat and pinnace hove out. The swinging booms were
then guyed out, and the boats made fast by geswarps, and everything in harbor
style. After breakfast, the hatches were taken off, and everything got ready
to receive hides from the Pilgrim. All day, boats were passing and repassing,
until we had taken her hides from her, and left her in ballast trim.
These hides made but little show in our hold, though they had loaded
the Pilgrim down to the water's edge. This changing of the hides settled
the question of the destination of the two vessels, which had been one of
some speculation with us. We were to remain in the leeward ports, while the
Pilgrim was to sail, the next morning, for San Francisco. After we had
knocked off work, and cleared up decks for the night, my friend Stimson came
on board, and spent an hour with me in our berth between decks. The Pilgrim's
crew envied me my place on board the ship, and seemed to think that I had
got a little to windward of them, especially in the matter of going home
first. Stimson was determined to go home in the Alert, by begging or buying.
If Captain Thompson would not let him come on other terms, he would purchase
an exchange with some one of the crew. The prospect of another year after the
Alert should sail was rather ``too much of the monkey.'' About seven o'clock
the mate came down into the steerage in fine trim for fun, roused the
boys out of the berth, turned up the carpenter with his fiddle, sent the
steward with lights to put in the between-decks, and set all hands to
dancing. The between-decks were high enough to allow of jumping, and being
clear, and white, from holystoning, made a good dancing-hall. Some of the
Pilgrim's crew were in the forecastle, and they all turned-to and had a
regular sailor's shuffle till eight bells. The Cape Cod boy could dance the
true fisherman's jig, barefooted, knocking with his heels, and slapping the
decks with his bare feet, in time with the music. This was a
favorite amusement of the mate's, who used to stand at the steerage
door, looking on, and if the boys would not dance, hazed them round with a
rope's end, much to the entertainment of the men.
The next morning, according to the orders of the agent,
the Pilgrim set sail for the windward, to be gone three or four months.
She got under way with no fuss, and came so near us as to throw a letter on
board, Captain Faucon standing at the tiller himself, and steering her as he
would a mackerel smack. When Captain Thompson was in command of the Pilgrim,
there was as much preparation and ceremony as there would be in getting
a seventy-four under way. Captain Faucon was a sailor, every inch of him.
He knew what a ship was, and was as much at home in one as a cobbler in his
stall. I wanted no better proof of this than the opinion of the ship's crew,
for they had been six months under his command, and knew him thoroughly, and
if sailors allow their captain to be a good seaman, you may be sure he is
one, for that is a thing they are not usually ready to admit. To find fault
with the seamanship of the captain is a crew's reserved store
for grumbling.
After the Pilgrim left us, we lay three weeks at San Pedro,
from the 11th of September until the 2d of October, engaged in the usual
port duties of landing cargo, taking off hides, &c., &c. These duties
were much easier, and went on much more agreeably, than on board the Pilgrim.
``The more the merrier'' is the sailor's maxim, and, by a division of labor,
a boat's crew of a dozen could take off all the hides brought down in a day
without much trouble; and on shore, as well as on board, a good-will,
and no discontent or grumbling, make everything go well. The officer, too,
who usually went with us, the third mate, was a pleasant young fellow, and
made no unnecessary trouble; so that we generally had a sociable time, and
were glad to be relieved from the restraint of the ship. While here, I often
thought of the miserable, gloomy weeks we had spent in this dull place, in
the brig; discontent and hard usage on board, and four hands to do all the
work on shore. Give me a big ship. There is more room, better outfit, better
regulation, more life, and more company. Another thing was better arranged
here: we had a regular gig's crew. A light whale-boat, handsomely painted,
and fitted out with stern seats, yoke and tiller-ropes, hung on the starboard
quarter, and was used as the gig. The youngest lad in the ship, a Boston
boy about fourteen years old, was coxswain of this boat, and had
the entire charge of her, to keep her clean and have her in readiness to
go and come at any hour. Four light hands, of about the same size and age, of
whom I was one, formed her crew. Each had his oar and seat numbered, and we
were obliged to be in our places, have our oars scraped white, our tholepins
in, and the fenders over the side. The bowman had charge of the boat-hook and
painter, and the coxswain of the rudder, yoke, and stern-sheets. Our duty was
to carry the captain and agent about, and passengers off and on, which
last was no trifling duty, as the people on shore have no boats, and every
purchaser, from the boy who buys his pair of shoes, to the trader who buys
his casks and bales, was to be brought off and taken ashore in our boat. Some
days, when people were coming and going fast, we were in the boat, pulling
off and on, all day long, with hardly time for our meals, making, as
we lay nearly three miles off shore, from thirty to forty miles' rowing in
a day. Still, we thought it the best berth in the ship; for when the gig was
employed, we had nothing to do with the cargo, except with small bundles
which the passengers took with them, and no hides to carry. Besides, we had
the opportunity of seeing everybody, making acquaintances, and hearing the
news. Unless the captain or agent was in the boat, we had no officer with
us, and often had fine times with the passengers, who were always willing to
talk and joke with us. Frequently, too, we were obliged to wait several hours
on shore, when we would haul the boat up on the beach, and, leaving one to
watch her, go to the nearest house, or spend the time in strolling about the
beach, picking up shells, or playing hop-scotch, and other games, on
the hard sand. The others of the crew never left the ship, except
for bringing heavy goods and taking off hides; and though we were always
in the water, the surf hardly leaving us a dry thread from morning till
night, yet we were young, and the climate was good, and we thought it much
better than the quiet, humdrum drag and pull on board ship. We made the
acquaintance of nearly half California; for, besides carrying everybody in
our boat,—men, women, and children,—all the messages, letters, and
light packages went by us, and, being known by our dress, we found a ready
reception everywhere.
At San Pedro, we had none of this amusement, for, there being
but one house in the place, there was nothing to see and no company. All
the variety that I had was riding, once a week, to the nearest rancho,[3] to
order a bullock down to the ship.
The brig Catalina came in from San Diego, and, being bound
to windward, we both got under way at the same time, for a trial of speed
up to Santa Barbara, a distance of about eighty miles. We hove up and got
under sail about eleven o'clock at night, with a light land-breeze, which
died away toward morning, leaving us becalmed only a few miles from our
anchoring-place. The Catalina, being a small vessel, of less than half our
size, put out sweeps and got a boat ahead, and pulled out to sea during the
night, so that she had the sea-breeze earlier and stronger than we did,
and we had the mortification of seeing her standing up the coast with a
fine breeze, the sea all ruffled about her, while we were becalmed in-shore.
When the sea-breeze died away, she was nearly out of sight; and, toward the
latter part of the afternoon, the regular northwest wind setting in fresh, we
braced sharp upon it, took a pull at every sheet, tack, and halyard, and
stood after her in fine style, our ship being very good upon a taut bowline.
We had nearly five hours of splendid sailing, beating up to windward by
long stretches in and off shore, and evidently gaining upon the Catalina at
every tack. When this breeze left us, we were so near as to count the painted
ports on her side. Fortunately, the wind died away when we were on our inward
tack, and she on her outward, so we were in-shore, and caught the land-breeze
first, which came off upon our quarter, about the middle of the first watch.
All hands were turned up, and we set all sail, to the skysails and
the royal studding-sails; and with these, we glided quietly through the
water, leaving the Catalina, which could not spread so much canvas as we,
gradually astern, and, by daylight, were off Santa Buenaventura, and our
competitor nearly out of sight. The sea-breeze, however, favored her again,
while we were becalmed under the headland, and laboring slowly along, and she
was abreast of us by noon. Thus we continued, ahead, astern, and abreast
of each other, alternately; now far out at sea, and again close in under
the shore. On the third morning we came into the great bay of Santa Barbara
two hours behind the brig, and thus lost the bet; though if the race had been
to the point, we should have beaten her by five or six hours. This, however,
settled the relative sailing of the vessels, for it was admitted that
although she, being small and light, could gain upon us in very light winds,
yet whenever there was breeze enough to set us agoing, we walked away from
her like hauling in a line; and, in beating to windward, which is the best
trial of a vessel, had much the advantage.
Sunday, October 4th. This was the day of our arrival; and,
somehow or other, our captain seemed to manage, not only to sail, but
to come into port, on a Sunday. The main reason for sailing on Sunday is
not, as many people suppose, because it is thought a lucky day but because it
is a leisure day. During the six days the crew are employed upon the cargo
and other ship's works, and, Sunday being their only day of rest, whatever
additional work can be thrown into it is so much gain to the owners. This is
the reason of our coasters and packets generally sailing on Sunday. Thus it
was with us nearly all the time we were on the coast, and many of
our Sundays were lost entirely to us. The Catholics on shore do not, as a
general thing, do regular trading or make journeys on Sunday, but the
American has no national religion, and likes to show his independence of
priestcraft by doing as he chooses on the Lord's Day.
Santa Barbara looked very much as it did when I left it
five months before: the long sand beach, with the heavy rollers, breaking
upon it in a continual roar, and the little town, embedded on the plain, girt
by its amphitheatre of mountains. Day after day the sun shone clear and
bright upon the wide bay and the red roofs of the houses, everything being as
still as death, the people hardly seeming to earn their sunlight. Daylight
was thrown away upon them. We had a few visitors, and collected about
a hundred hides, and every night, at sundown, the gig was sent ashore to
wait for the captain, who spent his evenings in the town. We always took our
monkey-jackets with us, and flint and steel, and made a fire on the beach
with the driftwood and the bushes which we pulled from the neighboring
thickets, and lay down by it, on the sand. Sometimes we would stray up to the
town, if the captain was likely to stay late, and pass the time at some
of the houses, in which we were almost always well received by
the inhabitants. Sometimes earlier and sometimes later, the captain came
down; when, after a good drenching in the surf, we went aboard, changed our
clothes, and turned-in for the night,—yet not for all the night, for there
was the anchor watch to stand.
This leads me to speak of my watchmate for nine months,—
and, taking him all in all, the most remarkable man I had ever seen,— Tom
Harris. An hour, every night, while lying in port, Harris and I had the deck
to ourselves, and walking fore and aft, night after night, for months, I
learned his character and history, and more about foreign nations, the habits
of different people, and especially the secrets of sailors' lives and
hardships, and also of practical seamanship (in which he was abundantly
capable of instructing me), than I could ever have learned elsewhere.
His memory was perfect, seeming to form a regular chain, reaching from his
earliest childhood up to the time I knew him, without a link wanting. His
power of calculation, too, was extraordinary. I called myself pretty quick at
figures, and had been through a course of mathematical studies; but, working
by my head, I was unable to keep within sight of this man, who had never been
beyond his arithmetic. He carried in his head, not only a log-book of
the voyage, which was complete and accurate, and from which no one thought
of appealing, but also an accurate registry of the cargo, knowing where each
thing was stowed, and how many hides we took in at each port.
One night he made a rough calculation of the number of hides
that could be stowed in the lower hold, between the fore and main masts,
taking the depth of hold and breadth of beam (for he knew the dimensions of
every part of a ship before he had been long on board), and the average area
and thickness of a hide; and he came surprisingly near the number, as it
afterwards turned out. The mate frequently came to him to know the capacity
of different parts of the vessel, and he could tell the sailmaker very
nearly the amount of canvas he would want for each sail in the ship;
for he knew the hoist of every mast, and spread of each sail, on the head
and foot, in feet and inches. When we were at sea, he kept a running account,
in his head, of the ship's way,—the number of knots and the courses; and,
if the courses did not vary much during the twenty-four hours, by taking the
whole progress and allowing so many eights southing or northing, to so many
easting or westing, he would make up his reckoning just before the
captain took the sun at noon, and often came very near the mark. He
had, in his chest, several volumes giving accounts of inventions
in mechanics, which he read with great pleasure, and made himself master
of. I doubt if he forgot anything that he read. The only thing in the way of
poetry that he ever read was Falconer's Shipwreck, which he was charmed with,
and pages of which he could repeat. He said he could recall the name of every
sailor that had ever been his shipmate, and also of every vessel, captain,
and officer, and the principal dates of each voyage; and a sailor whom we
afterwards fell in with, who had been in a ship with Harris nearly twelve
years before, was much surprised at having Harris tell him things about
himself which he had entirely forgotten. His facts, whether dates or events,
no one thought of disputing; and his opinions few of the sailors dared to
oppose, for, right or wrong, he always had the best of the argument with
them. His reasoning powers were striking. I have had harder work
maintaining an argument with him in a watch, even when I knew myself to
be right, and he was only doubting, than I ever had before, not from his
obstinacy, but from his acuteness. Give him only a little knowledge of his
subject, and, among all the young men of my acquaintance at college, there is
not one whom I had not rather meet in an argument than this man. I never
answered a question from him, or advanced an opinion to him, without thinking
more than once. With an iron memory, he seemed to have your whole
past conversation at command, and if you said a thing now which ill agreed
with something you had said months before, he was sure to have you on the
hip. In fact, I felt, when with him, that I was with no common man. I had a
positive respect for his powers of mind, and thought, often, that if half the
pains had been spent upon his education which are thrown away yearly, in our
colleges, he would have made his mark. Like many self-taught men of
real merit, he overrated the value of a regular education; and this
I often told him, though I had profited by his error; for he
always treated me with respect, and often unnecessarily gave way to
me, from an overestimate of my knowledge. For the intellectual capacities
of all the rest of the crew,—captain and all,—he had a sovereign
contempt. He was a far better sailor, and probably a better navigator, than
the captain, and had more brains than all the after part of the ship put
together. The sailors said, ``Tom's got a head as long as the bowsprit,'' and
if any one fell into an argument with him, they would call out: ``Ah, Jack!
you had better drop that as you would a hot potato, for Tom will turn you
inside out before you know it!''
I recollect his posing me once on the subject of the Corn
Laws. I was called to stand my watch, and, coming on deck, found him
there before me; and we began, as usual, to walk fore and aft, in
the waist. He talked about the Corn Laws; asked me my opinion about them,
which I gave him, and my reasons, my small stock of which I set forth to the
best advantage, supposing his knowledge on the subject must be less than
mine, if, indeed, he had any at all. When I had got through, he took the
liberty of differing from me, and brought arguments and facts which were new
to me, and to which I was unable to reply. I confessed that I knew almost
nothing of the subject, and expressed my surprise at the extent of
his information. He said that, a number of years before, while at
a boarding-house in Liverpool, he had fallen in with a pamphlet on the
subject, and, as it contained calculations, had read it very carefully, and
had ever since wished to find some one who could add to his stock of
knowledge on the question. Although it was many years since he had seen the
book, and it was a subject with which he had had no previous acquaintance,
yet he had the chain of reasoning, founded upon principles of political
economy, fully in his memory; and his facts, so far as I could judge, were
correct; at least, he stated them with precision. The principles of
the steam-engine, too, he was familiar with, having been several months on
board a steamboat, and made himself master of its secrets. He knew every
lunar star in both hemispheres, and was a master of the quadrant and sextant.
The men said he could take a meridian altitude of the sun from a tar bucket.
Such was the man, who, at forty, was still a dog before the mast, at twelve
dollars a month. The reason of this was to be found in his past life, as
I had it, at different times, from himself.
He was an Englishman, a native of Ilfracomb, in Devonshire.
His father was skipper of a small coaster from Bristol, and, dying, left
him, when quite young, to the care of his mother, by whose exertions he
received a common-school education, passing his winters at school and his
summers in the coasting trade until his seventeenth year, when he left home
to go upon foreign voyages. Of this mother he spoke with the greatest
respect, and said that she was a woman of a strong mind, and had an excellent
system of education, which had made respectable men of his three
brothers, and failed in him only from his own indomitable obstinacy.
One thing he mentioned, in which he said his mother differed from
all other mothers that he had ever seen disciplining their children; that
was, that when he was out of humor and refused to eat, instead of putting his
plate away, saying that his hunger would bring him to it in time, she would
stand over him and oblige him to eat it,—every mouthful of it. It was no
fault of hers that he was what I saw him; and so great was his sense of
gratitude for her efforts, though unsuccessful, that he determined, when
the voyage should end, to embark for home with all the wages he
should get, to spend with and for his mother, if perchance he should
find her alive.
After leaving home, he had spent nearly twenty years sailing
upon all sorts of voyages, generally out of the ports of New York
and Boston. Twenty years of vice! Every sin that a sailor knows, he had
gone to the bottom of. Several times he had been hauled up in the hospitals,
and as often the great strength of his constitution had brought him out again
in health. Several times, too, from his acknowledged capacity, he had been
promoted to the office of chief mate, and as often his conduct when in port,
especially his drunkenness, which neither fear nor ambition could induce him
to abandon, put him back into the forecastle. One night, when giving me an
account of his life, and lamenting the years of manhood he had thrown away,
``There,'' said he, ``in the forecastle, at the foot of those steps, a chest
of old clothes, is the result of twenty-two years of hard labor and
exposure—worked like a horse, and treated like a dog.'' As he had grown
older, he began to feel the necessity of some provision for his later years,
and came gradually to the conviction that rum had been his worst enemy.
One night, in Havana, a young shipmate of his was brought aboard drunk,
with a dangerous gash in his head, and his money and new clothes stripped
from him. Harris had been in hundreds of such scenes as these, but in his
then state of mind it fixed his determination, and he resolved never to taste
a drop of strong drink of any kind. He signed no pledge, and made no vow,
but relied on his own strength of purpose. The first thing with him was a
reason, and then a resolution, and the thing was done. The date of his
resolution he knew, of course, to the very hour. It was three years before I
became acquainted with him, and during all that time nothing stronger than
cider or coffee had passed his lips. The sailors never thought of enticing
Tom to take a glass, any more than they would of talking to the ship's
compass. He was now a temperate man for life, and capable of filling any
berth in a ship, and many a high station there is on shore which is held
by a meaner man.
He understood the management of a ship upon scientific
principles, and could give the reason for hauling every rope; and a
long experience, added to careful observation at the time, gave him
a knowledge of the expedients and resorts for times of hazard, for which I
became much indebted to him, as he took the greatest pleasure in opening his
stores of information to me, in return for what I was enabled to do for him.
Stories of tyranny and hardship which had driven men to piracy; of the
incredible ignorance of masters and mates, and of horrid brutality to the
sick, dead, and dying; as well as of the secret knavery and impositions
practised upon seamen by connivance of the owners, landlords, and
officers,— all these he had, and I could not but believe them; for he
made the impression of an exact man, to whom exaggeration was falsehood;
and his statements were always credited. I remember, among other things, his
speaking of a captain whom I had known by report, who never handed a thing to
a sailor, but put it on deck and kicked it to him; and of another, who was
highly connected in Boston, who absolutely murdered a lad from Boston who
went out with him before the mast to Sumatra, by keeping him hard at
work while ill of the coast fever, and obliging him to sleep in the close
steerage. (The same captain has since died of the same fever on the same
coast.)
In fact, taking together all that I learned from him
of seamanship, of the history of sailors' lives, of practical wisdom, and
of human nature under new circumstances and strange forms of life,—a great
history from which many are shut out,—I would not part with the hours I
spent in the watch with that man for the gift of many hours to be passed in
study and intercourse with even the best of society.
[1] Sailors call men from any part of the coast of
Massachusetts south of Boston Cape Cod men.
[2] Pronounced croj-ac.
[3] This was Sepulveda's rancho, where there was a fight,
during our war with Mexico in 1846, between some United States troops and
the Mexicans, under Don Andréas Pico.
CHAPTER XXIV
Sunday, October 11th. Set sail this morning for the
leeward; passed within sight of San Pedro, and, to our great joy, did
not come to anchor, but kept directly on to San Diego, where we arrived
and moored ship on--
Thursday, October 15th. Found here the Italian ship La Rosa,
from the windward, which reported the brig Pilgrim at San Francisco, all
well. Everything was as quiet here as usual. We discharged our hides, horns,
and tallow, and were ready to sail again on the following Sunday. I went
ashore to my old quarters, and found the gang at the hide-house going on in
the even tenor of their way, and spent an hour or two, after dark, at the
oven, taking a whiff with my old Kanaka friends, who really seemed glad to
see me again, and saluted me as the Aikane of the Kanakas. I was
grieved to find that my poor dog Bravo was dead. He had sickened and
died suddenly the very day after I sailed in the Alert.
Sunday was again, as usual, our sailing day, and we got under
way with a stiff breeze, which reminded us that it was the latter part of
the autumn, and time to expect southeasters once more. We beat up against a
strong head wind, under reefed topsails, as far as San Juan, where we came to
anchor nearly three miles from the shore, with slip-ropes on our cables, in
the old southeaster style of last winter. On the passage up, we had an old
sea-captain on board, who had married and settled in California, and had not
been on salt water for more than fifteen years. He was surprised at
the changes and improvements that had been made in ships, and still more
at the manner in which we carried sail; for he was really a little
frightened, and said that while we had top-gallant-sails on, he should have
been under reefed topsails. The working of the ship, and her progress to
windward, seemed to delight him, for he said she went to windward as though
she were kedging.
Tuesday, October 20th. Having got everything ready, we set
the agent ashore, who went up to the Mission to hurry down the hides for
the next morning. This night we had the strictest orders to look out for
southeasters; and the long, low clouds seemed rather threatening. But the
night passed over without any trouble, and early the next morning we hove out
the long-boat and pinnace, lowered away the quarter-boats, and went ashore to
bring off our hides. Here we were again, in this romantic spot,—
a perpendicular hill, twice the height of the ship's mast-head, with a
single circuitous path to the top, and long sand-beach at its base, with the
swell of the whole Pacific breaking high upon it, and our hides ranged in
piles on the overhanging summit. The captain sent me, who was the only one of
the crew that had ever been there before, to the top to count the hides and
pitch them down. There I stood again, as six months before, throwing off
the hides, and watching them, pitching and scaling, to the bottom, while
the men, dwarfed by the distance, were walking to and fro on the beach,
carrying the hides, as they picked them up, to the distant boats, upon the
tops of their heads. Two or three boat-loads were sent off, until at last all
were thrown down, and the boats nearly loaded again, when we were delayed by
a dozen or twenty hides which had lodged in the recesses of the bank,
and which we could not reach by any missiles, as the general line of the
side was exactly perpendicular, and these places were caved in, and could not
be seen or reached from the top. As hides are worth in Boston twelve and a
half cents a pound, and the captain's commission was one per cent, he
determined not to give them up, and sent on board for a pair of top-gallant
studding-sail halyards, and requested some one of the crew to go to the top
and come down by the halyards. The older sailors said the boys, who were
light and active, ought to go; while the boys thought that strength and
experience were necessary. Seeing the dilemma, and feeling myself to be near
the medium of these requisites, I offered my services, and went up, with one
man to tend the rope, and prepared for the descent.
We found a stake fastened strongly into the ground, and
apparently capable of holding my weight, to which we made one end of
the halyard well fast, and, taking the coil, threw it over the brink. The
end, we saw, just reached to a landing-place, from which the descent to the
beach was easy. Having nothing on but shirt, trousers, and hat, the common
sea rig of warm weather, I had no stripping to do, and began my descent by
taking hold of the rope with both hands, and slipping down, sometimes with
hands and feet round the rope, and sometimes breasting off with one hand and
foot against the precipice, and holding on to the rope with the other. In
this way I descended until I came to a place which shelved in, and in which
the hides were lodged. Keeping hold of the rope with one hand, I scrambled
in, and by aid of my feet and the other hand succeeded in dislodging all the
hides, and continued on my way. Just below this place, the precipice
projected again, and, going over the projection, I could see nothing below me
but the sea and the rocks upon which it broke, and a few gulls flying in
mid-air. I got down in safety, pretty well covered with dirt; and for
my pains was told, ``What a d---d fool you were to risk your life for half
a dozen hides!''
While we were carrying the hides to the boat, I perceived,
what I had been too busy to observe before, that heavy black clouds
were rolling up from seaward, a strong swell heaving in, and every sign of
a southeaster. The captain hurried everything. The hides were pitched into
the boats, and, with some difficulty, and by wading nearly up to our armpits,
we got the boats through the surf, and began pulling aboard. Our gig's crew
towed the pinnace astern of the gig, and the launch was towed by six men in
the jolly-boat. The ship was lying three miles off, pitching at her anchor,
and the farther we pulled, the heavier grew the swell. Our boat
stood nearly up and down several times; the pinnace parted her
tow-line, and we expected every moment to see the launch swamped. At
length we got alongside, our boats half full of water; and now came
the greatest trouble of all,—unloading the boats in a heavy sea, which
pitched them about so that it was almost impossible to stand in them, raising
them sometimes even with the rail, and again dropping them below the bends.
With great difficulty we got all the hides aboard and stowed under hatches,
the yard and stay tackles hooked on, and the launch and pinnace hoisted,
chocked, and griped. The quarter-boats were then hoisted up, and we
began heaving in on the chain. Getting the anchor was no easy work in such
a sea, but as we were not coming back to this port, the captain determined
not to slip. The ship's head pitched into the sea, and the water rushed
through the hawse-holes, and the chain surged so as almost to unship the
barrel of the windlass. ``Hove short, sir!'' said the mate. ``Aye, aye!
Weather-bit your chain and loose the topsails! Make sail on her, men,—with
a will!'' A few moments served to loose the topsails, which were furled
with reefs, to sheet them home, and hoist them up. ``Bear a hand!''
was the order of the day; and every one saw the necessity of it, for the
gale was already upon us. The ship broke out her own anchor, which we catted
and fished, after a fashion, and were soon close-hauled, under reefed sails,
standing off from the lee shore and rocks against a heavy head sea. The fore
course was given to her, which helped her a little; but as she hardly held
her own against the sea, which was setting her to leeward—``Board
the main tack!'' shouted the captain, when the tack was carried forward
and taken to the windlass, and all hands called to the handspikes. The great
sail bellied out horizontally, as though it would lift up the main stay; the
blocks rattled and flew about; but the force of machinery was too much for
her. ``Heave ho! Heave and pawl! Yo, heave, hearty, ho!'' and, in time with
the song, by the force of twenty strong arms, the windlass came slowly
round, pawl after pawl, and the weather clew of the sail was brought
down to the water-ways. The starboard watch hauled aft the sheet, and the
ship tore through the water like a mad horse, quivering and shaking at every
joint, and dashing from her head the foam, which flew off at each blow, yards
and yards to leeward. A half-hour of such sailing served our turn, when the
clews of the sail were hauled up, the sail furled, and the ship, eased of her
press, went more quietly on her way. Soon after, the foresail was reefed,
and we mizzen-top men were sent up to take another reef in the
mizzen topsail. This was the first time I had taken a weather earing,
and I felt not a little proud to sit astride of the weather yard-arm, pass
the earing, and sing out, ``Haul out to leeward!'' From this time until we
got to Boston the mate never suffered any one but our own gang to go upon the
mizzen topsail yard, either for reefing or furling, and the young English lad
and I generally took the earings between us.
Having cleared the point and got well out to sea, we squared
away the yards, made more sail, and stood on, nearly before the wind, for
San Pedro. It blew strong, with some rain, nearly all night, but fell calm
toward morning, and the gale having blown itself out, we
came-to,--
Thursday, October 22d, at San Pedro, in the old southeaster
berth, a league from shore, with a slip-rope on the cable, reefs in
the topsails, and rope-yarns for gaskets. Here we lay ten days, with the
usual boating, hide-carrying, rolling of cargo up the steep hill, walking
barefooted over stones, and getting drenched in salt water.
The third day after our arrival, the Rosa came in from San
Juan, where she went the day after the southeaster. Her crew said it
was as smooth as a mill-pond after the gale, and she took off nearly
a thousand hides, which had been brought down for us, and which we lost in
consequence of the southeaster. This mortified us: not only that an Italian
ship should have got to windward of us in the trade, but because every
thousand hides went towards completing the forty thousand which we were to
collect before we could say good by to California.
While lying here, we shipped one new hand, an Englishman, of
about six-and-twenty years, who was an acquisition, as he proved to be
a good sailor, could sing tolerably, and, what was of more importance to
me, had a good education and a somewhat remarkable history. He called himself
George P. Marsh; professed to have been at sea from a small boy, and to have
served his time in the smuggling trade between Germany and the coasts of
France and England. Thus he accounted for his knowledge of the
French language, which he spoke and read as well as he did English;
but his cutter education would not account for his English, which was far
too good to have been learned in a smuggler; for he wrote an uncommonly
handsome hand, spoke with great correctness, and frequently, when in private
talk with me, quoted from books, and showed a knowledge of the customs of
society, and particularly of the formalities of the various English courts of
law and of Parliament, which surprised me. Still he would give no
other account of himself than that he was educated in a smuggler. A
man whom we afterwards fell in with, who had been a shipmate of George's a
few years before, said that he heard, at the boarding-house from which they
shipped, that George had been at a college (probably a naval one, as he knew
no Latin or Greek), where he learned French and mathematics. He was not the
man by nature that Harris was. Harris had made everything of his mind
and character in spite of obstacles; while this man had evidently
been born in a different rank, and educated early in life accordingly, but
had been a vagabond, and done nothing for himself since. Neither had George
the character, strength of mind, or memory of Harris; yet there was about him
the remains of a pretty good education, which enabled him to talk quite up to
his brains, and a high spirit and amenability to the point of honor which
years of a dog's life had not broken. After he had been a little while
on board, we learned from him his adventures of the last two years, which
we afterwards heard confirmed in such a manner as put the truth of them
beyond a doubt.
He sailed from New York in the year 1833, if I mistake not,
before the mast, in the brig Lascar, for Canton. She was sold in the
East Indies, and he shipped at Manilla, in a small schooner, bound on
a trading voyage among the Ladrone and Pelew Islands. On one of the latter
islands their schooner was wrecked on a reef, and they were attacked by the
natives, and, after a desperate resistance, in which all their number, except
the captain, George, and a boy, were killed or drowned, they surrendered, and
were carried bound, in a canoe, to a neighboring island. In about a month
after this, an opportunity occurred by which one of their number might
get away. I have forgotten the circumstances, but only one could go, and
they gave way to the captain, upon his promising to send them aid if he
escaped. He was successful in his attempt; got on board an American vessel,
went back to Manilla, and thence to America, without making any effort for
their rescue, or, indeed, as George afterwards discovered, without even
mentioning their case to any one in Manilla. The boy that was with George
died, and he being alone, and there being no chance for his escape, the
natives soon treated him with kindness, and even with attention. They
painted him, tattooed his body (for he would never consent to be marked
in the face or hands), gave him two or three wives, and, in fact, made a
pet of him. In this way he lived for thirteen months, in a delicious climate,
with plenty to eat, half naked, and nothing to do. He soon, however, became
tired, and went round the island, on different pretences, to look out for a
sail. One day he was out fishing in a small canoe with another man, when he
saw a large sail to windward, about a league and a half off, passing
abreast of the island and standing westward. With some difficulty,
he persuaded the islander to go off with him to the ship, promising to
return with a good supply of rum and tobacco. These articles, which the
islanders had got a taste of from American traders, were too strong a
temptation for the fellow, and he consented. They paddled off in the track in
which the ship was bound, and lay-to until she came down to them. George
stepped on board the ship, nearly naked, painted from head to foot, and in no
way distinguishable from his companion until he began to speak. Upon this
the people on board were not a little astonished, and, having learned his
story, the captain had him washed and clothed, and, sending away the poor
astonished native with a knife or two and some tobacco and calico, took
George with him on the voyage. This was the ship Cabot, of New York, Captain
Low. She was bound to Manilla, from across the Pacific; and George did
seaman's duty in her until her arrival in Manilla, when he left her, and
shipped in a brig bound to the Sandwich Islands. From Oahu, he came, in
the British brig Clementine, to Monterey, as second officer, where, having
some difficulty with the captain, he left her, and, coming down the coast,
joined us at San Pedro. Nearly six months after this, among some papers we
received by an arrival from Boston, we found a letter from Captain Low, of
the Cabot, published immediately upon his arrival at New York, giving all
the particulars just as we had them from George. The letter was published
for the information of the friends of George, and Captain Low added that he
left him at Manilla to go to Oahu, and he had heard nothing of him
since.
George had an interesting journal of his adventures in the
Pelew Islands, which he had written out at length, in a handsome hand, and
in correct English.[1]
[1] In the spring of 1841, a sea-faring man called at my
rooms, in Boston and said he wished to see me, as he knew something about
a man I had spoken of in my book. He then told me that he was second mate
of the bark Mary Frazer, which sailed from Batavia in company with the Cabot,
bound to Manilla, that when off the Pelew Islands they fell in with a canoe
with two natives on board, who told them that there was an American ship
ahead, out of sight, and that they had put a white man on board of her. The
bark gave the canoe a tow for a short distance. When the Mary Frazer arrived
at Manilla, they found the Cabot there; and my informant said that George
came on board several times, and told the same story that I had given
of him in this book. He said the name of George's schooner was the Dash,
and that she was wrecked, and attacked by the natives, as George had told
me.
This man, whose name was Beauchamp, was second mate of the
Mary Frazer when she took the missionaries to Oahu. He became
religious during the passage, and joined the mission church at Oahu upon
his arrival. When I saw him, he was master of a bark.
CHAPTER XXV
Sunday, November 1st. Sailed this day (Sunday again) for
Santa Barbara, where we arrived on the 5th. Coming round
Santa Buenaventura, and nearing the anchorage, we saw two vessels in port,
a large full-rigged, and a small, hermaphrodite brig. The former, the crew
said, must be the Pilgrim; but I had been too long in the Pilgrim to be
mistaken in her, and I was right in differing from them, for, upon nearer
approach, her long, low, shear, sharp bows, and raking masts, told quite
another story. ``Man-of-war brig,'' said some of them; ``Baltimore
clipper,'' said others; the Ayacucho, thought I; and soon the broad folds
of the beautiful banner of St. George—white field with blood-red border
and cross—were displayed from her peak. A few minutes put it beyond a
doubt, and we were lying by the side of the Ayacucho, which had sailed from
San Diego about nine months before, while we were lying there in the Pilgrim.
She had since been to Valparaiso, Callao, and the Sandwich Islands, and had
just come upon the coast. Her boat came on board, bringing Captain Wilson;
and in half an hour the news was all over the ship that there was a
war between the United States and France. Exaggerated accounts reached the
forecastle. Battles had been fought, a large French fleet was in the Pacific,
&c., &c.; and one of the boat's crew of the Ayacucho said that, when
they left Callao, a large French frigate and the American frigate Brandywine,
which were lying there, were going outside to have a battle, and that the
English frigate Blonde was to be umpire, and see fair play. Here was
important news for us. Alone, on an unprotected coast, without an
American man-of-war within some thousands of miles, and the prospect of
a voyage home through the whole length of the Pacific and Atlantic Oceans!
A French prison seemed a much more probable place of destination than the
good port of Boston. However, we were too salt to believe every yarn that
comes into the forecastle, and waited to hear the truth of the matter from
higher authority. By means of the supercargo's clerk I got the amount of the
matter, which was, that the governments had had a difficulty about
the payment of a debt; that war had been threatened and prepared for, but
not actually declared, although it was pretty generally anticipated. This was
not quite so bad, yet was no small cause of anxiety. But we cared very little
about the matter ourselves. ``Happy go lucky'' with Jack! We did not believe
that a French prison would be much worse than ``hide droghing'' on the coast
of California; and no one who has not been a long, dull voyage, shut up in
one ship, can conceive of the effect of monotony upon one's thoughts and
wishes. The prospect of a change is a green spot in the desert, and the
probability of great events and exciting scenes creates a feeling of delight,
and sets life in motion, so as to give a pleasure which any one not in the
same state would be unable to explain. In fact, a more jovial night we had
not passed in the forecastle for months. All seemed in unaccountably
high spirits. An undefined anticipation of radical changes, of new scenes
and great doings, seemed to have possessed every one, and the common drudgery
of the vessel appeared contemptible. Here was a new vein opened,—a grand
theme of conversation and a topic for all sorts of discussions. National
feeling was wrought up. Jokes were cracked upon the only Frenchman in the
ship, and comparisons made between ``old horse'' and ``soup meagre,''
&c., &c.
We remained in uncertainty as to this war for more than
two months, when an arrival from the Sandwich Islands brought us the news
of an amicable arrangement of the difficulties.
The other vessel which we found in port was the hermaphrodite
brig Avon, from the Sandwich Islands. She was fitted up in handsome style;
fired a gun, and ran her ensign up and down at sunrise and sunset; had a band
of four or five pieces of music on board, and appeared rather like a pleasure
yacht than a trader; yet, in connection with the Loriotte, Clementine,
Bolivar, Convoy, and other small vessels, belonging to sundry Americans at
Oahu, she carried on a considerable trade,—legal and illegal,
in otter-skins, silks, teas, &c., as well as hides and
tallow.
The second day after our arrival, a full-rigged brig came
round the point from the northward, sailed leisurely through the bay, and
stood off again for the southeast in the direction of the large island of
Catalina. The next day the Avon got under way, and stood in the same
direction, bound for San Pedro. This might do for marines and Californians,
but we knew the ropes too well. The brig was never again seen on the coast,
and the Avon went into San Pedro in about a week with a replenished cargo of
Canton and American goods.
This was one of the means of escaping the heavy duties
the Mexicans lay upon all imports. A vessel comes on the coast, enters a
moderate cargo at Monterey, which is the only custom-house, and commences
trading. In a month or more, having sold a large part of her cargo, she
stretches over to Catalina, or other of the large, uninhabited islands which
lie off the coast, in a trip from port to port, and supplies herself with
choice goods from a vessel from Oahu, which has been lying off and on the
islands, waiting for her. Two days after the sailing of the Avon, the
Loriotte came in from the leeward, and without doubt had also a snatch at
the brig's cargo.
Tuesday, November 10th. Going ashore, as usual, in the gig,
just before sundown, to bring off the captain, we found, upon taking
in the captain and pulling off again, that our ship, which lay
the farthest out, had run up her ensign. This meant ``Sail ho!''
of course, but as we were within the point we could see nothing. ``Give
way, boys! Give way! Lay out on your oars, and long stroke!'' said the
captain; and stretching to the whole length of our arms, bending back again
so that our backs touched the thwarts, we sent her through the water like a
rocket. A few minutes of such pulling opened the islands, one after another,
in range of the point, and gave us a view of the Canal, where was a ship,
under top-gallant-sails, standing in, with a light breeze, for the anchorage.
Putting the boat's head in the direction of the ship, the captain told us to
lay out again; and we needed no spurring, for the prospect of boarding a new
ship, perhaps from home, hearing the news, and having something to tell of
when we got back, was excitement enough for us, and we gave way with
a will. Captain Nye, of the Loriotte, who had been an old whaleman, was in
the stern-sheets, and fell mightily into the spirit of it. ``Bend your backs,
and break your oars!'' said he. ``Lay me on, Captain Bunker!'' ``There she
flukes!'' and other exclamations current among whalemen. In the mean time it
fell flat calm, and, being within a couple of miles of the ship, we expected
to board her in a few minutes, when a breeze sprung up, dead ahead for
the ship, and she braced up and stood off toward the islands, sharp on the
larboard tack, making good way through the water. This, of course, brought us
up, and we had only to ``ease larboard oars, pull round starboard!'' and go
aboard the Alert, with something very like a flea in the ear. There was a
light land-breeze all night, and the ship did not come to anchor until the
next morning.
As soon as her anchor was down we went aboard, and found her
to be the whale-ship Wilmington and Liverpool Packet, of New Bedford, last
from the ``off-shore ground,'' with nineteen hundred barrels of oil. A
``spouter'' we knew her to be, as soon as we saw her, by her cranes and
boats, and by her stump top-gallant-masts, and a certain slovenly look to the
sails, rigging, spars, and hull; and when we got on board, we found
everything to correspond,—spouter fashion. She had a false deck, which was
rough and oily, and cut up in every direction by the chines of oil casks; her
rigging was slack, and turning white, paint worn off the spars and
blocks, clumsy seizings, straps without covers, and
``homeward-bound splices'' in every direction. Her crew, too, were not in
much better order. Her captain was a slab-sided Quaker, in a suit
of brown, with a broad-brimmed hat, bending his long legs as he
moved about decks, with his head down, like a sheep, and the men
looked more like fishermen and farmers than they did like
sailors.
Though it was by no means cold weather (we having on only our
red shirts and duck trousers), they all had on woollen trousers,—
not blue and ship-shape, but of all colors,—brown, drab, gray, aye, and
green,—with suspenders over their shoulders, and pockets to put their hands
in. This, added to Guernsey frocks, striped comforters about the neck, thick
cowhide boots, woollen caps, and a strong, oily smell, and a decidedly green
look, will complete the description. Eight or ten were on the fore topsail
yard, and as many more in the main, furling the topsails, while eight or
ten were hanging about the forecastle, doing nothing. This was a strange
sight for a vessel coming to anchor; so we went up to them, to see what was
the matter. One of them, a stout, hearty-looking fellow, held out his leg and
said he had the scurvy; another had cut his hand; and others had got nearly
well, but said that there were plenty aloft to furl the sails, so
they were sogering on the forecastle. There was only one ``splicer''
on board, a fine-looking old tar, who was in the bunt of the fore topsail.
He was probably the only thorough marline-spike seaman in the ship, before
the mast. The mates, of course, and the boat-steerers, and also two or three
of the crew, had been to sea before, but only on whaling voyages; and the
greater part of the crew were raw hands, just from the bush, and had not yet
got the hay-seed out of their hair. The mizzen topsail hung in
the buntlines until everything was furled forward. Thus a crew of thirty
men were half an hour in doing what would have been done in the Alert, with
eighteen hands to go aloft, in fifteen or twenty minutes.[1]
We found they had been at sea six or eight months, and had no
news to tell us, so we left them, and promised to get liberty to come on
board in the evening for some curiosities. Accordingly, as soon as we were
knocked off in the evening and were through supper, we obtained leave, took a
boat, and went aboard and spent an hour or two. They gave us pieces of
whalebone, and the teeth and other parts of curious sea animals, and we
exchanged books with them,— a practice very common among ships in foreign
ports, by which you get rid of the books you have read and re-read, and a
supply of new ones in their stead, and Jack is not very nice as to
their comparative value.[2]
Thursday, November 12th. This day was quite cool in the
early part, and there were black clouds about; but as it was often so
in the morning, nothing was apprehended, and all the captains went ashore
together to spend the day. Towards noon the clouds hung heavily over the
mountains, coming half-way down the hills that encircle the town of Santa
Barbara, and a heavy swell rolled in from the southeast. The mate immediately
ordered the gig's crew away, and, at the same time, we saw boats pulling
ashore from the other vessels. Here was a grand chance for a rowing-match,
and every one did his best. We passed the boats of the Ayacucho
and Loriotte, but could not hold our own with the long six-oared boat of
the whale-ship. They reached the breakers before us; but here we had the
advantage of them, for, not being used to the surf, they were obliged to wait
to see us beach our boat, just as, in the same place, nearly a year before,
we, in the Pilgrim, were glad to be taught by a boat's crew of
Kanakas.
We had hardly got the boats beached, and their heads pointed
out to sea, before our old friend, Bill Jackson, the handsome
English sailor, who steered the Loriotte's boat, called out that his
brig was adrift; and, sure enough, she was dragging her anchors,
and drifting down into the bight of the bay. Without waiting for
the captain (for there was no one on board the brig but the mate
and steward), he sprung into the boat, called the Kanakas together, and
tried to put off. But the Kanakas, though capital water-dogs, were frightened
by their vessel's being adrift, and by the emergency of the case, and seemed
to lose their faculties. Twice their boat filled, and came broadside upon the
beach. Jackson swore at them for a parcel of savages, and promised to flog
every one of them. This made the matter no better; when we came
forward, told the Kanakas to take their seats in the boat, and, going
two on each side, walked out with her till it was up to our shoulders, and
gave them a shove, when, giving way with their oars, they got her safely into
the long, regular swell. In the mean time, boats had put off to the Loriotte
from our ship and the whaler, and, coming all on board the brig together,
they let go the other anchor, paid out chain, braced the yards to the wind,
and brought the vessel up.
In a few minutes, the captains came hurrying down, on the run;
and there was no time to be lost, for the gale promised to be a
severe one, and the surf was breaking upon the beach, three deep,
higher and higher every instant. The Ayacucho's boat, pulled by
four Kanakas, put off first, and as they had no rudder or
steering-oar, would probably never have got off, had we not waded out with
them as far as the surf would permit. The next that made the attempt was
the whale-boat, for we, being the most experienced ``beach-combers,'' needed
no help, and stayed till the last. Whalemen make the best boats' crews in the
world for a long pull, but this landing was new to them, and, notwithstanding
the examples they had had, they slewed round and were hove up—
boat, oars, and men—all together, high and dry upon the sand. The second
time they filled, and had to turn their boat over, and set her off again. We
could be of no help to them, for they were so many as to be in one another's
way, without the addition of our numbers. The third time they got off, though
not without shipping a sea which drenched them all, and half filled their
boat, keeping them baling until they reached their ship. We now got ready to
go off, putting the boat's head out; English Ben and I, who were
the largest, standing on each side of the bows to keep her head out to the
sea, two more shipping and manning the two after oars, and the captain taking
the steering oar. Two or three Mexicans, who stood upon the beach looking at
us, wrapped their cloaks about them, shook their heads, and muttered
``Caramba!'' They had no taste for such doings; in fact, the hydrophobia is a
national malady, and shows itself in their persons as well as their
actions.
Watching for a ``smooth chance,'' we determined to show the
other boats the way it should be done, and, as soon as ours floated,
ran out with her, keeping her head out, with all our strength, and
the help of the captain's oar, and the two after oarsmen giving
way regularly and strongly, until our feet were off the ground, we tumbled
into the bows, keeping perfectly still, from fear of hindering the others.
For some time it was doubtful how it would go. The boat stood nearly up and
down in the water, and the sea, rolling from under her, let her fall upon the
water with a force which seemed almost to stave her bottom in. By quietly
sliding two oars forward, along the thwarts, without impeding the rowers,
we shipped two bow oars, and thus, by the help of four oars and
the captain's strong arm, we got safely off, though we shipped
several seas, which left us half full of water. We pulled alongside of
the Loriotte, put her skipper on board, and found her making preparations
for slipping, and then pulled aboard our own ship. Here Mr. Brown, always
``on hand,'' had got everything ready, so that we had only to hook on the gig
and hoist it up, when the order was given to loose the sails. While we were
on the yards, we saw the Loriotte under way, and, before our yards
were mast-headed, the Ayacucho had spread her wings, and, with
yards braced sharp up, was standing athwart our hawse. There is
no prettier sight in the world than a full-rigged, clipper-built brig,
sailing sharp on the wind. In a minute more our slip-rope was gone, the
head-yards filled away, and we were off. Next came the whaler; and in half an
hour from the time when four vessels were lying quietly at anchor, without a
rag out, or a sign of motion, the bay was deserted, and four white clouds
were moving over the water to seaward. Being sure of clearing the point,
we stood off with our yards a little braced in, while the Ayacucho went
off with a taut bowline, which brought her to windward of us. During all this
day, and the greater part of the night, we had the usual southeaster
entertainment, a gale of wind, with occasional rain, and finally topped off
with a drenching rain of three or four hours. At daybreak the clouds thinned
off and rolled away, and the sun came up clear. The wind, instead of coming
out from the northward, as is usual, blew steadily and freshly from
the anchoring-ground. This was bad for us, for, being ``flying light,''
with little more than ballast trim, we were in no condition for showing off
on a taut bowline, and had depended upon a fair wind, with which, by the help
of our light sails and studding-sails, we meant to have been the first at
the anchoring-ground; but the Ayacucho was a good league to windward of
us, and was standing in in fine style. The whaler, however, was as far to
leeward of us, and the Loriotte was nearly out of sight, among the islands,
up the Canal. By hauling every brace and bowline, and clapping watch-tackles
upon all the sheets and halyards, we managed to hold our own, and drop the
leeward vessels a little in every tack. When we reached the anchoring-ground,
the Ayacucho had got her anchor, furled her sails, squared her yards, and
was lying as quietly as if nothing had happened.
We had our usual good luck in getting our anchor without
letting go another, and were all snug, with our boats at the boom-ends,
in half an hour. In about two hours more the whaler came in, and made a
clumsy piece of work in getting her anchor, being obliged to let go her best
bower, and, finally, to get out a kedge and a hawser. They were heave-ho-ing,
stopping and unstopping, pawling, catting, and fishing for three hours; and
the sails hung from the yards all the afternoon, and were not furled until
sundown. The Loriotte came in just after dark, and let go her anchor, making
no attempt to pick up the other until the next day.
This affair led to a dispute as to the sailing of our ship and
the Ayacucho. Bets were made between the captains, and the crews took it
up in their own way; but as she was bound to leeward and we to windward, and
merchant captains cannot deviate, a trial never took place; and perhaps it
was well for us that it did not, for the Ayacucho had been eight years in the
Pacific, in every part of it,— Valparaiso, Sandwich Islands, Canton,
California, and all,—and was called the fastest merchant-man that traded in
the Pacific, unless it was the brig John Gilpin, and perhaps the ship
Ann McKim, of Baltimore.
Saturday, November 14th. This day we got under way, with the
agent and several Mexicans of note, as passengers, bound up to
Monterey. We went ashore in the gig to bring them off with their
baggage, and found them waiting on the beach, and a little afraid
about going off, as the surf was running very high. This was nuts to
us, for we liked to have a Mexican wet with salt water; and then the agent
was very much disliked by the crew, one and all; and we hoped, as there was
no officer in the boat, to have a chance to duck them, for we knew that they
were such ``marines'' that they would not know whether it was our fault or
not. Accordingly, we kept the boat so far from shore as to oblige them to wet
their feet in getting into her; and then waited for a good high
comber, and, letting the head slue a little round, sent the whole force
of the sea into the stern-sheets, drenching them from head to feet. The
Mexicans sprang out of the boat, swore, and shook themselves, and protested
against trying it again; and it was with the greatest difficulty that the
agent could prevail upon them to make another attempt. The next time we took
care, and went off easily enough, and pulled aboard. The crew came to the
side to hoist in their baggage, and heartily enjoyed the half-drowned looks
of the company.
Everything being now ready, and the passengers aboard, we ran
up the ensign and broad pennant (for there was no man-of-war, and we were
the largest vessel on the coast), and the other vessels ran up their ensigns.
Having hove short, cast off the gaskets, and made the bunt of each sail fast
by the jigger, with a man on each yard, at the word the whole canvas of the
ship was loosed, and with the greatest rapidity possible everything was
sheeted home and hoisted up, the anchor tripped and cat-headed, and the
ship under headway. We were determined to show the ``spouter'' how things
could be done in a smart ship, with a good crew, though not more than half
his numbers. The royal yards were all crossed at once, and royals and
sky-sails set, and, as we had the wind free, the booms were run out, and all
were aloft, active as cats, laying out on the yards and booms, reeving the
studding-sail gear; and sail after sail the captain piled upon her, until she
was covered with canvas, her sails looking like a great white cloud
resting upon a black speck. Before we doubled the point, we were going
at a dashing rate, and leaving the shipping far astern. We had a
fine breeze to take us through the Canal, as they call this bay of forty
miles long by ten wide. The breeze died away at night, and we were becalmed
all day on Sunday, about half-way between Santa Barbara and Point Conception.
Sunday night we had a light, fair wind, which set us up again; and having a
fine sea-breeze on the first part of Monday we had the prospect of passing,
without any trouble, Point Conception,—the Cape Horn of California,
where, the sailors say, it begins to blow the first of January, and
blows until the last of December. Toward the latter part of the afternoon,
however, the regular northwest wind, as usual, set in, which brought in our
studding-sails, and gave us the chance of beating round the Point, which we
were now just abreast of, and which stretched off into the Pacific, high,
rocky, and barren, forming the central point of the coast for hundreds of
miles north and south. A cap-full of wind will be a bag-full here, and
before night our royals were furled, and the ship was laboring hard
under her top-gallant-sails. At eight bells our watch went below, leaving
her with as much sail as she could stagger under, the water flying over the
forecastle at every plunge. It was evidently blowing harder, but then there
was not a cloud in the sky, and the sun had gone down bright.
We had been below but a short time, before we had the
usual premonitions of a coming gale,—seas washing over the whole forward
part of the vessel, and her bows beating against them with a force and sound
like the driving of piles. The watch, too, seemed very busy trampling about
decks, and singing out at the ropes. A sailor can tell, by the sound, what
sail is coming in; and, in a short time, we heard the top-gallant-sails come
in, one after another, and then the flying jib. This seemed to ease her
a good deal, and we were fast going off to the land of Nod, when— bang,
bang, bang—on the scuttle, and ``All hands, reef topsails, ahoy!'' started
us out of our berths; and, it not being very cold weather, we had nothing
extra to put on, and were soon on deck. I shall never forget the fineness of
the sight. It was a clear, and rather a chilly night; the stars were
twinkling with an intense brightness, and as far as the eye could reach there
was not a cloud to be seen. The horizon met the sea in a defined line.
A painter could not have painted so clear a sky. There was not a speck
upon it. Yet it was blowing great guns from the northwest. When you can see a
cloud to windward, you feel that there is a place for the wind to come from;
but here it seemed to come from nowhere. No person could have told from the
heavens, by their eyesight alone, that it was not a still summer's night. One
reef after another we took in the topsails, and before we could get them
hoisted up we heard a sound like a short, quick rattling of thunder, and the
jib was blown to atoms out of the bolt-rope. We got the topsails set, and the
fragments of the jib stowed away, and the fore topmast staysail set in its
place, when the great mainsail gaped open, and the sail ripped from head to
foot. ``Lay up on that main yard and furl the sail, before it blows
to tatters!'' shouted the captain; and in a moment we were up, gathering
the remains of it upon the yard. We got it wrapped round the yard, and passed
gaskets over it as snugly as possible, and were just on deck again, when,
with another loud rent, which was heard throughout the ship, the fore
topsail, which had been double-reefed, split in two athwartships, just below
the reef-band, from earing to earing. Here again it was—down yard, haul
out reef-tackles, and lay out upon the yard for reefing. By hauling the
reef-tackles chock-a-block we took the strain from the other earings, and
passing the close-reef earing, and knotting the points carefully, we
succeeded in setting the sail, close reefed.
We had but just got the rigging coiled up, and were waiting
to hear ``Go below the watch!'' when the main royal worked loose from the
gaskets, and blew directly out to leeward, flapping, and shaking the mast
like a wand. Here was a job for somebody. The royal must come in or be cut
adrift, or the mast would be snapped short off. All the light hands in the
starboard watch were sent up one after another, but they could do nothing
with it. At length, John, the tall Frenchman, the head of the starboard watch
(and a better sailor never stepped upon a deck), sprang aloft, and, by the
help of his long arms and legs, succeeded, after a hard struggle,—the sail
blowing over the yard-arm to leeward, and the skysail adrift directly over
his head,—in smothering it and frapping it with long pieces of sinnet. He
came very near being blown or shaken from the yard several times, but he was
a true sailor, every finger a fish-hook. Having made the sail snug,
he prepared to send the yard down, which was a long and difficult job;
for, frequently, he was obliged to stop, and hold on with all his might for
several minutes, the ship pitching so as to make it impossible to do anything
else at that height. The yard at length came down safe, and, after it, the
fore and mizzen royal yards were sent down. All hands were then sent aloft,
and for an hour or two we were hard at work, making the booms well fast,
unreeving the studding-sail and royal and skysail gear,
getting rolling-ropes on the yard, setting up the
weather breast-backstays, and making other preparations for a storm.
It was a fine night for a gale; just cool and bracing enough for quick
work, without being cold, and as bright as day. It was sport to have a gale
in such weather as this. Yet it blew like a hurricane. The wind seemed to
come with a spite, an edge to it, which threatened to scrape us off the
yards. The force of the wind was greater than I had ever felt it before; but
darkness, cold, and wet are the worst parts of a storm, to a
sailor.
Having got on deck again, we looked round to see what time
of night it was, and whose watch. In a few minutes the man at the wheel
struck four bells, and we found that the other watch was out, and our own
half out. Accordingly, the starboard watch went below, and left the ship to
us for a couple of hours, yet with orders to stand by for a
call.
Hardly had they got below, before away went the fore
topmast staysail, blown to ribands. This was a small sail, which we
could manage in the watch, so that we were not obliged to call up
the other watch. We laid out upon the bowsprit, where we were under water
half the time, and took in the fragments of the sail, and, as she must have
some head sail on her, prepared to bend another staysail. We got the new one
out into the nettings; seized on the tack, sheets, and halyards, and the
hanks; manned the halyards, cut adrift the frapping-lines, and hoisted away;
but before it was half-way up the stay it was blown all to pieces. When we
belayed the halyards, there was nothing left but the bolt-rope. Now
large eyes began to show themselves in the foresail, and, knowing that it
must soon go, the mate ordered us upon the yard to furl it. Being unwilling
to call up the watch who had been on deck all night, he roused out the
carpenter, sailmaker, cook, and steward, and with their help we manned the
fore yard, and, after nearly half an hour's struggle, mastered the sail, and
got it well furled round the yard. The force of the wind had never been
greater than at this moment. In going up the rigging, it seemed absolutely
to pin us down to the shrouds; and, on the yard, there was no such thing
as turning a face to windward. Yet here was no driving sleet, and darkness,
and wet, and cold, as off Cape Horn; and instead of stiff oil-cloth suits,
southwester caps, and thick boots, we had on hats, round jackets, duck
trousers, light shoes, and everything light and easy. These things make a
great difference to a sailor. When we got on deck, the man at the
wheel struck eight bells (four o'clock in the morning), and
``All Starbowlines, ahoy!'' brought the other watch up, but there was
no going below for us. The gale was now at its height, ``blowing
like scissors and thumb-screws''; the captain was on deck; the ship, which
was light, rolling and pitching as though she would shake the long sticks out
of her, and the sails were gaping open and splitting in every direction. The
mizzen topsail, which was a comparatively new sail, and close reefed, split
from head to foot, in the bunt; the fore topsail went, in one rent, from clew
to earing, and was blowing to tatters; one of the chain bobstays parted;
the spritsail yard sprung in the slings; the martingale had slued away off to
leeward; and, owing to the long dry weather, the lee rigging hung in large
bights at every lurch. One of the main top-gallant shrouds had parted; and,
to crown all, the galley had got adrift, and gone over to leeward, and the
anchor on the lee bow had worked loose, and was thumping the side. Here was
work enough for all hands for half a day. Our gang laid out on the mizzen
topsail yard, and after more than half an hour's hard work, furled the sail,
though it bellied out over our heads, and again, by a slat of the wind, blew
in under the yard with a fearful jerk, and almost threw us off from the
foot-ropes.
Double gaskets were passed round the yards, rolling tackles
and other gear bowsed taut, and everything made as secure as it could be.
Coming down, we found the rest of the crew just coming down the fore rigging,
having furled the tattered topsail, or, rather, swathed it round the yard,
which looked like a broken limb, bandaged. There was no sail now on the ship,
but the spanker and the close-reefed main topsail, which still held good. But
this was too much after sail, and order was given to furl the spanker.
The brails were hauled up, and all the light hands in the starboard watch
sent out on the gaff to pass the gaskets; but they could do nothing with it.
The second mate swore at them for a parcel of ``sogers,'' and sent up a
couple of the best men; but they could do no better, and the gaff was lowered
down. All hands were now employed in setting up the lee rigging, fishing the
spritsail yard, lashing the galley, and getting tackles upon the
martingale, to bowse it to windward. Being in the larboard watch, my duty
was forward, to assist in setting up the martingale. Three of us were out
on the martingale guys and back-ropes for more than half an hour, carrying
out, hooking and unhooking the tackles, several times buried in the seas,
until the mate ordered us in, from fear of our being washed off. The anchors
were then to be taken up on the rail, which kept all hands on the forecastle
for an hour, though every now and then the seas broke over it, washing
the rigging off to leeward, filling the lee scuppers breast-high,
and washing chock aft to the taffrail.
Having got everything secure again, we were promising
ourselves some breakfast, for it was now nearly nine o'clock in
the forenoon, when the main topsail showed evident signs of giving way.
Some sail must be kept on the ship, and the captain ordered the fore and main
spencer gaffs to be lowered down, and the two spencers (which were storm
sails, bran-new, small, and made of the strongest canvas) to be got up and
bent; leaving the main topsail to blow away, with a blessing on it, if it
would only last until we could set the spencers. These we bent on very
carefully, with strong robands and seizings, and, making tackles fast to
the clews, bowsed them down to the water-ways. By this time the
main topsail was among the things that have been, and we went aloft
to stow away the remnant of the last sail of all those which were on the
ship twenty-four hours before. The spencers were now the only whole sails on
the ship, and, being strong and small, and near the deck, presenting but
little surface to the wind above the rail, promised to hold out well. Hove-to
under these, and eased by having no sail above the tops, the ship rose and
fell, and drifted off to leeward like a line-of-battle ship.
It was now eleven o'clock, and the watch was sent below to
get breakfast, and at eight bells (noon), as everything was snug, although
the gale had not in the least abated, the watch was set, and the other watch
and idlers sent below. For three days and three nights the gale continued
with unabated fury, and with singular regularity. There were no lulls, and
very little variation in its fierceness. Our ship, being light, rolled so
as almost to send the fore yard-arm under water, and drifted off bodily to
leeward. All this time there was not a cloud to be seen in the sky, day or
night; no, not so large as a man's hand. Every morning the sun rose cloudless
from the sea, and set again at night in the sea, in a flood of light. The
stars, too, came out of the blue one after another, night after night,
unobscured, and twinkled as clear as on a still, frosty night at home, until
the day came upon them. All this time the sea was rolling in
immense surges, white with foam, as far as the eye could reach, on
every side, for we were now leagues and leagues from shore.
The between-decks being empty, several of us slept there
in hammocks, which are the best things in the world to sleep in during a
storm; it not being true of them, as it is of another kind of bed, ``when the
wind blows the cradle will rock''; for it is the ship that rocks, while they
hang vertically from the beams. During these seventy-two hours we had nothing
to do but to turn in and out, four hours on deck, and four below, eat, sleep,
and keep watch. The watches were only varied by taking the helm in
turn, and now and then by one of the sails, which were furled, blowing out
of the gaskets, and getting adrift, which sent us up on the yards, and by
getting tackles on different parts of the rigging, which were slack. Once the
wheel-rope parted, which might have been fatal to us, had not the chief mate
sprung instantly with a relieving tackle to windward, and kept the tiller up,
till a new rope could be rove. On the morning of the twentieth, at
daybreak, the gale had evidently done its worst, and had somewhat abated;
so much so that all hands were called to bend new sails, although it was
still blowing as hard as two common gales. One at a time, and with great
difficulty and labor, the old sails were unbent and sent down by the
buntlines, and three new topsails, made for the homeward passage round Cape
Horn, which had never been bent, were got up from the sail-room, and, under
the care of the sailmaker, were fitted for bending, and sent up by the
halyards into the tops, and, with stops and frapping-lines, were bent to the
yards, close-reefed, sheeted home, and hoisted. These were bent one at
a time, and with the greatest care and difficulty. Two spare courses were
then got up and bent in the same manner and furled, and a storm-jib, with the
bonnet off, bent and furled to the boom. It was twelve o'clock before we got
through, and five hours of more exhausting labor I never experienced; and no
one of that ship's crew, I will venture to say, will ever desire again to
unbend and bend five large sails in the teeth of a tremendous
northwester. Towards night a few clouds appeared in the horizon, and, as
the gale moderated, the usual appearance of driving clouds relieved the
face of the sky. The fifth day after the commencement of the storm, we shook
a reef out of each topsail, and set the reefed foresail, jib, and spanker,
but it was not until after eight days of reefed topsails that we had a whole
sail on the ship, and then it was quite soon enough, for the captain was
anxious to make up for leeway, the gale having blown us half the distance to
the Sandwich Islands.
Inch by inch, as fast as the gale would permit, we made sail
on the ship, for the wind still continued ahead, and we had many days'
sailing to get back to the longitude we were in when the storm took us. For
eight days more we beat to windward under a stiff top-gallant breeze, when
the wind shifted and became variable. A light southeaster, to which we could
carry a reefed topmast studding-sail, did wonders for our dead
reckoning.
Friday, December 4th. After a passage of twenty days, we
arrived at the mouth of the Bay of San Francisco.
[1] I have been told that this description of a whaleman has
given offence to the whale-trading people of Nantucket, New Bedford,
and the Vineyard. It is not exaggerated; and the appearance of such a ship
and crew might well impress a young man trained in the ways of a ship of the
style of the Alert. Long observation has satisfied me that there are no
better seamen, so far as handling a ship is concerned, and none so venturous
and skilful navigators, as the masters and officers of our whalemen. But
never, either on this voyage, or in a subsequent visit to the Pacific and
its islands, was it my fortune to fall in with a whaleship
whose appearance, and the appearance of whose crew, gave signs
of strictness of discipline and seaman-like neatness. Probably
these things are impossibilities, from the nature of the business, and
I may have made too much of them.
[2] This visiting between the crews of ships at sea is called,
among whalemen, ``gamming.''
CHAPTER XXVI
Our place of destination had been Monterey, but as we were to
the northward of it when the wind hauled ahead, we made a fair wind
for San Francisco. This large bay, which lies in latitude 37° 58',
was discovered by Sir Francis Drake, and by him represented to be
(as indeed it is) a magnificent bay, containing several good
harbors, great depth of water, and surrounded by a fertile and finely
wooded country. About thirty miles from the mouth of the bay, and on
the southeast side, is a high point, upon which the Presidio is
built. Behind this point is the little harbor, or bight, called
Yerba Buena, in which trading-vessels anchor, and, near it, the Mission of
Dolores. There was no other habitation on this side of the Bay, except a
shanty of rough boards put up by a man named Richardson, who was doing a
little trading between the vessels and the Indians.[1] Here, at anchor, and
the only vessel, was a brig under Russian colors, from Sitka, in Russian
America, which had come down to winter, and to take in a supply of tallow and
grain, great quantities of which latter article are raised in the Missions
at the head of the bay. The second day after our arrival we went on board
the brig, it being Sunday, as a matter of curiosity; and there was enough
there to gratify it. Though no larger than the Pilgrim, she had five or six
officers, and a crew of between twenty and thirty; and such a stupid and
greasy-looking set, I never saw before. Although it was quite comfortable
weather and we had nothing on but straw hats, shirts, and duck trousers, and
were barefooted, they had, every man of them, doubled-soled boots, coming up
to the knees, and well greased; thick woollen trousers,
frocks, waistcoats, pea-jackets, woollen caps, and everything in true
Nova Zembla rig; and in the warmest days they made no change. The clothing
of one of these men would weigh nearly as much as that of half our crew. They
had brutish faces, looked like the antipodes of sailors, and apparently dealt
in nothing but grease. They lived upon grease; eat it, drank it, slept in the
midst of it, and their clothes were covered with it. To a Russian, grease is
the greatest luxury. They looked with greedy eyes upon the tallow-bags as
they were taken into the vessel, and, no doubt, would have eaten one
up whole, had not the officer kept watch over it. The grease appeared to
fill their pores, and to come out in their hair and on their faces. It seems
as if it were this saturation which makes them stand cold and rain so well.
If they were to go into a warm climate, they would melt and die of the
scurvy.
The vessel was no better than the crew. Everything was in
the oldest and most inconvenient fashion possible: running trusses
and lifts on the yards, and large hawser cables, coiled all over
the decks, and served and parcelled in all directions. The
topmasts, top-gallant-masts, and studding-sail booms were nearly black
for want of scraping, and the decks would have turned the stomach of
a man-of-war's-man. The galley was down in the forecastle; and there the
crew lived, in the midst of the steam and grease of the cooking, in a place
as hot as an oven, and apparently never cleaned out. Five minutes in the
forecastle was enough for us, and we were glad to get into the open air. We
made some trade with them, buying Indian curiosities, of which they had a
great number; such as bead-work, feathers of birds, fur moccasons, &c.
I purchased a large robe, made of the skins of some animal, dried and
sewed nicely together, and covered all over on the outside with thick downy
feathers, taken from the breasts of various birds, and arranged with their
different colors so as to make a brilliant show.
A few days after our arrival the rainy season set in, and
for three weeks it rained almost every hour, without cessation. This was
bad for our trade, for the collecting of hides is managed differently in this
port from what it is in any other on the coast. The Mission of Dolores, near
the anchorage, has no trade at all; but those of San José, Santa Clara, and
others situated on the large creeks or rivers which run into the bay, and
distant between fifteen and forty miles from the anchorage, do a
greater business in hides than any in California. Large boats,
or launches, manned by Indians, and capable of carrying from five to six
hundred hides apiece, are attached to the Missions, and sent down to the
vessels with hides, to bring away goods in return. Some of the crews of the
vessels are obliged to go and come in the boats, to look out for the hides
and goods. These are favorite expeditions with the sailors in fine weather;
but now, to be gone three or four days, in open boats, in constant rain,
without any shelter, and with cold food, was hard service. Two of our men
went up to Santa Clara in one of these boats, and were gone three
days, during all which time they had a constant rain, and did not sleep a
wink, but passed three long nights walking fore and aft the boat, in the open
air. When they got on board they were completely exhausted, and took a watch
below of twelve hours. All the hides, too, that came down in the boats were
soaked with water, and unfit to put below, so that we were obliged to trice
them up to dry, in the intervals of sunshine or wind, upon all parts of the
vessel. We got up tricing-lines from the jib-boom-end to each arm of
the fore yard, and thence to the main and cross-jack yard-arms. Between
the tops, too, and the mast-heads, from the fore to the main swifters, and
thence to the mizzen rigging, and in all directions athwartships,
tricing-lines were run, and strung with hides. The head stays and guys, and
the spritsail yard were lined, and, having still more, we got out the
swinging-booms, and strung them and the forward and after guys with hides.
The rail, fore and aft, the windlass, capstan, the sides of the ship, and
every vacant place on deck, were covered with wet hides, on the least sign
of an interval for drying. Our ship was nothing but a mass of hides, from the
cat-harpins to the water's edge, and from the jib-boom-end to the
taffrail.
One cold, rainy evening, about eight o'clock, I received
orders to get ready to start for San José at four the next morning, in
one of these Indian boats, with four days' provisions. I got my oil-cloth
clothes, southwester, and thick boots ready, and turned into my hammock
early, determined to get some sleep in advance, as the boat was to be
alongside before daybreak. I slept on till all hands were called in the
morning; for, fortunately for me, the Indians, intentionally, or from
mistaking their orders, had gone off alone in the night, and were far out of
sight. Thus I escaped three or four days of very uncomfortable
service.
Four of our men, a few days afterwards, went up in one of
the quarter-boats to Santa Clara, to carry the agent, and remained out all
night in a drenching rain, in the small boat, in which there was not room for
them to turn round; the agent having gone up to the Mission and left the men
to their fate, making no provision for their accommodation, and not even
sending them anything to eat. After this they had to pull thirty miles, and
when they got on board were so stiff that they could not come up the
gangway ladder. This filled up the measure of the agent's
unpopularity, and never after this could he get anything done for him by
the crew; and many a delay and vexation, and many a good ducking in the
surf, did he get to pay up old scores, or ``square the yards with the bloody
quill-driver.''
Having collected nearly all the hides that were to be
procured, we began our preparations for taking in a supply of wood and
water, for both of which San Francisco is the best place on the coast.
A small island, about two leagues from the anchorage, called by us ``Wood
Island,'' and by the Mexicans ``Isla de los Angeles,'' was covered with trees
to the water's edge; and to this two of our crew, who were Kennebec men, and
could handle an axe like a plaything, were sent every morning to cut wood,
with two boys to pile it up for them. In about a week they had cut enough to
last us a year, and the third mate, with myself and three others,
were sent over in a large, schooner-rigged, open launch, which we
had hired of the Mission, to take in the wood, and bring it to the ship.
We left the ship about noon, but owing to a strong head wind, and a tide
which here runs four or five knots, did not get into the harbor, formed by
two points of the island, where the boats lie, until sundown. No sooner had
we come-to, than a strong southeaster, which had been threatening us all day,
set in, with heavy rain and a chilly air. We were in rather a bad situation:
an open boat, a heavy rain, and a long night; for in winter, in
this latitude, it was dark nearly fifteen hours. Taking a small
skiff which we had brought with us, we went ashore, but discovered
no shelter, for everything was open to the rain; and, collecting a little
wood, which we found by lifting up the leaves and brush, and a few mussels,
we put aboard again, and made the best preparations in our power for passing
the night. We unbent the mainsail, and formed an awning with it over the
after part of the boat, made a bed of wet logs of wood, and, with our jackets
on, lay down, about six o'clock, to sleep. Finding the rain running down
upon us, and our jackets getting wet through, and the rough, knotty logs
rather indifferent couches, we turned out; and, taking an iron pan which we
brought with us, we wiped it out dry, put some stones around it, cut the wet
bark from some sticks, and, striking a light, made a small fire in the pan.
Keeping some sticks near to dry, and covering the whole over with a roof
of boards, we kept up a small fire, by which we cooked our mussels, and
ate them, rather for an occupation than from hunger. Still it was not ten
o'clock, and the night was long before us, when one of the party produced an
old pack of Spanish cards from his monkey-jacket pocket, which we hailed as a
great windfall; and, keeping a dim, flickering light by our fagots, we played
game after game, till one or two o'clock, when, becoming really tired, we
went to our logs again, one sitting up at a time, in turn, to keep watch over
the fire. Toward morning the rain ceased, and the air became sensibly colder,
so that we found sleep impossible, and sat up, watching for daybreak. No
sooner was it light than we went ashore, and began our preparations for
loading our vessel. We were not mistaken in the coldness of the weather, for
a white frost was on the ground, and—a thing we had never seen before
in California—one or two little puddles of fresh water were skimmed over
with a thin coat of ice. In this state of the weather, and before sunrise, in
the gray of the morning, we had to wade off, nearly up to our hips in water,
to load the skiff with the wood by armfuls. The third mate remained on board
the launch, two more men stayed in the skiff to load and manage it, and all
the water-work, as usual, fell upon the two youngest of us; and there we were
with frost on the ground, wading forward and back, from the beach to the
boat, with armfuls of wood, barefooted, and our trousers rolled up. When the
skiff went off with her load, we could only keep our feet from freezing by
racing up and down the beach on the hard sand, as fast as we could go. We
were all day at this work, and toward sundown, having loaded the vessel as
deep as she would bear, we hove up our anchor and made sail, beating out of
the bay. No sooner had we got into the large bay than we found a
strong tide setting us out to seaward, a thick fog which prevented
our seeing the ship, and a breeze too light to set us against the tide,
for we were as deep as a sand-barge. By the utmost exertions, we saved
ourselves from being carried out to sea, and were glad to reach the
leewardmost point of the island, where we came-to, and prepared to pass
another night more uncomfortable than the first, for we were loaded up to the
gunwale, and had only a choice among logs and sticks for a resting-place. The
next morning we made sail at slack water, with a fair wind, and got
on board by eleven o'clock, when all hands were turned-to to unload and
stow away the wood, which took till night.
Having now taken in all our wood, the next morning a
water-party was ordered off with all the casks. From this we escaped,
having had a pretty good siege with the wooding. The water-party were gone
three days, during which time they narrowly escaped being carried out to sea,
and passed one day on an island, where one of them shot a deer, great numbers
of which overrun the islands and hills of San Francisco Bay.
While not off on these wood and water parties, or up the
rivers to the Missions, we had easy times on board the ship. We were
moored, stem and stern, within a cable's length of the shore, safe
from southeasters, and with little boating to do; and, as it rained nearly
all the time, awnings were put over the hatchways, and all hands sent down
between decks, where we were at work, day after day, picking oakum, until we
got enough to calk the ship all over, and to last the whole voyage. Then we
made a whole suit of gaskets for the voyage home, a pair of wheel-ropes from
strips of green hide, great quantities of spun-yarn, and everything else
that could be made between decks. It being now midwinter and in
high latitude, the nights were very long, so that we were not
turned-to until seven in the morning, and were obliged to knock off at
five in the evening, when we got supper; which gave us nearly three hours
before eight bells, at which time the watch was set.
As we had now been about a year on the coast, it was time to
think of the voyage home; and, knowing that the last two or three
months of our stay would be very busy ones, and that we should never
have so good an opportunity to work for ourselves as the present, we all
employed our evenings in making clothes for the passage home, and more
especially for Cape Horn. As soon as supper was over and the kids cleared
away, and each man had taken his smoke, we seated ourselves on our chests
round the lamp, which swung from a beam, and went to work each in his own
way, some making hats, others trousers, others jackets, &c., &c., and
no one was idle. The boys who could not sew well enough to make their own
clothes laid up grass into sinnet for the men, who sewed for them in
return. Several of us clubbed together and bought a large piece of
twilled cotton, which we made into trousers and jackets, and, giving
them several coats of linseed oil, laid them by for Cape Horn. I
also sewed and covered a tarpaulin hat, thick and strong enough to
sit upon, and made myself a complete suit of flannel underclothing for bad
weather. Those who had no southwester caps made them; and several of the crew
got up for themselves tarpaulin jackets and trousers, lined on the inside
with flannel. Industry was the order of the day, and every one did something
for himself; for we knew that as the season advanced, and we went further
south, we should have no evenings to work in.
Friday, December 25th. This day was Christmas; and, as it
rained all day long, and there were no hides to take in, and
nothing especial to do, the captain gave us a holiday (the first we
had had, except Sundays, since leaving Boston), and plum-duff for dinner.
The Russian brig, following the Old Style, had celebrated their Christmas
eleven days before, when they had a grand blow-out, and (as our men said)
drank, in the forecastle, a barrel of gin, ate up a bag of tallow, and made a
soup of the skin.
Sunday, December 27th. We had now finished all our business
at this port, and, it being Sunday, we unmoored ship and got under way,
firing a salute to the Russian brig, and another to the presidio, which were
both answered. The commandante of the presidio, Don Guadalupe Vallejo, a
young man, and the most popular, among the Americans and English, of any man
in California, was on board when we got under way. He spoke English very
well, and was suspected of being favorably inclined
to foreigners.
We sailed down this magnificent bay with a light wind, the
tide, which was running out, carrying us at the rate of four or
five knots. It was a fine day; the first of entire sunshine we had had for
more than a month. We passed directly under the high cliff on which the
presidio is built, and stood into the middle of the bay, from whence we could
see small bays making up into the interior, large and beautifully wooded
islands, and the mouths of several small rivers. If California ever becomes a
prosperous country, this bay will be the centre of its prosperity. The
abundance of wood and water; the extreme fertility of its shores;
the excellence of its climate, which is as near to being perfect as any in
the world; and its facilities for navigation, affording the best
anchoring-grounds in the whole western coast of America,— all fit it for a
place of great importance.
The tide leaving us, we came to anchor near the mouth of the
bay, under a high and beautifully sloping hill, upon which herds
of hundreds and hundreds of red deer, and the stag, with his
high branching antlers, were bounding about, looking at us for a moment,
and then starting off, affrighted at the noises which we made for the purpose
of seeing the variety of their beautiful attitudes and motions.
At midnight, the tide having turned, we hove up our anchor
and stood out of the bay, with a fine starry heaven above us,—the first
we had seen for many weeks. Before the light northerly winds, which blow here
with the regularity of trades, we worked slowly along, and made Point Año
Nuevo, the northerly point of the Bay of Monterey, on Monday afternoon. We
spoke, going in, the brig Diana, of the Sandwich Islands, from the Northwest
Coast, last from Sitka. She was off the point at the same time with us,
but did not get in to the anchoring-ground until an hour or two after us.
It was ten o'clock on Tuesday morning when we came to anchor. Monterey looked
just as it did when I saw it last, which was eleven months before, in the
brig Pilgrim. The pretty lawn on which it stands, as green as sun and rain
could make it; the pine wood on the south; the small river on the north side;
the adobe houses, with their white walls and red-tiled roofs, dotted
about on the green; the low, white presidio, with its soiled
tri-colored flag flying, and the discordant din of drums and trumpets of
the noon parade,—all brought up the scene we had witnessed here with so
much pleasure nearly a year before, when coming from a long voyage, and from
our unprepossessing reception at Santa Barbara. It seemed almost like coming
to a home.
[1] The next year Richardson built a one-story adobe house on
the same spot, which was long afterwards known as the oldest house in the
great city of San Francisco.
CHAPTER XXVII
The only other vessel in the port was a Russian government
bark from Sitka, mounting eight guns (four of which we found to
be quakers), and having on board the ex-governor, who was going in her to
Mazatlan, and thence overland to Vera Cruz. He offered to take letters, and
deliver them to the American consul at Vera Cruz, whence they could be easily
forwarded to the United States. We accordingly made up a packet of letters,
almost every one writing, and dating them ``January 1st, 1836.'' The governor
was true to his promise, and they all reached Boston before the middle of
March; the shortest communication ever yet made across
the country.
The brig Pilgrim had been lying in Monterey through the
latter part of November, according to orders, waiting for us. Day
after day Captain Faucon went up to the hill to look out for us, and
at last gave us up, thinking we must have gone down in the gale which we
experienced off Point Conception, and which had blown with great fury over
the whole coast, driving ashore several vessels in the snuggest ports. An
English brig, which had put into San Francisco, lost both her anchors, the
Rosa was driven upon a mud bank in San Diego, and the Pilgrim, with great
difficulty, rode out the gale in Monterey, with three anchors ahead. She
sailed early in December for San Diego and intermedios.
As we were to be here over Sunday, and Monterey was the best
place to go ashore on the whole coast, and we had had no liberty-day
for nearly three months, every one was for going ashore. On Sunday morning
as soon as the decks were washed, and we were through breakfast, those who
had obtained liberty began to clean themselves, as it is called, to go
ashore. Buckets of fresh water, cakes of soap, large coarse towels, and we
went to work scrubbing one another, on the forecastle. Having gone through
this, the next thing was to step into the head,—one on each side,—with
a bucket apiece, and duck one another, by drawing up water and heaving
over each other, while we were stripped to a pair of trousers. Then came the
rigging up. The usual outfit of pumps, white stockings, loose white duck
trousers, blue jackets, clean checked shirts, black kerchiefs, hats well
varnished, with a fathom of black ribbon over the left eye, a silk
handkerchief flying from the outside jacket pocket, and four or five
dollars tied up in the back of the neckerchief, and we were ``all
right.'' One of the quarter-boats pulled us ashore, and we streamed up
to the town. I tried to find the church, in order to see the worship, but
was told that there was no service, except a mass early in the morning; so we
went about the town, visiting the Americans and English, and the Mexicans
whom we had known when we were here before. Toward noon we procured horses,
and rode out to the Carmel Mission, which is about a league from the town,
where we got something in the way of a dinner—beef, eggs,
fríjoles, tortillas, and some middling wine—from the mayor-domo, who,
of course, refused to make any charge, as it was the Lord's gift,
yet received our present, as a gratuity, with a low bow, a touch of the
hat, and ``Dios se lo pague!''
After this repast we had a fine run, scouring the country on
our fleet horses, and came into town soon after sundown. Here we found our
companions, who had refused to go to ride with us, thinking that a sailor has
no more business with a horse than a fish has with a balloon. They were
moored, stem and stern, in a grog-shop, making a great noise, with a crowd of
Indians and hungry half-breeds about them, and with a fair prospect of being
stripped and dirked, or left to pass the night in the calabozo. With
a great deal of trouble we managed to get them down to the boats, though
not without many angry looks and interferences from the Mexicans, who had
marked them out for their prey. The Diana's crew— a set of worthless
outcasts who had been picked up at the islands from the refuse of
whale-ships—were all as drunk as beasts, and had a set-to on the beach with
their captain, who was in no better state than themselves. They swore they
would not go aboard, and went back to the town, were robbed and beaten,
and lodged in the calabozo, until the next day, when the captain brought
them out. Our forecastle, as usual after a liberty-day, was a scene of tumult
all night long, from the drunken ones. They had just got to sleep toward
morning, when they were turned-up with the rest, and kept at work all day in
the water, carrying hides, their heads aching so that they could hardly
stand. This is sailor's pleasure.
Nothing worthy of remark happened while we were here, except
a little boxing-match on board our own ship, which gave us something to
talk about. Our broad-backed, big-headed Cape Cod boy, about sixteen years
old, had been playing the bully, for the whole voyage, over a slender,
delicate-looking boy from one of the Boston schools, and over whom he had
much the advantage in strength, age, and experience in the ship's duty, for
this was the first time the Boston boy had been on salt water. The
latter, however, had ``picked up his crumbs,'' was learning his duty,
and getting strength and confidence daily, and began to assert his rights
against his oppressor. Still, the other was his master, and, by his superior
strength, always tackled with him and threw him down. One afternoon, before
we were turned-to, these boys got into a violent squabble in the
between-decks, when George (the Boston boy) said he would fight Nat if he
could have fair play. The chief mate heard the noise, dove down the hatchway,
hauled them both up on deck, and told them to shake hands and have no more
trouble for the voyage, or else they should fight till one gave in for
beaten. Finding neither willing to make an offer of reconciliation, he called
all hands up (for the captain was ashore, and he could do as he chose
aboard), ranged the crew in the waist, marked a line on the deck, brought the
two boys up to it, making them ``toe the mark''; then made the bight of a
rope fast to a belaying-pin, and stretched it across the deck, bringing it
just above their waists. ``No striking below the rope!'' And there they
stood, one on each side of it, face to face, and went at it like two
game-cocks. The Cape Cod boy, Nat, put in his double-fisters, starting the
blood, and bringing the black-and-blue spots all over the face and arms of
the other, whom we expected to see give in every moment; but, the more he
was hurt, the better he fought. Again and again he was knocked
nearly down, but up he came again and faced the mark, as bold as a
lion, again to take the heavy blows, which sounded so as to make
one's heart turn with pity for him. At length he came up to the mark
the last time, his shirt torn from his body, his face covered with blood
and bruises, and his eyes flashing fire, and swore he would stand there until
one or the other was killed, and set-to like a young fury. ``Hurrah in the
bow!'' said the men, cheering him on. ``Never say die, while there's a shot
in the locker!'' Nat tried to close with him, knowing his advantage, but the
mate stopped that, saying there should be fair play, and no fingering. Nat
then came up to the mark, but looked white about the mouth, and his blows
were not given with half the spirit of his first. Something was the matter. I
was not sure whether he was cowed, or, being good-natured, he did not care to
beat the boy any more. At all events he faltered. He had always been master,
and had nothing to gain and everything to lose; while the other fought for
honor and freedom, and under a sense of wrong. It was soon over. Nat
gave in,—apparently not much hurt,—and never afterwards tried to act
the bully over the boy. We took George forward, washed him in the deck-tub,
complimented his pluck, and from this time he became somebody on board,
having fought himself into notice. Mr. Brown's plan had a good effect, for
there was no more quarrelling among the boys for the rest of the
voyage.
Wednesday, January 6th, 1836. Set sail from Monterey, with
a number of Mexicans as passengers, and shaped our course for
Santa Barbara. The Diana went out of the bay in company with us,
but parted from us off Point Pinos, being bound to the Sandwich Islands.
We had a smacking breeze for several hours, and went along at a great rate
until night, when it died away, as usual, and the land-breeze set in, which
brought us upon a taut bowline. Among our passengers was a young man who was
a good representation of a decayed gentleman. He reminded me much of some of
the characters in Gil Blas. He was of the aristocracy of the country, his
family being of pure Spanish blood, and once of considerable importance in
Mexico. His father had been governor of the province, and, having amassed a
large property, settled at San Diego, where he built a large house with a
court-yard in front, kept a retinue of Indians, and set up for the grandee of
that part of the country. His son was sent to Mexico, where he received
an education, and went into the first society of the capital. Misfortune,
extravagance, and the want of any manner of getting interest on money, soon
ate the estate up, and Don Juan Bandini returned from Mexico accomplished,
poor, and proud, and without any office or occupation, to lead the life of
most young men of the better families,—dissipated and extravagant when the
means are at hand; ambitious at heart, and impotent in act; often pinched
for bread; keeping up an appearance of style, when their poverty is known to
each half-naked Indian boy in the street, and standing in dread of every
small trader and shopkeeper in the place. He had a slight and elegant figure,
moved gracefully, danced and waltzed beautifully, spoke good Castilian, with
a pleasant and refined voice and accent, and had, throughout, the bearing
of a man of birth and figure. Yet here he was, with his passage given him (as
I afterwards learned), for he had not the means of paying for it, and living
upon the charity of our agent. He was polite to every one, spoke to the
sailors, and gave four reals—I dare say the last he had in his pocket—to
the steward, who waited upon him. I could not but feel a pity for
him, especially when I saw him by the side of his fellow-passenger
and townsman, a fat, coarse, vulgar, pretentious fellow of a
Yankee trader, who had made money in San Diego, and was eating out
the vitals of the Bandinis, fattening upon their extravagance, grinding
them in their poverty; having mortgages on their lands, forestalling their
cattle, and already making an inroad upon their jewels, which were their last
hope.
Don Juan had with him a retainer, who was as much like many of
the characters in Gil Blas as his master. He called himself a
private secretary, though there was no writing for him to do, and he
lived in the steerage with the carpenter and sailmaker. He was certainly a
character; could read and write well; spoke good Spanish; had been over the
greater part of Spanish America, and lived in every possible situation, and
served in every conceivable capacity, though generally in that of
confidential servant to some man of figure. I cultivated this man's
acquaintance, and during the five weeks that he was with us,—for he
remained on board until we arrived at San Diego,—I gained a greater
knowledge of the state of political parties in Mexico, and the habits and
affairs of the different classes of society, than I could have learned
from almost any one else. He took great pains in correcting my
Spanish, and supplying me with colloquial phrases, and common terms
and exclamations, in speaking. He lent me a file of late newspapers from
the city of Mexico, which were full of the triumphal reception of Santa Ana,
who had just returned from Tampico after a victory, and with the preparations
for his expedition against the Texans. ``Viva Santa Ana!'' was the byword
everywhere, and it had even reached California, though there were still many
here, among whom was Don Juan Bandini, who were opposed to his government,
and intriguing to bring in Bustamente. Santa Ana, they said, was
for breaking down the Missions; or, as they termed it, ``Santa Ana
no quiere religion.'' Yet I had no doubt that the office of administrador
of San Diego would reconcile Don Juan to any dynasty, and any state of the
church. In these papers, too, I found scraps of American and English news;
but which was so unconnected, and I was so ignorant of everything preceding
them for eighteen months past, that they only awakened a curiosity which
they could not satisfy. One article spoke of Taney as Justicia Mayor de los
Estados Unidos, (what had become of Marshall? was he dead, or banished?) and
another made known, by news received from Vera Cruz, that ``El Vizconde
Melbourne'' had returned to the office of ``primer ministro,'' in place of
Sir Roberto Peel. (Sir Robert Peel had been minister, then? and where were
Earl Grey and the Duke of Wellington?) Here were the outlines of grand
political overturns, the filling up of which I was left to imagine at my
leisure.
The second morning after leaving Monterey, we were off
Point Conception. It was a bright, sunny day, and the wind, though strong,
was fair; and everything was in striking contrast with our experience in the
same place two months before, when we were drifting off from a northwester
under a fore and main spencer. ``Sail ho!'' cried a man who was rigging out a
top-gallant studding-sail boom.—``Where away?''—``Weather beam, sir!''
and in a few minutes a full-rigged brig was seen standing out from under
Point Conception. The studding-sail halyards were let go, and the yards
boom-ended, the after yards braced aback, and we waited her coming down. She
rounded to, backed her main topsail, and showed her decks full of men, four
guns on a side, hammock nettings, and everything man-of-war fashion, except
that there was no boatswain's whistle, and no uniforms on the quarter-deck.
A short, square-built man, in a rough gray jacket, with a speaking-trumpet
in hand, stood in the weather hammock nettings. ``Ship ahoy!''—``Hallo!''—
``What ship is that, pray?''— ``Alert.''—``Where are you from, pray?''
&c., &c. She proved to be the brig Convoy, from the Sandwich Islands,
engaged in otter-hunting among the islands which lie along the coast.
Her armament was because of her being a contrabandista. The otter are very
numerous among these islands, and, being of great value, the government
require a heavy sum for a license to hunt them, and lay a high duty upon
every one shot or carried out of the country. This vessel had no license, and
paid no duty, besides being engaged in smuggling goods on board other vessels
trading on the coast, and belonging to the same owners in Oahu. Our captain
told him to look out for the Mexicans, but he said that they had not
an armed vessel of his size in the whole Pacific. This was without doubt
the same vessel that showed herself off Santa Barbara a few months before.
These vessels frequently remain on the coast for years, without making port,
except at the islands for wood and water, and an occasional visit to Oahu for
a new outfit.
Sunday, January 10th. Arrived at Santa Barbara, and on
the following Wednesday slipped our cable and went to sea, on account of a
southeaster. Returned to our anchorage the next day. We were the only vessel
in the port. The Pilgrim had passed through the Canal and hove-to off the
town, nearly six weeks before, on her passage down from Monterey, and was now
at the leeward. She heard here of our safe arrival at San
Francisco.
Great preparations were making on shore for the marriage of
our agent, who was to marry Doña Anita de la Guerra de Noriego y Corillo,
youngest daughter of Don Antonio Noriego, the grandee of the place, and the
head of the first family in California. Our steward was ashore three days,
making pastry and cake, and some of the best of our stores were sent off with
him. On the day appointed for the wedding, we took the captain ashore in the
gig, and had orders to come for him at night, with leave to go up to the
house and see the fandango. Returning on board, we found preparations making
for a salute. Our guns were loaded and run out, men appointed to each,
cartridges served out, matches lighted, and all the flags ready to be run up.
I took my place at the starboard after gun, and we all waited for the signal
from on shore. At ten o'clock the bride went up with her sister to
the confessional, dressed in deep black. Nearly an hour intervened, when
the great doors of the Mission church opened, the bells rang out a loud,
discordant peal, the private signal for us was run up by the captain ashore,
the bride, dressed in complete white, came out of the church with the
bridegroom, followed by a long procession. Just as she stepped from the
church door, a small white cloud issued from the bows of our ship, which was
full in sight, the loud report echoed among the surrounding hills and
over the bay, and instantly the ship was dressed in flags and
pennants from stem to stern. Twenty-three guns followed in
regular succession, with an interval of fifteen seconds between each,
when the cloud blew off, and our ship lay dressed in her colors all day.
At sundown another salute of the same number of guns was fired, and all the
flags run down. This we thought was pretty well— a gun every fifteen
seconds—for a merchantman with only four guns and a dozen or twenty
men.
After supper, the gig's crew were called, and we rowed
ashore, dressed in our uniform, beached the boat, and went up to
the fandango. The bride's father's house was the principal one in
the place, with a large court in front, upon which a tent was
built, capable of containing several hundred people. As we drew near,
we heard the accustomed sound of violins and guitars, and saw a
great motion of the people within. Going in, we found nearly all
the people of the town—men, women, and children—collected and crowded
together, leaving barely room for the dancers; for on these occasions no
invitations are given, but every one is expected to come, though there is
always a private entertainment within the house for particular friends. The
old women sat down in rows, clapping their hands to the music, and applauding
the young ones. The music was lively, and among the tunes we
recognized several of our popular airs, which we, without doubt, have
taken from the Spanish. In the dancing I was much disappointed. The women
stood upright, with their hands down by their sides, their eyes fixed upon
the ground before them, and slided about without any perceptible means of
motion; for their feet were invisible, the hem of their dresses forming a
circle about them, reaching to the ground. They looked as grave as though
they were going through some religious ceremony, their faces as little
excited as their limbs; and on the whole, instead of the spirited,
fascinating Spanish dances which I had expected, I found the
Californian fandango, on the part of the women at least, a lifeless
affair. The men did better. They danced with grace and spirit, moving
in circles round their nearly stationary partners, and showing
their figures to advantage.
A great deal was said about our friend Don Juan Bandini, and
when he did appear, which was toward the close of the evening,
he certainly gave us the most graceful dancing that I had ever seen. He
was dressed in white pantaloons, neatly made, a short jacket of dark silk,
gayly figured, white stockings and thin morocco slippers upon his very small
feet. His slight and graceful figure was well adapted to dancing, and he
moved about with the grace and daintiness of a young fawn. An occasional
touch of the toe to the ground seemed all that was necessary to give him a
long interval of motion in the air. At the same time he was not fantastic
or flourishing, but appeared to be rather repressing a strong tendency to
motion. He was loudly applauded, and danced frequently toward the close of
the evening. After the supper, the waltzing began, which was confined to a
very few of the ``gente de razon,'' and was considered a high accomplishment,
and a mark of aristocracy. Here, too, Don Juan figured greatly, waltzing
with the sister of the bride (Doña Angustias, a handsome woman and
a general favorite) in a variety of beautiful figures, which lasted as
much as half an hour, no one else taking the floor. They were repeatedly and
loudly applauded, the old men and women jumping out of their seats in
admiration, and the young people waving their hats and handkerchiefs. The
great amusement of the evening—owing to its being the Carnival—was the
breaking of eggs filled with cologne, or other essences, upon the heads of
the company. The women bring a great number of these secretly about them, and
the amusement is to break one upon the head of a gentleman when his back
is turned. He is bound in gallantry to find out the lady and return the
compliment, though it must not be done if the person sees you. A tall,
stately Don, with immense gray whiskers, and a look of great importance, was
standing before me, when I felt a light hand on my shoulder, and, turning
round, saw Doña Angustias (whom we all knew, as she had been up to Monterey,
and down again, in the Alert), with her finger upon her lip, motioning me
gently aside. I stepped back a little, when she went up behind the
Don, and with one hand knocked off his huge sombrero, and at the
same instant, with the other, broke the egg upon his head, and, springing
behind me, was out of sight in a moment. The Don turned slowly round, the
cologne running down his face and over his clothes, and a loud laugh breaking
out from every quarter. He looked round in vain for some time, until the
direction of so many laughing eyes showed him the fair offender. She was his
niece, and a great favorite with him, so old Don Domingo had to join in
the laugh. A great many such tricks were played, and many a war of sharp
manoeuvring was carried on between couples of the younger people, and at
every successful exploit a general laugh was raised.
Another of their games I was for some time at a loss about.
A pretty young girl was dancing, named—after what would appear to us an
almost sacrilegious custom of the country—Espíritu Santo, when a young man
went behind her and placed his hat directly upon her head, letting it fall
down over her eyes, and sprang back among the crowd. She danced for some time
with the hat on, when she threw it off, which called forth a general shout,
and the young man was obliged to go out upon the floor and pick it
up. Some of the ladies, upon whose heads hats had been placed, threw them
off at once, and a few kept them on throughout the dance, and took them off
at the end, and held them out in their hands, when the owner stepped out,
bowed, and took it from them. I soon began to suspect the meaning of the
thing, and was afterwards told that it was a compliment, and an offer to
become the lady's gallant for the rest of the evening, and to wait upon her
home. If the hat was thrown off, the offer was refused, and the gentleman was
obliged to pick up his hat amid a general laugh. Much amusement was
caused sometimes by gentlemen putting hats on the ladies' heads,
without permitting them to see whom it was done by. This obliged them
to throw them off, or keep them on at a venture, and when they came to
discover the owner the laugh was turned upon one or the other.
The captain sent for us about ten o'clock, and we went aboard
in high spirits, having enjoyed the new scene much, and were of
great importance among the crew, from having so much to tell, and from the
prospect of going every night until it was over; for these fandangos
generally last three days. The next day, two of us were sent up to the town,
and took care to come back by way of Señor Noriego's, and take a look into
the booth. The musicians were again there, upon their platform, scraping and
twanging away, and a few people, apparently of the lower classes, were
dancing. The dancing is kept up, at intervals, throughout the day, but
the crowd, the spirit, and the élite come in at night. The next
night, which was the last, we went ashore in the same manner, until we got
almost tired of the monotonous twang of the instruments, the drawling sounds
which the women kept up, as an accompaniment, and the slapping of the hands
in time with the music, in place of castanets. We found ourselves as great
objects of attention as any persons or anything at the place. Our sailor
dresses—and we took great pains to have them neat and ship-shape—were
much admired, and we were invited, from every quarter, to give them an
American dance; but after the ridiculous figure some of our countrymen
cut in dancing after the Mexicans, we thought it best to leave it to their
imaginations. Our agent, with a tight, black, swallow-tailed coat just
imported from Boston, a high stiff cravat, looking as if he had been pinned
and skewered, with only his feet and hands left free, took the floor just
after Bandini, and we thought they had had enough of Yankee
grace.
The last night they kept it up in great style, and were
getting into a high-go, when the captain called us off to go aboard,
for, it being southeaster season, he was afraid to remain on shore long;
and it was well he did not, for that night we slipped our cables, as a
crowner to our fun ashore, and stood off before a southeaster, which lasted
twelve hours, and returned to our anchorage the next day.
CHAPTER XXVIII
Monday, February, 1st. After having been in port twenty-one
days, we sailed for San Pedro, where we arrived on the following
day, having gone ``all fluking,'' with the weather clew of the
mainsail hauled up, the yards braced in a little, and the
lower studding-sail just drawing; the wind hardly shifting a point during
the passage. Here we found the Ayacucho and the Pilgrim, which last we had
not seen since the 11th of September,—nearly five months; and I really felt
something like an affection for the old brig which had been my first home,
and in which I had spent nearly a year, and got the first rough and tumble of
a sea life. She, too, was associated in my mind with Boston, the wharf
from which we sailed, anchorage in the stream, leave-taking, and all such
matters, which were now to me like small links connecting me with another
world, which I had once been in, and which, please God, I might yet see
again. I went on board the first night, after supper; found the old cook in
the galley, playing upon the fife which I had given him as a parting present;
had a hearty shake of the hand from him; and dove down into the forecastle,
where were my old shipmates, the same as ever, glad to see me; for they
had nearly given us up as lost, especially when they did not find us in
Santa Barbara. They had been at San Diego last, had been lying at San Pedro
nearly a month, and had received three thousand hides from the pueblo.
But--
``Sic vos non vobis''
these we took from her the next day, which filled us up, and
we both got under way on the 4th, she bound to San Francisco again, and we
to San Diego, where we arrived on the 6th.
We were always glad to see San Diego; it being the depot, and
a snug little place, and seeming quite like home, especially to me, who
had spent a summer there. There was no vessel in port, the Rosa having sailed
for Valparaiso and Cadiz, and the Catalina for Callao, nearly a month before.
We discharged our hides, and in four days were ready to sail again for the
windward; and, to our great joy—for the last time! Over thirty thousand
hides had been already collected, cured, and stowed away in the house,
which, together with what we should collect, and the Pilgrim would
bring down from San Francisco, would make out our cargo. The thought that
we were actually going up for the last time, and that the next time we went
round San Diego point it would be ``homeward bound,'' brought things so near
a close that we felt as though we were just there, though it must still be
the greater part of a year before we could see Boston.
I spent one evening, as had been my custom, at the oven with
the Sandwich-Islanders; but it was far from being the usual
noisy, laughing time. It has been said that the greatest curse to each
of the South Sea Islands was the first man who discovered it; and every
one who knows anything of the history of our commerce in those parts knows
how much truth there is in this; and that the white men, with their vices,
have brought in diseases before unknown to the islanders, which are now
sweeping off the native population of the Sandwich Islands at the rate of one
fortieth of the entire population annually. They seem to be a doomed
people. The curse of a people calling themselves Christians seems
to follow them everywhere; and even here, in this obscure place, lay two
young islanders, whom I had left strong, active young men, in the vigor of
health, wasting away under a disease which they would never have known but
for their intercourse with people from Christian America and Europe. One of
them was not so ill, and was moving about, smoking his pipe, and talking, and
trying to keep up his spirits; but the other, who was my friend and aikane,
Hope, was the most dreadful object I had ever seen in my life,—his eyes
sunken and dead, his cheeks fallen in against his teeth, his hands looking
like claws; a dreadful cough, which seemed to rack his whole shattered
system, a hollow, whispering voice, and an entire inability to move himself.
There he lay, upon a mat, on the ground, which was the only floor of the
oven, with no medicine, no comforts, and no one to care for or help him but a
few Kanakas, who were willing enough, but could do nothing. The sight of
him made me sick and faint. Poor fellow! During the four months that
I lived upon the beach, we were continually together, in work, and in our
excursions in the woods and upon the water. I felt a strong affection for
him, and preferred him to any of my own countrymen there; and I believe there
was nothing which he would not have done for me. When I came into the oven he
looked at me, held out his hand, and said, in a low voice, but with a
delightful smile, ``Aloha, Aikane! Aloha nui!'' I comforted him as well as I
could, and promised to ask the captain to help him from
the medicine-chest, and told him I had no doubt the captain would do what
he could for him, as he had worked in our employ for several years, both on
shore and aboard our vessels on the coast. I went aboard and turned into my
hammock, but I could not sleep.
Thinking, from my education, that I must have some knowledge
of medicine, the Kanakas had insisted upon my examining him carefully; and
it was not a sight to be forgotten. One of our crew, an old man-of-war's-man
of twenty years' standing, who had seen sin and suffering in every shape, and
whom I afterwards took to see Hope, said it was dreadfully worse than
anything he had ever seen, or even dreamed of. He was horror-struck, as
his countenance showed; yet he had been among the worst cases in our naval
hospitals. I could not get the thought of the poor fellow out of my head all
night,—his dreadful suffering, and his apparently inevitable horrible
end.
The next day I told Captain Thompson of Hope's state, and
asked him if he would be so kind as to go and see him.
``What? a d---d Kanaka?''
``Yes, sir,'' said I; ``but he has worked four years for
our vessels, and has been in the employ of our owners, both on shore and
aboard.''
``Oh! he be d---d!'' said the captain, and walked
off.
This man died afterwards of a fever on the deadly coast
of Sumatra; and God grant he had better care taken of him in
his sufferings than he ever gave to any one else.
Finding nothing was to be got from the captain, I consulted an
old shipmate, who had much experience in these matters, and got a recipe
from him, which he kept by him. With this I went to the mate, and told him
the case. Mr. Brown had been intrusted with the general care of the
medicine-chest, and although a driving fellow, and a taut hand in a watch, he
had good feelings, and was inclined to be kind to the sick. He said that Hope
was not strictly one of the crew, but, as he was in our employ when taken
sick, he should have the medicines; and he got them and gave them to me,
with leave to go ashore at night. Nothing could exceed the delight of the
Kanakas, when I came, bringing the medicines. All their terms of affection
and gratitude were spent upon me, and in a sense wasted (for I could not
understand half of them), yet they made all known by their manner. Poor Hope
was so much revived at the bare thought of anything being done for him that
he seemed already stronger and better. I knew he must die as he was, and he
could but die under the medicines, and any chance was worth running.
An oven exposed to every wind and change of weather is no place to take
calomel; but nothing else would do, and strong remedies must be used, or he
was gone. The applications, internal and external, were powerful, and I gave
him strict directions to keep warm and sheltered, telling him it was his only
chance for life. Twice after this, I visited him, having only time to run up,
while waiting in the boat. He promised to take his medicines
regularly while we were up the coast, until we returned, and insisted
upon it that he was doing better.
We got under way on the 10th, bound up to San Pedro, and had
three days of calm and head winds, making but little progress. On
the fourth, we took a stiff southeaster, which obliged us to reef
our topsails. While on the yard, we saw a sail on the weather bow, and in
about half an hour passed the Ayacucho, under double-reefed topsails, beating
down to San Diego. Arrived at San Pedro on the fourth day, and came-to in the
old place, a league from shore, with no other vessel in port, and the
prospect of three weeks or more of dull life, rolling goods up a slippery
hill, carrying hides on our heads over sharp stones, and, perhaps, slipping
for a southeaster.
There was but one man in the only house here, and him I
shall always remember as a good specimen of a California ranger. He
had been a tailor in Philadelphia, and, getting intemperate and in debt,
joined a trapping party, and went to the Columbia River, and thence down to
Monterey, where he spent everything, left his party, and came to the Pueblo
de los Angeles to work at his trade. Here he went dead to leeward among the
pulperías, gambling-rooms, &c., and came down to San Pedro to be moral by
being out of temptation. He had been in the house several weeks, working
hard at his trade, upon orders which he had brought with him, and talked
much of his resolution, and opened his heart to us about his past life. After
we had been here some time, he started off one morning, in fine spirits, well
dressed, to carry the clothes which he had been making to the pueblo, and
saying that he would bring back his money and some fresh orders the next day.
The next day came, and a week passed, and nearly a fortnight, when one
day, going ashore, we saw a tall man, who looked like our friend
the tailor, getting out of the back of an Indian's cart, which had just
come down from the pueblo. He stood for the house, but we bore up after him;
when, finding that we were overhauling him, he hove-to and spoke us. Such a
sight! Barefooted, with an old pair of trousers tied round his waist by a
piece of green hide, a soiled cotton shirt, and a torn Indian hat; ``cleaned
out'' to the last real, and completely ``used up.'' He confessed the
whole matter; acknowledged that he was on his back; and now he had
a prospect of a fit of the horrors for a week, and of being worse than
useless for months. This is a specimen of the life of half of the Americans
and English who are adrift along the coasts of the Pacific and its islands,—
commonly called ``beach-combers.'' One of the same stamp was Russell, who was
master of the hide-house at San Diego while I was there, but had been
afterwards dismissed for his misconduct. He spent his own money, and nearly
all the stores among the half-bloods upon the beach, and went up to the
presidio, where he lived the life of a desperate ``loafer,'' until
some rascally deed sent him off ``between two days,'' with men
on horseback, dogs, and Indians in full cry after him, among the hills.
One night he burst into our room at the hide-house, breathless, pale as a
ghost, covered with mud, and torn by thorns and briers, nearly naked, and
begged for a crust of bread, saying he had neither eaten nor slept for three
days. Here was the great Mr. Russell, who a month before was ``Don Tomas,''
``Capitan de la playa,'' ``Maestro de la casa,'' &c., &c., begging
food and shelter of Kanakas and sailors. He stayed with us till he
had given himself up, and was dragged off to the calabozo.
Another, and a more amusing, specimen was one whom we saw at
San Francisco. He had been a lad on board the ship California, in one of
her first voyages, and ran away and commenced Ranchero, gambling, stealing
horses, &c. He worked along up to San Francisco, and was living on a
rancho near there while we were in port. One morning, when we went ashore in
the boat, we found him at the landing-place, dressed in California style,—a
wide hat, faded velveteen trousers, and a blanket thrown over his
shoulders,— and wishing to go off in the boat, saying he was going to
pasear with our captain a little. We had many doubts of the reception
he would meet with; but he seemed to think himself company for any one. We
took him aboard, landed him at the gangway, and went about our work, keeping
an eye upon the quarter-deck, where the captain was walking. The lad went up
to him with complete assurance, and, raising his hat, wished him a good
afternoon. Captain Thompson turned round, looked at him from head to foot,
and, saying coolly, ``Hallo! who the hell are you?'' kept on his walk. This
was a rebuff not to be mistaken, and the joke passed about among the crew
by winks and signs at different parts of the ship. Finding himself
disappointed at head-quarters, he edged along forward to the mate, who was
overseeing some work upon the forecastle, and tried to begin a yarn; but it
would not do. The mate had seen the reception he had met with aft, and would
have no cast-off company. The second mate was aloft, and the third mate and
myself were painting the quarter-boat, which hung by the davits, so he
betook himself to us; but we looked at each other, and the officer was too
busy to say a word. From us, he went to one and another of the crew, but the
joke had got before him, and he found everybody busy and silent. Looking over
the rail a few moments afterward, we saw him at the galley-door talking with
the cook. This was indeed a come-down, from the highest seat in the synagogue
to a seat in the galley with the black cook. At night, too, when supper was
called, he stood in the waist for some time, hoping to be asked down
with the officers, but they went below, one after another, and left him.
His next chance was with the carpenter and sailmaker, and he lounged round
the after hatchway until the last had gone down. We had now had fun enough
out of him, and, taking pity on him, offered him a pot of tea, and a cut at
the kid, with the rest, in the forecastle. He was hungry, and it was growing
dark, and he began to see that there was no use in playing the caballero
any longer, and came down into the forecastle, put into the ``grub'' in
sailor's style, threw off all his airs, and enjoyed the joke as much as any
one; for a man must take a joke among sailors. He gave us an account of his
adventures in the country,—roguery and all,— and was very entertaining. He
was a smart, unprincipled fellow, was in many of the rascally doings of the
country, and gave us a great deal of interesting information as to the ways
of the world we were in.
Saturday, February 13th. Were called up at midnight to slip
for a violent northeaster; for this miserable hole of San Pedro is thought
unsafe in almost every wind. We went off with a flowing sheet, and hove-to
under the lee of Catalina Island, where we lay three days, and then returned
to our anchorage.
Tuesday, February 23d. This afternoon a signal was made from
the shore, and we went off in the gig, and found the agent's clerk, who
had been up to the pueblo, waiting at the landing-place, with a package under
his arm, covered with brown paper and tied carefully with twine. No sooner
had we shoved off than he told us there was good news from Santa Barbara.
``What's that?'' said one of the crew; ``has the bloody agent slipped off the
hooks? Has the old bundle of bones got him at last?''—``No; better than
that. The California has arrived.'' Letters, papers, news, and,
perhaps,— friends, on board! Our hearts were all up in our mouths, and
we pulled away like good fellows, for the precious packet could not be
opened except by the captain. As we pulled under the stern, the clerk held up
the package, and called out to the mate, who was leaning over the taffrail;
that the California had arrived.
``Hurrah!'' said the mate, so as to be heard fore and
aft; ``California come, and news from Boston!''
Instantly there was a confusion on board which no one
would understand who had not been in the same situation. All
discipline seemed for a moment relaxed.
``What's that, Mr. Brown?'' said the cook, putting his head
out of the galley; ``California come?''
``Aye, aye! you angel of darkness, and there's a letter for
you from Bullknop 'treet, number two-two-five,—green door and
brass knocker!''
The packet was sent down into the cabin, and every one waited
to hear of the result. As nothing came up, the officers began to feel that
they were acting rather a child's part, and turned the crew to again; and the
same strict discipline was restored, which prohibits speech between man and
man while at work on deck; so that, when the steward came forward with
letters for the crew, each man took his letters, carried them below to his
chest, and came up again immediately, and not a letter was read until we
had cleared up decks for the night.
An overstrained sense of manliness is the characteristic
of sea-faring men. This often gives an appearance of want of feeling, and
even of cruelty. From this, if a man comes within an ace of breaking his neck
and escapes, it is made a joke of; and no notice must be taken of a bruise or
a cut; and any expression of pity, or any show of attention, would look
sisterly, and unbecoming a man who has to face the rough and tumble of such a
life. From this cause, too, the sick are neglected at sea, and, whatever
sailors may be ashore, a sick man finds little sympathy or
attention, forward or aft. A man, too, can have nothing peculiar or sacred
on board ship; for all the nicer feelings they take pride in disregarding,
both in themselves and others. A thin-skinned man could hardly live on
shipboard. One would be torn raw unless he had the hide of an ox. A moment of
natural feeling for home and friends, and then the frigid routine of sea life
returned. Jokes were made upon those who showed any interest in the expected
news, and everything near and dear was made common stock for rude
jokes and unfeeling coarseness, to which no exception could be taken
by any one.
Supper, too, must be eaten before the letters were read; and
when, at last, they were brought out, they all got round any one who had a
letter, and expected to hear it read aloud, and have it all in common. If any
one went by himself to read, it was—``Fair play, there, and no skulking!''
I took mine and went into the sailmaker's berth where I could read it without
interruption. It was dated August, just a year from the time I had sailed
from home, and every one was well, and no great change had taken
place. Thus, for one year, my mind was set at ease, yet it was already six
months from the date of the letter, and what another year would bring to pass
who could tell? Every one away from home thinks that some great thing must
have happened, while to those at home there seems to be a continued monotony
and lack of incident.
As much as my feelings were taken up by my own news from home,
I could not but be amused by a scene in the steerage. The carpenter had
been married just before leaving Boston, and during the voyage had talked
much about his wife, and had to bear and forbear, as every man, known to be
married, must, aboard ship; yet the certainty of hearing from his wife by the
first ship seemed to keep up his spirits. The California came, the packet was
brought on board, no one was in higher spirits than he; but when
the letters came forward, there was none for him. The captain
looked again, but there was no mistake. Poor ``Chips'' could eat
no supper. He was completely down in the mouth. ``Sails'' (the sailmaker)
tried to comfort him, and told him he was a bloody fool to give up his grub
for any woman's daughter, and reminded him that he had told him a dozen times
that he'd never see or hear from his wife again.
``Ah!'' said Chips, ``you don't know what it is to have a
wife, and—''
``Don't I?'' said Sails; and then came, for the hundredth
time, the story of his coming ashore at New York, from the
Constellation frigate, after a cruise of four years round the Horn,—being
paid off with over five hundred dollars,—marrying, and taking a couple
of rooms in a four-story house,—furnishing the rooms (with a particular
account of the furniture, including a dozen flag-bottomed chairs, which he
always dilated upon whenever the subject of furniture was alluded to),—
going off to sea again, leaving his wife half-pay like a fool,—coming home
and finding her ``off, like Bob's horse, with nobody to pay the
reckoning''; furniture gone, flag-bottomed chairs and all,—and with it
his ``long togs,'' the half-pay, his beaver hat, and white linen shirts.
His wife he never saw or heard of from that day to this, and never wished to.
Then followed a sweeping assertion, not much to the credit of the sex, in
which he has Pope to back him. ``Come, Chips, cheer up like a man, and take
some hot grub! Don't be made a fool of by anything in petticoats! As for your
wife, you'll never see her again; she was `up keeleg and off' before
you were outside of Cape Cod. You've hove your money away like a fool; but
every man must learn once, just as I did; so you'd better square the yards
with her, and make the best of it.''
This was the best consolation ``Sails'' had to offer, but it
did not seem to be just the thing the carpenter wanted; for,
during several days, he was very much dejected, and bore with
difficulty the jokes of the sailors, and with still more difficulty
their attempts at advice and consolation, of most of which the
sailmaker's was a good specimen.
Thursday, February 25th. Set sail for Santa Barbara, where
we arrived on Sunday, the 28th. We just missed seeing the California, for
she had sailed three days before, bound to Monterey, to enter her cargo and
procure her license, and thence to San Francisco, &c. Captain Arthur left
files of Boston papers for Captain Thompson, which, after they had been read
and talked over in the cabin, I procured from my friend the third mate. One
file was of all the Boston Transcripts for the month of August, 1835, and
the rest were about a dozen Daily Advertisers and Couriers of different
dates. After all, there is nothing in a strange land like a newspaper from
home. Even a letter, in many respects, is nothing in comparison with it. It
carries you back to the spot better than anything else. It is almost equal to
clairvoyance. The names of the streets, with the things advertised, are
almost as good as seeing the signs; and while reading ``Boy lost!'' one
can almost hear the bell and well-known voice of ``Old Wilson,'' crying
the boy as ``strayed, stolen, or mislaid!'' Then there was the Commencement
at Cambridge, and the full account of the exercises at the graduating of my
own class. A list of all those familiar names (beginning as usual with Abbot,
and ending with W), which, as I read them over, one by one, brought up their
faces and characters as I had known them in the various scenes of
college life. Then I imagined them upon the stage, speaking
their orations, dissertations, colloquies, &c., with the
familiar gestures and tones of each, and tried to fancy the manner in
which each would handle his subject. ----, handsome, showy,
and superficial; ----, with his strong head, clear brain,
cool self-possession; ----, modest, sensitive, and underrated; ----,
the mouth-piece of the debating clubs, noisy, vaporous, and democratic;
and, so, following. Then I could see them receiving their A.B.'s from the
dignified, feudal-looking President, with his ``auctoritate mihi commissâ,''
and walking off the stage with their diplomas in their hands; while upon the
same day their classmate was walking up and down California beach with a
hide upon his head.
Every watch below, for a week, I pored over these papers,
until I was sure there could be nothing in them that had escaped
my attention, and was ashamed to keep them any longer.
Saturday, March 5th. This was an important day in our almanac,
for it was on this day that we were first assured that our voyage
was really drawing to a close. The captain gave orders to have the ship
ready for getting under way; and observed that there was a good breeze to
take us down to San Pedro. Then we were not going up to windward. Thus much
was certain, and was soon known fore and aft; and when we went in the gig to
take him off, he shook hands with the people on the beach, and said that he
did not expect to see Santa Barbara again. This settled the matter, and sent
a thrill of pleasure through the heart of every one in the boat. We pulled
off with a will, saying to ourselves (I can speak for myself at least),
``Good by, Santa Barbara! This is the last pull here! No more duckings in
your breakers, and slipping from your cursed southeasters!'' The news was
soon known aboard, and put life into everything when we were getting under
way. Each one was taking his last look at the Mission, the town, the breakers
on the beach, and swearing that no money would make him ship to see
them again; and when all hands tallied on to the cat-fall, the chorus of
``Time for us to go!'' was raised for the first time, and joined in, with
full swing, by everybody. One would have thought we were on our voyage home,
so near did it seem to us, though there were yet three months for us on the
coast.
We left here the young Englishman, George Marsh, of whom I
have before spoken, who was wrecked upon the Pelew Islands. He left us to
take the berth of second mate on board the Ayacucho, which was lying in port.
He was well qualified for this post, and his education would enable him to
rise to any situation on board ship. I felt really sorry to part from him.
There was something about him which excited my curiosity; for I could not,
for a moment, doubt that he was well born, and, in early life, well bred.
There was the latent gentleman about him, and the sense of honor, and
no little of the pride, of a young man of good family. The situation was
offered him only a few hours before we sailed; and though he must give up
returning to America, yet I have no doubt that the change from a dog's berth
to an officer's was too agreeable to his feelings to be declined. We pulled
him on board the Ayacucho, and when he left the boat he gave each of its crew
a piece of money except myself, and shook hands with me, nodding his head, as
much as to say ``We understand each other,'' and sprang on board. Had
I known, an hour sooner, that he was to leave us, I would have made an
effort to get from him the true history of his birth and early life. He knew
that I had no faith in the story which he told the crew about them, and
perhaps, in the moment of parting from me, probably forever, he would have
given me the true account. Whether I shall ever meet him again, or whether
his manuscript narrative of his adventures in the Pelew Islands, which would
be creditable to him and interesting to the world, will ever see the light,
I cannot tell. His is one of those cases which are more numerous than
those suppose who have never lived anywhere but in their own homes, and never
walked but in one line from their cradles to their graves. We must come down
from our heights, and leave our straight paths for the by-ways and low places
of life, if we would learn truths by strong contrasts; and in hovels, in
forecastles, and among our own outcasts in foreign lands, see what has
been wrought among our fellow-creatures by accident, hardship, or
vice.
Two days brought us to San Pedro, and two days more (to our
no small joy) gave us our last view of that place, which was universally
called the hell of California, and seemed designed in every way for the wear
and tear of sailors. Not even the last view could bring out one feeling of
regret. No thanks, thought I, as we left the hated shores in the distance,
for the hours I have walked over your stones barefooted, with hides on my
head,—for the burdens I have carried up your steep, muddy hill,—for
the duckings in your surf; and for the long days and longer nights passed
on your desolate hill, watching piles of hides, hearing the sharp bark of
your eternal coyotes, and the dismal hooting of your owls.
As I bade good by to each successive place, I felt as though
one link after another were struck from the chain of my servitude. Having
kept close in shore for the land-breeze, we passed the Mission of San Juan
Capistrano the same night, and saw distinctly, by the bright moonlight, the
cliff which I had gone down by a pair of halyards in search of a few paltry
hides.
``Forsan et haec olim,''
thought I, and took my last look of that place too. And on
the next morning we were under the high point of San Diego. The flood tide
took us swiftly in, and we came-to opposite our hide-house, and prepared to
get everything in trim for a long stay. This was our last port. Here we were
to discharge everything from the ship, clean her out, smoke her, take in our
hides, wood, and water, and set sail for Boston. While all this was doing, we
were to lie still in one place, the port a safe one, and no fear
of southeasters. Accordingly, having picked out a good berth in
the stream, with a smooth beach opposite for a landing-place, and within
two cables' length of our hide-house, we moored ship, unbent the sails, sent
down the top-gallant-yards and the studding-sail booms, and housed the
top-gallant-masts. The boats were then hove out and all the sails, the spare
spars, the stores, the rigging not rove, and, in fact, everything which was
not in daily use, sent ashore, and stowed away in the house. Then went our
hides and horns, and we left hardly anything in the ship but her ballast, and
this we made preparations to heave out the next day. At night, after we had
knocked off, and were sitting round in the forecastle, smoking and talking,
and taking sailor's pleasure, we congratulated ourselves upon being in that
situation in which we had wished ourselves every time we had come into San
Diego. ``If we were only here for the last time,'' we had often
said, ``with our top-gallant-masts housed and our sails unbent!''—
and now we had our wish. Six weeks, or two months, of the hardest work we
had yet seen, but not the most disagreeable or trying, was before us, and
then—``Good by to California!''
CHAPTER XXIX
We turned-in early, knowing that we might expect an early
call; and sure enough, before the stars had quite faded, ``All
hands ahoy!'' and we were turned-to, heaving out ballast. A regulation of
the port forbids any ballast to be thrown overboard; accordingly, our
long-boat was lined inside with rough boards and brought alongside the
gangway, but where one tubful went into the boat twenty went overboard. This
is done by every vessel, as it saves more than a week of labor, which would
be spent in loading the boats, rowing them to the point, and unloading them.
When any people from the presidio were on board, the boat was hauled up
and the ballast thrown in; but when the coast was clear, she was dropped
astern again, and the ballast fell overboard. This is one of those petty
frauds which many vessels practise in ports of inferior foreign nations, and
which are lost sight of among the deeds of greater weight which are hardly
less common. Fortunately, a sailor, not being a free agent in work aboard
ship, is not accountable; yet the fact of being constantly employed,
without thought, in such things, begets an indifference to the rights
of others.
Friday, and a part of Saturday, we were engaged in this
work, until we had thrown out all but what we wanted under our cargo
on the passage home; when, as the next day was Sunday, and a good day for
smoking ship, we cleared everything out of the cabin and forecastle, made a
slow fire of charcoal, birch bark, brimstone, and other matters, on the
ballast in the bottom of the hold, calked up the hatches and every open seam,
and pasted over the cracks of the windows, and the slides of the scuttles
and companion-way. Wherever smoke was seen coming out, we calked
and pasted and, so far as we could, made the ship smoke tight. The captain
and officers slept under the awning which was spread over the quarter-deck;
and we stowed ourselves away under an old studding-sail, which we drew over
one side of the forecastle. The next day, from fear that something might
happen in the way of fire, orders were given for no one to leave the ship,
and, as the decks were lumbered up, we could not wash them down, so we
had nothing to do all day long. Unfortunately, our books were where
we could not get at them, and we were turning about for something to do,
when one man recollected a book he had left in the galley. He went after it,
and it proved to be Woodstock. This was a great windfall, and as all could
not read it at once, I, being the scholar of the company, was appointed
reader. I got a knot of six or eight about me, and no one could have had a
more attentive audience. Some laughed at the ``scholars,'' and went over
the other side of the forecastle to work and spin their yarns; but
I carried the day, and had the cream of the crew for my hearers. Many of
the reflections, and the political parts, I omitted, but all the narrative
they were delighted with; especially the descriptions of the Puritans, and
the sermons and harangues of the Round-head soldiers. The gallantry of
Charles, Dr. Radcliffe's plots, the knavery of ``trusty Tompkins,''—in
fact, every part seemed to chain their attention. Many things which, while I
was reading, I had a misgiving about, thinking them above their tastes, I
was surprised to find them enter into completely.
I read nearly all day, until sundown; when, as soon as supper
was over, as I had nearly finished, they got a light from the galley; and,
by skipping what was less interesting, I carried them through to the marriage
of Everard, and the restoration of Charles the Second, before eight
o'clock.
The next morning, we took the battens from the hatches, and
opened the ship. A few stifled rats were found; and what
bugs, cockroaches, fleas, and other vermin there might have been on board
must have unrove their life-lines before the hatches were opened. The ship
being now ready, we covered the bottom of the hold over, fore and aft, with
dried brush for dunnage, and, having levelled everything away, we were ready
to take in our cargo. All the hides that had been collected since the
California left the coast (a little more than two years), amounting to about
forty thousand, had been cured, dried, and stowed away in the
house, waiting for our good ship to take them to Boston.
Now began the operation of taking in our cargo, which kept us
hard at work, from the gray of the morning till starlight, for six weeks,
with the exception of Sundays, and of just time to swallow our meals. To
carry the work on quicker, a division of labor was made. Two men threw the
hides down from the piles in the house, two more picked them up and put them
on a long horizontal pole, raised a few feet from the ground, where they were
beaten by two more with flails, somewhat like those used in threshing
wheat. When beaten, they were taken from this pole by two more, and placed
upon a platform of boards; and ten or a dozen men, with their trousers rolled
up, and hides upon their heads, were constantly going back and forth from the
platform to the boat, which was kept off where she would just float. The
throwing the hides upon the pole was the most difficult work, and required
a sleight of hand which was only to be got by long practice. As I was
known for a hide-curer, this post was assigned to me, and I continued at it
for six or eight days, tossing, in that time, from eight to ten thousand
hides, until my wrists became so lame that I gave in, and was transferred to
the gang that was employed in filling the boats, where I remained for the
rest of the time. As we were obliged to carry the hides on our heads from
fear of their getting wet, we each had a piece of sheepskin sewed into
the inside of our hats, with the wool next our heads, and thus were able
to bear the weight, day after day, which might otherwise have worn off our
hair, and borne hard upon our skulls. Upon the whole ours was the best berth,
for though the water was nipping cold, early in the morning and late at
night, and being so continually wet was rather an exposure, yet we got rid of
the constant dust and dirt from the beating of the hides, and, being all of
us young and hearty, did not mind the exposure. The older men of the
crew, whom it would have been imprudent to keep in the water, remained on
board with the mate, to stow the hides away, as fast as they were brought off
by the boats.
We continued at work in this manner until the lower hold
was filled to within four feet of the beams, when all hands were called
aboard to begin steeving. As this is a peculiar operation, it will require a
minute description.
Before stowing the hides, as I have said, the ballast is
levelled off, just above the keelson, and then loose dunnage is placed
upon it, on which the hides rest. The greatest care is used in stowing, to
make the ship hold as many hides as possible. It is no mean art, and a man
skilled in it is an important character in California. Many a dispute have I
heard raging high between professed ``beach-combers,'' as to whether the
hides should be stowed ``shingling,'' or ``back-to-back and
flipper-to-flipper''; upon which point there was an entire and bitter
division of sentiment among the savans. We adopted each method at
different periods of the stowing, and parties ran high in the
forecastle, some siding with ``old Bill'' in favor of the former, and
others scouting him and relying upon ``English Bob'' of the Ayacucho,
who had been eight years in California, and was willing to risk his life
and limb for the latter method. At length a compromise was effected, and a
middle course of shifting the ends and backs at every lay was adopted, which
worked well, and which each party granted was better than that of the other,
though inferior to its own.
Having filled the ship up, in this way, to within four feet of
her beams, the process of steeving began, by which a hundred hides are got
into a place where scarce one could be forced by hand, and which presses the
hides to the utmost, sometimes starting the beams of the ship,—resembling
in its effects the jack-screws which are used in stowing cotton. Each morning
we went ashore, and beat and brought off as many hides as we could steeve in
a day, and, after breakfast, went down into the hold, where we remained at
work until night, except a short spell for dinner. The length of the hold,
from stem to stern, was floored off level; and we began with raising a pile
in the after part, hard against the bulkhead of the run, and filling it up to
the beams, crowding in as many as we could by hand and pushing in with oars,
when a large ``book'' was made of from twenty-five to fifty hides, doubled
at the backs, and placed one within another, so as to leave but
one outside hide for the book. An opening was then made between two hides
in the pile, and the back of the outside hide of the book inserted. Above and
below this book were placed smooth strips of wood, well greased, called
``ways,'' to facilitate the sliding in of the book. Two long, heavy spars,
called steeves, made of the strongest wood, and sharpened off like a wedge at
one end, were placed with their wedge ends into the inside of the hide which
was the centre of the book, and to the other end of each straps
were fitted, into which large tackles[1] were hooked, composed each of two
huge purchase blocks, one hooked to the strap on the end of the steeve, and
the other into a dog, fastened into one of the beams, as far aft as it could
be got. When this was arranged, and the ways greased upon which the book was
to slide, the falls of the tackles were stretched forward, and all hands
tallied on, and bowsed away upon them until the book was well entered, when
these tackles were nippered, straps and toggles clapped upon the
falls, and two more luff tackles hooked on, with dogs, in the same manner;
and thus, by luff upon luff, the power was multiplied, until into a pile in
which one hide more could not be crowded by hand a hundred or a hundred and
fifty were often driven by this complication of purchases. When the last luff
was hooked on, all hands were called to the rope,—cook, steward, and all,—
and ranging ourselves at the falls, one behind the other, sitting down on
the hides, with our heads just even with the beams, we set taut upon the
tackles, and striking up a song, and all lying back at the chorus, we bowsed
the tackles home, and drove the large books chock in out of
sight.
The sailors' songs for capstans and falls are of a peculiar
kind, having a chorus at the end of each line. The burden is usually sung
by one alone, and, at the chorus, all hands join in,—and, the louder the
noise, the better. With us, the chorus seemed almost to raise the decks of
the ship, and might be heard at a great distance ashore. A song is as
necessary to sailors as the drum and fife to a soldier. They must pull
together as soldiers must step in time, and they can't pull in time, or pull
with a will, without it. Many a time, when a thing goes heavy, with
one fellow yo-ho-ing, a lively song, like ``Heave, to the girls!'' ``Nancy
O!'' ``Jack Crosstree,'' ``Cheerly, men,'' &c., has put life and strength
into every arm. We found a great difference in the effect of the various
songs in driving in the hides. Two or three songs would be tried, one after
the other, with no effect,— not an inch could be got upon the tackles; when
a new song, struck up, seemed to hit the humor of the moment, and drove the
tackles ``two blocks'' at once. ``Heave round hearty!'' ``Captain
gone ashore!'' ``Dandy ship and a dandy crew,'' and the like, might do for
common pulls, but on an emergency, when we wanted a heavy, ``raise-the-dead
pull,'' which should start the beams of the ship, there was nothing like
``Time for us to go!'' ``Round the corner,'' ``Tally high ho! you know,'' or
``Hurrah! hurrah! my hearty bullies!''
This was the most lively part of our work. A little boating
and beach work in the morning; then twenty or thirty men down in a close
hold, where we were obliged to sit down and slide about, passing hides, and
rowsing about the great steeves, tackles, and dogs, singing out at the falls,
and seeing the ship filling up every day. The work was as hard as it could
well be. There was not a moment's cessation from Monday morning till Saturday
night, when we were generally beaten out, and glad to have a full
night's rest, a wash and shift of clothes, and a quiet Sunday. During
all this time—which would have startled Dr. Graham—we lived
upon almost nothing but fresh beef; fried beefsteaks, three times a day,—
morning, noon, and night. At morning and night we had a quart of tea to each
man, and an allowance of about a pound of hard bread a day; but our chief
article of food was beef. A mess, consisting of six men, had a large wooden
kid piled up with beefsteaks, cut thick, and fried in fat, with the grease
poured over them. Round this we sat, attacking it with our jack-knives and
teeth, and with the appetite of young lions, and sent back an empty kid to
the galley. This was done three times a day. How many pounds each man ate in
a day I will not attempt to compute. A whole bullock (we ate liver and all)
lasted us but four days. Such devouring of flesh, I will venture to say, is
not often seen. What one man ate in a day, over a hearty man's allowance,
would make an English peasant's heart leap into his mouth. Indeed, during
all the time we were upon the coast, our principal food was fresh beef,
and every man had perfect health; but this was a time of especial devouring,
and what we should have done without meat I cannot tell. Once or twice, when
our bullocks failed, and we were obliged to make a meal upon dry bread and
water, it seemed like feeding upon shavings. Light and dry, feeling
unsatisfied, and, at the same time, full, we were glad to see four quarters
of a bullock, just killed, swinging from the fore-top. Whatever theories
may be started by sedentary men, certainly no men could have gone through
more hard work and exposure for sixteen months in more perfect health, and
without ailings and failings, than our ship's crew, let them have lived upon
Hygeia's own baking and dressing.
Friday, April 15th. Arrived, brig Pilgrim, from the windward.
It was a sad sight for her crew to see us getting ready to go off
the coast, while they, who had been longer on the coast than the Alert,
were condemned to another year's hard service. I spent an evening on board,
and found them making the best of the matter, and determined to rough it out
as they might. But Stimson, after considerable negotiating and working, had
succeeded in persuading my English friend, Tom Harris,—my companion in the
anchor watch,— for thirty dollars, some clothes, and an intimation from
Captain Faucon that he should want a second mate before the voyage
was over, to take his place in the brig as soon as she was ready to go up
to windward.
The first opportunity I could get to speak to Captain Faucon,
I asked him to step up to the oven and look at Hope, whom he knew well,
having had him on board his vessel. He went to see him at once, and said that
he was doing pretty well, but there was so little medicine on board the brig,
and she would be so long on the coast, that he could spare none for him, but
that Captain Arthur would take care of him when he came down in the
California, which would be in a week or more. I had been to see Hope the
first night after we got into San Diego this last time, and had
frequently since spent the early part of a night in the oven. I
hardly expected, when I left him to go to windward, to find him alive upon
my return. He was certainly as low as he could well be when I left him, and
what would be the effect of the medicines that I gave him I hardly then dared
to conjecture. Yet I knew that he must die without them. I was not a little
rejoiced, therefore, and relieved, upon our return, to see him decidedly
better. The medicines were strong, and took hold and gave a check to
the disorder which was destroying him; and, more than that, they had begun
the work of exterminating it. I shall never forget the gratitude that he
expressed. All the Kanakas attributed his escape solely to my knowledge, and
would not be persuaded that I had not all the secrets of the physical system
open to me and under my control. My medicines, however, were gone, and no
more could be got from the ship, so that his life was left to hang upon
the arrival of the California.
Sunday, April 24th. We had now been nearly seven weeks in
San Diego, and had taken in the greater part of our cargo, and
were looking out every day for the arrival of the California, which
had our agent on board; when, this afternoon, some Kanakas, who had been
over the hill for rabbits and to fight rattlesnakes, came running down the
path, singing out ``Kail ho!'' with all their might. Mr. Hatch, our third
mate, was ashore, and, asking them particularly about the size of the sail,
&c., and learning that it was ``Moku—Nui Moku,'' hailed our ship, and
said that the California was on the other side of the point. Instantly,
all hands were turned up, the bow guns run out and loaded, the ensign and
broad pennant set, the yards squared by lifts and braces, and everything got
ready to make a fair appearance. The instant she showed her nose round the
point we began our salute. She came in under top-gallant-sails, clewed up and
furled her sails in good order, and came-to within swinging distance of us.
It being Sunday, and nothing to do, all hands were on the
forecastle, criticising the new comer. She was a good, substantial ship,
not quite so long as the Alert, wall-sided and kettle-bottomed, after the
latest fashion of south-shore cotton and sugar wagons; strong, too, and
tight, and a good average sailer, but with no pretensions to beauty, and
nothing in the style of a ``crack ship.'' Upon the whole, we were perfectly
satisfied that the Alert might hold up her head with a ship twice as smart as
she.
At night some of us got a boat and went on board, and found
a large, roomy forecastle (for she was squarer forward than the Alert),
and a crew of a dozen or fifteen men and boys sitting around on their chests,
smoking and talking, and ready to give a welcome to any of our ship's
company. It was just seven months since they left Boston, which seemed but
yesterday to us. Accordingly, we had much to ask; for though we had seen
the newspapers which she had brought, yet these were the very men who had
been in Boston, and seen everything with their own eyes. One of the green
hands was a Boston boy, from one of the public schools, and, of course, knew
many things which we wished to ask about, and, on inquiring the names of our
two Boston boys, found that they had been school-mates of his. Our men had
hundreds of questions to ask about Ann Street, the boarding-houses, the
ships in port, the rate of wages, and other matters.
Among her crew were two English man-of-war's-men, so that,
of course, we soon had music. They sang in the true sailor's style, and
the rest of the crew, which was a remarkably musical one, joined in the
choruses. They had many of the latest sailor songs, which had not yet got
about among our merchantmen, and which they were very choice of. They began
soon after we came on board, and kept it up until after two bells, when the
second mate came forward and called ``the Alerts away!''
Battle-songs, drinking-songs, boat-songs, love-songs, and everything else,
they seemed to have a complete assortment of, and I was glad to find that
``All in the Downs,'' ``Poor Tom Bowline,'' ``The Bay of Biscay,'' ``List, ye
Landsmen!'' and other classical songs of the sea, still held their places. In
addition to these, they had picked up at the theatres and other places a few
songs of a little more genteel cast, which they were very proud of; and I
shall never forget hearing an old salt, who had broken his voice by
hard drinking on shore, and bellowing from the mast-head in a
hundred northwesters, singing—with all manner of ungovernable trills
and quavers, in the high notes breaking into a rough falsetto, and in the
low ones growling along like the dying away of the boatswain's ``All hands
ahoy!'' down the hatchway—``O no, we never mention him.''
``Perhaps, like me, he struggles
with Each feeling of
regret; But if he's loved as I have
loved, He never can forget!''
The last line he roared out at the top of his voice, breaking
each word into half a dozen syllables. This was very popular, and Jack was
called upon every night to give them his ``sentimental song.'' No one called
for it more loudly than I, for the complete absurdity of the execution, and
the sailors' perfect satisfaction in it, were ludicrous beyond
measure.
The next day the California began unloading her cargo; and
her boats' crews, in coming and going, sang their boat-songs, keeping time
with their oars. This they did all day long for several days, until their
hides were all discharged, when a gang of them were sent on board the Alert
to help us steeve our hides. This was a windfall for us, for they had a set
of new songs for the capstan and fall, and ours had got nearly worn out by
six weeks' constant use. I have no doubt that this timely re-enforcement of
songs hastened our work several days.
Our cargo was now nearly all taken in, and my old friend,
the Pilgrim, having completed her discharge, unmoored, to set sail
the next morning on another long trip to windward. I was just thinking of
her hard lot, and congratulating myself upon my escape from her, when I
received a summons into the cabin. I went aft, and there found, seated round
the cabin table, my own captain, Captain Faucon of the Pilgrim, and Mr.
Robinson, the agent. Captain Thompson turned to me and asked
abruptly,--
``Dana, do you want to go home in the ship?''
``Certainly, sir,'' said I; ``I expect to go home in the
ship.''
``Then,'' said he, ``you must get some one to go in your place
on board the Pilgrim.''
I was so completely ``taken aback'' by this sudden intimation
that for a moment I could make no reply. I thought it would be hopeless to
attempt to prevail upon any of the ship's crew to take twelve months more
upon California in the brig. I knew, too, that Captain Thompson had received
orders to bring me home in the Alert, and he had told me, when I was at the
hide-house, that I was to go home in her; and even if this had not been so,
it was cruel to give me no notice of the step they were going to take, until
a few hours before the brig would sail. As soon as I had got my wits about
me, I put on a bold front, and told him plainly that I had a letter in my
chest informing me that he had been written to by the owners in Boston to
bring me home in the ship; and, moreover, that he had told me that he had
such instructions, and that I was to return in the ship.
To have this told him, and to be opposed in such a manner,
was more than my lord paramount had been used to. He turned fiercely upon
me, and tried to look me down, and face me out of my statement; but finding
that that wouldn't do, and that I was entering upon my defence in such a way
as would show to the other two that he was in the wrong, he changed his
ground, and pointed to the shipping-papers of the Pilgrim, from which my name
had never been erased, and said that there was my name,—that I belonged
to her,—that he had an absolute discretionary power,— and, in short, that
I must be on board the Pilgrim by the next morning with my chest and hammock,
or have some one ready to go in my place, and that he would not hear another
word from me. No court of star chamber could proceed more summarily with a
poor devil than this trio was about to do with me; condemning me to
a punishment worse than a Botany Bay exile, and to a fate which might
alter the whole current of my future life; for two years more in California
might have made me a sailor for the rest of my days. I felt all this, and saw
the necessity of being determined. I repeated what I had said, and insisted
upon my right to return in the ship.
``I raised my arm, and tauld my
crack, Before them a'.''
But it would have all availed me nothing had I been ``some
poor body'' before this absolute, domineering tribunal. But they saw that
I would not go, unless ``vi et armis,'' and they knew that I had friends and
interest enough at home to make them suffer for any injustice they might do
me. It was probably this that turned the scale; for the captain changed his
tone entirely, and asked me if, in case any one went in my place, I would
give him the same sum that Stimson gave Harris to exchange with him. I told
them that if any one was sent on board the brig I should pity him, and be
willing to help him to that, or almost any amount; but would not speak of it
as an exchange.
``Very well,'' said he. ``Go forward about your business, and
send English Ben here to me!''
I went forward with a light heart, but feeling as much anger
and contempt as I could well contain between my teeth. English Ben
was sent aft, and in a few moments came forward, looking as though he had
received his sentence to be hanged. The captain had told him to get his
things ready to go on board the brig next morning; and that I would give him
thirty dollars and a suit of clothes. The hands had ``knocked off'' for
dinner, and were standing about the forecastle, when Ben came forward and
told his story. I could see plainly that it made a great excitement, and
that, unless I explained the matter to them, the feeling would be turned
against me. Ben was a poor English boy, a stranger in Boston, and
without friends or money; and, being an active, willing lad, and a
good sailor for his years, was a general favorite. ``O yes!'' said
the crew; ``the captain has let you off because you are a gentleman's son,
and taken Ben because he is poor, and has got nobody to say a word for him.''
I knew that this was too true to be answered, but I excused myself from any
blame, and told them that I had a right to go home, at all events. This
pacified them a little, but Jack had got a notion that a poor lad was to be
imposed upon, and did not distinguish very clearly; and though I knew that I
was in no fault, and, in fact, had barely escaped the grossest
injustice, yet I felt that my berth was getting to be a disagreeable one.
The notion that I was not ``one of them,'' which, by a participation in
all their labor and hardships, and having no favor shown me, and never
asserting myself among them, had been laid asleep, was beginning to revive.
But far stronger than any feeling for myself was the pity I felt for the poor
lad. He had depended upon going home in the ship; and from Boston was going
immediately to Liverpool, to see his friends. Besides this, having begun
the voyage with very few clothes, he had taken up the greater part of his
wages in the slop-chest, and it was every day a losing concern to him; and,
like all the rest of the crew, he had a hearty hatred of California, and the
prospect of eighteen months or two years more of hide droghing seemed
completely to break down his spirit. I had determined not to go myself,
happen what would, and I knew that the captain would not dare to attempt to
force me. I knew, too, that the two captains had agreed together to get some
one, and that unless I could prevail upon somebody to go
voluntarily, there would be no help for Ben. From this consideration, though
I had said that I would have nothing to do with an exchange, I did my best
to get some one to go voluntarily. I offered to give an order upon the owners
in Boston for six months' wages, and also all the clothes, books, and other
matters which I should not want upon the voyage home. When this offer was
published in the ship, and the case of poor Ben set forth in strong colors,
several, who would not dream of going themselves, were busy in talking it up
to others, who, they thought, might be tempted to accept it; and,
at length, a Boston boy, a harum-scarum lad, a great favorite, Harry May,
whom we called Harry Bluff, and who did not care what country or ship he was
in, if he had clothes enough and money enough,— partly from pity for Ben,
and partly from the thought he should have ``cruising money'' for the rest of
his stay,—came forward, and offered to go and ``sling his hammock in the
bloody hooker.'' Lest his purpose should cool, I signed an order for the sum
upon the owners in Boston, gave him all the clothes I could spare,
and sent him aft to the captain, to let him know what had been done. The
skipper accepted the exchange, and was, doubtless, glad to have it pass off
so easily. At the same time he cashed the order, which was indorsed to
him,[2] and the next morning the lad went aboard the brig, apparently in good
spirits, having shaken hands with each of us and wished us a pleasant passage
home, jingling the money in his pockets, and calling out ``Never say die,
while there's a shot in the locker.'' The same boat carried off Harris, my
old watchmate, who had previously made an exchange with my friend
Stimson.
I was sorry to part with Harris. Nearly two hundred hours (as
we had calculated it) had we walked the ship's deck together, at anchor
watch, when all hands were below, and talked over and over every subject
which came within the ken of either of us. He gave me a strong gripe with his
hand; and I told him, if he came to Boston, not to fail to find me out, and
let me see my old watchmate. The same boat brought on board Stimson, who had
begun the voyage with me from Boston, and, like me, was going back to his
family and to the society in which he had been born and brought up. We
congratulated each other upon finding what we had long talked over and wished
for thus brought about; and none on board the ship were more glad than
ourselves to see the old brig standing round the point, under full sail. As
she passed abreast of us, we all collected in the waist, and gave her three
loud, hearty cheers, waving our hats in the air. Her crew sprang into the
rigging and chains, and answered us with three as loud, to which we, after
the nautical custom, gave one in return. I took my last look of their
familiar faces as they passed over the rail, and saw the old black cook put
his head out of the galley, and wave his cap over his head. Her crew flew
aloft to loose the top-gallant-sails and royals; the two captains waved their
hands to each other; and, in ten minutes, we saw the last inch of
her white canvas, as she rounded the point.
Relieved as I was to see her well off (and I felt like one who
had just sprung from an iron trap which was closing upon him), I had yet a
feeling of regret at taking the last look at the old craft in which I had
spent a year, and the first year, of my sailor's life, which had been my
first home in the new world into which I had entered, and with which I had
associated so many events,—my first leaving home, my first crossing the
equator, Cape Horn, Juan Fernandez, death at sea, and other things, serious
and common. Yet, with all this, and the sentiment I had for my old
shipmates condemned to another term of California life, the thought that
we were done with it, and that one week more would see us on our way to
Boston, was a cure for everything.
Friday, May 6th, completed the getting in of our cargo, and
was a memorable day in our calendar. The time when we were to take in our
last hide we had looked forward to, for sixteen months, as the first bright
spot. When the last hide was stowed away, the hatches calked down, the
tarpaulins battened on to them, the long-boat hoisted in and secured, and the
decks swept down for the night,— the chief mate sprang upon the top of the
long-boat, called all hands into the waist, and, giving us a signal by
swinging his cap over his head, we gave three long, loud cheers, which came
from the bottom of our hearts, and made the hills and valleys ring again.
In a moment we heard three in answer from the California's crew, who had seen
us taking in our long-boat; ``the cry they heard,—its meaning
knew.''
The last week we had been occupied in taking in a supply of
wood and water for the passage home, and in bringing on board the
spare spars, sails, &c. I was sent off with a party of Indians to
fill the water-casks, at a spring about three miles from the shipping and
near the town, and was absent three days, living at the town, and spending
the daytime in filling the casks and transporting them on ox-carts to the
landing-place, whence they were taken on board by the crew with boats. This
being all done with, we gave one day to bending our sails, and at night every
sail, from the courses to the skysails, was bent, and every studding-sail
ready for setting.
Before our sailing an unsuccessful attempt was made by one of
the crew of the California to effect an exchange with one of our number.
It was a lad, between fifteen and sixteen years of age, who went by the name
of the ``reefer,'' having been a midshipman in an East India Company's ship.
His singular character and story had excited our interest ever since the ship
came into the port. He was a delicate, slender little fellow, with a
beautiful pearly complexion, regular features; forehead as white as marble,
black hair curling beautifully round it; tapering, delicate fingers; small
feet, soft voice, gentle manners, and, in fact, every sign of having been
well born and bred. At the same time there was something in his expression
which showed a slight deficiency of intellect. How great the deficiency was,
or what it resulted from; whether he was born so; whether it was the result
of disease or accident; or whether, as some said, it was brought on by
his distress of mind during the voyage,—I cannot say. From his account
of himself, and from many circumstances which were known in connection with
his story, he must have been the son of a man of wealth. His mother was an
Italian. He was probably a natural son, for in scarcely any other way could
the incidents of his early life be accounted for. He said that his parents
did not live together, and he seemed to have been ill treated by his
father. Though he had been delicately brought up, and indulged in
every way (and he had then with him trinkets which had been given him
at home), yet his education had been sadly neglected; and when only twelve
years old, he was sent as midshipman in the Company's service. His own story
was, that he afterwards ran away from home, upon a difficulty which he had
with his father, and went to Liverpool, whence he sailed in the ship Rialto,
Captain Holmes, for Boston. Captain Holmes endeavored to get him a passage
back, but, there being no vessel to sail for some time, the boy left him,
and went to board at a common sailor's boarding-house in Ann Street, where he
supported himself for a few weeks by selling some of his valuables. At
length, according to his own account, being desirous of returning home, he
went to a shipping-office, where the shipping articles of the California were
open. Upon asking where the ship was going, he was told by the
shipping-master that she was bound to California. Not knowing where that was,
he told him that he wanted to go to Europe, and asked if California was
in Europe. The shipping-master answered him in a way which the boy did not
understand, and advised him to ship. The boy signed the articles, received
his advance, laid out a little of it in clothes, and spent the rest, and was
ready to go on board, when, upon the morning of sailing, he heard that the
ship was bound upon the Northwest Coast, on a two or three years' voyage, and
was not going to Europe. Frightened at this prospect, he slipped away
when the crew were going aboard, wandered up into another part of
the town, and spent all the forenoon in straying about the Common, and the
neighboring streets. Having no money, and all his clothes and other things
being in his chest on board, and being a stranger, he became tired and
hungry, and ventured down toward the shipping, to see if the vessel had
sailed. He was just turning the corner of a street, when the shipping-master,
who had been in search of him, popped upon him, seized him, and carried him
on board. He cried and struggled, and said he did not wish to go in the ship;
but the topsails were at the mast-head, the fasts just ready to be
cast off, and everything in the hurry and confusion of departure, so that
he was hardly noticed; and the few who did inquire about the matter were told
that it was merely a boy who had spent his advance and tried to run away. Had
the owners of the vessel known anything of the matter, they would doubtless
have interfered; but they either knew nothing of it, or heard, like the rest,
that it was only an unruly boy who was sick of his bargain. As soon as
the boy found himself actually at sea, and upon a voyage of two or three
years in length, his spirits failed him; he refused to work, and became so
miserable that Captain Arthur took him into the cabin, where he assisted the
steward, and occasionally pulled and hauled about decks. He was in this
capacity when we saw him; and though it was much better for him than the life
in a forecastle, and the hard work, watching, and exposure, which his
delicate frame could not have borne, yet, to be joined with a black
fellow in waiting upon a man whom he probably looked upon as but
little, in point of education and manners, above one of his
father's servants, was almost too much for his spirit to bear. Had
he entered upon this situation of his own free will, he could have endured
it; but to have been deceived, and, in addition to that, forced into it, was
intolerable. He made every effort to go home in our ship, but his captain
refused to part with him except in the way of exchange, and that he could not
effect. If this account of the whole matter, which we had from the boy, and
which was confirmed by the crew, be correct, I cannot understand why
Captain Arthur should have refused to let him go, especially as he had
the name, not only with that crew, but with all he had ever commanded, of
an unusually kind-hearted man. The truth is, the unlimited power which
merchant captains have upon long voyages on strange coasts takes away the
sense of responsibility, and too often, even in men otherwise well disposed,
gives growth to a disregard for the rights and feelings of others. The lad
was sent on shore to join the gang at the hide-house, from whence, I was
afterwards rejoiced to hear, he effected his escape, and went down to
Callao in a small Spanish schooner; and from Callao he probably
returned to England.
Soon after the arrival of the California, I spoke to
Captain Arthur about Hope, the Kanaka; and as he had known him on
the voyage before, and liked him, he immediately went to see him, gave him
proper medicines, and, under such care, he began rapidly to recover. The
Saturday night before our sailing I spent an hour in the oven, and took leave
of my Kanaka friends; and, really, this was the only thing connected with
leaving California which was in any way unpleasant. I felt an interest and
affection for many of these simple, true-hearted men, such as I never felt
before but for a near relation. Hope shook me by the hand; said he
should soon be well again, and ready to work for me when I came upon
the coast, next voyage, as officer of the ship; and told me not to forget,
when I became captain, how to be kind to the sick. Old ``Mr. Bingham'' and
``King Mannini'' went down to the boat with me, shook me heartily by the
hand, wished us a good voyage, and went back to the oven, chanting one of
their deep, monotonous, improvised songs, the burden of which I gathered to
be about us and our voyage.
Sunday, May 8th, 1836. This promised to be our last day
in California. Our forty thousand hides and thirty thousand horns, besides
several barrels of otter and beaver skins, were all stowed below, and the
hatches calked down.[3] All our spare spars were taken on board and lashed,
our water-casks secured, and our live stock, consisting of four bullocks, a
dozen sheep, a dozen or more pigs, and three or four dozens of poultry, were
all stowed away in their different quarters; the bullocks in the long-boat,
the sheep in a pen on the fore hatch, the pigs in a sty under the bows
of the long-boat, and the poultry in their proper coop, and the jolly-boat
was full of hay for the sheep and bullocks. Our unusually large cargo,
together with the stores for a five months' voyage, brought the ship channels
down into the water. In addition to this, she had been steeved so thoroughly,
and was so bound by the compression of her cargo, forced into her by
machinery so powerful, that she was like a man in a strait-jacket, and would
be but a dull sailer until she had worked herself loose.
The California had finished discharging her cargo, and was to
get under way at the same time with us. Having washed down decks and got
breakfast, the two vessels lay side by side, in complete readiness for sea,
our ensigns hanging from the peaks, and our tall spars reflected from the
glassy surface of the river, which, since sunrise, had been unbroken by a
ripple. At length a few whiffs came across the water, and, by eleven o'clock
the regular northwest wind set steadily in. There was no need of calling
all hands, for we had all been hanging about the forecastle the
whole forenoon, and were ready for a start upon the first sign of
a breeze. Often we turned our eyes aft upon the captain, who was walking
the deck, with every now and then a look to windward. He made a sign to the
mate, who came forward, took his station deliberately between the
knight-heads, cast a glance aloft, and called out ``All hands, lay aloft and
loose the sails!'' We were half in the rigging before the order came, and
never since we left Boston were the gaskets off the yards, and the rigging
overhauled, in a shorter time. ``All ready forward, sir!''—``All ready
the main!''—``Cross-jack yards all ready, sir!''—``Lay down, all hands
but one on each yard!'' The yard-arm and bunt gaskets were cast off; and each
sail hung by the jigger, with one man standing by the tie to let it go. At
the same moment that we sprang aloft, a dozen hands sprang into the rigging
of the California, and in an instant were all over her yards; and her sails,
too, were ready to be dropped at the word. In the mean time our bow gun had
been loaded and run out, and its discharge was to be the signal
for dropping the sails. A cloud of smoke came out of our bows; the echoes
of the gun rattled our farewell among the hills of California, and the two
ships were covered, from head to foot, with their white canvas. For a few
minutes all was uproar and apparent confusion; men jumping about like monkeys
in the rigging; ropes and blocks flying, orders given and answered amid
the confused noises of men singing out at the ropes. The topsails came to
the mast-heads with ``Cheerly, men!'' and, in a few minutes, every sail was
set, for the wind was light. The head sails were backed, the windlass came
round ``slip—slap'' to the cry of the sailors;—``Hove short, sir,'' said
the mate;—``Up with him!''— ``Aye, aye, sir.'' A few hearty and long
heaves, and the anchor showed its head. ``Hook cat!'' The fall was stretched
along the decks; all hands laid hold;—``Hurrah, for the last time,''
said the mate; and the anchor came to the cat-head to the tune of ``Time
for us to go,'' with a rollicking chorus. Everything was done quick, as
though it was for the last time. The head yards were filled away, and our
ship began to move through the water on her homeward-bound
course.
The California had got under way at the same moment, and we
sailed down the narrow bay abreast, and were just off the mouth,
and, gradually drawing ahead of her, were on the point of giving her three
parting cheers, when suddenly we found ourselves stopped short, and the
California ranging fast ahead of us. A bar stretches across the mouth of the
harbor, with water enough to float common vessels, but, being low in the
water, and having kept well to leeward, as we were bound to the southward, we
had stuck fast, while the California, being light, had floated
over.
We kept all sail on, in the hope of forcing over, but, failing
in this, we hove aback, and lay waiting for the tide, which was on the
flood, to take us back into the channel. This was something of a damper to
us, and the captain looked not a little mortified and vexed. ``This is the
same place where the Rosa got ashore, sir,'' observed our red-headed second
mate, most malàpropos. A malediction on the Rosa, and him too, was all the
answer he got, and he slunk off to leeward. In a few minutes the force of
the wind and the rising of the tide backed us into the stream, and we were
on our way to our old anchoring-place, the tide setting swiftly up, and the
ship barely manageable in the light breeze. We came-to in our old berth
opposite the hide-house, whose inmates were not a little surprised to see us
return. We felt as though we were tied to California; and some of the crew
swore that they never should get clear of the bloody[4] coast.
In about half an hour, which was near high water, the order
was given to man the windlass, and again the anchor was catted; but there
was no song, and not a word was said about the last time. The California had
come back on finding that we had returned, and was hove-to, waiting for us,
off the point. This time we passed the bar safely, and were soon up with the
California, who filled away, and kept us company. She seemed desirous of a
trial of speed, and our captain accepted the challenge, although we
were loaded down to the bolts of our chain-plates, as deep as
a sand-barge, and bound so taut with our cargo that we were no more fit
for a race than a man in fetters; while our antagonist was in her best trim.
Being clear of the point, the breeze became stiff, and the royal-masts bent
under our sails, but we would not take them in until we saw three boys spring
aloft into the rigging of the California; when they were all furled at once,
but with orders to our boys to stay aloft at the top-gallant mast-heads and
loose them again at the word. It was my duty to furl the fore royal; and,
while standing by to loose it again, I had a fine view of the scene. From
where I stood, the two vessels seemed nothing but spars and sails, while
their narrow decks, far below, slanting over by the force of the wind aloft,
appeared hardly capable of supporting the great fabrics raised upon them. The
California was to windward of us, and had every advantage; yet, while the
breeze was stiff, we held our own. As soon as it began to slacken,
she ranged a little ahead, and the order was given to loose the royals. In
an instant the gaskets were off and the bunt dropped. ``Sheet home the fore
royal!—Weather sheet's home!''—``Lee sheet's home!''—``Hoist away,
sir!'' is bawled from aloft. ``Overhaul your clew-lines!'' shouts the mate.
``Aye, aye, sir! all clear!''—``Taut leech! belay! Well the lee brace; haul
taut to windward,''—and the royals are set. These brought us up again;
but, the wind continuing light, the California set hers, and it was soon
evident that she was walking away from us. Our captain then hailed, and said
that he should keep off to his course; adding, ``She isn't the Alert now. If
I had her in your trim she would have been out of sight by this time.'' This
was good-naturedly answered from the California, and she braced sharp up,
and stood close upon the wind up the coast; while we squared away our yards,
and stood before the wind to the south-southwest. The California's crew
manned her weather rigging, waved their hats in the air, and gave us three
hearty cheers, which we answered as heartily, and the customary single cheer
came back to us from over the water. She stood on her way, doomed to eighteen
months' or two years' hard service upon that hated coast, while we were
making our way to our home, to which every hour and every mile
was bringing us nearer.
As soon as we parted company with the California, all hands
were sent aloft to set the studding-sails. Booms were rigged out,
tacks and halyards rove, sail after sail packed upon her, until
every available inch of canvas was spread, that we might not lose a breath
of the fair wind. We could now see how much she was cramped and deadened by
her cargo; for with a good breeze on her quarter, and every stitch of canvas
spread, we could not get more than six knots out of her. She had no more life
in her than if she were water-logged. The log was hove several times; but she
was doing her best. We had hardly patience with her, but the older
sailors said, ``Stand by! you'll see her work herself loose in a week
or two, and then she'll walk up to Cape Horn like a
race-horse.''
When all sail had been set, and the decks cleared up,
the California was a speck in the horizon, and the coast lay like a low
cloud along the northeast. At sunset they were both out of sight, and we were
once more upon the ocean, where sky and water meet.
[1] This word, when used to signify a pulley or purchase
formed by blocks and a rope, is always by seamen pronounced
ta-kl.
[2] When our crew were paid off in Boston, the owners answered
the orders of Stimson and me, but refused to deduct the amount from
the pay-roll, saying that the exchanges were made under
compulsion.
[3] We had also a small quantity of gold dust, which Mexicans
or Indians had brought down to us from the interior. It was not uncommon
for our ships to bring a little, as I have since learned from the owners. I
heard rumors of gold discoveries, but they attracted little or no attention,
and were not followed up.
[4] This is a common expletive among sailors, and suits any
purpose.
CHAPTER XXX
At eight o'clock all hands were called aft, and the watches
set for the voyage. Some changes were made; but I was glad to find myself
still in the larboard watch. Our crew was somewhat diminished; for a man and
a boy had gone in the Pilgrim; another was second mate of the Ayacucho; and a
fourth, Harry Bennett, the oldest man of the crew, had broken down under the
hard work and constant exposure on the coast, and, having had a stroke of
the palsy, was left behind at the hide-house, under the charge of Captain
Arthur. The poor fellow wished very much to come home in the ship; and he
ought to have been brought home in her. But a live dog is better than a dead
lion, and a sick sailor belongs to nobody's mess; so he was sent ashore with
the rest of the lumber, which was only in the way. He had come on board, with
his chest, in the morning, and tried to make himself useful about decks;
but his shuffling feet and weak arms led him into trouble, and some words
were said to him by the mate. He had the spirit of a man, and had become a
little tender, perhaps weakened in mind, and said, ``Mr. Brown, I always did
my duty aboard until I was sick. If you don't want me, say so, and I'll go
ashore.'' ``Bring up his chest,'' said Mr. Brown, and poor Bennett went down
into a boat and was taken ashore, with tears in his eyes. He loved the
ship and the crew, and wished to get home, but could not bear to
be treated as a soger or loafer on board. This was the only hard-hearted
thing I ever knew Mr. Brown to do.
By these diminutions, we were short-handed for a voyage round
Cape Horn in the dead of winter. Beside Stimson and myself, there
were only five in the forecastle; who, together with four boys in
the steerage, the sailmaker, carpenter, cook, and steward, composed the
crew. In addition to this, we were only four days out, when the sailmaker,
who was the oldest and best seaman on board, was taken with the palsy, and
was useless for the rest of the voyage. The constant wading in the water, in
all weathers, to take off hides, together with the other labors, is too much
for men even in middle life, and for any who have not good constitutions.
(Beside these two men of ours, the second officer of the California
and the carpenter of the Pilgrim, as we afterwards learned, broke
down under the work, and the latter died at Santa Barbara. The young man,
too, Henry Mellus, who came out with us from Boston in the Pilgrim, had to be
taken from his berth before the mast and made clerk, on account of a fit of
rheumatism which attacked him soon after he came upon the coast.) By the loss
of the sailmaker, our watch was reduced to five, of whom two were boys, who
never steered but in fine weather, so that the other two and myself had to
stand at the wheel four hours apiece out of every twenty-four; and the other
watch had only four helmsmen. ``Never mind,—we're homeward bound!'' was the
answer to everything; and we should not have minded this, were it not for the
thought that we should be off Cape Horn in the very dead of winter. It was
now the first part of May; and two months would bring us off the Cape in
July, which is the worst month in the year there; when the sun rises
at nine and sets at three, giving eighteen hours night, and there is snow
and rain, gales and high seas, in abundance.
The prospect of meeting this in a ship half manned, and loaded
so deep that every heavy sea must wash her fore and aft, was by no means
pleasant. The Alert, in her passage out, doubled the Cape in the month of
February, which is midsummer; and we came round in the Pilgrim in the latter
part of October, which we thought was bad enough. There was only one of our
crew who had been off there in the winter, and that was in a whale-ship, much
lighter and higher than our ship; yet he said they had man-killing weather
for twenty days without intermission, and their decks were swept twice,
and they were all glad enough to see the last of it. The Brandywine frigate,
also, in her recent passage round, had sixty days off the Cape, and lost
several boats by the heavy seas. All this was for our comfort; yet pass it we
must; and all hands agreed to make the best of it.
During our watches below we overhauled our clothes, and made
and mended everything for bad weather. Each of us had made for himself a
suit of oil-cloth or tarpaulin, and these we got out, and gave thorough
coatings of oil or tar, and hung upon the stays to dry. Our stout boots, too,
we covered over with a thick mixture of melted grease and tar. Thus we took
advantage of the warm sun and fine weather of the Pacific to prepare for its
other face. In the forenoon watches below, our forecastle looked like the
workshop of what a sailor is,—a Jack-at-all-trades. Thick stockings
and drawers were darned and patched; mittens dragged from the bottom of
the chest and mended; comforters made for the neck and ears; old flannel
shirts cut up to line monkey-jackets; southwesters were lined with flannel,
and a pot of paint smuggled forward to give them a coat on the outside; and
everything turned to hand; so that, although two years had left us but a
scanty wardrobe, yet the economy and invention which necessity teaches a
sailor soon put each of us in pretty good trim for bad weather, before we
had seen the last of the fine. Even the cobbler's art was not out
of place. Several old shoes were very decently repaired, and with waxed
ends, an awl, and the top of an old boot, I made me quite a respectable
sheath for my knife.
There was one difficulty, however, which nothing that we could
do would remedy; and that was the leaking of the forecastle, which made it
very uncomfortable in bad weather, and rendered half of the berths
tenantless. The tightest ships, in a long voyage, from the constant strain
which is upon the bowsprit, will leak more or less round the heel of the
bowsprit and the bitts, which come down into the forecastle; but, in addition
to this, we had an unaccountable leak on the starboard bow, near the
cat-head, which drove us from the forward berths on that side, and, indeed,
when she was on the starboard tack, from all the forward berths. One
of the after berths, too, leaked in very bad weather; so that in a ship
which was in other respects unusually tight, and brought her cargo to Boston
perfectly dry, we had, after every effort made to prevent it, in the way of
calking and leading, a forecastle with only three dry berths for seven of us.
However, as there is never but one watch below at a time, by ``turning in and
out,'' we did pretty well. And there being in our watch but three of us
who lived forward, we generally had a dry berth apiece in
bad weather.[1]
All this, however, was but anticipation. We were still in
fine weather in the North Pacific, running down the northeast
trades, which we took on the second day after leaving San Diego.
Sunday, May 15th, one week out, we were in latitude 14° 56'
N., lon. 116° 14' W., having gone, by reckoning, over thirteen
hundred miles in seven days. In fact, ever since leaving San Diego, we
had had a fair wind, and as much as we wanted of it. For seven days
our lower and topmast studding-sails were set all the time, and our royals
and top-gallant studding-sails whenever she could stagger under them. Indeed,
the captain had shown, from the moment we got to sea, that he was to have no
boy's play, but that the ship was to carry all she could, and that he was
going to make up by ``cracking on'' to her what she wanted in lightness. In
this way we frequently made three degrees of latitude, besides something
in longitude, in the course of twenty-four hours. Our days we spent in the
usual ship's work. The rigging which had become slack from being long in port
was to be set up; breast backstays got up; studding-sail booms rigged upon
the main yard; and royal studding-sails got ready for the light trades;
ring-tail set; and new rigging fitted, and sails made ready for Cape Horn.
For, with a ship's gear, as well as a sailor's wardrobe, fine weather
must be improved to get ready for the bad to come. Our forenoon
watch below, as I have said, was given to our own work, and our
night watches were spent in the usual manner,—a trick at the wheel, a
lookout on the forecastle, a nap on a coil of rigging under the lee of the
rail; a yarn round the windlass-end; or, as was generally my way, a solitary
walk fore and aft, in the weather waist, between the windlass-end and the
main tack. Every wave that she threw aside brought us nearer home, and every
day's observation at noon showed a progress which, if it continued, would,
in less than five months, take us into Boston Bay. This is the pleasure of
life at sea,—fine weather, day after day, without interruption,—fair
wind, and a plenty of it,—and homeward bound. Every one was in good humor;
things went right; and all was done with a will. At the dog watch, all hands
came on deck, and stood round the weather side of the forecastle, or
sat upon the windlass, and sung sea-songs and those ballads of pirates and
highwaymen which sailors delight in. Home, too, and what we should do when we
got there, and when and how we should arrive, was no infrequent topic. Every
night, after the kids and pots were put away, and we had lighted our pipes
and cigars at the galley, and gathered about the windlass, the first question
was,--
``Well, Dana, what was the latitude to-day?''
``Why, fourteen, north; and she has been going seven knots
ever since.''
``Well, this will bring us to the line in five
days.''
``Yes, but these trades won't last twenty-four hours
longer,'' says an old salt, pointing with the sharp of his hand to
leeward; ``I know that by the look of the clouds.''
Then came all manner of calculations and conjectures as to
the continuance of the wind, the weather under the line, the
southeast trades, &c., and rough guesses as to the time the ship would be
up with the Horn; and some, more venturous, gave her so many days
to Boston Light, and offered to bet that she would not exceed
it.
``You'd better wait till you get round Cape Horn,'' says an
old croaker.
``Yes,'' says another, ``you may see Boston, but you've got
to `smell hell' before that good day.''
Rumors also of what had been said in the cabin, as usual,
found their way forward. The steward had heard the captain say
something about the Straits of Magellan, and the man at the wheel fancied
he had heard him tell the ``passenger'' that, if he found the wind ahead
and the weather very bad off the Cape, he should stick her off for New
Holland, and come home round the Cape of Good Hope.
This passenger—the first and only one we had had, except to
go from port to port, on the coast—was no one else than a gentleman whom
I had known in my smoother days, and the last person I should have expected
to see on the coast of California,—Professor Nuttall, of Cambridge. I had
left him quietly seated in the chair of Botany and Ornithology in Harvard
University, and the next I saw of him, he was strolling about San Diego
beach, in a sailor's pea-jacket, with a wide straw hat, and barefooted, with
his trousers rolled up to his knees, picking up stones and shells. He had
travelled overland to the Northwest Coast, and come down in a small vessel to
Monterey. There he learned that there was a ship at the leeward about to sail
for Boston, and, taking passage in the Pilgrim, which was then at Monterey,
he came slowly along, visiting the intermediate ports, and examining the
trees, plants, earths, birds, &c., and joined us at San Diego shortly
before we sailed. The second mate of the Pilgrim told me that they had
an old gentleman on board who knew me, and came from the college that I
had been in. He could not recollect his name, but said he was a ``sort of an
oldish man,'' with white hair, and spent all his time in the bush, and along
the beach, picking up flowers and shells and such truck, and had a dozen
boxes and barrels full of them. I thought over everybody who would be likely
to be there, but could fix upon no one; when, the next day, just as we were
about to shove off from the beach, he came down to the boat in the rig
I have described, with his shoes in his hand, and his pockets full of
specimens. I knew him at once, though I should hardly have been more
surprised to have seen the Old South steeple shoot up from the hide-house. He
probably had no more difficulty in recognizing me. As we left home about the
same time, we had nothing to tell each other; and, owing to our different
situations on board, I saw but little of him on the passage home. Sometimes,
when I was at the wheel of a calm night, and the steering required
little attention, and the officer of the watch was forward, he would
come aft and hold a short yarn with me; but this was against the rules of
the ship, as is, in fact, all intercourse between passengers and the crew. I
was often amused to see the sailors puzzled to know what to make of him, and
to hear their conjectures about him and his business. They were as much at a
loss as our old sailmaker was with the captain's instruments in the cabin. He
said there were three,—the chro-nometer, the chre-nometer, and
the the-nometer. The Pilgrim's crew called Mr. Nuttall ``Old Curious,''
from his zeal for curiosities; and some of them said that he was crazy, and
that his friends let him go about and amuse himself in this way. Why else a
rich man (sailors call every man rich who does not work with his hands, and
who wears a long coat and cravat) should leave a Christian country and come
to such a place as California to pick up shells and stones, they could
not understand. One of them, however, who had seen something more of the
world ashore, set all to rights, as he thought; ``O, 'vast there! You don't
know anything about them craft. I've seen them colleges and know the ropes.
They keep all such things for cur'osities, and study 'em, and have men a
purpose to go and get 'em. This old chap knows what he's about. He a'n't the
child you take him for. He'll carry all these things to the college, and
if they are better than any that they have had before, he'll be head of
the college. Then, by and by, somebody else will go after some more, and if
they beat him he'll have to go again, or else give up his berth. That's the
way they do it. This old covey knows the ropes. He has worked a traverse over
'em, and come 'way out here where nobody's ever been afore, and where they'll
never think of coming.'' This explanation satisfied Jack; and as it raised
Mr. Nuttall's credit, and was near enough to the truth for
common purposes, I did not disturb it.
With the exception of Mr. Nuttall, we had no one on board but
the regular ship's company and the live stock. Upon the stock we had made
a considerable inroad. We killed one of the bullocks every four days, so that
they did not last us up to the line. We, or rather the cabin, then began upon
the sheep and the poultry, for these never come into Jack's mess.[2] The pigs
were left for the latter part of the voyage, for they are sailors, and can
stand all weathers. We had an old sow on board, the mother of a
numerous progeny, who had been twice round the Cape of Good Hope and
once round Cape Horn. The last time going round was very nearly her death.
We heard her squealing and moaning one dark night after it had been snowing
and hailing for several hours, and, climbing over into the sty, we found her
nearly frozen to death. We got some straw, an old sail, and other things, and
wrapped her up in a corner of the sty, where she stayed until we came into
fine weather again.
Wednesday, May 18th. Lat. 9° 54' N., lon. 113° 17' W. The
northeast trades had now left us, and we had the usual variable winds,
the ``doldrums,'' which prevail near the line, together with some rain. So
long as we were in these latitudes, we had but little rest in our watch on
deck at night; for, as the winds were light and variable, and we could not
lose a breath, we were all the watch bracing the yards, and taking in and
making sail, and ``humbugging'' with our flying kites. A little puff of wind
on the larboard quarter, and then—``larboard fore braces!''—and
studding-sail booms were rigged out, studding-sails set alow and aloft, the
yards trimmed, and jibs and spanker in; when it would come as calm as
a duck-pond, the man at the wheel standing with the palm of his hand up,
feeling for the wind. ``Keep her off a little!'' ``All aback forward, sir!''
cries a man from the forecastle. Down go the braces again; in come the
studding-sails, all in a mess, which half an hour won't set right; yards
braced sharp up, and she's on the starboard tack, close-hauled. The
studding-sails must now be cleared away, and set up in the tops and on the
booms, and the gear cut off and made fast. By the time this is done, and you
are looking out for a soft plank for a nap,—``Lay aft here, and
square in the head yards!'' and the studding-sails are all set again on
the starboard side. So it goes until it is eight bells,—call
the watch,—heave the log,—relieve the wheel, and go below the larboard
watch.
Sunday, May 22d. Lat. 5° 14' N., lon. 166° 45' W. We were now
a fortnight out, and within five degrees of the line, to which two days of
good breeze would take us; but we had, for the most part, what the sailors
call ``an Irishman's hurricane,—right up and down.'' This day it rained
nearly all day, and, being Sunday and nothing to do, we stopped up the
scuppers and filled the decks with rain water, and, bringing all our clothes
on deck, had a grand wash, fore and aft. When this was through, we stripped
to our drawers, and taking pieces of soap, with strips of canvas for towels,
we turned-to and soaped, washed, and scrubbed one another down, to get
off, as we said, the California grime; for the common wash in salt water,
which is all that Jack can get, being on an allowance of fresh, had little
efficacy, and was more for taste than utility. The captain was below all the
afternoon, and we had something nearer to Saturnalia than anything we had yet
seen; for the mate came into the scuppers, with a couple of boys to
scrub him, and got into a contest with them in heaving water.
By unplugging the holes, we let the soapsuds off the decks, and in a short
time had a new supply of clear rain water, in which we had a grand rinsing.
It was surprising to see how much soap and fresh water did for the
complexions of many of us; how much of what we supposed to be tan and
sea-blacking we got rid of. The next day, the sun rising clear, the ship was
covered, fore and aft, with clothes of all sorts, hanging out to
dry.
As we approached the line, the wind became more easterly, and
the weather clearer, and in twenty days from San Diego,--
Saturday, May 28th, at about three P.M., with a fine breeze
from the east-southeast, we crossed the equator. In twenty-four
hours after crossing the line, we took, which was very unusual,
the regular southeast trades. These winds come a little from the eastward
of southeast, and with us they blew directly from the east-southeast, which
was fortunate for us, as our course was south-by-west, and we could thus go
one point free. The yards were braced so that every sail drew, from the
spanker to the flying-jib; and, the upper yards being squared in a little,
the fore and main top-gallant studding-sails were set, and
drew handsomely. For twelve days this breeze blew steadily, not varying a
point, and just so fresh that we could carry our royals; and during the whole
time we hardly started a brace. Such progress did we make that at the end of
seven days from the time we took the breeze, on--
Sunday, June 5th, we were in lat. 19° 29' S., and lon. 118°
01' W., having made twelve hundred miles in seven days, very nearly upon
a taut bowline. Our good ship was getting to be herself again, and
had increased her rate of sailing more than one third since leaving
San Diego. The crew ceased complaining of her, and the officers hove
the log every two hours with evident satisfaction. This was
glorious sailing. A steady breeze; the light tradewind clouds over our
heads; the incomparable temperature of the Pacific,—neither hot nor
cold; a clear sun every day, and clear moon and stars every night, and
new constellations rising in the south, and the familiar ones sinking in
the north, as we went on our course,—``stemming nightly toward the pole.''
Already we had sunk the North Star and the Great Bear, while the Southern
Cross appeared well above the southern horizon, and all hands looked out
sharp to the southward for the Magellan Clouds, which, each succeeding night,
we expected to make. ``The next time we see the North Star,'' said one,
``we shall be standing to the northward, the other side of the
Horn.'' This was true enough, and no doubt it would be a welcome
sight, for sailors say that in coming home from round Cape Horn, or
the Cape of Good Hope, the North Star is the first land you
make.
These trades were the same that in the passage out in the
Pilgrim lasted nearly all the way from Juan Fernandez to the line;
blowing steadily on our starboard quarter for three weeks, without
our starting a brace, or even brailing down the skysails. Though we had
now the same wind, and were in the same latitude with the Pilgrim on her
passage out, yet we were nearly twelve hundred miles to the westward of her
course; for the captain, depending upon the strong southwest winds which
prevail in high southern latitudes during the winter months, took the full
advantage of the trades, and stood well to the westward, so far that we
passed within about two hundred miles of Ducie's Island.
It was this weather and sailing that brought to my mind a
little incident that occurred on board the Pilgrim, while we were in
the same latitude. We were going along at a great rate, dead before the
wind, with studding-sails out on both sides, alow and aloft, on a dark night,
just after midnight, and everything as still as the grave, except the washing
of the water by the vessel's side; for, being before the wind, with a smooth
sea, the little brig, covered with canvas, was doing great business with very
little noise. The other watch was below, and all our watch, except
myself and the man at the wheel, were asleep under the lee of the
boat. The second mate, who came out before the mast, and was always
very thick with me, had been holding a yarn with me, and just gone aft to
his place on the quarter-deck, and I had resumed my usual walk to and from
the windlass-end, when, suddenly, we heard a loud scream coming from ahead,
apparently directly from under the bows. The darkness, and complete stillness
of the night, and the solitude of the ocean, gave to the sound a dreadful and
almost supernatural effect. I stood perfectly still, and my heart
beat quick. The sound woke up the rest of the watch, who stood looking at
one another. ``What, in the name of God, is that?'' said the second mate,
coming slowly forward. The first thought I had was, that it might be a boat,
with the crew of some wrecked vessel, or perhaps the boat of some whale-ship,
out over night, and we had run it down in the darkness. Another scream! but
less loud than the first. This started us, and we ran forward, and looked
over the bows, and over the sides, to leeward, but nothing was to be seen
or heard. What was to be done? Heave the ship aback, and call the captain?
Just at this moment, in crossing the forecastle, one of the men saw a light
below, and, looking down the scuttle, saw the watch all out of their berths,
and afoul of one poor fellow, dragging him out of his berth, and shaking him,
to wake him out of a nightmare. They had been waked out of their sleep, and
as much alarmed at the scream as we were, and were hesitating whether
to come on deck, when the second sound, proceeding directly from one of
the berths, revealed the cause of the alarm. The fellow got a good shaking
for the trouble he had given. We made a joke of the matter; and we could well
laugh, for our minds were not a little relieved by its ridiculous
termination.
We were now close upon the southern tropical line, and, with
so fine a breeze, were daily leaving the sun behind us, and drawing nearer
to Cape Horn, for which it behooved us to make every preparation. Our rigging
was all overhauled and mended, or changed for new, where it was necessary;
new and strong bobstays fitted in the place of the chain ones, which were
worn out; the spritsail yard and martingale guys and back-ropes set well
taut; bran-new fore and main braces rove; top-gallant sheets, and
wheelropes, made of green hide, laid up in the form of rope, were
stretched and fitted; and new topsail clew-lines, &c. rove; new
fore-topmast backstays fitted; and other preparations made in good season,
that the ropes might have time to stretch and become limber before we got
into cold weather.
Sunday, June 12th. Lat. 26° 04' S., lon. 116° 31' W. We had
now lost the regular trades, and had the winds variable, principally from
the westward, and kept on in a southerly course, sailing very nearly upon
a meridian, and at the end of the week,--
Sunday, June 19th, were in lat. 34° 15' S., and lon. 116° 38'
W.
[1] On removing the cat-head, after the ship arrived at
Boston, it was found that there were two holes under it which had been
bored for the purpose of driving treenails, and which, accidentally,
had not been plugged up when the cat-head was placed over them.
This provoking little piece of negligence caused us great
discomfort.
[2] The customs as to the allowance of ``grub'' are very
nearly the same in all American merchantmen. Whenever a pig is killed,
the sailors have one mess from it. The rest goes to the cabin. The smaller
live stock, poultry, &c. the sailors never taste. And indeed they do not
complain of this, for it would take a great deal to supply them with a good
meal; and without the accompaniments (which could hardly be furnished to
them), it would not be much better than salt beef. But even as to the salt
beef they are scarcely dealt fairly with; for whenever a barrel is opened,
before any of the beef is put into the harness-cask, the steward comes up and
picks it all over, and takes out the best pieces (those that have any fat in
them) for the cabin. This was done in both the vessels I was in, and the men
said that it was usual in other vessels. Indeed, it is made no secret, and
some of the crew are usually called to help in assorting and putting
away the pieces. By this arrangement the hard, dry pieces, which
the sailors call ``old horse,'' come to their share.
There is a singular piece of rhyme, traditional among
sailors, which they say over such pieces of beef. I do not know that
it ever appeared in print before. When seated round the kid, if
a particularly bad piece is found, one of them takes it up, and addresses
it thus:--
```Old horse! old horse! what brought you
here?' `From Sacarap to Portland
Pier I've carted stone this many a
year; Till, killed by blows and sore
abuse, They salted me down for sailors'
use. The sailors they do me
despise; They turn me over and damn my
eyes; Cut off my meat, and scrape my
bones, And pitch me over to Davy
Jones.'''
There is a story current among seamen, that a beef-dealer
was convicted, at Boston, of having sold old horse for ship's
stores, instead of beef, and had been sentenced to be confined in
jail until he should eat the whole of it; and that he is now lying
in Boston jail. I have heard this story often, on board other
vessels besides those of our own nation. It is very generally
believed, and is always highly commended, as a fair instance of
retaliatory justice.
CHAPTER XXXI
There began now to be a decided change in the appearance of
things. The days became shorter and shorter; the sun running lower in
its course each day, and giving less and less heat, and the nights so cold
as to prevent our sleeping on deck; the Magellan Clouds in sight, of a clear,
moonless night; the skies looking cold and angry; and, at times, a long,
heavy, ugly sea, setting in from the southward, told us what we were coming
to. Still, however, we had a fine, strong breeze, and kept on our way under
as much sail as our ship would bear. Toward the middle of the week, the wind
hauled to the southward, which brought us upon a taut bowline, made the
ship meet, nearly head-on, the heavy swell which rolled from that quarter;
and there was something not at all encouraging in the manner in which she met
it. Being still so deep and heavy, she wanted the buoyancy which should have
carried her over the seas, and she dropped heavily into them, the water
washing over the decks; and every now and then, when an unusually large sea
met her fairly upon the bows, she struck it with a sound as dead and
heavy as that with which a sledge-hammer falls upon the pile, and took the
whole of it in upon the forecastle, and, rising, carried it aft in the
scuppers, washing the rigging off the pins, and carrying along with it
everything which was loose on deck. She had been acting in this way all of
our forenoon watch below; as we could tell by the washing of the water over
our heads, and the heavy breaking of the seas against her bows, only the
thickness of a plank from our heads, as we lay in our berths, which
are directly against the bows. At eight bells, the watch was called, and
we came on deck, one hand going aft to take the wheel, and another going to
the galley to get the grub for dinner. I stood on the forecastle, looking at
the seas, which were rolling high, as far as the eye could reach, their tops
white with foam, and the body of them of a deep indigo blue, reflecting the
bright rays of the sun. Our ship rose slowly over a few of the largest of
them, until one immense fellow came rolling on, threatening to cover her,
and which I was sailor enough to know, by the ``feeling of her'' under my
feet, she would not rise over. I sprang upon the knight-heads, and, seizing
hold of the fore-stay, drew myself up upon it. My feet were just off the
stanchion when the bow struck fairly into the middle of the sea, and it
washed the ship fore and aft, burying her in the water. As soon as she rose
out of it, I looked aft, and everything forward of the mainmast, except
the long-boat, which was griped and double-lashed down to the ring-bolts,
was swept off clear. The galley, the pigsty, the hen-coop, and a large
sheep-pen which had been built upon the fore-hatch, were all gone in the
twinkling of an eye,—leaving the deck as clean as a chin new reaped,—and
not a stick left to show where anything had stood. In the scuppers lay the
galley, bottom up, and a few boards floating about,—the wreck of
the sheep-pen,—and half a dozen miserable sheep floating among them, wet
through, and not a little frightened at the sudden change that had come upon
them. As soon as the sea had washed by, all hands sprang up out of the
forecastle to see what had become of the ship; and in a few moments the cook
and Old Bill crawled out from under the galley, where they had been lying in
the water, nearly smothered, with the galley over them. Fortunately, it
rested against the bulwarks, or it would have broken some of their
bones. When the water ran off, we picked the sheep up, and put them in the
long-boat, got the galley back in its place, and set things a little to
rights; but, had not our ship had uncommonly high bulwarks and rail,
everything must have been washed overboard, not excepting Old Bill and the
cook. Bill had been standing at the galley-door, with the kid of beef in his
hand for the forecastle mess, when away he went, kid, beef, and all. He held
on to the kid to the last, like a good fellow, but the beef was gone, and
when the water had run off we saw it lying high and dry, like a rock
at low tide,—nothing could hurt that. We took the loss of our beef very
easily, consoling ourselves with the recollection that the cabin had more to
lose than we; and chuckled not a little at seeing the remains of the
chicken-pie and pancakes floating in the scuppers. ``This will never do!''
was what some said, and every one felt. Here we were, not yet within a
thousand miles of the latitude of Cape Horn, and our decks swept by a sea not
one half so high as we must expect to find there. Some blamed the
captain for loading his ship so deep when he knew what he must
expect; while others said that the wind was always southwest, off
the Cape, in the winter, and that, running before it, we should not mind
the seas so much. When we got down into the forecastle, Old Bill, who was
somewhat of a croaker,—having met with a great many accidents at sea,—
said that, if that was the way she was going to act, we might as well make
our wills, and balance the books at once, and put on a clean shirt. ``'Vast
there, you bloody old owl! you're always hanging out blue lights! You're
frightened by the ducking you got in the scuppers, and can't take a
joke! What's the use in being always on the lookout for Davy
Jones?'' ``Stand by!'' says another, ``and we'll get an afternoon
watch below, by this scrape''; but in this they were disappointed, for at
two bells all hands were called and set to work, getting lashings upon
everything on deck; and the captain talked of sending down the long
top-gallant-masts; but as the sea went down toward night, and the wind hauled
abeam, we left them standing, and set the studding-sails.
The next day all hands were turned-to upon unbending the
old sails, and getting up the new ones; for a ship, unlike people
on shore, puts on her best suit in bad weather. The old sails were sent
down, and three new topsails, and new fore and main courses, jib, and
fore-topmast staysail, which were made on the coast and never had been used,
were bent, with a complete set of new earings, robands, and reef-points; and
reef-tackles were rove to the courses, and spilling-lines to the topsails.
These, with new braces and clew-lines fore and aft, gave us a good suit of
running rigging.
The wind continued westerly, and the weather and sea less
rough since the day on which we shipped the heavy sea, and we were making
great progress under studding-sails, with our light sails all set, keeping a
little to the eastward of south; for the captain, depending upon westerly
winds off the Cape, had kept so far to the westward that, though we were
within about five hundred miles of the latitude of Cape Horn, we were nearly
seventeen hundred miles to the westward of it. Through the rest of the
week we continued on with a fair wind, gradually, as we got more to
the southward, keeping a more easterly course, and bringing the wind on
our larboard quarter, until--
Sunday, June 26th, when, having a fine, clear day, the captain
got a lunar observation, as well as his meridian altitude, which made us
in lat. 47° 50' S., lon. 113° 49' W.; Cape Horn bearing, according to my
calculations, E. S. E. 1/2 E., and distant eighteen hundred
miles.
Monday, June 27th. During the first part of this day the
wind continued fair, and, as we were going before it, it did not feel very
cold, so that we kept at work on deck in our common clothes and round
jackets. Our watch had an afternoon watch below for the first time since
leaving San Diego; and, having inquired of the third mate what the latitude
was at noon, and made our usual guesses as to the time she would need to be
up with the Horn, we turned-in for a nap. We were sleeping away ``at the rate
of knots,'' when three knocks on the scuttle and ``All hands,
ahoy!'' started us from our berths. What could be the matter? It did
not appear to be blowing hard, and, looking up through the scuttle,
we could see that it was a clear day overhead; yet the watch were taking
in sail. We thought there must be a sail in sight, and that we were about to
heave-to and speak her; and were just congratulating ourselves upon it,—for
we had seen neither sail nor land since we left port,—when we heard the
mate's voice on deck (he turned-in ``all-standing,'' and was always on deck
the moment he was called) singing out to the men who were taking in the
studding-sails, and asking where his watch were. We did not wait for a second
call, but tumbled up the ladder; and there, on the starboard bow, was a bank
of mist, covering sea and sky, and driving directly for us. I had seen the
same before in my passage round in the Pilgrim, and knew what it meant, and
that there was no time to be lost. We had nothing on but thin clothes, yet
there was not a moment to spare, and at it we went.
The boys of the other watch were in the tops, taking in
the top-gallant studding-sails and the lower and topmast studding-sails
were coming down by the run. It was nothing but ``haul down and clew up,''
until we got all the studding-sails in, and the royals, flying jib, and
mizzen top-gallant-sail furled, and the ship kept off a little, to take the
squall. The fore and main top-gallant sails were still on her, for the ``old
man'' did not mean to be frightened in broad daylight, and was determined
to carry sail till the last minute. We all stood waiting for its coming,
when the first blast showed us that it was not to be trifled with. Rain,
sleet, snow, and wind enough to take our breath from us, and make the
toughest turn his back to windward! The ship lay nearly over upon her
beam-ends; the spars and rigging snapped and cracked; and her
top-gallant-masts bent like whip-sticks. ``Clew up the fore and main
top-gallant-sails!'' shouted the captain, and all hands sprang to the
clew-lines. The decks were standing nearly at an angle of forty-five degrees,
and the ship going like a mad steed through the water, the whole forward
part of her in a smother of foam. The halyards were let go, and the yard
clewed down, and the sheets started, and in a few minutes the sails smothered
and kept in by clewlines and buntlines. ``Furl 'em, sir?'' asked the mate.
``Let go the topsail halyards, fore and aft!'' shouted the captain in answer,
at the top of his voice. Down came the topsail yards, the
reef-tackles were manned and hauled out, and we climbed up to windward,
and sprang into the weather rigging. The violence of the wind, and
the hail and sleet, driving nearly horizontally across the ocean, seemed
actually to pin us down to the rigging. It was hard work making head against
them. One after another we got out upon the yards. And here we had work to
do; for our new sails had hardly been bent long enough to get the stiffness
out of them, and the new earings and reef-points, stiffened with the sleet,
knotted like pieces of iron wire. Having only our round jackets and
straw hats on, we were soon wet through, and it was every moment
growing colder. Our hands were soon numbed, which, added to the
stiffness of everything else, kept us a good while on the yard. After we
had got the sail hauled upon the yard, we had to wait a long time for the
weather earing to be passed; but there was no fault to be found, for French
John was at the earing, and a better sailor never laid out on a yard; so we
leaned over the yard and beat our hands upon the sail to keep them from
freezing. At length the word came, ``Haul out to leeward,'' and we seized the
reef-points and hauled the band taut for the lee earing. ``Taut band—
knot away,'' and we got the first reef fast, and were just going to
lay down, when—``Two reefs—two reefs!'' shouted the mate, and we had a
second reef to take, in the same way. When this was fast we went down on
deck, manned the halyards to leeward, nearly up to our knees in water, set
the topsail, and then laid aloft on the main topsail yard, and reefed that
sail in the same manner; for, as I have before stated, we were a good deal
reduced in numbers, and, to make it worse, the carpenter, only two days
before, had cut his leg with an axe, so that he could not go aloft.
This weakened us so that we could not well manage more than one topsail at
a time, in such weather as this, and, of course, each man's labor was
doubled. From the main topsail yard, we went upon the main yard, and took a
reef in the mainsail. No sooner had we got on deck than—``Lay aloft there,
and close-reef mizzen topsail!'' This called me; and, being nearest to the
rigging, I got first aloft, and out to the weather earing. English Ben was up
just after me, and took the lee earing, and the rest of our gang were soon
on the yard, and began to fist the sail, when the mate considerately sent up
the cook and steward to help us. I could now account for the long time it
took to pass the other earings, for, to do my best, with a strong hand to
help me at the dog's ear, I could not get it passed until I heard them
beginning to complain in the bunt. One reef after another we took in, until
the sail was close-reefed, when we went down and hoisted away at the
halyards. In the mean time, the jib had been furled and the staysail
set, and the ship under her reduced sail had got more upright, and
was under management; but the two top-gallant-sails were still hanging in
the buntlines, and slatting and jerking as though they would take the masts
out of her. We gave a look aloft, and knew that our work was not done yet;
and, sure enough, no sooner did the mate see that we were on deck than—
``Lay aloft there, four of you, and furl the top-gallant-sails!'' This called
me again, and two of us went aloft up the fore rigging, and two more up the
main, upon the top-gallant yards. The shrouds were now iced over, the
sleet having formed a crust round all the standing rigging, and on
the weather side of the masts and yards. When we got upon the yard,
my hands were so numb that I could not have cast off the knot of
the gasket if it were to save my life. We both lay over the yard for a few
seconds, beating our hands upon the sail, until we started the blood into our
fingers' ends, and at the next moment our hands were in a burning heat. My
companion on the yard was a lad (the boy, George Somerby), who came out in
the ship a weak, puny boy, from one of the Boston schools,—``no larger than
a spritsail-sheet knot,'' nor ``heavier than a paper of lamp-black,'' and
``not strong enough to haul a shad off a gridiron,'' but who was now ``as
long as a spare topmast, strong enough to knock down an ox, and hearty enough
to eat him.'' We fisted the sail together, and, after six or eight minutes of
hard hauling and pulling and beating down the sail, which was about
as stiff as sheet-iron, we managed to get it furled; and snugly furled it
must be, for we knew the mate well enough to be certain that if it got adrift
again we should be called up from our watch below, at any hour of the night,
to furl it.
I had been on the lookout for a chance to jump below and clap
on a thick jacket and southwester; but when we got on deck we found that
eight bells had been struck, and the other watch gone below, so that there
were two hours of dog watch for us, and a plenty of work to do. It had now
set in for a steady gale from the southwest; but we were not yet far enough
to the southward to make a fair wind of it, for we must give Terra del Fuego
a wide berth. The decks were covered with snow, and there was a constant
driving of sleet. In fact, Cape Horn had set in with good earnest. In
the midst of all this, and before it became dark, we had all
the studding-sails to make up and stow away, and then to lay aloft and rig
in all the booms, fore and aft, and coil away the tacks, sheets, and
halyards. This was pretty tough work for four or five hands, in the face of a
gale which almost took us off the yards, and with ropes so stiff with ice
that it was almost impossible to bend them. I was nearly half an hour out on
the end of the fore yard, trying to coil away and stop down the topmast
studding-sail tack and lower halyards. It was after dark when we got
through, and we were not a little pleased to hear four bells struck,
which sent us below for two hours, and gave us each a pot of hot tea with
our cold beef and bread, and, what was better yet, a suit of thick, dry
clothing, fitted for the weather, in place of our thin clothes, which were
wet through and now frozen stiff.
This sudden turn, for which we were so little prepared, was
as unacceptable to me as to any of the rest; for I had been troubled for
several days with a slight toothache, and this cold weather and wetting and
freezing were not the best things in the world for it. I soon found that it
was getting strong hold, and running over all parts of my face; and before
the watch was out I went aft to the mate, who had charge of the
medicine-chest, to get something for it. But the chest showed like the end of
a long voyage, for there was nothing that would answer but a few drops of
laudanum, which must be saved for an emergency; so I had only to bear
the pain as well as I could.
When we went on deck at eight bells, it had stopped snowing,
and there were a few stars out, but the clouds were still black, and it
was blowing a steady gale. Just before midnight, I went aloft and sent down
the mizzen royal yard, and had the good luck to do it to the satisfaction of
the mate, who said it was done ``out of hand and ship-shape.'' The next four
hours below were but little relief to me, for I lay awake in my berth the
whole time, from the pain in my face, and heard every bell strike, and, at
four o'clock, turned out with the watch, feeling little spirit for
the hard duties of the day. Bad weather and hard work at sea can be borne
up against very well if one only has spirit and health; but there is nothing
brings a man down, at such a time, like bodily pain and want of sleep. There
was, however, too much to do to allow time to think; for the gale of
yesterday, and the heavy seas we met with a few days before, while we had yet
ten degrees more southing to make, had convinced the captain that we had
something before us which was not to be trifled with, and orders were
given to send down the long top-gallant-masts. The top-gallant and
royal yards were accordingly struck, the flying jib-boom rigged in,
and the top-gallant-masts sent down on deck, and all lashed together by
the side of the long-boat. The rigging was then sent down and coiled away
below, and everything made snug aloft. There was not a sailor in the ship who
was not rejoiced to see these sticks come down; for, so long as the yards
were aloft, on the least sign of a lull, the top-gallant-sails were loosed,
and then we had to furl them again in a snow-squall, and shin up and down
single ropes caked with ice, and send royal yards down in the teeth of a
gale coming right from the south pole. It was an interesting sight, too,
to see our noble ship, dismantled of all her top-hamper of long tapering
masts and yards, and boom pointed with spear-head, which ornamented her in
port; and all that canvas, which a few days before had covered her like a
cloud, from the truck to the water's edge, spreading far out beyond her hull
on either side, now gone; and she stripped, like a wrestler for the fight.
It corresponded, too, with the desolate character of her
situation,— alone, as she was, battling with storms, wind, and ice, at
this extremity of the globe, and in almost constant night.
Friday, July 1st. We were now nearly up to the latitude of
Cape Horn, and having over forty degrees of easting to make, we
squared away the yards before a strong westerly gale, shook a reef out
of the fore topsail, and stood on our way, east-by-south, with
the prospect of being up with the Cape in a week or ten days. As
for myself, I had had no sleep for forty-eight hours; and the want
of rest, together with constant wet and cold, had increased the swelling,
so that my face was nearly as large as two, and I found it impossible to get
my mouth open wide enough to eat. In this state, the steward applied to the
captain for some rice to boil for me, but he only got a—``No! d---
you! Tell him to eat salt junk and hard bread, like the rest of them.'' This
was, in truth, what I expected. However, I did not starve, for Mr. Brown, who
was a man as well as a sailor, and had always been a good friend to me,
smuggled a pan of rice into the galley, and told the cook to boil it for me,
and not let the ``old man'' see it. Had it been fine weather, or in port, I
should have gone below and lain by until my face got well; but in such
weather as this, and short-handed as we were, it was not for me to desert my
post; so I kept on deck, and stood my watch and did my duty as well as
I could.
Saturday, July 2d. This day the sun rose fair, but it ran too
low in the heavens to give any heat, or thaw out our sails and rigging;
yet the sight of it was pleasant; and we had a steady ``reef-topsail breeze''
from the westward. The atmosphere, which had previously been clear and cold,
for the last few hours grew damp, and had a disagreeable, wet chilliness in
it; and the man who came from the wheel said he heard the captain tell
``the passenger'' that the thermometer had fallen several degrees
since morning, which he could not account for in any other way than
by supposing that there must be ice near us; though such a thing
was rarely heard of in this latitude at this season of the year. At twelve
o'clock we went below, and had just got through dinner, when the cook put his
head down the scuttle and told us to come on deck and see the finest sight
that we had ever seen. ``Where away, Doctor?''[1] asked the first man who was
up. ``On the larboard bow.'' And there lay, floating in the ocean, several
miles off, an immense, irregular mass, its top and points covered with snow,
and its centre of a deep indigo color. This was an iceberg, and of
the largest size, as one of our men said who had been in the
Northern Ocean. As far as the eye could reach, the sea in every
direction was of a deep blue color, the waves running high and fresh,
and sparkling in the light, and in the midst lay this
immense mountain-island, its cavities and valleys thrown into deep
shade, and its points and pinnacles glittering in the sun. All hands
were soon on deck, looking at it, and admiring in various ways its beauty
and grandeur. But no description can give any idea of the strangeness,
splendor, and, really, the sublimity, of the sight. Its great size,—for it
must have been from two to three miles in circumference, and several hundred
feet in height,—its slow motion, as its base rose and sank in the water,
and its high points nodded against the clouds; the dashing of the waves
upon it, which, breaking high with foam, lined its base with a
white crust; and the thundering sound of the cracking of the mass, and the
breaking and tumbling down of huge pieces; together with its nearness and
approach, which added a slight element of fear,—all combined to give to it
the character of true sublimity. The main body of the mass was, as I have
said, of an indigo color, its base crusted with frozen foam; and as it grew
thin and transparent toward the edges and top, its color shaded off from a
deep blue to the whiteness of snow. It seemed to be drifting slowly toward
the north, so that we kept away and avoided it. It was in sight all the
afternoon; and when we got to leeward of it the wind died away, so that we
lay-to quite near it for a greater part of the night. Unfortunately, there
was no moon, but it was a clear night, and we could plainly mark the long,
regular heaving of the stupendous mass, as its edges moved slowly against the
stars, now revealing them, and now shutting them in. Several times in
our watch loud cracks were heard, which sounded as though they must have
run through the whole length of the iceberg, and several pieces fell down
with a thundering crash, plunging heavily into the sea. Toward morning a
strong breeze sprang up, and we filled away, and left it astern, and at
daylight it was out of sight. The next day, which was--
Sunday, July 3d, the breeze continued strong, the air
exceedingly chilly, and the thermometer low. In the course of the day we
saw several icebergs of different sizes, but none so near as the one which
we saw the day before. Some of them, as well as we could judge, at the
distance at which we were, must have been as large as that, if not larger. At
noon we were in latitude 55° 12' south, and supposed longitude 89° 5' west.
Toward night the wind hauled to the southward, and headed us off our course a
little, and blew a tremendous gale; but this we did not mind, as there was no
rain nor snow, and we were already under close sail.
Monday, July 4th. This was ``Independence Day'' in Boston.
What firing of guns, and ringing of bells, and rejoicings of all sorts, in
every part of our country! The ladies (who have not gone down to Nahant, for
a breath of cool air and sight of the ocean) walking the streets with
parasols over their heads, and the dandies in their white pantaloons and silk
stockings! What quantities of ice-cream have been eaten, and how many loads
of ice brought into the city from a distance, and sold out by the lump and
the pound! The smallest of the islands which we saw to-day would have made
the fortune of poor Jack, if he had had it in Boston; and I dare say he would
have had no objection to being there with it. This, to be sure, was
no place to keep the Fourth of July. To keep ourselves warm, and the ship
out of the ice, was as much as we could do. Yet no one forgot the day; and
many were the wishes and conjectures and comparisons, both serious and
ludicrous, which were made among all hands. The sun shone bright as long as
it was up, only that a scud of black clouds was ever and anon driving across
it. At noon we were in lat. 54° 27' S., and lon. 85° 5' W., having made a
good deal of easting, but having lost in our latitude by the heading off of
the wind. Between daylight and dark—that is, between nine o'clock
and three—we saw thirty-four ice islands of various sizes; some
no bigger than the hull of our vessel, and others apparently nearly
as large as the one that we first saw; though, as we went on, the islands
became smaller and more numerous; and, at sundown of this day, a man at the
mast-head saw large tracts of floating ice, called ``field-ice,'' at the
southeast. This kind of ice is much more dangerous than the large islands,
for those can be seen at a distance, and kept away from; but the field-ice,
floating in great quantities, and covering the ocean for miles and miles, in
pieces of every size,-- large, flat, and broken cakes, with here and
there an island rising twenty and thirty feet, and as large as the
ship's hull,—this it is very difficult to sheer clear of. A
constant lookout was necessary; for many of these pieces, coming with
the heave of the sea, were large enough to have knocked a hole in
the ship, and that would have been the end of us; for no boat (even if we
could have got one out) could have lived in such a sea; and no man could have
lived in a boat in such weather. To make our condition still worse, the wind
came out due east, just after sundown, and it blew a gale dead ahead, with
hail and sleet and a thick fog, so that we could not see half the length of
the ship. Our chief reliance, the prevailing westerly gales, was thus cut
off; and here we were, nearly seven hundred miles to the westward of
the Cape, with a gale dead from the eastward, and the weather so
thick that we could not see the ice, with which we were surrounded,
until it was directly under our bows. At four P.M. (it was then
quite dark) all hands were called, and sent aloft, in a violent squall of
hail and rain, to take in sail. We had now all got on our ``Cape Horn
rig,''—thick boots, southwesters coming down over our neck and ears, thick
trousers and jackets, and some with oil-cloth suits over all. Mittens, too,
we wore on deck, but it would not do to go aloft with them, as, being wet and
stiff, they might let a man slip overboard, for all the hold he could get
upon a rope: so we were obliged to work with bare hands, which, as well as
our faces, were often cut with the hailstones, which fell thick and
large. Our ship was now all cased with ice,—hull, spars, and
standing rigging; and the running rigging so stiff that we could
hardly bend it so as to belay it, or, still less, take a knot with it; and
the sails frozen. One at a time (for it was a long piece of work and required
many hands) we furled the courses, mizzen topsail, and fore-topmast staysail,
and close-reefed the fore and main topsails, and hove the ship to under the
fore, with the main hauled up by the clew-lines and buntlines, and ready to
be sheeted home, if we found it necessary to make sail to get to windward
of an ice island. A regular lookout was then set, and kept by each watch
in turn, until the morning. It was a tedious and anxious night. It blew hard
the whole time, and there was an almost constant driving of either rain,
hail, or snow. In addition to this, it was ``as thick as muck,'' and the ice
was all about us. The captain was on deck nearly the whole night, and kept
the cook in the galley, with a roaring fire, to make coffee for him,
which he took every few hours, and once or twice gave a little to
his officers; but not a drop of anything was there for the crew.
The captain, who sleeps all the daytime, and comes and goes at night as he
chooses, can have his brandy-and-water in the cabin, and his hot coffee at
the galley; while Jack, who has to stand through everything, and work in wet
and cold, can have nothing to wet his lips or warm his stomach. This was a
``temperance ship'' by her articles, and, like too many such ships, the
temperance was all in the forecastle. The sailor, who only takes his one
glass as it is dealt out to him, is in danger of being drunk; while the
captain, upon whose self-possession and cool judgment the lives of
all depend, may be trusted with any amount, to drink at his will. Sailors
will never be convinced that rum is a dangerous thing by taking it away from
them and giving it to the officers; nor can they see a friend in that
temperance which takes from them what they have always had, and gives them
nothing in the place of it. By seeing it allowed to their officers, they will
not be convinced that it is taken from them for their good; and by
receiving nothing in its place they will not believe that it is done
in kindness. On the contrary, many of them look upon the change as a new
instrument of tyranny. Not that they prefer rum. I never knew a sailor, who
had been a month away from the grog shops, who would not prefer a pot of hot
coffee or chocolate, in a cold night, to all the rum afloat. They all say
that rum only warms them for a time; yet, if they can get nothing better,
they will miss what they have lost. The momentary warmth and glow from
drinking it; the break and change which it makes in a long, dreary watch by
the mere calling all hands aft and serving of it out; and the
simply having some event to look forward to and to talk about,—all
give it an importance and a use which no one can appreciate who has
not stood his watch before the mast. On my passage out, the Pilgrim was
not under temperance articles, and grog was served out every middle and
morning watch, and after every reefing of topsails; and, though I had never
drunk rum before, nor desire to again, I took my allowance then at the
capstan, as the rest did, merely for the momentary warmth it gave the system,
and the change in our feelings and aspect of our duties on the watch. At the
same time, as I have said, there was not a man on board who would not
have pitched the rum to the dogs (I have heard them say so a dozen times)
for a pot of coffee or chocolate; or even for our common beverage,—``water
bewitched and tea begrudged,'' as it was.[2] The temperance reform is the
best thing that ever was undertaken for the sailor; but when the grog is
taken from him, he ought to have something in its place. As it is now, in
most vessels, it is a mere saving to the owners; and this accounts for the
sudden increase of temperance ships, which surprised even the best friends
of the cause. If every merchant, when he struck grog from the list of the
expenses of his ship, had been obliged to substitute as much coffee, or
chocolate, as would give each man a pot-full when he came off the topsail
yard, on a stormy night,— I fear Jack might have gone to ruin on the old
road.[3]
But this is not doubling Cape Horn. Eight hours of the night
our watch was on deck, and during the whole of that time we kept a bright
lookout: one man on each bow, another in the bunt of the fore yard, the third
mate on the scuttle, one man on each quarter, and another always standing by
the wheel. The chief mate was everywhere, and commanded the ship when the
captain was below. When a large piece of ice was seen in our way, or drifting
near us, the word was passed along, and the ship's head turned one way and
another; and sometimes the yards squared or braced up. There was little else
to do than to look out; and we had the sharpest eyes in the ship on the
forecastle. The only variety was the monotonous voice of the lookout
forward,—``Another island!''— ``Ice ahead!''—``Ice on the lee bow!''—
``Hard up the helm!''— ``Keep her off a little!''—
``Stead-y!''
In the mean time the wet and cold had brought my face into
such a state that I could neither eat nor sleep; and though I stood it out
all night, yet, when it became light, I was in such a state that all hands
told me I must go below, and lie-by for a day or two, or I should be laid up
for a long time. When the watch was changed I went into the steerage, and
took off my hat and comforter, and showed my face to the mate, who told me to
go below at once, and stay in my berth until the swelling went down,
and gave the cook orders to make a poultice for me, and said he
would speak to the captain.
I went below and turned-in, covering myself over with blankets
and jackets, and lay in my berth nearly twenty-four hours, half asleep and
half awake, stupid from the dull pain. I heard the watch called, and the men
going up and down, and sometimes a noise on deck, and a cry of ``ice,'' but I
gave little attention to anything. At the end of twenty-four hours the pain
went down, and I had a long sleep, which brought me back to my proper state;
yet my face was so swollen and tender that I was obliged to keep my berth
for two or three days longer. During the two days I had been below, the
weather was much the same that it had been,—head winds, and snow and rain;
or, if the wind came fair, too foggy, and the ice too thick, to run. At the
end of the third day the ice was very thick; a complete fog-bank covered the
ship. It blew a tremendous gale from the eastward, with sleet and snow, and
there was every promise of a dangerous and fatiguing night. At dark,
the captain called all hands aft, and told them that not a man was
to leave the deck that night; that the ship was in the greatest danger,
any cake of ice might knock a hole in her, or she might run on an island and
go to pieces. No one could tell whether she would be a ship the next morning.
The lookouts were then set, and every man was put in his station. When I
heard what was the state of things, I began to put on my clothes to stand it
out with the rest of them, when the mate came below, and, looking at my
face, ordered me back to my berth, saying that if we went down, we should
all go down together, but if I went on deck I might lay myself up for life.
This was the first word I had heard from aft; for the captain had done
nothing, nor inquired how I was, since I went below.
In obedience to the mate's orders, I went back to my berth;
but a more miserable night I never wish to spend. I never felt the
curse of sickness so keenly in my life. If I could only have been on deck
with the rest where something was to be done and seen and heard, where there
were fellow-beings for companions in duty and danger; but to be cooped up
alone in a black hole, in equal danger, but without the power to do, was the
hardest trial. Several times, in the course of the night, I got up,
determined to go on deck; but the silence which showed that there was
nothing doing, and the knowledge that I might make myself seriously
ill, for no purpose, kept me back. It was not easy to sleep, lying, as I
did, with my head directly against the bows, which might be dashed in by an
island of ice, brought down by the very next sea that struck her. This was
the only time I had been ill since I left Boston, and it was the worst time
it could have happened. I felt almost willing to bear the plagues of Egypt
for the rest of the voyage, if I could but be well and strong for that one
night. Yet it was a dreadful night for those on deck. A watch of
eighteen hours, with wet and cold and constant anxiety, nearly wore
them out; and when they came below at nine o'clock for breakfast,
they almost dropped asleep on their chests, and some of them were so stiff
that they could with difficulty sit down. Not a drop of anything had been
given them during the whole time (though the captain, as on the night that I
was on deck, had his coffee every four hours), except that the mate stole a
pot-full of coffee for two men to drink behind the galley, while he kept a
lookout for the captain. Every man had his station, and was not allowed
to leave it; and nothing happened to break the monotony of the
night, except once setting the main topsail, to run clear of a
large island to leeward, which they were drifting fast upon. Some of
the boys got so sleepy and stupefied that they actually fell asleep
at their posts; and the young third mate, Mr. Hatch, whose post was the
exposed one of standing on the fore scuttle, was so stiff, when he was
relieved, that he could not bend his knees to get down. By a constant
lookout, and a quick shifting of the helm, as the islands and pieces came in
sight, the ship went clear of everything but a few small pieces, though
daylight showed the ocean covered for miles. At daybreak it fell a dead calm,
and with the sun the fog cleared a little, and a breeze sprung up from
the westward, which soon grew into a gale. We had now a fair
wind, daylight, and comparatively clear weather; yet, to the surprise
of every one, the ship continued hove-to. ``Why does not he run?'' ``What
is the captain about?'' was asked by every one; and from questions it soon
grew into complaints and murmurings. When the daylight was so short, it was
too bad to lose it, and a fair wind, too, which every one had been praying
for. As hour followed hour, and the captain showed no sign of making sail,
the crew became impatient, and there was a good deal of talking and
consultation together on the forecastle. They had been beaten out with
the exposure and hardship, and impatient to get out of it, and
this unaccountable delay was more than they could bear in quietness,
in their excited and restless state. Some said the captain
was frightened,—completely cowed by the dangers and difficulties that
surrounded us, and was afraid to make sail; while others said that in his
anxiety and suspense he had made a free use of brandy and opium, and was
unfit for his duty. The carpenter, who was an intelligent man, and a thorough
seaman, and had great influence with the crew, came down into the forecastle,
and tried to induce them to go aft and ask the captain why he did not run, or
request him, in the name of all hands, to make sail. This appeared to be
a very reasonable request, and the crew agreed that if he did not make
sail before noon they would go aft. Noon came, and no sail was made. A
consultation was held again, and it was proposed to take the ship from the
captain and give the command of her to the mate, who had been heard to say
that if he could have his way the ship would have been half the distance to
the Cape before night,— ice or no ice. And so irritated and impatient had
the crew become, that even this proposition, which was open mutiny,
was entertained, and the carpenter went to his berth, leaving it tacitly
understood that something serious would be done if things remained as they
were many hours longer. When the carpenter left, we talked it all over, and I
gave my advice strongly against it. Another of the men, too, who had known
something of the kind attempted in another ship by a crew who were
dissatisfied with their captain, and which was followed with serious
consequences, was opposed to it. Stimson, who soon came down, joined us, and
we determined to have nothing to do with it. By these means the crew were
soon induced to give it up for the present, though they said they would not
lie where they were much longer without knowing the reason.
The affair remained in this state until four o'clock, when
an order came forward for all hands to come aft upon the quarter-deck. In
about ten minutes they came forward again, and the whole affair had been
blown. The carpenter, prematurely, and without any authority from the crew,
had sounded the mate as to whether he would take command of the ship, and
intimated an intention to displace the captain; and the mate, as in duty
bound, had told the whole to the captain, who immediately sent for
all hands aft. Instead of violent measures, or, at least, an outbreak of
quarter-deck bravado, threats, and abuse, which they had every reason to
expect, a sense of common danger and common suffering seemed to have tamed
his spirit, and begotten in him something like a humane fellow-feeling; for
he received the crew in a manner quiet, and even almost kind. He told them
what he had heard, and said that he did not believe that they would try to do
any such thing as was intimated; that they had always been good
men,— obedient, and knew their duty, and he had no fault to find
with them, and asked them what they had to complain of; said that no one
could say that he was slow to carry sail (which was true enough), and that,
as soon as he thought it was safe and proper, he should make sail. He added a
few words about their duty in their present situation, and sent them forward,
saying that he should take no further notice of the matter; but, at the
same time, told the carpenter to recollect whose power he was in, and that
if he heard another word from him he would have cause to remember him to the
day of his death.
This language of the captain had a very good effect upon the
crew, and they returned quietly to their duty.
For two days more the wind blew from the southward and
eastward, and in the short intervals when it was fair, the ice was too
thick to run; yet the weather was not so dreadfully bad, and the crew had
watch and watch. I still remained in my berth, fast recovering, yet not well
enough to go safely on deck. And I should have been perfectly useless; for,
from having eaten nothing for nearly a week, except a little rice which I
forced into my mouth the last day or two, I was as weak as an infant. To be
sick in a forecastle is miserable indeed. It is the worst part of a
dog's life, especially in bad weather. The forecastle, shut up tight
to keep out the water and cold air; the watch either on deck or asleep in
their berths; no one to speak to; the pale light of the single lamp, swinging
to and fro from the beam, so dim that one can scarcely see, much less read,
by it; the water dropping from the beams and carlines and running down the
sides, and the forecastle so wet and dark and cheerless, and so lumbered up
with chests and wet clothes, that sitting up is worse than lying in
the berth. These are some of the evils. Fortunately, I needed no help from
any one, and no medicine; and if I had needed help I don't know where I
should have found it. Sailors are willing enough, but it is true, as is often
said,—no one ships for nurse on board a vessel. Our merchant ships are
always undermanned, and if one man is lost by sickness, they cannot spare
another to take care of him. A sailor is always presumed to be well, and if
he's sick he's a poor dog. One has to stand his wheel, and another his
lookout, and the sooner he gets on deck again the better.
Accordingly, as soon as I could possibly go back to my duty, I
put on my thick clothes and boots and southwester, and made my appearance
on deck. I had been but a few days below, yet everything looked strangely
enough. The ship was cased in ice,— decks, sides, masts, yards, and rigging.
Two close-reefed topsails were all the sail she had on, and every sail and
rope was frozen so stiff in its place that it seemed as though it would
be impossible to start anything. Reduced, too, to her topmasts, she had
altogether a most forlorn and crippled appearance. The sun had come up
brightly; the snow was swept off the decks and ashes thrown upon them so that
we could walk, for they had been as slippery as glass. It was, of course, too
cold to carry on any ship's work, and we had only to walk the deck and keep
ourselves warm. The wind was still ahead, and the whole ocean, to
the eastward, covered with islands and field-ice. At four bells the order
was given to square away the yards, and the man who came from the helm said
that the captain had kept her off to N. N. E. What could this mean? The
wildest rumors got adrift. Some said that he was going to put into Valparaiso
and winter, and others that he was going to run out of the ice and cross the
Pacific, and go home round the Cape of Good Hope. Soon, however, it leaked
out, and we found that we were running for the Straits of Magellan.
The news soon spread through the ship, and all tongues were at
work talking about it. No one on board had been through the straits; but I
had in my chest an account of the passage of the ship A. J. Donelson, of New
York, through those straits a few years before. The account was given by the
captain, and the representation was as favorable as possible. It was soon
read by every one on board, and various opinions pronounced. The
determination of our captain had at least this good effect; it gave us
something to think and talk about, made a break in our life, and diverted our
minds from the monotonous dreariness of the prospect before us. Having made
a fair wind of it, we were going off at a good rate, and leaving
the thickest of the ice behind us. This, at least, was
something.
Having been long enough below to get my hands well warmed
and softened, the first handling of the ropes was rather tough; but a few
days hardened them, and as soon as I got my mouth open wide enough to take in
a piece of salt beef and hard bread, I was all right again.
Sunday, July 10th. Lat. 54° 10', lon. 79° 07'. This was our
position at noon. The sun was out bright; the ice was all left behind,
and things had quite a cheering appearance. We brought our wet pea-jackets
and trousers on deck, and hung them up in the rigging, that the breeze and
the few hours of sun might dry them a little; and, by leave of the cook, the
galley was nearly filled with stockings and mittens, hung round to be dried.
Boots, too, were brought up; and, having got a little tar and slush from
below, we gave them thick coats. After dinner all hands were turned-to, to
get the anchors over the bows, bend on the chains, &c. The
fish-tackle was got up, fish-davit rigged out, and, after two or three hours
of hard and cold work, both the anchors were ready for instant use,
a couple of kedges got up, a hawser coiled away upon the fore-hatch, and
the deep-sea-lead-line overhauled and made ready. Our spirits returned with
having something to do; and when the tackle was manned to bowse the anchor
home, notwithstanding the desolation of the scene, we struck up ``Cheerly,
men!'' in full chorus. This pleased the mate, who rubbed his hands and cried
out, ``That's right, my boys; never say die! That sounds like the old
crew!'' and the captain came up, on hearing the song, and said to
the passenger, within hearing of the man at the wheel, ``That sounds like
a lively crew. They'll have their song so long as there're enough left for a
chorus!''
This preparation of the cable and anchors was for the passage
of the straits; for, as they are very crooked, and with a variety
of currents, it is necessary to come frequently to anchor. This was not,
by any means, a pleasant prospect; for, of all the work that a sailor is
called upon to do in cold weather, there is none so bad as working the
ground-tackle. The heavy chain cables to be hauled and pulled about decks
with bare hands; wet hawsers, slip-ropes, and buoy-ropes to be hauled aboard,
dripping in water, which is running up your sleeves, and freezing; clearing
hawse under the bows; getting under way and coming-to at all hours of the
night and day, and a constant lookout for rocks and sands and turns of
tides,—these are some of the disagreeables of such a navigation to a common
sailor. Fair or foul, he wants to have nothing to do with the ground-tackle
between port and port. One of our hands, too, had unluckily fallen upon a
half of an old newspaper which contained an account of the passage, through
the straits, of a Boston brig, called, I think, the Peruvian, in which she
lost every cable and anchor she had, got aground twice, and arrived at
Valparaiso in distress. This was set off against the account of the A. J.
Donelson, and led us to look forward with less confidence to the passage,
especially as no one on board had ever been through, and we heard that the
captain had no very satisfactory charts. However, we were spared any
further experience on the point; for the next day, when we must have
been near the Cape of Pillars, which is the southwest point of the mouth
of the straits, a gale set in from the eastward, with a heavy fog, so that we
could not see half the ship's length ahead. This, of course, put an end to
the project for the present; for a thick fog and a gale blowing dead ahead
are not the most favorable circumstances for the passage of difficult and
dangerous straits. This weather, too, seemed likely to last for some time,
and we could not think of beating about the mouth of the straits for
a week or two, waiting for a favorable opportunity; so we braced up on the
larboard tack, put the ship's head due south, and stuck her off for Cape Horn
again.
[1] The cook's title in all vessels.
[2] The proportions of the ingredients of the tea that was
made for us (and ours, as I have before stated, was a favorable specimen
of American merchantmen) were a pint of tea and a pint and a half
of molasses to about three gallons of water. These are all boiled down
together in the ``coppers,'' and, before serving it out, the mess is stirred
up with a stick, so as to give each man his fair share of sweetening and
tea-leaves. The tea for the cabin is, of course, made in the usual way, in a
teapot, and drunk with sugar.
[3] I do not wish these remarks, so far as they relate to the
saving of expense in the outfit, to be applied to the owners of our
ship, for she was supplied with an abundance of stores of the best
kind that are given to seamen; though the dispensing of them
is necessarily left to the captain. And I learned, on our return, that the
captain withheld many of the stores from us, from mere ugliness. He brought
several barrels of flour home, but would not give us the usual twice-a-week
duff, and so as to other stores. Indeed, so high was the reputation of ``the
employ'' among men and officers for the character and outfit of their
vessels, and for their liberality in conducting their voyages, that when it
was known that they had the Alert fitting out for a long voyage, and that
hands were to be shipped at a certain time,—a half hour before the time, as
one of the crew told me, sailors were steering down the wharf, hopping over
the barrels, like a drove of sheep.
CHAPTER XXXII
In our first attempt to double the Cape, when we came up to
the latitude of it, we were nearly seventeen hundred miles to
the westward, but, in running for the Straits of Magellan, we stood so far
to the eastward that we made our second attempt at a distance of not more
than four or five hundred miles; and we had great hopes, by this means, to
run clear of the ice; thinking that the easterly gales, which had prevailed
for a long time, would have driven it to the westward. With the wind about
two points free, the yards braced in a little, and two close-reefed topsails
and a reefed foresail on the ship, we made great way toward the southward;
and almost every watch, when we came on deck, the air seemed to grow colder,
and the sea to run higher. Still we saw no ice, and had great hopes of going
clear of it altogether, when, one afternoon, about three o'clock, while we
were taking a siesta during our watch below, ``All hands!'' was called in a
loud and fearful voice. ``Tumble up here, men!—tumble up!—don't
stop for your clothes—before we're upon it!'' We sprang out of
our berths and hurried upon deck. The loud, sharp voice of the captain was
heard giving orders, as though for life or death, and we ran aft to the
braces, not waiting to look ahead, for not a moment was to be lost. The helm
was hard up, the after yards shaking, and the ship in the act of wearing.
Slowly, with the stiff ropes and iced rigging, we swung the yards round,
everything coming hard and with a creaking and rending sound, like pulling up
a plank which has been frozen into the ice. The ship wore round fairly, the
yards were steadied, and we stood off on the other tack, leaving
behind us, directly under our larboard quarter, a large ice
island, peering out of the mist, and reaching high above our tops;
while astern, and on either side of the island, large tracts of field-ice
were dimly seen, heaving and rolling in the sea. We were now safe, and
standing to the northward; but, in a few minutes more, had it not been for
the sharp lookout of the watch, we should have been fairly upon the ice, and
left our ship's old bones adrift in the Southern Ocean. After standing to
the northward a few hours, we wore ship, and, the wind having hauled, we
stood to the southward and eastward. All night long a bright lookout was kept
from every part of the deck; and whenever ice was seen on the one bow or the
other the helm was shifted and the yards braced, and, by quick working of the
ship, she was kept clear. The accustomed cry of ``Ice ahead!''—``Ice on the
lee bow!''—``Another island!'' in the same tones, and with the
same orders following them, seemed to bring us directly back to our
old position of the week before. During our watch on deck, which was from
twelve to four, the wind came out ahead, with a pelting storm of hail and
sleet, and we lay hove-to, under a close-reefed fore topsail, the whole
watch. During the next watch it fell calm with a drenching rain until
daybreak, when the wind came out to the westward, and the weather cleared up,
and showed us the whole ocean, in the course which we should have steered,
had it not been for the head wind and calm, completely blocked up with ice.
Here, then, our progress was stopped, and we wore ship, and once
more stood to the northward and eastward; not for the Straits of Magellan,
but to make another attempt to double the Cape, still farther to the
eastward; for the captain was determined to get round if perseverance could
do it, and the third time, he said, never failed.
With a fair wind we soon ran clear of the field-ice, and by
noon had only the stray islands floating far and near upon the ocean. The
sun was out bright, the sea of a deep blue, fringed with the white foam of
the waves, which ran high before a strong southwester; our solitary ship tore
on through the open water as though glad to be out of her confinement; and
the ice islands lay scattered here and there, of various sizes and shapes,
reflecting the bright rays of the sun, and drifting slowly northward
before the gale. It was a contrast to much that we had lately seen, and
a spectacle not only of beauty, but of life; for it required but little
fancy to imagine these islands to be animate masses which had broken loose
from the ``thrilling regions of thick-ribbed ice,'' and were working their
way, by wind and current, some alone, and some in fleets, to milder climes.
No pencil has ever yet given anything like the true effect of an iceberg. In
a picture, they are huge, uncouth masses, stuck in the sea, while their
chief beauty and grandeur—their slow, stately motion, the whirling of the
snow about their summits, and the fearful groaning and cracking of their
parts—the picture cannot give. This is the large iceberg,—while the small
and distant islands, floating on the smooth sea, in the light of a clear day,
look like little floating fairy isles of sapphire.
From a northeast course we gradually hauled to the eastward,
and after sailing about two hundred miles, which brought us as near to the
western coast of Terra del Fuego as was safe, and having lost sight of the
ice altogether,—for the third time we put the ship's head to the southward,
to try the passage of the Cape. The weather continued clear and cold, with a
strong gale from the westward, and we were fast getting up with the latitude
of the Cape, with a prospect of soon being round. One fine afternoon,
a man who had gone into the fore-top to shift the rolling tackles sung out
at the top of his voice, and with evident glee, ``Sail ho!'' Neither land nor
sail had we seen since leaving San Diego; and only those who have traversed
the length of a whole ocean alone can imagine what an excitement such an
announcement produced on board. ``Sail ho!'' shouted the cook, jumping out of
his galley; ``Sail ho!'' shouted a man, throwing back the slide of
the scuttle, to the watch below, who were soon out of their berths and on
deck; and ``Sail ho!'' shouted the captain down the companion-way to the
passenger in the cabin. Beside the pleasure of seeing a ship and human beings
in so desolate a place, it was important for us to speak a vessel, to learn
whether there was ice to the eastward, and to ascertain the longitude; for we
had no chronometer, and had been drifting about so long that we had nearly
lost our reckoning; and opportunities for lunar observations are not frequent
or sure in such a place as Cape Horn. For these various reasons the
excitement in our little community was running high, and conjectures were
made, and everything thought of for which the captain would hail, when
the man aloft sung out—``Another sail, large on the weather bow!'' This
was a little odd, but so much the better, and did not shake our faith in
their being sails. At length the man in the top hailed, and said he believed
it was land, after all. ``Land in your eye!'' said the mate, who was looking
through the telescope; ``they are ice islands, if I can see a hole through a
ladder''; and a few moments showed the mate to be right; and all
our expectations fled; and instead of what we most wished to see we had
what we most dreaded, and what we hoped we had seen the last of. We soon,
however, left these astern, having passed within about two miles of them, and
at sundown the horizon was clear in all directions.
Having a fine wind, we were soon up with and passed the
latitude of the Cape, and, having stood far enough to the southward to
give it a wide berth, we began to stand to the eastward, with a
good prospect of being round and steering to the northward, on the other
side, in a very few days. But ill luck seemed to have lighted upon us. Not
four hours had we been standing on in this course before it fell dead calm,
and in half an hour it clouded up, a few straggling blasts, with spits of
snow and sleet, came from the eastward, and in an hour more we lay hove-to
under a close-reefed main topsail, drifting bodily off to leeward
before the fiercest storm that we had yet felt, blowing dead ahead,
from the eastward. It seemed as though the genius of the place had
been roused at finding that we had nearly slipped through his fingers, and
had come down upon us with tenfold fury. The sailors said that every blast,
as it shook the shrouds, and whistled through the rigging, said to the old
ship, ``No, you don't!''—``No, you don't!''
For eight days we lay drifting about in this manner.
Sometimes— generally towards noon—it fell calm; once or twice a
round copper ball showed itself for a few moments in the place where
the sun ought to have been, and a puff or two came from the
westward, giving some hope that a fair wind had come at last. During
the first two days we made sail for these puffs, shaking the reefs out of
the topsails and boarding the tacks of the courses; but finding that it only
made work for us when the gale set in again, it was soon given up, and we
lay-to under our close-reefs. We had less snow and hail than when we were
farther to the westward, but we had an abundance of what is worse to a sailor
in cold weather,— drenching rain. Snow is blinding, and very bad when coming
upon a coast, but, for genuine discomfort, give me rain with
freezing weather. A snowstorm is exciting, and it does not wet through
the clothes (a fact important to a sailor); but a constant rain there is
no escaping from. It wets to the skin, and makes all protection vain. We had
long ago run through all our dry clothes, and as sailors have no other way of
drying them than by the sun, we had nothing to do but to put on those which
were the least wet. At the end of each watch, when we came below, we took off
our clothes and wrung them out; two taking hold of a pair of trousers, one at
each end,—and jackets in the same way. Stockings, mittens, and all, were
wrung out also, and then hung up to drain and chafe dry against the
bulkheads. Then, feeling of all our clothes, we picked out those which were
the least wet, and put them on, so as to be ready for a call, and turned-in,
covered ourselves up with blankets, and slept until three knocks on the
scuttle and the dismal sound of ``All Starbowlines ahoy! Eight bells, there
below! Do you hear the news?'' drawled out from on deck, and the
sulky answer of ``Aye, aye!'' from below, sent us up again.
On deck all was dark, and either a dead calm, with the
rain pouring steadily down, or, more generally, a violent gale dead ahead,
with rain pelting horizontally, and occasional variations of hail and sleet;
decks afloat with water swashing from side to side, and constantly wet feet,
for boots could not be wrung out like drawers, and no composition could stand
the constant soaking. In fact, wet and cold feet are inevitable in such
weather, and are not the least of those items which go to make up the grand
total of the discomforts of a winter passage round Cape Horn. Few
words were spoken between the watches as they shifted; the wheel
was relieved, the mate took his place on the quarter-deck, the lookouts in
the bows; and each man had his narrow space to walk fore and aft in, or
rather to swing himself forward and back in, from one belaying-pin to
another, for the decks were too slippery with ice and water to allow of much
walking. To make a walk, which is absolutely necessary to pass away the time,
one of us hit upon the expedient of sanding the decks; and afterwards,
whenever the rain was not so violent as to wash it off, the weather-side of
the quarter-deck, and a part of the waist and forecastle were sprinkled
with the sand which we had on board for holystoning, and thus we made a good
promenade, where we walked fore and aft, two and two, hour after hour, in our
long, dull, and comfortless watches. The bells seemed to be an hour or two
apart, instead of half an hour, and an age to elapse before the welcome sound
of eight bells. The sole object was to make the time pass on. Any change
was sought for which would break the monotony of the time; and even the two
hours' trick at the wheel, which came round to us in turn, once in every
other watch, was looked upon as a relief. The never-failing resource of long
yarns, which eke out many a watch, seemed to have failed us now; for we had
been so long together that we had heard each other's stories told over and
over again till we had them by heart; each one knew the whole history of
each of the others, and we were fairly and literally talked out. Singing and
joking we were in no humor for; and, in fact, any sound of mirth or laughter
would have struck strangely upon our ears, and would not have been tolerated
any more than whistling or a wind instrument. The last resort, that of
speculating upon the future, seemed now to fail us; for our discouraging
situation, and the danger we were really in (as we expected every day to
find ourselves drifted back among the ice), ``clapped a stopper'' upon all
that. From saying ``when we get home,'' we began insensibly to alter it to
``if we get home,'' and at last the subject was dropped by a tacit
consent.
In this state of things, a new light was struck out, and a
new field opened, by a change in the watch. One of our watch was laid up
for two or three days by a bad hand (for in cold weather the least cut or
bruise ripens into a sore), and his place was supplied by the carpenter. This
was a windfall, and there was a contest who should have the carpenter to walk
with him. As ``Chips'' was a man of some little education, and he and I had
had a good deal of intercourse with each other, he fell in with me in my
walk. He was a Fin, but spoke English well, and gave me long accounts of his
country,—the customs, the trade, the towns, what little he knew of the
government (I found he was no friend of Russia), his voyages, his first
arrival in America, his marriage and courtship; he had married a countrywoman
of his, a dress-maker, whom he met with in Boston. I had very little to
tell him of my quiet, sedentary life at home; and in spite of our
best efforts, which had protracted these yarns through five or
six watches, we fairly talked each other out, and I turned him over
to another man in the watch, and put myself upon my own
resources.
I commenced a deliberate system of time-killing, which united
some profit with a cheering up of the heavy hours. As soon as I came
on deck, and took my place and regular walk, I began with repeating over
to myself in regular order a string of matters which I had in my memory,—
the multiplication table and the tables of weights and measures; the Kanaka
numerals; then the States of the Union, with their capitals; the counties of
England, with their shire towns, and the kings of England in their order, and
other things. This carried me through my facts, and, being
repeated deliberately, with long intervals, often eked out the first
two bells. Then came the Ten Commandments, the thirty-ninth chapter
of Job, and a few other passages from Scripture. The next in the order,
which I seldom varied from, came Cowper's Castaway, which was a great
favorite with me; its solemn measure and gloomy character, as well as the
incident it was founded upon, making it well suited to a lonely watch at sea.
Then his lines to Mary, his address to the Jackdaw, and a short extract from
Table Talk (I abounded in Cowper, for I happened to have a volume of his
poems in my chest); ``Ille et nefasto'' from Horace, and Goethe's
Erl König. After I had got through these, I allowed myself a more general
range among everything that I could remember, both in prose and verse. In
this way, with an occasional break by relieving the wheel, heaving the log,
and going to the scuttle-butt for a drink of water, the longest watch was
passed away; and I was so regular in my silent recitations that, if
there was no interruption by ship's duty, I could tell very nearly
the number of bells by my progress.
Our watches below were no more varied than the watch on deck.
All washing, sewing, and reading was given up, and we did nothing but eat,
sleep, and stand our watch, leading what might be called a Cape Horn life.
The forecastle was too uncomfortable to sit up in; and whenever we were
below, we were in our berths. To prevent the rain and the sea-water which
broke over the bows from washing down, we were obliged to keep the scuttle
closed, so that the forecastle was nearly air-tight. In this little, wet,
leaky hole, we were all quartered, in an atmosphere so bad that our
lamp, which swung in the middle from the beams, sometimes actually burned
blue, with a large circle of foul air about it. Still, I was never in better
health than after three weeks of this life. I gained a great deal of flesh,
and we all ate like horses. At every watch when we came below, before turning
in, the bread barge and beef kid were overhauled. Each man drank his quart of
hot tea night and morning, and glad enough we were to get it; for
no nectar and ambrosia were sweeter to the lazy immortals than was a pot
of hot tea, a hard biscuit, and a slice of cold salt beef to us after a watch
on deck. To be sure, we were mere animals, and, had this life lasted a year
instead of a month, we should have been little better than the ropes in the
ship. Not a razor, nor a brush, nor a drop of water, except the rain and the
spray, had come near us all the time; for we were on an allowance of
fresh water; and who would strip and wash himself in salt water on
deck, in the snow and ice, with the thermometer at zero?
After about eight days of constant easterly gales, the wind
hauled occasionally a little to the southward, and blew hard, which, as we
were well to the southward, allowed us to brace in a little, and stand on
under all the sail we could carry. These turns lasted but a short while, and
sooner or later it set in again from the old quarter; yet at each time we
made something, and were gradually edging along to the eastward. One night,
after one of these shifts of the wind, and when all hands had been up a
great part of the time, our watch was left on deck, with the
mainsail hanging in the buntlines, ready to be set if necessary. It came
on to blow worse and worse, with hail and snow beating like so many furies
upon the ship, it being as dark and thick as night could make it. The
mainsail was blowing and slatting with a noise like thunder, when the captain
came on deck and ordered it to be furled. The mate was about to call all
hands, when the captain stopped him, and said that the men would be beaten
out if they were called up so often; that, as our watch must stay on deck,
it might as well be doing that as anything else. Accordingly, we went upon
the yard; and never shall I forget that piece of work. Our watch had been so
reduced by sickness, and by some having been left in California, that, with
one man at the wheel, we had only the third mate and three beside myself to
go aloft; so that at most we could only attempt to furl one yard-arm at a
time. We manned the weather yard-arm, and set to work to make a furl of
it. Our lower masts being short, and our yards very square, the sail had a
head of nearly fifty feet, and a short leech, made still shorter by the deep
reef which was in it, which brought the clew away out on the quarters of the
yard, and made a bunt nearly as square as the mizzen royal yard. Beside this
difficulty, the yard over which we lay was cased with ice, the gaskets and
rope of the foot and leech of the sail as stiff and hard as a piece of
leather hose, and the sail itself about as pliable as though it had
been made of sheets of sheathing copper. It blew a perfect hurricane, with
alternate blasts of snow, hail, and rain. We had to fist the sail with bare
hands. No one could trust himself to mittens, for if he slipped he was a gone
man. All the boats were hoisted in on deck, and there was nothing to be
lowered for him. We had need of every finger God had given us. Several times
we got the sail upon the yard, but it blew away again before we could secure
it. It required men to lie over the yard to pass each turn of the gaskets,
and when they were passed it was almost impossible to knot them so that they
would hold. Frequently we were obliged to leave off altogether and take to
beating our hands upon the sail to keep them from freezing. After some time—
which seemed forever— we got the weather side stowed after a fashion, and
went over to leeward for another trial. This was still worse, for the body
of the sail had been blown over to leeward, and, as the yard
was a-cock-bill by the lying over of the vessel, we had to light it all up
to windward. When the yard-arms were furled, the bunt was all adrift again,
which made more work for us. We got all secure at last, but we had been
nearly an hour and a half upon the yard, and it seemed an age. It had just
struck five bells when we went up, and eight were struck soon after we came
down. This may seem slow work; but considering the state of everything, and
that we had only five men to a sail with just half as many square yards
of canvas in it as the mainsail of the Independence, sixty-gun ship, which
musters seven hundred men at her quarters, it is not wonderful that we were
no quicker about it. We were glad enough to get on deck, and still more to go
below. The oldest sailor in the watch said, as he went down, ``I shall never
forget that main yard; it beats all my going a-fishing. Fun is fun, but
furling one yard-arm of a course at a time, off Cape Horn, is no better
than man-killing.''
During the greater part of the next two days, the wind was
pretty steady from the southward. We had evidently made great
progress, and had good hope of being soon up with the Cape, if we were
not there already. We could put but little confidence in our reckoning, as
there had been no opportunities for an observation, and we had drifted too
much to allow of our dead reckoning being anywhere near the mark. If it would
clear off enough to give a chance for an observation, or if we could make
land, we should know where we were; and upon these, and the chances of
falling in with a sail from the eastward, we depended almost
entirely.
Friday, July 22d. This day we had a steady gale from
the southward, and stood on under close sail, with the yards eased
a little by the weather braces, the clouds lifting a little, and showing
signs of breaking away. In the afternoon, I was below with Mr. Hatch, the
third mate, and two others, filling the bread locker in the steerage from the
casks, when a bright gleam of sunshine broke out and shone down the
companionway, and through the skylight, lighting up everything below, and
sending a warm glow through the hearts of all. It was a sight we had not seen
for weeks,—an omen, a godsend. Even the roughest and hardest
face acknowledged its influence. Just at that moment we heard a loud shout
from all parts of the deck, and the mate called out down the companion-way to
the captain, who was sitting in the cabin. What he said we could not
distinguish, but the captain kicked over his chair, and was on deck at one
jump. We could not tell what it was; and, anxious as we were to know, the
discipline of the ship would not allow of our leaving our places. Yet, as we
were not called, we knew there was no danger. We hurried to get through with
our job, when, seeing the steward's black face peering out of the pantry,
Mr. Hatch hailed him to know what was the matter. ``Lan' o, to be sure, sir!
No you hear 'em sing out, `Lan' o?' De cap'em say 'im Cape
Horn!''
This gave us a new start, and we were soon through our work
and on deck; and there lay the land, fair upon the larboard beam,
and slowly edging away upon the quarter. All hands were busy looking at
it,—the captain and mates from the quarter-deck, the cook from his galley,
and the sailors from the forecastle; and even Mr. Nuttall, the passenger, who
had kept in his shell for nearly a month, and hardly been seen by anybody,
and whom we had almost forgotten was on board, came out like a butterfly, and
was hopping round as bright as a bird.
The land was the island of Staten Land, just to the eastward
of Cape Horn; and a more desolate-looking spot I never wish to set eyes
upon,—bare, broken, and girt with rocks and ice, with here and there,
between the rocks and broken hillocks, a little stunted vegetation of shrubs.
It was a place well suited to stand at the junction of the two oceans, beyond
the reach of human cultivation, and encounter the blasts and snows of a
perpetual winter. Yet, dismal as it was, it was a pleasant sight to us; not
only as being the first land we had seen, but because it told us that we
had passed the Cape,—were in the Atlantic,—and that, with twenty-four
hours of this breeze, we might bid defiance to the Southern Ocean. It told
us, too, our latitude and longitude better than any observation; and the
captain now knew where we were, as well as if we were off the end of Long
Wharf.
In the general joy, Mr. Nuttall said he should like to go
ashore upon the island and examine a spot which probably no human
being had ever set foot upon; but the captain intimated that he would see
the island, specimens and all, in—another place, before he would get out a
boat or delay the ship one moment for him.
We left the land gradually astern; and at sundown had the
Atlantic Ocean clear before us.
CHAPTER XXXIII
It is usual, in voyages round the Cape from the Pacific, to
keep to the eastward of the Falkland Islands; but as there had now set in
a strong, steady, and clear southwester, with every prospect of its lasting,
and we had had enough of high latitudes, the captain determined to stand
immediately to the northward, running inside the Falkland Islands.
Accordingly, when the wheel was relieved at eight o'clock, the order was
given to keep her due north, and all hands were turned up to square away the
yards and make sail. In a moment the news ran through the ship that the
captain was keeping her off, with her nose straight for Boston, and Cape Horn
over her taffrail. It was a moment of enthusiasm. Every one was on
the alert, and even the two sick men turned out to lend a hand at
the halyards. The wind was now due southwest, and blowing a gale to which
a vessel close hauled could have shown no more than a single close-reefed
sail; but as we were going before it, we could carry on. Accordingly, hands
were sent aloft, and a reef shaken out of the topsails, and the reefed
foresail set. When we came to mast-head the topsail yards, with all hands at
the halyards, we struck up ``Cheerly, men,'' with a chorus which might have
been heard half-way to Staten Land. Under her increased sail, the
ship drove on through the water. Yet she could bear it well; and
the captain sang out from the quarter-deck, ``Another reef out of
that fore topsail, and give it to her!'' Two hands sprang aloft;
the frozen reef-points and earings were cast adrift, the halyards manned,
and the sail gave out her increased canvas to the gale. All hands were kept
on deck to watch the effect of the change. It was as much as she could well
carry, and with a heavy sea astern it took two men at the wheel to steer her.
She flung the foam from her bows, the spray breaking aft as far as the
gangway. She was going at a prodigious rate. Still everything held.
Preventer braces were reeved and hauled taut, tackles got upon
the backstays, and everything done to keep all snug and strong.
The captain walked the deck at a rapid stride, looked aloft at the sails,
and then to windward; the mate stood in the gangway, rubbing his hands, and
talking aloud to the ship, ``Hurrah, old bucket! the Boston girls have got
hold of the tow-rope!'' and the like; and we were on the forecastle, looking
to see how the spars stood it, and guessing the rate at which she was going,
when the captain called out ``Mr. Brown, get up the topmast
studding-sail! What she can't carry she may drag!'' The mate looked a moment;
but he would let no one be before him in daring. He sprang
forward. ``Hurrah, men! rig out the topmast studding-sail boom! Lay
aloft, and I'll send the rigging up to you!'' We sprang aloft into
the top; lowered a girt-line down, by which we hauled up the rigging; rove
the tacks and halyards; ran out the boom and lashed it fast, and sent down
the lower halyards as a preventer. It was a clear starlight night, cold and
blowing; but everybody worked with a will. Some, indeed, looked as though
they thought the ``old man'' was mad, but no one said a word. We had had a
new topmast studding-sail made with a reef in it,—a thing hardly ever
heard of, and which the sailors had ridiculed a good deal, saying
that when it was time to reef a studding-sail it was time to take it in.
But we found a use for it now; for, there being a reef in the topsail, the
studding-sail could not be set without one in it also. To be sure, a
studding-sail with reefed topsails was rather a novelty; yet there was some
reason in it, for if we carried that away we should lose only a sail and a
boom; but a whole topsail might have carried away the mast and
all.
While we were aloft the sail had been got out, bent to the
yard, reefed, and ready for hoisting. Waiting for a good opportunity, the
halyards were manned and the yard hoisted fairly up to the block; but when
the mate came to shake the catspaw out of the downhaul, and we began to
boom-end the sail, it shook the ship to her centre. The boom buckled up and
bent like a whip-stick, and we looked every moment to see something go; but,
being of the short, tough upland spruce, it bent like whalebone, and nothing
could break it. The carpenter said it was the best stick he had ever seen.
The strength of all hands soon brought the tack to the boom-end, and the
sheet was trimmed down, and the preventer and the weather brace hauled taut
to take off the strain. Every rope-yarn seemed stretched to the utmost, and
every thread of canvas; and with this sail added to her, the ship sprang
through the water like a thing possessed. The sail being nearly
all forward, it lifted her out of the water, and she seemed actually to
jump from sea to sea. From the time her keel was laid, she had never been so
driven; and had it been life or death with every one of us, she could not
have borne another stitch of canvas.
Finding that she would bear the sail, the hands were sent
below, and our watch remained on deck. Two men at the wheel had as much as
they could do to keep her within three points of her course, for she steered
as wild as a young colt. The mate walked the deck, looking at the sails, and
then over the side to see the foam fly by her,—slapping his hands upon his
thighs and talking to the ship,—``Hurrah, you jade, you've got the scent!—
you know where you're going!'' And when she leaped over the seas, and almost
out of the water, and trembled to her very keel, the spars and
masts snapping and creaking,—``There she goes!—There she
goes,— handsomely?—As long as she cracks she holds!''—while we
stood with the rigging laid down fair for letting go, and ready to take in
sail and clear away, if anything went. At four bells we hove the log, and she
was going eleven knots fairly; and had it not been for the sea from aft which
sent the chip home, and threw her continually off her course, the log would
have shown her to have been going somewhat faster. I went to the wheel with a
young fellow from the Kennebec, Jack Stewart, who was a good helmsman, and
for two hours we had our hands full. A few minutes showed us that our
monkey-jackets must come off; and, cold as it was, we stood in our
shirt-sleeves in a perspiration, and were glad enough to have it eight bells,
and the wheel relieved. We turned-in and slept as well as we could, though
the sea made a constant roar under her bows, and washed over the forecastle
like a small cataract.
At four o'clock we were called again. The same sail was still
on the vessel, and the gale, if there was any change, had increased
a little. No attempt was made to take the studding-sail in; and, indeed,
it was too late now. If we had started anything toward taking it in, either
tack or halyards, it would have blown to pieces, and carried something away
with it. The only way now was to let everything stand, and if the gale went
down, well and good; if not, something must go,—the weakest stick or rope
first,— and then we could get it in. For more than an hour she was
driven on at such a rate that she seemed to crowd the sea into a
heap before her; and the water poured over the spritsail yard as it would
over a dam. Toward daybreak the gale abated a little, and she was just
beginning to go more easily along, relieved of the pressure, when Mr. Brown,
determined to give her no respite, and depending upon the wind's subsiding as
the sun rose, told us to get along the lower studding-sail. This was an
immense sail, and held wind enough to last a Dutchman a week,—hove-to. It
was soon ready, the boom topped up, preventer guys rove, and the
idlers called up to man the halyards; yet such was still the force of
the gale that we were nearly an hour setting the sail; carried away the
outhaul in doing it, and came very near snapping off the swinging boom. No
sooner was it set than the ship tore on again like one mad, and began to
steer wilder than ever. The men at the wheel were puffing and blowing at
their work, and the helm was going hard up and hard down, constantly. Add to
this, the gale did not lessen as the day came on, but the sun rose in clouds.
A sudden lurch threw the man from the weather wheel across the deck and
against the side. The mate sprang to the wheel, and the man, regaining his
feet, seized the spokes, and they hove the wheel up just in time to save the
ship from broaching to, though as she came up the studding-sail boom stood at
an angle of forty-five degrees. She had evidently more on her than she could
bear; yet it was in vain to try to take it in,—the clew-line was not
strong enough, and they were thinking of cutting away, when another
wide yaw and a come-to snapped the guys, and the swinging boom came
in with a crash against the lower rigging. The outhaul block gave way, and
the topmast studding-sail boom bent in a manner which I never before supposed
a stick could bend. I had my eye on it when the guys parted, and it made one
spring and buckled up so as to form nearly a half-circle, and sprang out
again to its shape. The clew-line gave way at the first pull; the cleat to
which the halyards were belayed was wrenched off, and the sail blew
round the spritsail yard and head guys, which gave us a bad job to get it
in. A half-hour served to clear all away, and she was suffered to drive on
with her topmast studding-sail set, it being as much as she could stagger
under.
During all this day and the next night we went on under the
same sail, the gale blowing with undiminished violence; two men at
the wheel all the time; watch and watch, and nothing to do but to steer
and look out for the ship, and be blown along;—until the noon of the next
day,--
Sunday, July 24th, when we were in lat. 50° 27' S., lon. 62°
13' W., having made four degrees of latitude in the last twenty-four
hours. Being now to the northward of the Falkland Islands, the ship
was kept off, northeast, for the equator; and with her head for
the equator, and Cape Horn over her taffrail, she went gloriously on;
every heave of the sea leaving the Cape astern, and every hour bringing us
nearer to home and to warm weather. Many a time, when blocked up in the ice,
with everything dismal and discouraging about us, had we said, if we were
only fairly round, and standing north on the other side, we should ask for no
more; and now we had it all, with a clear sea and as much wind as a sailor
could pray for. If the best part of a voyage is the last part, surely we
had all now that we could wish. Every one was in the highest spirits, and
the ship seemed as glad as any of us at getting out of her confinement. At
each change of the watch, those coming on deck asked those going below, ``How
does she go along?'' and got, for answer, the rate, and the customary
addition, ``Aye! and the Boston girls have had hold of the tow-rope all the
watch.'' Every day the sun rose higher in the horizon, and the nights
grew shorter; and at coming on deck each morning there was a
sensible change in the temperature. The ice, too, began to melt from
off the rigging and spars, and, except a little which remained in the tops
and round the hounds of the lower masts, was soon gone. As we left the gale
behind us, the reefs were shaken out of the topsails, and sail made as fast
as she could bear it; and every time all hands were sent to the halyards a
song was called for, and we hoisted away with a will.
Sail after sail was added, as we drew into fine weather; and
in one week after leaving Cape Horn, the long top-gallant-masts were got
up, top-gallant and royal yards crossed, and the ship restored to her fair
proportions.
The Southern Cross and the Magellan Clouds settled lower and
lower in the horizon; and so great was our change of latitude that
each succeeding night we sank some constellation in the south, and raised
another in the northern horizon.
Sunday, July 31st. At noon we were in lat. 36° 41' S., lon.
38° 08' W.; having traversed the distance of two thousand miles, allowing for
changes of course, in nine days. A thousand miles in four days and a half!
This is equal to steam.
Soon after eight o'clock the appearance of the ship gave
evidence that this was the first Sunday we had yet had in fine weather.
As the sun came up clear, with the promise of a fair, warm day, and, as
usual on Sunday, there was no work going on, all hands turned-to upon
clearing out the forecastle. The wet and soiled clothes which had accumulated
there during the past month were brought up on deck; the chests moved;
brooms, buckets of water, swabs, scrubbing-brushes, and scrapers carried down
and applied, until the forecastle floor was as white as chalk, and
everything neat and in order. The bedding from the berths was then spread
on deck, and dried and aired; the deck-tub filled with water; and a grand
washing begun of all the clothes which were brought up. Shirts, frocks,
drawers, trousers, jackets, stockings, of every shape and color, wet and
dirty,—many of them mouldy from having been lying a long time wet in a foul
corner,—these were all washed and scrubbed out, and finally towed overboard
for half an hour; and then made fast in the rigging to dry. Wet boots
and shoes were spread out to dry in sunny places on deck; and the whole
ship looked like a back yard on a washing-day. After we had done with our
clothes, we began upon our persons. A little fresh water, which we had saved
from our allowance, was put in buckets, and, with soap and towels, we had
what sailors call a fresh-water wash. The same bucket, to be sure, had to go
through several hands, and was spoken for by one after another, but as we
rinsed off in salt water, pure from the ocean, and the fresh was used only
to start the accumulated grime and blackness of five weeks, it was held of
little consequence. We soaped down and scrubbed one another with towels and
pieces of canvas, stripping to it; and then, getting into the head, threw
buckets of water upon each other. After this came shaving, and combing, and
brushing; and when, having spent the first part of the day in this way, we
sat down on the forecastle, in the afternoon, with clean duck trousers and
shirts on, washed, shaved, and combed, and looking a dozen shades lighter for
it, reading, sewing, and talking at our ease, with a clear sky and warm sun
over our heads, a steady breeze over the larboard quarter, studding-sails out
alow and aloft, and all the flying kites abroad,—we felt that we had got
back into the pleasantest part of a sailor's life. At sunset the clothes
were all taken down from the rigging,—clean and dry,—and stowed neatly
away in our chests; and our southwesters, thick boots, Guernsey frocks, and
other accompaniments of bad weather, put out of the way, we hoped, for the
rest of the voyage, as we expected to come upon the coast early in the
autumn.
Notwithstanding all that has been said about the beauty of a
ship under full sail, there are very few who have ever seen a
ship, literally, under all her sail. A ship coming in or going out
of port, with her ordinary sails, and perhaps two or three studding-sails,
is commonly said to be under full sail; but a ship never has all her sail
upon her, except when she has a light, steady breeze, very nearly, but not
quite, dead aft, and so regular that it can be trusted, and is likely to last
for some time. Then, with all her sails, light and heavy,
and studding-sails, on each side, alow and aloft, she is the most glorious
moving object in the world. Such a sight very few, even some who have been at
sea a good deal, have ever beheld; for from the deck of your own vessel you
cannot see her, as you would a separate object.
One night, while we were in these tropics, I went out to the
end of the flying-jib-boom upon some duty, and, having finished it, turned
round, and lay over the boom for a long time, admiring the beauty of the
sight before me. Being so far out from the deck, I could look at the ship as
at a separate vessel; and there rose up from the water, supported only by the
small black hull, a pyramid of canvas, spreading out far beyond the hull, and
towering up almost, as it seemed in the indistinct night air, to the
clouds. The sea was as still as an inland lake; the light trade-wind
was gently and steadily breathing from astern; the dark blue sky
was studded with the tropical stars; there was no sound but the rippling
of the water under the stem; and the sails were spread out, wide and high,—
the two lower studding-sails stretching on each side far beyond the deck; the
topmast studding-sails like wings to the topsails; the top-gallant
studding-sails spreading fearlessly out above them; still higher, the two
royal studding-sails, looking like two kites flying from the same string;
and, highest of all, the little skysail, the apex of the pyramid, seeming
actually to touch the stars, and to be out of reach of human hand. So quiet,
too, was the sea, and so steady the breeze, that if these sails had been
sculptured marble they could not have been more motionless. Not a ripple upon
the surface of the canvas; not even a quivering of the extreme edges of the
sail, so perfectly were they distended by the breeze. I was so lost in the
sight that I forgot the presence of the man who came out with me, until he
said (for he, too, rough old man-of-war's-man as he was, had been gazing at
the show), half to himself, still looking at the marble sails,—``How
quietly they do their work!''
The fine weather brought work with it, as the ship was to be
put in order for coming into port. To give a landsman some notion of what
is done on board ship, it may be truly said that all the first part of a
passage is spent in getting a ship ready for sea, and the last part in
getting her ready for port. She is, as sailors say, like a lady's watch,
always out of repair. The new, strong sails, which we had up off Cape Horn,
were to be sent down, and the old set, which were still serviceable in fine
weather, to be bent in their place; all the rigging to be set up, fore
and aft; the masts stayed; the standing rigging to be tarred down; lower
and topmast rigging to be rattled down, fore and aft; the ship scraped inside
and out, and painted; decks varnished; new and neat knots, seizings and
coverings, to be fitted; and every part put in order, to look well to the
owner's eye, and to all critics, on coming into Boston. This, of course, was
a long matter; and all hands were kept on deck at work for the whole of each
day, during the rest of the voyage. Sailors call this hard usage; but the
ship must be in crack order; and ``We're homeward bound'' was the answer
to everything.
We went on for several days, employed in this way,
nothing remarkable occurring; and, at the latter part of the week, fell
in with the southeast trades, blowing about east-southeast, which brought
them nearly two points abaft our beam. They blew strong and steady, so that
we hardly started a rope, until we were beyond their latitude. The first day
of ``all hands'' one of those little incidents occurred, which are nothing in
themselves, but are great matters in the eyes of a ship's company, as they
serve to break the monotony of a voyage, and afford conversation to the crew
for days afterwards. These things, too, are often interesting, as
they show the customs and states of feeling on shipboard.
In merchant vessels, the captain gives his orders, as to
the ship's work, to the mate, in a general way, and leaves the execution
of them, with the particular ordering, to him. This has become so fixed a
custom that it is like a law, and is never infringed upon by a wise master,
unless his mate is no seaman; in which case the captain must often oversee
things for himself. This, however, could not be said of our chief mate, and
he was very jealous of any encroachment upon the borders of
his authority.
On Monday morning the captain told him to stay the fore
topmast plumb. He accordingly came forward, turned all hands to,
with tackles on the stays and backstays, coming up with the
seizings, hauling here, belaying there, and full of business,
standing between the knight-heads to sight the mast,—when the
captain came forward, and also began to give orders. This made
confusion, and the mate left his place and went aft, saying to the
captain:--
``If you come forward, sir, I'll go aft. One is enough on
the forecastle.''
This produced a reply, and another fierce answer; and the
words flew, fists were doubled up, and things looked
threateningly.
``I'm master of this ship.''
``Yes, sir, and I'm mate of her, and know my place! My place
is forward, and yours is aft.''
``My place is where I choose! I command the whole ship, and
you are mate only so long as I choose!''
``Say the word, Captain Thompson, and I'm done! I can do a
man's work aboard! I didn't come through the cabin windows! If I'm
not mate, I can be man,'' &c., &c.
This was all fun for us, who stood by, winking at each other,
and enjoying the contest between the higher powers. The captain took the
mate aft; and they had a long talk, which ended in the mate's returning to
his duty. The captain had broken through a custom, which is a part of the
common law of a ship, and without reason, for he knew that his mate was a
sailor, and needed no help from him; and the mate was excusable for being
angry. Yet, in strict law, he was wrong, and the captain right. Whatever the
captain does is right, ipso facto, and any opposition to it is wrong
on board ship; and every officer and man knows this when he signs
the ship's articles. It is a part of the contract. Yet there has grown up
in merchant vessels a series of customs, which have become a well-understood
system, and have somewhat the force of prescriptive law. To be sure, all
power is in the captain, and the officers hold their authority only during
his will, and the men are liable to be called upon for any service; yet, by
breaking in upon these usages, many difficulties have occurred on board
ship, and even come into courts of justice, which are
perfectly unintelligible to any one not acquainted with the universal
nature and force of these customs. Many a provocation has been
offered, and a system of petty oppression pursued towards men, the
force and meaning of which would appear as nothing to strangers,
and doubtless do appear so to many ``'long-shore'' juries and
judges.
The next little diversion was a battle on the forecastle,
one afternoon, between the mate and the steward. They had been on
bad terms the whole voyage, and had threatened a rupture several times.
Once, on the coast, the mate had seized the steward, when the steward
suddenly lowered his head, and pitched it straight into Mr. Brown's stomach,
butting him against the galley, grunting at every shove, and calling out
``You Brown!'' Mr. Brown looked white in the face, and the heaviest blows he
could give seemed to have no effect on the negro's head. He was pulled off by
the second mate, and Mr. Brown was going at him again, when the captain
separated them; and Mr. Brown told his tale to the captain, adding ``and,
moreover, he called me Brown!'' From this time ``moreover, he called me
Brown,'' became a by-word on board. Mr. Brown went aft, saying, ``I've
promised it to you, and now you've got it.'' But he did not seem to be sure
which had ``got it''; nor did we. We knew Mr. Brown would not leave the thing
in that equivocal position all the voyage, if he could help it.
This afternoon the mate asked the steward for a tumbler of water, and he
refused to get it for him, saying that he waited upon nobody but the captain;
and here he had the custom on his side. But, in answering, he committed the
unpardonable offence of leaving off the handle to the mate's name. This
enraged the mate, who called him a ``black soger,'' and at it they went,
clenching, striking, and rolling over and over; while we stood by, looking on
and enjoying the fun. The darkey tried to butt him, as before, but
the mate got him down, and held him, the steward singing out, ``Let me go,
Mr. Brown, or there'll be blood spilt!'' In the midst of this, the captain
came on deck, separated them, took the steward aft, and gave him half a dozen
with a rope's end. The steward tried to justify himself, but he had been
heard to talk of spilling blood, and that was enough to earn him his
flogging; and the captain did not choose to inquire any further. Mr. Brown
was satisfied to let him alone after that, as he had, on the whole,
vindicated his superiority in the eyes of the crew.
CHAPTER XXXIV
The same day, I met with one of those narrow escapes which are
so often happening in a sailor's life. I had been aloft nearly all the
afternoon, at work, standing for as much as an hour on the fore top-gallant
yard, which was hoisted up, and hung only by the tie; when, having got
through my work, I balled up my yarns, took my serving-board in my hand, laid
hold deliberately of the top-gallant rigging, took one foot from the yard,
and was just lifting the other, when the tie parted, and down the yard fell.
I was safe, by my hold upon the rigging, but it made my heart beat quick.
Had the tie parted one instant sooner, or had I stood an instant longer on
the yard, I should inevitably have been thrown violently from the height of
ninety or a hundred feet, overboard; or, what is worse, upon the deck.
However, ``a miss is as good as a mile''; a saying which sailors very often
have occasion to use. An escape is always a joke on board ship. A man would
be ridiculed who should make a serious matter of it. A sailor knows too
well that his life hangs upon a thread, to wish to be often reminded
of it; so, if a man has an escape, he keeps it to himself, or makes a joke
of it. I have often known a man's life to be saved by an instant of time, or
by the merest chance,—the swinging of a rope,—and no notice taken of it.
One of our boys, off Cape Horn, reefing topsails of a dark night when there
were no boats to be lowered away, and where, if a man fell overboard, he must
be left behind, lost his hold of the reef-point, slipped from
the foot-rope, and would have been in the water in a moment, when the man
who was next to him on the yard, French John, caught him by the collar of his
jacket, and hauled him up upon the yard, with, ``Hold on, another time, you
young monkey, and be d---d to you!''— and that was all that was heard about
it.
Sunday, August 7th. Lat. 25° 59' S., lon. 27° 0' W. Spoke
the English bark Mary Catherine, from Bahia, bound to Calcutta. This was
the first sail we had fallen in with, and the first time we had seen a human
form or heard the human voice, except of our own number, for nearly a hundred
days. The very yo-ho-ing of the sailors at the ropes sounded sociably upon
the ear. She was an old, damaged-looking craft, with a high poop and
top-gallant forecastle, and sawed off square, stem and stern, like a true
English ``tea-wagon,'' and with a run like a sugar-box. She
had studding-sails out alow and aloft, with a light but steady breeze, and
her captain said he could not get more than four knots out of her, and
thought he should have a long passage. We were going six on an easy
bowline.
The next day, about three P.M., passed a large
corvette-built ship, close upon the wind, with royals and skysails set fore
and aft, under English colors. She was standing south-by-east, probably
bound round Cape Horn. She had men in her tops, and black mast-heads; heavily
sparred, with sails cut to a t, and other marks of a man-of-war. She sailed
well, and presented a fine appearance; the proud, feudal-looking banner of
St. George—the cross in a blood-red field—waving from the mizzen. We
probably were nearly as fine a sight, with our studding-sails spread
far out beyond the ship on either side, and rising in a pyramid to royal
studding-sails and skysails, burying the hull in canvas and looking like what
the whalemen on the Banks, under their stump top-gallant-masts, call ``a Cape
Horn-er under a cloud of sail.''
Friday, August 12th. At daylight made the island of
Trinidad, situated in lat. 20° 28' S., lon. 29° 08' W. At twelve M.,
it bore N.W. 1/2 N., distant twenty-seven miles. It was a beautiful day,
the sea hardly ruffled by the light trades, and the island looking like a
small blue mound rising from a field of glass. Such a fair and
peaceful-looking spot is said to have been, for a long time, the resort of a
band of pirates, who ravaged the tropical seas.
Thursday, August 18th. At three P.M., made the island of
Fernando Naronha, lying in lat. 3° 55' S., lon. 32° 35' W.; and
between twelve o'clock Friday night and one o'clock Saturday
morning crossed the equator, for the fourth time since leaving Boston, in
lon. 35° W.; having been twenty-seven days from Staten Land,— a distance, by
the courses we had made, of more than four thousand miles.
We were now to the northward of the line, and every day added
to our latitude. The Magellan Clouds, the last sign of south latitude, had
long been sunk, and the North Star, the Great Bear, and the familiar signs of
northern latitudes, were rising in the heavens. Next to seeing land, there is
no sight which makes one realize more that he is drawing near home, than to
see the same heavens, under which he was born, shining at night over his
head. The weather was extremely hot, with the usual tropical alternations
of a scorching sun and squalls of rain; yet not a word was said in complaint
of the heat, for we all remembered that only three or four weeks before we
would have given our all to be where we now were. We had a plenty of water,
too, which we caught by spreading an awning, with shot thrown in to make
hollows. These rain squalls came up in the manner usual between the tropics.
A clear sky; burning, vertical sun; work going lazily on, and men about
decks with nothing but duck trousers, checked shirts, and straw hats; the
ship moving as lazily through the water; the man at the helm resting against
the wheel, with his hat drawn over his eyes; the captain below, taking an
afternoon nap; the passenger leaning over the taffrail, watching a dolphin
following slowly in our wake; the sailmaker mending an old topsail on the lee
side of the quarter-deck; the carpenter working at his bench, in
the waist; the boys making sinnet; the spun-yarn winch whizzing round and
round, and the men walking slowly fore and aft with the yarns. A cloud rises
to windward, looking a little black; the skysails are brailed down; the
captain puts his head out of the companion-way, looks at the cloud, comes up,
and begins to walk the deck. The cloud spreads and comes on; the tub of
yarns, the sail, and other matters, are thrown below, and the sky-light
and booby-hatch put on, and the slide drawn over the forecastle. ``Stand
by the royal halyards''; and the man at the wheel keeps a good weather helm,
so as not to be taken aback. The squall strikes her. If it is light, the
royal yards are clewed down, and the ship keeps on her way; but if the squall
takes strong hold, the royals are clewed up, fore and aft; light hands lay
aloft and furl them; top-gallant yards are clewed down, flying-jib hauled
down, and the ship kept off before it,—the man at the helm laying out
his strength to heave the wheel up to windward. At the same time
a drenching rain, which soaks one through in an instant. Yet no one puts
on a jacket or cap; for if it is only warm, a sailor does not mind a ducking;
and the sun will soon be out again. As soon as the force of the squall has
passed, though to a common eye the ship would seem to be in the midst of
it,—``Keep her up to her course again!''—``Keep her up, sir,''
(answer.)[1]—``Hoist away the top-gallant yards!''—``Run up the
flying-jib!''—``Lay aloft, you boys, and loose the royals!'' and all sail
is on her again before she is fairly out of the squall; and she is going on
in her course. The sun comes out once more, hotter than ever, dries up the
decks and the sailors' clothes; the hatches are taken off; the sail got up
and spread on the quarter-deck; spun-yarn winch set a whirling again; rigging
coiled up; captain goes below; and every sign of an interruption
disappears.
These scenes, with occasional dead calms, lasting for hours,
and sometimes for days, are fair specimens of the Atlantic tropics. The
nights were fine; and as we had all hands all day, the watch were allowed to
sleep on deck at night, except the man at the wheel, and one lookout on the
forecastle. This was not so much expressly allowed as winked at. We could do
it if we did not ask leave. If the lookout was caught napping, the whole
watch was kept awake. We made the most of this permission, and stowed
ourselves away upon the rigging, under the weather rail, on the spars,
under the windlass, and in all the snug corners; and frequently slept out
the watch, unless we had a wheel or a lookout. And we were glad enough to get
this rest; for under the ``all-hands'' system, out of every other thirty-six
hours we had only four below; and even an hour's sleep was a gain not to be
neglected. One would have thought so to have seen our watch some nights,
sleeping through a heavy rain. And often have we come on deck, and,
finding a dead calm and a light, steady rain, and determined not to
lose our sleep, have laid a coil of rigging down so as to keep us out of
the water which was washing about decks, and stowed ourselves away upon it,
covering a jacket over us, and slept as soundly as a Dutchman between two
feather-beds.
For a week or ten days after crossing the line, we had the
usual variety of calms, squalls, head winds, and fair winds,—at one time
braced sharp upon the wind, with a taut bowline, and in an hour after
slipping quietly along, with a light breeze over the taffrail, and
studding-sails set out on both sides,—until we fell in with the northeast
trade-winds; which we did on the afternoon of--
Sunday, August 28th, in lat. 12° N. The trade-wind clouds had
been in sight for a day or two previously, and we expected to take
the trades every hour. The light southerly breeze, which had
been breathing languidly during the first part of the day, died
away toward noon, and in its place came puffs from the northeast,
which caused us to take in our studding-sails and brace up; and, in
a couple of hours more, we were bowling gloriously along, dashing the
spray far ahead and to leeward, with the cool, steady northeast trades
freshening up the sea, and giving us as much as we could carry our royals to.
These winds blew strong and steady, keeping us generally upon a bowline, as
our course was about north-northwest; and, sometimes, as they veered a little
to the eastward, giving us a chance at a main top-gallant
studding-sail, and sending us well to the northward, until--
Sunday, September 4th, when they left us in lat. 22° N., lon.
51° W., directly under the tropic of Cancer.
For several days we lay ``humbugging about'' in the
Horse latitudes, with all sorts of winds and weather, and occasionally, as
we were in the latitude of the West Indies,—a thunder-storm. It was
hurricane month, too, and we were just in the track of the tremendous
hurricane of 1830, which swept the North Atlantic, destroying almost
everything before it.
The first night after the trade-winds left us, while we were
in the latitude of the island of Cuba, we had a specimen of a
true tropical thunder-storm. A light breeze had been blowing from
aft during the first part of the night, which gradually died away,
and before midnight it was dead calm, and a heavy black cloud had shrouded
the whole sky. When our watch came on deck at twelve o'clock, it was as black
as Erebus; the studding-sails were all taken in, and the royals furled; not a
breath was stirring; the sails hung heavy and motionless from the yards; and
the stillness and the darkness, which was almost palpable, were truly
appalling. Not a word was spoken, but every one stood as though waiting
for something to happen. In a few minutes the mate came forward, and in a
low tone, which was almost a whisper, told us to haul down the jib. The fore
and mizzen top-gallant sails were taken in in the same silent manner; and we
lay motionless upon the water, with an uneasy expectation, which, from the
long suspense, became actually painful. We could hear the captain walking the
deck, but it was too dark to see anything more than one's hand before
the face. Soon the mate came forward again, and gave an order, in a low
tone, to clew up the main top-gallant-sail; and so infectious was the awe and
silence that the clew-lines and buntlines were hauled up without any singing
out at the ropes. An English lad and myself went up to furl it; and we had
just got the bunt up, when the mate called out to us something, we did not
hear what,—but, supposing it to be an order to bear-a-hand, we hurried and
made all fast, and came down, feeling our way among the rigging. When we
got down we found all hands looking aloft, and there, directly over where we
had been standing, upon the main top-gallant mast-head, was a ball of light,
which the sailors call a corposant (corpus sancti), and which the mate had
called out to us to look at. They were all watching it carefully, for sailors
have a notion that if the corposant rises in the rigging it is a sign of
fair weather, but if it comes lower down there will be a
storm. Unfortunately, as an omen, it came down, and showed itself on
the top-gallant yard-arm. We were off the yard in good season, for it is
held a fatal sign to have the pale light of the corposant thrown upon one's
face. As it was, the English lad did not feel comfortably at having had it so
near him, and directly over his head. In a few minutes it disappeared, and
showed itself again on the fore top-gallant yard; and, after playing about
for some time, disappeared once more, when the man on the forecastle pointed
to it upon the flying-jib-boom-end. But our attention was drawn
from watching this, by the falling of some drops of rain, and by
a perceptible increase of the darkness, which seemed suddenly to add a new
shade of blackness to the night. In a few minutes, low, grumbling thunder was
heard, and some random flashes of lightning came from the southwest. Every
sail was taken in but the topsails; still, no squall appeared to be coming. A
few puffs lifted the topsails, but they fell again to the mast, and all was
as still as ever. A moment more, and a terrific flash and peal
broke simultaneously upon us, and a cloud appeared to open directly
over our heads, and let down the water in one body, like a falling ocean.
We stood motionless, and almost stupefied; yet nothing had been struck. Peal
after peal rattled over our heads, with a sound which seemed actually to stop
the breath in the body, and the ``speedy gleams'' kept the whole ocean in a
glare of light. The violent fall of rain lasted but a few minutes, and was
followed by occasional drops and showers; but the lightning
continued incessant for several hours, breaking the midnight darkness
with irregular and blinding flashes. During all this time there was not a
breath stirring, and we lay motionless, like a mark to be shot at, probably
the only object on the surface of the ocean for miles and miles. We stood
hour after hour, until our watch was out, and we were relieved, at four
o'clock. During all this time hardly a word was spoken; no bells were struck,
and the wheel was silently relieved. The rain fell at intervals in heavy
showers, and we stood drenched through and blinded by the flashes, which
broke the Egyptian darkness with a brightness that seemed almost
malignant; while the thunder rolled in peals, the concussion of
which appeared to shake the very ocean. A ship is not often injured
by lightning, for the electricity is separated by the great number
of points she presents, and the quantity of iron which she has scattered
in various parts. The electric fluid ran over our anchors, topsail sheets and
ties; yet no harm was done to us. We went below at four o'clock, leaving
things in the same state. It is not easy to sleep when the very next flash
may tear the ship in two, or set her on fire; or where the deathlike calm may
be broken by the blast of a hurricane, taking the masts out of the ship.
But a man is no sailor if he cannot sleep when he turns-in, and turn out
when he's called. And when, at seven bells, the customary ``All the larboard
watch, ahoy!'' brought us on deck, it was a fine, clear, sunny morning, the
ship going leisurely along, with a soft breeze and all sail set.
[1] A man at the wheel is required to repeat every order given
him. A simple ``Aye, aye, sir,'' is not enough there.
CHAPTER XXXV
From the latitude of the West Indies, until we got inside
the Bermudas, where we took the westerly and southwesterly winds, which
blow steadily off the coast of the United States early in the autumn, we had
every variety of weather, and two or three moderate gales, or, as sailors
call them, double-reef-topsail breezes, which came on in the usual manner,
and of which one is a specimen of all. A fine afternoon; all hands at work,
some in the rigging, and others on deck; a stiff breeze, and ship close
upon the wind, and skysails brailed down. Latter part of the
afternoon, breeze increases, ship lies over to it, and clouds look
windy. Spray begins to fly over the forecastle, and wets the yarns
the boys are knotting;—ball them up and put them below. Mate knocks off
work and clears up decks earlier than usual, and orders a man who has been
employed aloft to send the royal halyards over to windward, as he comes down.
Breast back-stays hauled taut, and a tackle got upon the martingale
back-rope. One of the boys furls the mizzen royal. Cook thinks there is going
to be ``nasty work,'' and has supper ready early. Mate gives orders to get
supper by the watch, instead of all hands, as usual. While eating supper,
hear the watch on deck taking in the royals. Coming on deck, find it
is blowing harder, and an ugly head sea running. Instead of having all
hands on the forecastle in the dog watch, smoking, singing, and telling
yarns, one watch goes below and turns-in, saying that it's going to be an
ugly night, and two hours' sleep is not to be lost. Clouds look black and
wild; wind rising, and ship working hard against a heavy head sea, which
breaks over the forecastle, and washes aft through the scuppers. Still, no
more sail is taken in, for the captain is a driver, and, like all drivers,
very partial to his top-gallant-sails. A top-gallant-sail, too, makes the
difference between a breeze and a gale. When a top-gallant-sail is on a ship,
it is only a breeze, though I have seen ours set over a reefed topsail, when
half the bowsprit was under water, and it was up to a man's knees in the lee
scuppers. At eight bells, nothing is said about reefing the topsails,
and the watch go below, with orders to ``stand by for a call.''
We turn-in, growling at the ``old man'' for not reefing the topsails when
the watch was changed, but putting it off so as to call all hands, and break
up a whole watch below—turn-in ``all standing,'' and keep ourselves awake,
saying there is no use in going to sleep to be waked up again. Wind whistles
on deck, and ship works hard, groaning and creaking, and pitching into a
heavy head sea, which strikes against the bows, with a noise like knocking
upon a rock. The dim lamp in the forecastle swings to and fro, and things
``fetch away'' and go over to leeward. ``Doesn't that booby of a second mate
ever mean to take in his top-gallant-sails? He'll have the sticks out of her
soon,'' says Old Bill, who was always growling, and, like most old sailors,
did not like to see a ship abused. By and by, an order is given; ``Aye,
aye, sir!'' from the forecastle; rigging is thrown down on deck; the noise of
a sail is heard fluttering aloft, and the short, quick cry which sailors make
when hauling upon clew-lines. ``Here comes his fore top-gallant-sail in!'' We
are wide awake, and know all that's going on as well as if we were on deck.
A well-known voice is heard from the mast-head singing out to the officer
of the watch to haul taut the weather brace. ``Hallo! There's Ben Stimson
aloft to furl the sail!'' Next thing, rigging is thrown down directly over
our heads, and a long-drawn cry and a rattling of hanks announce that the
flying-jib has come in. The second mate holds on to the main top-gallant-sail
until a heavy sea is shipped, and washes over the forecastle as though the
whole ocean had come aboard; when a noise further aft shows that
that sail, too, is taking in. After this the ship is more easy for a time;
two bells are struck, and we try to get a little sleep. By and by,—bang,
bang, bang, on the scuttle,—``All ha-a-ands, aho-o-y!'' We spring out of
our berths, clap on a monkey-jacket and southwester, and tumble up the
ladder. Mate up before us, and on the forecastle, singing out like a roaring
bull; the captain singing out on the quarter-deck, and the second mate
yelling, like a hyena, in the waist. The ship is lying over half upon
her beam-ends; lee scuppers under water, and forecastle all in a smother
of foam. Rigging all let go, and washing about decks; topsail yards down upon
the caps, and sails flapping and beating against the masts; and starboard
watch hauling out the reef-tackles of the main topsail. Our watch haul out
the fore, and lay aloft and put two reefs into it, and reef the foresail,
and race with the starboard watch to see which will mast-head its topsail
first. All hands tally-on to the main tack, and while some are furling the
jib and hoisting the staysail, we mizzen-top-men double-reef the mizzen
topsail and hoist it up. All being made fast,—``Go below, the watch!'' and
we turn-in to sleep out the rest of the time, which is perhaps an hour and a
half. During all the middle, and for the first part of the morning watch, it
blows as hard as ever, but toward daybreak it moderates considerably, and
we shake a reef out of each topsail, and set the top-gallant-sails over them;
and when the watch come up, at seven bells, for breakfast, shake the other
reefs out, turn all hands to upon the halyards, get the watch-tackle upon the
top-gallant sheets and halyards, set the flying-jib, and crack on to
her again.
Our captain had been married only a few weeks before he
left Boston, and, after an absence of over two years, it may be supposed
he was not slow in carrying sail. The mate, too, was not to be beaten by
anybody; and the second mate, though he was afraid to press sail, was still
more afraid of the captain, and, being between two fears, sometimes carried
on longer than any of them. We snapped off three flying-jib-booms in
twenty-four hours, as fast as they could be fitted and rigged out; sprung the
spritsail yard, and made nothing of studding-sail booms. Beside the
natural desire to get home, we had another reason for urging the ship
on. The scurvy had begun to show itself on board. One man had it so badly
as to be disabled and off duty, and the English lad, Ben, was in a dreadful
state, and was daily growing worse. His legs swelled and pained him so that
he could not walk; his flesh lost its elasticity, so that if pressed in it
would not return to its shape; and his gums swelled until he could not open
his mouth. His breath, too, became very offensive; he lost all strength
and spirit; could eat nothing; grew worse every day; and, in fact, unless
something was done for him, would be a dead man in a week, at the rate at
which he was sinking. The medicines were all, or nearly all, gone, and if we
had had a chest-full, they would have been of no use, for nothing but fresh
provisions and terra firma has any effect upon the scurvy. This disease is
not so common now as formerly, and is attributed generally to salt
provisions, want of cleanliness, the free use of grease and fat (which is
the reason of its prevalence among whalemen), and, last of all,
to laziness. It never could have been from the last cause on board our
ship; nor from the second, for we were a very cleanly crew, kept our
forecastle in neat order, and were more particular about washing and changing
clothes than many better-dressed people on shore. It was probably from having
none but salt provisions, and possibly from our having run very rapidly into
hot weather, after our having been so long in the extremest
cold.
Depending upon the westerly winds which prevail off the coast
in the autumn, the captain stood well to the westward, to run inside of
the Bermudas, and in the hope of falling in with some vessel bound to the
West Indies or the Southern States. The scurvy had spread no further among
the crew, but there was danger that it might; and these cases were bad
ones.
Sunday, September 11th. Lat. 30° 04' N., lon. 63° 23' W.;
the Bermudas bearing north-northwest, distant one hundred and fifty miles.
The next morning about ten o'clock, ``Sail ho!'' was cried on deck; and all
hands turned up to see the stranger. As she drew nearer, she proved to be an
ordinary-looking hermaphrodite brig, standing south-southeast, and probably
bound out from the Northern States to the West Indies, and was just
the thing we wished to see. She hove-to for us, seeing that we wished to
speak her, and we ran down to her, boom-ended our studding-sails, backed our
main topsail, and hailed her: ``Brig ahoy!'' ``Hallo!'' ``Where are you from,
pray?'' ``From New York, bound to Curaçoa.'' ``Have you any fresh provisions
to spare?'' ``Aye, aye! plenty of them!'' We lowered away the
quarter-boat instantly, and the captain and four hands sprang in, and were
soon dancing over the water and alongside the brig. In about half an hour
they returned with half a boat-load of potatoes and onions, and each vessel
filled away and kept on her course. She proved to be the brig Solon, of
Plymouth, from the Connecticut River, and last from New York, bound to the
Spanish Main, with a cargo of fresh provisions, mules, tin bake-pans, and
other notions. The onions were fresh; and the mate of the brig told the men
in the boat, as he passed the bunches over the side, that the girls
had strung them on purpose for us the day he sailed. We had made
the mistake, on board, of supposing that a new President had been chosen
the last winter, and, as we filled away, the captain hailed and asked who was
President of the United States. They answered, Andrew Jackson; but, thinking
that the old General could not have been elected for a third time, we hailed
again, and they answered, Jack Downing, and left us to correct the mistake at
our leisure.
Our boat's crew had a laugh upon one of our number, Joe, who
was vain and made the best show of everything. The style and gentility of
a ship and her crew depend upon the length and character of the voyage. An
India or China voyage always is the thing, and a voyage to the Northwest
coast (the Columbia River or Russian America) for furs is romantic and
mysterious, and if it takes the ship round the world, by way of the Islands
and China, it out-ranks them all. The grave, slab-sided mate of the schooner
leaned over the rail, and spoke to the men in our boat: ``Where are you
from?'' Joe answered up quick, ``From the Nor'west coast.'' ``What's
your cargo?'' This was a poser; but Joe was ready with an
equivoke. ``Skins,'' said he. ``Here and there a horn?'' asked the mate,
in the dryest manner. The boat's crew laughed out, and Joe's glory faded.
Apropos of this, a man named Sam, on board the Pilgrim, used to tell a story
of a mean little captain in a mean little brig, in which he sailed from
Liverpool to New York, who insisted on speaking a great, homeward-bound
Indiaman, with her studding-sails out on both sides, sunburnt men in
wide-brimmed hats on her decks, and a monkey and paroquet in her
rigging, ``rolling down from St. Helena.'' There was no need of
his stopping her to speak her, but his vanity led him to do it, and then
his meanness made him so awestruck that he seemed to quail. He called out, in
a small, lisping voice, ``What ship is that, pray?'' A deep-toned voice
roared through the trumpet, ``The Bashaw, from Canton, bound to Boston.
Hundred and ten days out! Where are you from?'' ``Only from Liverpool, sir,''
he lisped, in the most apologetic and subservient voice. But the humor will
be felt by those only who know the ritual of hailing at sea. No one says
``sir,'' and the ``only'' was wonderfully expressive.
It was just dinner-time when we filled away, and the
steward, taking a few bunches of onions for the cabin, gave the rest to
us, with a bottle of vinegar. We carried them forward, stowed them away in
the forecastle, refusing to have them cooked, and ate them raw, with our beef
and bread. And a glorious treat they were. The freshness and crispness of the
raw onion, with the earthy taste, give it a great relish to one who has been
a long time on salt provisions. We were ravenous after them. It was like a
scent of blood to a hound. We ate them at every meal, by the dozen,
and filled our pockets with them, to eat in our watch on deck; and
the bunches, rising in the form of a cone, from the largest at the bottom,
to the smallest, no larger than a strawberry, at the top, soon disappeared.
The chief use, however, of the fresh provisions, was for the men with the
scurvy. One of them was able to eat, and he soon brought himself to, by
gnawing upon raw potatoes and onions; but the other, by this time, was hardly
able to open his mouth, and the cook took the potatoes raw, pounded them in
a mortar, and gave him the juice to drink. This he swallowed, by
the teaspoonful at a time, and rinsed it about his gums and throat. The
strong earthy taste and smell of this extract of the raw potato at first
produced a shuddering through his whole frame, and, after drinking it, an
acute pain, which ran through all parts of his body; but knowing by this that
it was taking strong hold, he persevered, drinking a spoonful every hour or
so, and holding it a long time in his mouth, until, by the effect of this
drink, and of his own restored hope (for he had nearly given up
in despair), he became so well as to be able to move about, and open his
mouth enough to eat the raw potatoes and onions pounded into a soft pulp.
This course soon restored his appetite and strength, and in ten days after we
spoke the Solon, so rapid was his recovery that, from lying helpless and
almost hopeless in his berth, he was at the mast-head, furling a
royal.
With a fine southwest wind we passed inside of the Bermudas,
and, notwithstanding the old couplet, which was quoted again and again by
those who thought we should have one more touch of a storm before our long
absence,--
``If the Bermudas let you
pass, You must beware of Hatteras,''--
we were to the northward of Hatteras, with good weather,
and beginning to count, not the days, but the hours, to the time when we
should be at anchor in Boston harbor.
Our ship was in fine order, all hands having been hard at
work upon her, from daylight to dark, every day but Sunday from the time
we got into warm weather on this side the Cape.
It is a common notion with landsmen that a ship is in her
finest condition when she leaves port to enter upon her voyage, and
that she comes home, after a long absence,--
``With over-weathered ribs and ragged
sails; Lean, rent, and beggared by the strumpet
wind.''
But so far from that, unless a ship meets with some accident,
or comes upon the coast in the dead of winter, when work cannot be done
upon the rigging, she is in her finest order at the end of the voyage. When
she sails from port, her rigging is generally slack; the masts need staying;
the decks and sides are black and dirty from taking in cargo; riggers'
seizings and overhand knots in place of nice seamanlike work; and everything,
to a sailor's eye, adrift. But on the passage home the fine weather between
the tropics is spent in putting the ship in the neatest order. No merchant
vessel looks better than an Indiaman, or a Cape Horn-er, after a long voyage,
and captains and mates stake their reputation for seamanship upon the
appearance of their ships when they haul into the dock. All our standing
rigging, fore and aft, was set up and tarred, the masts stayed, the lower and
topmast rigging rattled down (or up, as the fashion now is); and so careful
were our officers to keep the ratlines taut and straight, that we
were obliged to go aloft upon the ropes and shearpoles with which
the rigging was swifted in; and these were used as jury ratlines until we
got close upon the coast. After this, the ship was scraped, inside and out,
decks, masts, booms, and all; a stage being rigged outside, upon which we
scraped her down to the water-line, pounding the rust off the chains, bolts,
and fastenings. Then, taking two days of calm under the line, we painted her
on the outside, giving her open ports in her streak, and finishing off the
nice work upon the stern, where sat Neptune in his car, holding his trident,
drawn by sea horses; and retouched the gilding and coloring of the cornucopia
which ornamented her billet-head. The inside was then painted, from the
skysail truck to the waterways,—the yards, black; mast-heads and tops,
white; monkey-rail, black, white, and yellow; bulwarks,
green; plank-shear, white; waterways, lead-color, &c., &c. The
anchors and ring-bolts, and other iron work, were blackened with
coal-tar; and the steward was kept at work, polishing the brass of
the wheel, bell, capstan, &c. The cabin, too, was scraped,
varnished, and painted; and the forecastle scraped and scrubbed, there
being no need of paint and varnish for Jack's quarters. The decks
were then scraped and varnished, and everything useless thrown overboard;
among which, the empty tar barrels were set on fire and thrown overboard, of
a dark night, and left blazing astern, lighting up the ocean for miles. Add
to all this labor the neat work upon the rigging,—the knots, flemish-eyes,
splices, seizings, coverings, pointings, and graffings which show a ship
in crack order. The last preparation, and which looked still more like
coming into port, was getting the anchors over the bows, bending the cables,
rowsing the hawsers up from between decks, and overhauling the deep-sea
lead-line.
Thursday, September 15th. This morning the temperature
and peculiar appearance of the water, the quantities of gulf-weed floating
about, and a bank of clouds lying directly before us, showed that we were on
the border of the Gulf Stream. This remarkable current, running northeast,
nearly across the ocean, is almost constantly shrouded in clouds and is the
region of storms and heavy seas. Vessels often run from a clear sky and light
wind, with all sail, at once into a heavy sea and cloudy sky,
with double-reefed topsails. A sailor told me that, on a passage
from Gibraltar to Boston, his vessel neared the Gulf Stream with a light
breeze, clear sky, and studding-sails out, alow and aloft; while before it
was a long line of heavy, black clouds, lying like a bank upon the water, and
a vessel coming out of it, under double-reefed topsails, and with royal yards
sent down. As they drew near, they began to take in sail after sail, until
they were reduced to the same condition; and, after twelve or fourteen
hours of rolling and pitching in a heavy sea, before a smart gale,
they ran out of the bank on the other side, and were in fine
weather again, and under their royals and skysails. As we drew into
it, the sky became cloudy, the sea high, and everything had the appearance
of the going off, or the coming on, of a storm. It was blowing no more than a
stiff breeze; yet the wind being northeast, which is directly against the
course of the current, made an ugly, chopping sea, which heaved and pitched
the vessel about, so that we were obliged to send down the royal yards, and
to take in our light sails. At noon, the thermometer, which had been
repeatedly lowered into the water, showed the temperature to be
seventy; which was considerably above that of the air,—as is always
the case in the centre of the Stream. A lad who had been at work at the
royal-mast-head came down upon deck, and took a turn round the long-boat;
and, looking pale, said he was so sick that he could stay aloft no longer,
but was ashamed to acknowledge it to the officer. He went up again, but soon
gave out and came down, and leaned over the rail, ``as sick as a lady
passenger.'' He had been to sea several years, and had, he said, never been
sick before. He was made so by the irregular pitching motion of the
vessel, increased by the height to which he had been above the hull,
which is like the fulcrum of the lever. An old sailor, who was at work on
the top-gallant yard, said he felt disagreeably all the time, and was glad,
when his job was done, to get down into the top, or upon deck. Another hand
was sent to the royal-mast-head, who stayed nearly an hour, but gave up. The
work must be done, and the mate sent me. I did very well for some time, but
began at length to feel very unpleasantly, though I never had been sick since
the first two days from Boston, and had been in all sorts of weather and
situations. Still, I kept my place, and did not come down, until I had got
through my work, which was more than two hours. The ship certainly never
acted so before. She was pitched and jerked about in all manner of ways; the
sails seeming to have no steadying power over her. The tapering points of the
masts made various curves against the sky overhead, and sometimes, in
one sweep of an instant, described an arc of more than forty-five degrees,
bringing up with a sudden jerk, which made it necessary to hold on with both
hands, and then sweeping off in another long, irregular curve. I was not
positively sick, and came down with a look of indifference, yet was not
unwilling to get upon the comparative terra firma of the deck. A few hours
more carried us through, and when we saw the sun go down, upon our larboard
beam, in the direction of the continent of North America, we had left the
banks of dark, stormy clouds astern, in the twilight.
CHAPTER XXXVI
Friday, September 16th. Lat. 38° N., lon. 69° 00' W. A
fine southwest wind; every hour carrying us nearer in toward the land. All
hands on deck at the dog watch, and nothing talked about but our getting in;
where we should make the land; whether we should arrive before Sunday; going
to church; how Boston would look; friends; wages paid; and the like. Every
one was in the best spirits; and, the voyage being nearly at an end, the
strictness of discipline was relaxed, for it was not necessary to order
in a cross tone what all were ready to do with a will. The differences and
quarrels which a long voyage breeds on board a ship were forgotten, and every
one was friendly; and two men, who had been on the eve of a fight half the
voyage, were laying out a plan together for a cruise on shore. When the mate
came forward, he talked to the men, and said we should be on George's Bank
before to-morrow noon; and joked with the boys, promising to go and see them,
and to take them down to Marblehead in a coach.
Saturday, 17th. The wind was light all day, which kept us
back somewhat; but a fine breeze springing up at nightfall, we
were running fast in toward the land. At six o'clock we expected to have
the ship hove-to for soundings, as a thick fog, coming up, showed we were
near them; but no order was given, and we kept on our way. Eight o'clock
came, and the watch went below, and, for the whole of the first hour the ship
was driving on, with studding-sails out, alow and aloft, and the night as
dark as a pocket. At two bells the captain came on deck, and said a word
to the mate, when the studding-sails were hauled into the tops,
or boom-ended, the after yards backed, the deep-sea-lead carried forward,
and everything got ready for sounding. A man on the spritsail yard with the
lead, another on the cat-head with a handful of the line coiled up, another
in the fore chains, another in the waist, and another in the main chains,
each with a quantity of the line coiled away in his hand. ``All ready there,
forward?''— ``Aye, aye, sir!''—``He-e-ave!''—``Watch! ho! watch!''
sings out the man on the spritsail yard, and the heavy lead drops into the
water. ``Watch! ho! watch!'' bawls the man on the cat-head, as the last fake
of the coil drops from his hand, and ``Watch! ho! watch!'' is shouted by each
one as the line falls from his hold, until it comes to the mate, who tends
the lead, and has the line in coils on the quarter-deck. Eighty fathoms and
no bottom! A depth as great as the height of St. Peters! The line is
snatched in a block upon the swifter, and three or four men haul it in
and coil it away. The after yards are braced full, the
studding-sails hauled out again, and in a few minutes more, the ship had
her whole way upon her. At four bells backed again, hove the lead,
and— soundings! at sixty fathoms! Hurrah for Yankee land! Hand over hand
we hauled the lead in, and the captain, taking it to the light, found black
mud on the bottom. Studding-sails taken in; after yards filled, and ship kept
on under easy sail all night, the wind dying away.
The soundings on the American coast are so regular that
a navigator knows as well where he has made land by the soundings, as he
would by seeing the land. Black mud is the soundings of Block Island. As you
go toward Nantucket, it changes to a dark sand; then, sand and white shells;
and on George's Banks, white sand; and so on. As our soundings showed us to
be off Block Island, our course was due east, to Nantucket Shoals and the
South Channel; but the wind died away and left us becalmed in a thick fog,
in which we lay the whole of Sunday. At noon of--
Sunday, 18th, Block Island bore, by calculation, N.W. 1/4 W.
fifteen miles; but the fog was so thick all day that we could see
nothing.
Having got through the ship's duty, and washed and changed
our clothes, we went below, and had a fine time overhauling our chests,
laying aside the clothes we meant to go ashore in, and throwing overboard all
that were worn out and good for nothing. Away went the woollen caps in which
we had carried hides upon our heads, for sixteen months, on the coast of
California; the duck frocks for tarring down rigging; and the worn-out and
darned mittens and patched woollen trousers which had stood the tug
of Cape Horn. We hove them overboard with a good will; for there
is nothing like being quit of the very last appendages, remnants,
and mementos of our hard fortune. We got our chests all ready for going
ashore; ate the last ``duff'' we expected to have on board the ship Alert;
and talked as confidently about matters on shore as though our anchor were on
the bottom.
``Who'll go to church with me a week from
to-day?''
``I will,'' says Jack; who said aye to
everything.
``Go away, salt water!'' says Tom. ``As soon as I get both
legs ashore, I'm going to shoe my heels, and button my ears behind me, and
start off into the bush, a straight course, and not stop till I'm out of the
sight of salt water!''
``Oh! belay that! If you get once moored, stem and stern, in
old Barnes's grog-shop, with a coal fire ahead and the bar under your lee,
you won't see daylight for three weeks!''
``No!'' says Tom, ``I'm going to knock off grog and go and
board at the Home, and see if they won't ship me for a deacon!''
``And I,'' says Bill, ``am going to buy a quadrant and ship
for navigator of a Hingham packet!''
Harry White swore he would take rooms at the Tremont House and
set up for a gentleman; he knew his wages would hold out for two weeks or
so.
These and the like served to pass the time while we were
lying waiting for a breeze to clear up the fog and send us on our
way.
Toward night a moderate breeze sprang up; the fog,
however, continuing as thick as before; and we kept on to the
eastward. About the middle of the first watch, a man on the forecastle
sang out, in a tone which showed that there was not a moment to be lost,—
``Hard up the helm!'' and a great ship loomed up out of the fog, coming
directly down upon us. She luffed at the same moment, and we just passed each
other, our spanker boom grazing over her quarter. The officer of the deck had
only time to hail, and she answered, as she went into the fog again,
something about Bristol. Probably a whaleman from Bristol, Rhode Island,
bound out. The fog continued through the night, with a very light breeze,
before which we ran to the eastward, literally feeling our way along. The
lead was heaved every two hours, and the gradual change from black mud to
sand showed that we were approaching Nantucket South Shoals. On Monday
morning, the increased depth and dark-blue color of the water, and the
mixture of shells and white sand which we brought up, upon sounding, showed
that we were in the channel, and nearing George's; accordingly, the ship's
head was put directly to the northward, and we stood on, with
perfect confidence in the soundings, though we had not taken
an observation for two days, nor seen land; and the difference of
an eighth of a mile out of the way might put us ashore. Throughout the day
a provokingly light wind prevailed, and at eight o'clock, a small fishing
schooner, which we passed, told us we were nearly abreast of Chatham lights.
Just before midnight, a light land-breeze sprang up, which carried us well
along; and at four o'clock, thinking ourselves to the northward of Race
Point, we hauled upon the wind and stood into the bay, west-northwest,
for Boston light, and began firing guns for a pilot. Our watch went below
at four o'clock, but could not sleep, for the watch on deck were banging away
at the guns every few minutes. And indeed, we cared very little about it, for
we were in Boston Bay; and if fortune favored us, we could all ``sleep in''
the next night, with nobody to call the watch every four hours.
We turned out, of our own will, at daybreak, to get a sight
of land. In the gray of the morning, one or two small fishing
smacks peered out of the mist; and when the broad day broke upon us, there
lay the low sand-hills of Cape Cod over our larboard quarter, and before us
the wide waters of Massachusetts Bay, with here and there a sail gliding over
its smooth surface. As we drew in toward the mouth of the harbor, as toward a
focus, the vessels began to multiply, until the bay seemed alive with sails
gliding about in all directions; some on the wind, and others before
it, as they were bound to or from the emporium of trade and centre of the
bay. It was a stirring sight for us, who had been months on the ocean without
seeing anything but two solitary sails; and over two years without seeing
more than the three or four traders on an almost desolate coast. There were
the little coasters, bound to and from the various towns along the south
shore, down in the bight of the bay, and to the eastward; here and there
a square-rigged vessel standing out to seaward; and, far in the distance,
beyond Cape Ann, was the smoke of a steamer, stretching along in a narrow
black cloud upon the water. Every sight was full of beauty and interest. We
were coming back to our homes; and the signs of civilization and prosperity
and happiness, from which we had been so long banished, were multiplying
about us. The high land of Cape Ann and the rocks and shore of Cohasset were
full in sight, the light-houses standing like sentries in white before
the harbors; and even the smoke from the chimneys on the plains of Hingham
was seen rising slowly in the morning air. One of our boys was the son of a
bucket-maker; and his face lighted up as he saw the tops of the well-known
hills which surround his native place. About ten o'clock a little boat came
bobbing over the water, and put a pilot on board, and sheered off in pursuit
of other vessels bound in. Being now within the scope of the telegraph
stations, our signals were run up at the fore; and in half an
hour afterwards, the owner on 'Change, or in his counting-room, knew that
his ship was below; and the landlords, runners, and sharks in Ann Street
learned that there was a rich prize for them down in the bay,—a ship from
round the Horn, with a crew to be paid off with two years'
wages.
The wind continuing very light, all hands were sent aloft to
strip off the chafing gear; and battens, parcellings, roundings,
hoops, mats, and leathers came flying from aloft, and left the
rigging neat and clean, stripped of all its sea bandaging. The last
touch was put to the vessel by painting the skysail poles; and I was sent
up to the fore, with a bucket of white paint and a brush, and touched her
off, from the truck to the eyes of the royal rigging. At noon we lay becalmed
off the lower light-house; and, it being about slack water, we made little
progress. A firing was heard in the direction of Hingham, and the pilot said
there was a review there. The Hingham boy got wind of this, and said if the
ship had been twelve hours sooner he should have been down among
the soldiers, and in the booths, and having a grand time. As it was, we
had little prospect of getting in before night. About two o'clock a breeze
sprang up ahead, from the westward, and we began beating up against it. A
full-rigged brig was beating in at the same time, and we passed each other in
our tacks, sometimes one and sometimes the other working to windward, as the
wind and tide favored or opposed. It was my trick at the wheel from two
till four; and I stood my last helm, making between nine hundred and
a thousand hours which I had spent at the helms of our two vessels. The
tide beginning to set against us, we made slow work; and the afternoon was
nearly spent before we got abreast of the inner light. In the meanwhile,
several vessels were coming down, outward bound; among which, a fine, large
ship, with yards squared, fair wind and fair tide, passed us like a
race-horse, the men running out upon her yards to rig out the studding-sail
booms. Toward sundown the wind came off in flaws, sometimes blowing very
stiff, so that the pilot took in the royals, and then it died away;
when, in order to get us in before the tide became too strong, the royals
were set again. As this kept us running up and down the rigging, one hand was
sent aloft at each mast-head, to stand by to loose and furl the sails at the
moment of the order. I took my place at the fore, and loosed and furled the
royal five times between Rainsford Island and the Castle. At one tack we ran
so near to Rainsford Island that, looking down from the royal yard, the
island, with its hospital buildings, nice gravelled walks, and green plats,
seemed to lie directly under our yard-arms. So close is the channel to some
of these islands, that we ran the end of our flying-jib-boom over one of the
outworks of the fortifications on George's Island; and had an opportunity of
seeing the advantages of that point as a fortified place; for, in working
up the channel, we presented a fair stem and stern, for raking, from the
batteries, three or four times. One gun might have knocked us to
pieces.
We had all set our hearts upon getting up to town before night
and going ashore, but the tide beginning to run strong against us, and the
wind, what there was of it, being ahead, we made but little by weather-bowing
the tide, and the pilot gave orders to cock-bill the anchor and overhaul the
chain. Making two long stretches, which brought us into the roads, under the
lee of the Castle, he clewed up the topsails, and let go the anchor; and for
the first time since leaving San Diego,—one hundred and thirty-five
days,— our anchor was upon bottom. In half an hour more, we were
lying snugly, with all sails furled, safe in Boston harbor; our
long voyage ended; the well-known scene about us; the dome of the
State House fading in the western sky; the lights of the city
starting into sight, as the darkness came on; and at nine o'clock
the clangor of the bells, ringing their accustomed peals; among which the
Boston boys tried to distinguish the well-known tone of the Old
South.
We had just done furling the sails, when a beautiful
little pleasure-boat luffed up into the wind, under our quarter, and
the junior partner of the firm to which our ship belonged, Mr.
Hooper, jumped on board. I saw him from the mizzen-topsail yard, and
knew him well. He shook the captain by the hand, and went down into
the cabin, and in a few minutes came up and inquired of the mate for me.
The last time I had seen him I was in the uniform of an undergraduate of
Harvard College, and now, to his astonishment, there came down from aloft a
``rough alley'' looking fellow, with duck trousers and red shirt, long hair,
and face burnt as dark as an Indian's. We shook hands, and he congratulated
me upon my return and my appearance of health and strength, and said that
my friends were all well. He had seen some of my family a few days before.
I thanked him for telling me what I should not have dared to ask; and
if--
``The first bringer of unwelcome
news Hath but a losing office; and his
tongue Sounds ever after like a sullen
bell,''--
certainly I ought ever to remember this gentleman and his
words with pleasure.
The captain went up to town in the boat with Mr. Hooper, and
left us to pass another night on board ship, and to come up with
the morning's tide under command of the pilot.
So much did we feel ourselves to be already at home,
in anticipation, that our plain supper of hard bread and salt beef was
barely touched; and many on board, to whom this was the first voyage, could
scarcely sleep. As for myself, by one of those anomalous changes of feeling
of which we are all the subjects, I found that I was in a state of
indifference for which I could by no means account. A year before, while
carrying hides on the coast, the assurance that in a twelvemonth we should
see Boston made me half wild; but now that I was actually there, and in
sight of home, the emotions which I had so long anticipated feeling I did
not find, and in their place was a state of very nearly entire apathy.
Something of the same experience was related to me by a sailor whose first
voyage was one of five years upon the Northwest Coast. He had left home a
lad, and when, after so many years of hard and trying experience, he found
himself homeward bound, such was the excitement of his feelings that, during
the whole passage, he could talk and think of nothing else but his arrival,
and how and when he should jump from the vessel and take his way
directly home. Yet, when the vessel was made fast to the wharf and the
crew dismissed, he seemed suddenly to lose all feeling about the matter.
He told me that he went below and changed his dress; took some water from the
scuttle-butt and washed himself leisurely; overhauled his chest, and put his
clothes all in order; took his pipe from its place, filled it, and, sitting
down upon his chest, smoked it slowly for the last time. Here he looked round
upon the forecastle in which he had spent so many years, and being
alone and his shipmates scattered, began to feel actually unhappy.
Home became almost a dream; and it was not until his brother (who
had heard of the ship's arrival) came down into the forecastle and told
him of things at home, and who were waiting there to see him, that he could
realize where he was, and feel interest enough to put him in motion toward
that place for which he had longed, and of which he had dreamed, for years.
There is probably so much of excitement in prolonged expectation that the
quiet realizing of it produces a momentary stagnation of feeling as well as
of effort. It was a good deal so with me. The activity of preparation,
the rapid progress of the ship, the first making land, the coming up the
harbor, and old scenes breaking upon the view, produced a mental as well as
bodily activity, from which the change to a perfect stillness, when both
expectation and the necessity of labor failed, left a calmness, almost an
indifference, from which I must be roused by some new excitement. And the
next morning, when all hands were called, and we were busily at work,
clearing the decks, and getting everything in readiness for going up to
the wharves,—loading the guns for a salute, loosing the sails,
and manning the windlass,—mind and body seemed to wake
together.
About ten o'clock a sea-breeze sprang up, and the pilot
gave orders to get the ship under way. All hands manned the windlass, and
the long-drawn ``Yo, heave, ho!'' which we had last heard dying away among
the desolate hills of San Diego, soon brought the anchor to the bows; and,
with a fair wind and tide, a bright sunny morning, royals and skysails set,
ensign, streamer, signals, and pennant flying, and with our guns firing, we
came swiftly and handsomely up to the city. Off the end of the wharf,
we rounded-to, and let go our anchor; and no sooner was it on the bottom
than the decks were filled with people: custom-house officers; Topliff's
agent, to inquire for news; others, inquiring for friends on board, or left
upon the coast; dealers in grease, besieging the galley to make a bargain
with the cook for his slush; ``loafers'' in general; and, last and chief,
boarding-house runners, to secure their men. Nothing can exceed the
obliging disposition of these runners, and the interest they take in
a sailor returned from a long voyage with a plenty of money. Two or three
of them, at different times, took me by the hand; pretended to remember me
perfectly; were quite sure I had boarded with them before I sailed; were
delighted to see me back; gave me their cards; had a hand-cart waiting on the
wharf, on purpose to take my things up; would lend me a hand to get my chest
ashore; bring a bottle of grog on board if we did not haul in immediately;
and the like. In fact, we could hardly get clear of them to go aloft
and furl the sails. Sail after sail, for the hundredth time, in
fair weather and in foul, we furled now for the last time together,
and came down and took the warp ashore, manned the capstan, and with
a chorus which waked up half North End, and rang among the buildings in
the dock, we hauled her in to the wharf.[1] The city bells were just ringing
one when the last turn was made fast and the crew dismissed; and in five
minutes more not a soul was left on board the good ship Alert but the old
ship-keeper, who had come down from the counting-house to take charge of
her.
[1] [Sept. 21, 1836.]
TWENTY-FOUR YEARS AFTER
It was in the winter of 1835-6 that the ship Alert, in
the prosecution of her voyage for hides on the remote and almost unknown
coast of California, floated into the vast solitude of the Bay of San
Francisco. All around was the stillness of nature. One vessel, a Russian, lay
at anchor there, but during our whole stay not a sail came or went. Our trade
was with remote Missions, which sent hides to us in launches manned by their
Indians. Our anchorage was between a small island, called Yerba Buena, and
a gravel beach in a little bight or cove of the same name, formed by two
small, projecting points. Beyond, to the westward of the landing-place, were
dreary sand-hills, with little grass to be seen, and few trees, and beyond
them higher hills, steep and barren, their sides gullied by the rains. Some
five or six miles beyond the landing-place, to the right, was a ruinous
Presidio, and some three or four miles to the left was the Mission
of Dolores, as ruinous as the Presidio, almost deserted, with but
few Indians attached to it, and but little property in cattle. Over
a region far beyond our sight there were no other human
habitations, except that an enterprising Yankee, years in advance of his
time, had put up, on the rising ground above the landing, a shanty
of rough boards, where he carried on a very small retail trade between the
hide ships and the Indians. Vast banks of fog, invading us from the North
Pacific, drove in through the entrance, and covered the whole bay; and when
they disappeared, we saw a few well-wooded islands, the sand-hills on the
west, the grassy and wooded slopes on the east, and the vast stretch of the
bay to the southward, where we were told lay the Missions of Santa Clara
and San José, and still longer stretches to the northward
and northeastward, where we understood smaller bays spread out, and large
rivers poured in their tributes of waters. There were no settlements on these
bays or rivers, and the few ranchos and Missions were remote and widely
separated. Not only the neighborhood of our anchorage, but the entire region
of the great bay, was a solitude. On the whole coast of California there
was not a light-house, a beacon, or a buoy, and the charts were made up
from old and disconnected surveys by British, Russian, and Mexican voyagers.
Birds of prey and passage swooped and dived about us, wild beasts ranged
through the oak groves, and as we slowly floated out of the harbor with the
tide, herds of deer came to the water's edge, on the northerly side of the
entrance, to gaze at the strange spectacle.
On the evening of Saturday, the 13th of August, 1859, the
superb steamship Golden Gate, gay with crowds of passengers, and
lighting the sea for miles around with the glare of her signal lights
of red, green, and white, and brilliant with lighted saloons
and staterooms, bound up from the Isthmus of Panama, neared the entrance
to San Francisco, the great centre of a world-wide commerce. Miles out at
sea, on the desolate rocks of the Farallones, gleamed the powerful rays of
one of the most costly and effective light-houses in the world. As we drew in
through the Golden Gate, another light-house met our eyes, and in the
clear moonlight of the unbroken California summer we saw, on the right, a
large fortification protecting the narrow entrance, and just before us the
little island of Alcatraz confronted us,—one entire fortress. We bore round
the point toward the old anchoring-ground of the hide ships, and there,
covering the sand-hills and the valleys, stretching from the water's edge
to the base of the great hills, and from the old Presidio to the Mission,
flickering all over with the lamps of its streets and houses, lay a city of
one hundred thousand inhabitants. Clocks tolled the hour of midnight from its
steeples, but the city was alive from the salute of our guns, spreading the
news that the fortnightly steamer had come, bringing mails and passengers
from the Atlantic world. Clipper ships of the largest size lay at anchor
in the stream, or were girt to the wharves; and capacious high-pressure
steamers, as large and showy as those of the Hudson or Mississippi, bodies of
dazzling light, awaited the delivery of our mails to take their courses up
the Bay, stopping at Benicia and the United States Naval Station, and then up
the great tributaries—the Sacramento, San Joaquin, and Feather Rivers—
to the far inland cities of Sacramento, Stockton, and
Marysville.
The dock into which we drew, and the streets about it,
were densely crowded with express wagons and hand-carts to take luggage,
coaches and cabs for passengers, and with men,—some looking out for friends
among our hundreds of passengers,—agents of the press, and a greater
multitude eager for newspapers and verbal intelligence from the great
Atlantic and European world. Through this crowd I made my way, along the
well-built and well-lighted streets, as alive as by day, where boys in
high-keyed voices were already crying the latest New York papers; and
between one and two o'clock in the morning found myself comfortably
abed in a commodious room, in the Oriental Hotel, which stood, as well as
I could learn, on the filled-up cove, and not far from the spot where we used
to beach our boats from the Alert.
Sunday, August 14th. When I awoke in the morning, and looked
from my windows over the city of San Francisco, with its
storehouses, towers, and steeples; its court-houses, theatres, and
hospitals; its daily journals; its well-filled learned professions;
its fortresses and light-houses; its wharves and harbor, with
their thousand-ton clipper ships, more in number than London or Liverpool
sheltered that day, itself one of the capitals of the American Republic, and
the sole emporium of a new world, the awakened Pacific; when I looked across
the bay to the eastward, and beheld a beautiful town on the fertile, wooded
shores of the Contra Costa, and steamers, large and small, the ferryboats to
the Contra Costa, and capacious freighters and passenger-carriers to all
parts of the great bay and its tributaries, with lines of their smoke in the
horizon,—when I saw all these things, and reflected on what I once was and
saw here, and what now surrounded me, I could scarcely keep my hold on
reality at all, or the genuineness of anything, and seemed to myself like one
who had moved in ``worlds not realized.''
I could not complain that I had not a choice of places of
worship. The Roman Catholics have an archbishop, a cathedral, and five
or six smaller churches, French, German, Spanish, and English; and the
Episcopalians a bishop, a cathedral, and three other churches; the Methodists
and Presbyterians have three or four each, and there are Congregationalists,
Baptists, a Unitarian, and other societies. On my way to church, I met two
classmates of mine at Harvard standing in a door-way, one a lawyer and the
other a teacher, and made appointments for a future meeting. A
little farther on I came upon another Harvard man, a fine scholar and wit,
and full of cleverness and good-humor, who invited me to go to breakfast with
him at the French house,—he was a bachelor, and a late riser on Sundays. I
asked him to show me the way to Bishop Kip's church. He hesitated, looked a
little confused, and admitted that he was not as well up in certain classes
of knowledge as in others, but, by a desperate guess, pointed out a wooden
building at the foot of the street, which any one might have seen could not
be right, and which turned out to be an African Baptist meeting-house. But my
friend had many capital points of character, and I owed much of the pleasure
of my visit to his attentions.
The congregation at the Bishop's church was precisely like one
you would meet in New York, Philadelphia, or Boston. To be sure,
the identity of the service makes one feel at once at home, but the people
were alike, nearly all of the English race, though from all parts of the
Union. The latest French bonnets were at the head of the chief pews, and
business men at the foot. The music was without character, but there was an
instructive sermon, and the church was full.
I found that there were no services at any of the
Protestant churches in the afternoon. They have two services on Sunday; at
11 A.M., and after dark. The afternoon is spent at home, or in friendly
visiting, or teaching of Sunday Schools, or other humane and social
duties.
This is as much the practice with what at home are called
the strictest denominations as with any others. Indeed, I
found individuals, as well as public bodies, affected in a marked
degree by a change of oceans and by California life. One Sunday
afternoon I was surprised at receiving the card of a man whom I had
last known, some fifteen years ago, as a strict and formal deacon of
a Congregational Society in New England. He was a deacon still, in San
Francisco, a leader in all pious works, devoted to his denomination and to
total abstinence,—the same internally, but externally—what a change! Gone
was the downcast eye, the bated breath, the solemn, non-natural voice, the
watchful gait, stepping as if he felt responsible for the balance of the
moral universe! He walked with a stride, an uplifted open countenance, his
face covered with beard, whiskers, and mustache, his voice strong
and natural,—and, in short, he had put off the New England deacon and
become a human being. In a visit of an hour I learned much from him about the
religious societies, the moral reforms, the ``Dashaways,''—total abstinence
societies, which had taken strong hold on the young and wilder parts of
society,—and then of the Vigilance Committee, of which he was a member, and
of more secular points of interest.
In one of the parlors of the hotel, I saw a man of about
sixty years of age, with his feet bandaged and resting in a chair,
whom somebody addressed by the name of Lies.[1] Lies! thought I, that must
be the man who came across the country from Kentucky to Monterey while we lay
there in the Pilgrim in 1835, and made a passage in the Alert, when he used
to shoot with his rifle bottles hung from the top-gallant
studding-sail-boom-ends. He married the beautiful Doña Rosalía Vallejo,
sister of Don Guadalupe. There were the old high features and sandy hair. I
put my chair beside him, and began conversation, as any one may do in
California. Yes, he was the Mr. Lies; and when I gave my name he professed at
once to remember me, and spoke of my book. I found that almost—I might
perhaps say quite—every American in California had read it; for when
California ``broke out,'' as the phrase is, in 1848, and so large a portion
of the Anglo-Saxon race flocked to it, there was no book upon California but
mine. Many who were on the coast at the time the book refers to, and
afterwards read it, and remembered the Pilgrim and Alert, thought they also
remembered me. But perhaps more did remember me than I was inclined at first
to believe, for the novelty of a collegian coming out before the mast had
drawn more attention to me than I was aware of at the time.
Late in the afternoon, as there were vespers at the Roman
Catholic churches, I went to that of Notre Dame des Victoires.
The congregation was French, and a sermon in French was preached by
an Abbé; the music was excellent, all things airy and tasteful, and making
one feel as if in one of the chapels in Paris. The Cathedral of St. Mary,
which I afterwards visited, where the Irish attend, was a contrast indeed,
and more like one of our stifling Irish Catholic churches in Boston or New
York, with intelligence in so small a proportion to the number of faces.
During the three Sundays I was in San Francisco, I visited three of the
Episcopal churches, and the Congregational, a Chinese Mission Chapel, and
on the Sabbath (Saturday) a Jewish synagogue. The Jews are a wealthy and
powerful class here. The Chinese, too, are numerous, and do a great part of
the manual labor and small shop-keeping, and have some wealthy mercantile
houses.
It is noticeable that European Continental fashions
prevail generally in this city,—French cooking, lunch at noon,
and dinner at the end of the day, with café noir after meals, and to
a great extent the European Sunday,—to all which emigrants from the
United States and Great Britain seem to adapt themselves. Some dinners which
were given to me at French restaurants were, it seemed to me,—a poor judge
of such matters, to be sure,—as sumptuous and as good, in dishes and wines,
as I have found in Paris. But I had a relish-maker which my friends at table
did not suspect,—the remembrance of the forecastle dinners I ate
here twenty-four years before.
August 17th. The customs of California are free; and any
person who knows about my book speaks to me. The newspapers have announced
the arrival of the veteran pioneer of all. I hardly walk out without meeting
or making acquaintances. I have already been invited to deliver the
anniversary oration before the Pioneer Society, to celebrate the settlement
of San Francisco. Any man is qualified for election into this society who
came to California before 1853. What moderns they are! I tell them of the
time when Richardson's shanty of 1835—not his adobe house of 1836—
was the only human habitation between the Mission and the Presidio, and
when the vast bay, with all its tributaries and recesses, was a solitude,—
and yet I am but little past forty years of age. They point out the place
where Richardson's adobe house stood, and tell me that the first court and
first town council were convened in it, the first Protestant worship
performed in it, and in it the first capital trial by the Vigilance Committee
held. I am taken down to the wharves, by antiquaries of a ten or twelve
years' range, to identify the two points, now known as Clark's and Rincon,
which formed the little cove of Yerba Buena, where we used to beach our
boats,—now filled up and built upon. The island we called ``Wood Island,''
where we spent the cold days and nights of December, in our launch, getting
wood for our year's supply, is clean shorn of trees; and the bare rocks of
Alcatraz Island, an entire fortress. I have looked at the city from the
water, and at the water and islands from the city, but I can see nothing
that recalls the times gone by, except the venerable Mission, the ruinous
Presidio, the high hills in the rear of the town, and the great stretches of
the bay in all directions.
To-day I took a California horse of the old style,—the run,
the loping gait,—and visited the Presidio. The walls stand as they did,
with some changes made to accommodate a small garrison of United States
troops. It has a noble situation, and I saw from it a clipper ship of the
very largest class, coming through the Gate, under her fore-and-aft sails.
Thence I rode to the Fort, now nearly finished, on the southern shore of the
Gate, and made an inspection of it. It is very expensive and of the latest
style. One of the engineers here is Custis Lee, who has just left
West Point at the head of his class,—a son of Colonel Robert E. Lee, who
distinguished himself in the Mexican War.[2]
Another morning I ride to the Mission Dolores. It has a
strangely solitary aspect, enhanced by its surroundings of the
most uncongenial, rapidly growing modernisms; the hoar of ages surrounded
by the brightest, slightest, and rapidest of modern growths. Its old belfries
still clanged with the discordant bells, and Mass was saying within, for it
is used as a place of worship for the extreme south part of the
city.
In one of my walks about the wharves, I found a pile of dry
hides lying by the side of a vessel. Here was something to
feelingly persuade me what I had been, to recall a past scarce credible
to myself. I stood lost in reflection. What were these hides—what were
they not?—to us, to me, a boy, twenty-four years ago? These were our
constant labor, our chief object, our almost habitual thought. They brought
us out here, they kept us here, and it was only by getting them that we could
escape from the coast and return to home and civilized life. If it had not
been that I might be seen, I should have seized one, slung it over my head,
walked off with it, and thrown it by the old toss—I do not believe yet a
lost art—to the ground. How they called up to my mind the months of curing
at San Diego, the year and more of beach and surf work, and the steeving of
the ship for home! I was in a dream of San Diego, San Pedro,—with its hill
so steep for taking up goods, and its stones so hard to our bare feet,—and
the cliffs of San Juan! All this, too, is no more! The entire
hide-business is of the past, and to the present inhabitants of California a
dim tradition. The gold discoveries drew off all men from the gathering or
cure of hides, the inflowing population made an end of the great droves of
cattle; and now not a vessel pursues the— I was about to say dear—the
dreary, once hated business of gathering hides upon the coast, and the beach
of San Diego is abandoned and its hide-houses have disappeared. Meeting
a respectable-looking citizen on the wharf, I inquired of him how the
hide-trade was carried on. ``O,'' said he, ``there is very little of it, and
that is all here. The few that are brought in are placed under sheds in
winter, or left out on the wharf in summer, and are loaded from the wharves
into the vessels alongside. They form parts of cargoes of other materials.''
I really felt too much, at the instant, to express to him the cause of my
interest in the subject, and only added, ``Then the old business of trading
up and down the coast and curing hides for cargoes is all over?'' ``O yes,
sir,'' said he, ``those old times of the Pilgrim and Alert and California,
that we read about, are gone by.''
Saturday, August 20th. The steamer Senator makes regular trips
up and down the coast, between San Francisco and San Diego, calling at
intermediate ports. This is my opportunity to revisit the old scenes. She
sails to-day, and I am off, steaming among the great clippers anchored in the
harbor, and gliding rapidly round the point, past Alcatraz Island, the
light-house, and through the fortified Golden Gate, and bending to the
southward,—all done in two or three hours, which, in the Alert, under
canvas, with head tides, variable winds, and sweeping currents to deal with,
took us full two days.
Among the passengers I noticed an elderly gentleman, thin,
with sandy hair and a face that seemed familiar. He took off his glove and
showed one shrivelled hand. It must be he! I went to him and said, ``Captain
Wilson, I believe.'' Yes, that was his name. ``I knew you, sir, when you
commanded the Ayacucho on this coast, in old hide-droghing times, in
1835-6.'' He was quickened by this, and at once inquiries were made on each
side, and we were in full talk about the Pilgrim and Alert, Ayacucho and
Loriotte, the California and Lagoda. I found he had been very much flattered
by the praise I had bestowed in my book on his seamanship, especially in
bringing the Pilgrim to her berth in San Diego harbor, after she had
drifted successively into the Lagoda and Loriotte, and was coming into
him. I had made a pet of his brig, the Ayacucho, which pleased him
almost as much as my remembrance of his bride and their wedding, which I
saw at Santa Barbara in 1836. Doña Ramona was now the mother of a large
family, and Wilson assured me that if I would visit him at his rancho, near
San Luis Obispo, I should find her still a handsome woman, and very glad to
see me. How we walked the deck together, hour after hour, talking over the
old times,—the ships, the captains, the crews, the traders on shore, the
ladies, the Missions, the southeasters! indeed, where could we stop? He had
sold the Ayacucho in Chili for a vessel of war, and had given up the
sea, and had been for years a ranchero. (I learned from others that he had
become one of the most wealthy and respectable farmers in the State, and that
his rancho was well worth visiting.) Thompson, he said, hadn't the sailor in
him; and he never could laugh enough at his fiasco in San Diego, and his
reception by Bradshaw. Faucon was a sailor and a navigator. He did not know
what had become of George Marsh (ante, pp. 255-258), except that he left him
in Callao; nor could he tell me anything of handsome Bill Jackson (ante, p.
104), nor of Captain Nye of the Loriotte. I told him all I then knew of
the ships, the masters, and the officers. I found he had kept some run of my
history, and needed little information. Old Señor Noriego of Santa Barbara,
he told me, was dead, and Don Carlos and Don Santiago, but I should find
their children there, now in middle life. Doña Angustias, he said, I had made
famous by my praises of her beauty and dancing, and I should have from her
a royal reception. She had been a widow, and remarried since, and had a
daughter as handsome as herself. The descendants of Noriego had taken the
ancestral name of De la Guerra, as they were nobles of Old Spain by birth;
and the boy Pablo, who used to make passages in the Alert, was now Don Pablo
de la Guerra, a Senator in the State Legislature for Santa Barbara
County.
The points in the country, too, we noticed, as we passed
them,— Santa Cruz, San Luis Obispo, Point Año Nuevo, the opening
to Monterey, which to my disappointment we did not visit. No; Monterey,
the prettiest town on the coast, and its capital and seat of customs, had got
no advantage from the great changes, was out of the way of commerce and of
the travel to the mines and great rivers, and was not worth stopping at.
Point Conception we passed in the night, a cheery light gleaming over the
waters from its tall light-house, standing on its outermost peak.
Point Conception! That word was enough to recall all our experiences
and dreads of gales, swept decks, topmast carried away, and the hardships
of a coast service in the winter. But Captain Wilson tells me that the
climate has altered; that the southeasters are no longer the bane of the
coast they once were, and that vessels now anchor inside the kelp at Santa
Barbara and San Pedro all the year round. I should have thought this owing to
his spending his winters on a rancho instead of the deck of the Ayacucho, had
not the same thing been told me by others.
Passing round Point Conception, and steering easterly, we
opened the islands that form, with the main-land, the canal of
Santa Barbara. There they are, Santa Cruz and Santa Rosa; and there is the
beautiful point, Santa Buenaventura; and there lies Santa Barbara on its
plain, with its amphitheatre of high hills and distant mountains. There is
the old white Mission with its belfries, and there the town, with its
one-story adobe houses, with here and there a two-story wooden house of later
build; yet little is it altered,—the same repose in the golden sunlight
and glorious climate, sheltered by its hills; and then, more
remindful than anything else, there roars and tumbles upon the beach
the same grand surf of the great Pacific as on the beautiful day when the
Pilgrim, after her five months' voyage, dropped her weary anchors here; the
same bright blue ocean, and the surf making just the same monotonous,
melancholy roar, and the same dreamy town, and gleaming white Mission, as
when we beached our boats for the first time, riding over the breakers with
shouting Kanakas, the three small hide-traders lying at anchor in the offing.
But now we are the only vessel, and that an unromantic, sail-less,
spar-less, engine-driven hulk!
I landed in the surf, in the old style, but it was not high
enough to excite us, the only change being that I was
somehow unaccountably a passenger, and did not have to jump overboard
and steady the boat, and run her up by the gunwales.
Santa Barbara has gained but little. I should not know,
from anything I saw, that she was now a seaport of the United States,
a part of the enterprising Yankee nation, and not still a lifeless Mexican
town. At the same old house, where Señor Noriego lived, on the piazza in
front of the court-yard, where was the gay scene of the marriage of our
agent, Mr. Robinson, to Doña Anita, where Don Juan Bandini and Doña Angustias
danced, Don Pablo de la Guerra received me in a courtly fashion. I passed the
day with the family, and in walking about the place; and ate the old
dinner with its accompaniments of fríjoles, native olives and grapes,
and native wines. In due time I paid my respects to Doña Angustias, and,
notwithstanding what Wilson told me, I could hardly believe that after
twenty-four years there would still be so much of the enchanting woman about
her. She thanked me for the kind and, as she called them, greatly exaggerated
compliments I had paid her; and her daughter told me that all travellers who
came to Santa Barbara called to see her mother, and that she herself
never expected to live long enough to be a belle.
Mr. Alfred Robinson, our agent in 1835-6, was here, with a
part of his family. I did not know how he would receive me,
remembering what I had printed to the world about him at a time when I
took little thought that the world was going to read it; but there was no
sign of offence, only a cordiality which gave him, as between us, rather the
advantage in status.
The people of this region are giving attention to
sheep-raising, wine-making, and the raising of olives, just enough to keep
the town from going backwards.
But evening is drawing on, and our boat sails to-night.
So, refusing a horse or carriage, I walk down, not unwilling to be
a little early, that I may pace up and down the beach, looking off to the
islands and the points, and watching the roaring, tumbling billows. How
softening is the effect of time! It touches us through the affections. I
almost feel as if I were lamenting the passing away of something loved and
dear,—the boats, the Kanakas, the hides, my old shipmates! Death, change,
distance, lend them a character which makes them quite another thing
from the vulgar, wearisome toil of uninteresting, forced manual
labor.
The breeze freshened as we stood out to sea, and the wild
waves rolled over the red sun, on the broad horizon of the Pacific; but it
is summer, and in summer there can be no bad weather in California. Every day
is pleasant. Nature forbids a drop of rain to fall by day or night, or a wind
to excite itself beyond a fresh summer breeze.
The next morning we found ourselves at anchor in the Bay of
San Pedro. Here was this hated, this thoroughly detested spot. Although we
lay near, I could scarce recognize the hill up which we rolled and dragged
and pushed and carried our heavy loads, and down which we pitched the hides,
to carry them barefooted over the rocks to the floating long-boat. It was no
longer the landing-place. One had been made at the head of the creek,
and boats discharged and took off cargoes from a mole or wharf, in a quiet
place, safe from southeasters. A tug ran to take off passengers from the
steamer to the wharf,—for the trade of Los Angeles is sufficient to support
such a vessel. I got the captain to land me privately, in a small boat, at
the old place by the hill. I dismissed the boat, and, alone, found my way to
the high ground. I say found my way, for neglect and weather had left
but few traces of the steep road the hide-vessels had built to the top.
The cliff off which we used to throw the hides, and where I spent nights
watching them, was more easily found. The population was doubled, that is to
say, there were two houses, instead of one, on the hill. I stood on the brow
and looked out toward the offing, the Santa Catalina Island, and, nearer, the
melancholy Dead Man's Island, with its painful tradition, and recalled
the gloomy days that followed the flogging, and fancied the Pilgrim
at anchor in the offing. But the tug is going toward our steamer, and I
must awake and be off. I walked along the shore to the new landing-place,
where were two or three store-houses and other buildings, forming a small
depot; and a stage-coach, I found, went daily between this place and the
Pueblo. I got a seat on the top of the coach, to which were tackled six
little less than wild California horses. Each horse had a man at his head,
and when the driver had got his reins in hand he gave the word, all the
horses were let go at once, and away they went on a spring, tearing
over the ground, the driver only keeping them from going the wrong
way, for they had a wide, level pampa to run over the whole thirty miles
to the Pueblo. This plain is almost treeless, with no grass, at least none
now in the drought of midsummer, and is filled with squirrel-holes, and alive
with squirrels. As we changed horses twice, we did not slacken our speed
until we turned into the streets of the Pueblo.
The Pueblo de los Angeles I found a large and flourishing town
of about twenty thousand inhabitants, with brick sidewalks, and blocks of
stone or brick houses. The three principal traders when we were here for
hides in the Pilgrim and Alert are still among the chief traders of the
place,—Stearns, Temple, and Warner, the two former being reputed very rich.
I dined with Mr. Stearns, now a very old man, and met there Don Juan Bandini,
to whom I had given a good deal of notice in my book. From him, as indeed
from every one in this town, I met with the kindest attentions. The wife
of Don Juan, who was a beautiful young girl when we were on the coast, Doña
Refugio, daughter of Don Santiago Argüello, the commandante of San Diego, was
with him, and still handsome. This is one of several instances I have noticed
of the preserving quality of the California climate. Here, too, was Henry
Mellus, who came out with me before the mast in the Pilgrim, and left
the brig to be agent's clerk on shore. He had experienced varying fortunes
here, and was now married to a Mexican lady, and had a family. I dined with
him, and in the afternoon he drove me round to see the vineyards, the chief
objects in this region. The vintage of last year was estimated at half a
million of gallons. Every year new square miles of ground are laid down to
vineyards, and the Pueblo promises to be the centre of one of the
largest wine-producing regions in the world. Grapes are a drug here, and
I found a great abundance of figs, olives, peaches, pears, and melons. The
climate is well suited to these fruits, but is too hot and dry for successful
wheat crops.
Towards evening, we started off in the stage-coach, with again
our relays of six mad horses, and reached the creek before dark, though it
was late at night before we got on board the steamer, which was slowly moving
her wheels, under way for San Diego.
As we skirted along the coast, Wilson and I recognized, or
thought we did, in the clear moonlight, the rude white Mission of San
Juan Capistrano, and its cliff, from which I had swung down by a pair of
halyards to save a few hides,—a boy who could not be prudential, and who
caught at every chance for adventure.
As we made the high point off San Diego, Point Loma, we
were greeted by the cheering presence of a light-house. As we swept round
it in the early morning, there, before us, lay the little harbor of San
Diego, its low spit of sand, where the water runs so deep; the opposite
flats, where the Alert grounded in starting for home; the low hills, without
trees, and almost without brush; the quiet little beach;—but the chief
objects, the hide-houses, my eye looked for in vain. They were gone, all, and
left no mark behind.
I wished to be alone, so I let the other passengers go up to
the town, and was quietly pulled ashore in a boat, and left to myself. The
recollections and the emotions all were sad, and only sad.
Fugit, interea fugit irreparabile
tempus.
The past was real. The present, all about me, was
unreal, unnatural, repellant. I saw the big ships lying in the stream,
the Alert, the California, the Rosa, with her Italians; then the handsome
Ayacucho, my favorite; the poor dear old Pilgrim, the home of hardship and
hopelessness; the boats passing to and fro; the cries of the sailors at the
capstan or falls; the peopled beach; the large hide-houses, with their gangs
of men; and the Kanakas interspersed everywhere. All, all were gone! not a
vestige to mark where one hide-house stood. The oven, too, was gone.
I searched for its site, and found, where I thought it should be, a few
broken bricks and bits of mortar. I alone was left of all, and how strangely
was I here! What changes to me! Where were they all? Why should I care for
them,—poor Kanakas and sailors, the refuse of civilization, the outlaws and
beach-combers of the Pacific! Time and death seemed to transfigure them.
Doubtless nearly all were dead; but how had they died, and where? In
hospitals, in fever-climes, in dens of vice, or falling from the mast,
or dropping exhausted from the wreck,--
``When for a moment, like a drop of
rain, He sinks into thy depths with bubbling
groan, Without a grave, unknelled, uncoffined, and
unknown.''
The light-hearted boys are now hardened middle-aged men, if
the seas, rocks, fevers, and the deadlier enemies that beset a sailor's
life on shore have spared them; and the then strong men have bowed
themselves, and the earth or sea has covered them.
Even the animals are gone,—the colony of dogs, the broods
of poultry, the useful horses; but the coyotes bark still in the woods,
for they belong not to man, and are not touched by his changes.
I walked slowly up the hill, finding my way among the few
bushes, for the path was long grown over, and sat down where we used
to rest in carrying our burdens of wood, and to look out for vessels that
might, though so seldom, be coming down from the windward.
To rally myself by calling to mind my own better fortune
and nobler lot, and cherished surroundings at home, was impossible. Borne
down by depression, the day being yet at its noon, and the sun over the old
point,—it is four miles to the town, the Presidio,—I have walked it
often, and can do it once more,—I passed the familiar objects, and it
seemed to me that I remembered them better than those of any other place I
had ever been in;— the opening to the little cave; the low hills where we
cut wood and killed rattlesnakes, and where our dogs chased the
coyotes; and the black ground where so many of the ship's crew
and beach-combers used to bring up on their return at the end of a liberty
day, and spend the night sub Jove.
The little town of San Diego has undergone no change whatever
that I can see. It certainly has not grown. It is still, like
Santa Barbara, a Mexican town. The four principal houses of the gente
de razon—of the Bandinis, Estudillos, Argüellos, and Picos—are the
chief houses now; but all the gentlemen—and their families, too, I
believe—are gone. The big vulgar shop-keeper and trader, Fitch, is long
since dead; Tom Wrightington, who kept the rival pulpería, fell from his
horse when drunk, and was found nearly eaten up by coyotes; and I can scarce
find a person whom I remember. I went into a familiar one-story adobe house,
with its piazza and earthen floor, inhabited by a respectable
lower-class family by the name of Machado, and inquired if any of the
family remained, when a bright-eyed middle-aged woman recognized me,
for she had heard I was on board the steamer, and told me she had married
a shipmate of mine, Jack Stewart, who went out as second mate the next
voyage, but left the ship and married and settled here. She said he wished
very much to see me. In a few minutes he came in, and his sincere pleasure in
meeting me was extremely grateful. We talked over old times as long as I
could afford to. I was glad to hear that he was sober and doing well. Doña
Tomasa Pico I found and talked with. She was the only person of the
old upper class that remained on the spot, if I rightly recollect. I found
an American family here, with whom I dined,—Doyle and his wife, nice young
people, Doyle agent for the great line of coaches to run to the frontier of
the old States.
I must complete my acts of pious remembrance, so I take a
horse and make a run out to the old Mission, where Ben Stimson and I went
the first liberty day we had after we left Boston (ante, p. 140). All
has gone to decay. The buildings are unused and ruinous, and the
large gardens show now only wild cactuses, willows, and a few
olive-trees. A fast run brings me back in time to take leave of the few I
knew and who knew me, and to reach the steamer before she sails. A
last look—yes, last for life—to the beach, the hills, the low
point, the distant town, as we round Point Loma and the first beams of
the light-house strike out towards the setting sun.
Wednesday, August 24th. At anchor at San Pedro by daylight.
But instead of being roused out of the forecastle to row the
long-boat ashore and bring off a load of hides before breakfast, we
were served with breakfast in the cabin, and again took our drive with the
wild horses to the Pueblo and spent the day; seeing nearly the same persons
as before, and again getting back by dark. We steamed again for Santa
Barbara, where we only lay an hour, and passed through its canal and round
Point Conception, stopping at San Luis Obispo to land my friend, as I may
truly call him after this long passage together, Captain Wilson, whose most
earnest invitation to stop here and visit him at his rancho I was obliged to
decline.
Friday evening, 26th August, we entered the Golden Gate,
passed the light-houses and forts, and clipper ships at anchor, and
came to our dock, with this great city, on its high hills and
rising surfaces, brilliant before us, and full of eager life.
Making San Francisco my head-quarters, I paid visits to
various parts of the State,—down the Bay to Santa Clara, with its
live oaks and sycamores, and its Jesuit College for boys; and San
José, where is the best girls' school in the State, kept by the Sisters of
Notre Dame,—a town now famous for a year's session of ``The legislature of
a thousand drinks,''—and thence to the rich Almaden quicksilver mines,
returning on the Contra Costa side through the rich agricultural country,
with its ranchos and the vast grants of the Castro and Soto families, where
farming and fruit-raising are done on so large a scale. Another excursion
was up the San Joaquin to Stockton, a town of some ten
thousand inhabitants, a hundred miles from San Francisco, and crossing
the Tuolumne and Stanislaus and Merced, by the little Spanish town
of Hornitos, and Snelling's Tavern, at the ford of the Merced, where so
many fatal fights are had. Thence I went to Mariposa County, and Colonel
Fremont's mines, and made an interesting visit to ``the Colonel,'' as he is
called all over the country, and Mrs. Fremont, a heroine equal to either
fortune, the salons of Paris and the drawing-rooms of New York and
Washington, or the roughest life of the remote and wild mining regions of
Mariposa,—with their fine family of spirited, clever children. After a
rest there, we went on to Clark's Camp and the Big Trees, where I measured
one tree ninety-seven feet in circumference without its bark, and the bark is
usually eighteen inches thick; and rode through another which lay on the
ground, a shell, with all the insides out,—rode through it mounted, and
sitting at full height in the saddle; then to the wonderful Yo Semite
Valley,—itself a stupendous miracle of nature, with its Dome, its Capitan,
its walls of three thousand feet of perpendicular height,—but a valley
of streams, of waterfalls, from the torrent to the mere shimmer of a bridal
veil, only enough to reflect a rainbow, with their plunges of twenty-five
hundred feet, or their smaller falls of eight hundred, with nothing at the
base but thick mists, which form and trickle, and then run and at last plunge
into the blue Merced that flows through the centre of the valley. Back by
the Coulterville trail, the peaks of Sierra Nevada in sight, across the
North Fork of the Merced, by Gentry's Gulch, over hills and through cañons,
to Fremont's again, and thence to Stockton and San Francisco,—all this at
the end of August, when there has been no rain for four months, and the air
is clear and very hot, and the ground perfectly dry; windmills, to raise
water for artificial irrigation of small patches, seen all over the
landscape, while we travel through square miles of hot dust, where they tell
us, and truly, that in winter and early spring we should be up to
our knees in flowers; a country, too, where surface gold-digging is
so common and unnoticed that the large, six-horse stage-coach, in which I
travelled from Stockton to Hornitos, turned off in the high road for a
Chinaman, who, with his pan and washer, was working up a hole which an
American had abandoned, but where the minute and patient industry of the
Chinaman averaged a few dollars a day.
These visits were so full of interest, with grandeurs and
humors of all sorts, that I am strongly tempted to describe them. But
I remember that I am not to write a journal of a visit over the
new California, but to sketch briefly the contrasts with the old spots of
1835-6, and I forbear.
How strange and eventful has been the brief history of
this marvellous city, San Francisco! In 1835 there was one board shanty.
In 1836, one adobe house on the same spot. In 1847, a population of four
hundred and fifty persons, who organized a town government. Then came the
auri sacra fames, the flocking together of many of the worst spirits of
Christendom; a sudden birth of a city of canvas and boards, entirely
destroyed by fire five times in eighteen months, with a loss of sixteen
millions of dollars, and as often rebuilt, until it became a solid city of
brick and stone, of nearly one hundred thousand inhabitants, with all
the accompaniments of wealth and culture, and now (in 1859) the most quiet
and well-governed city of its size in the United States. But it has been
through its season of Heaven-defying crime, violence, and blood, from which
it was rescued and handed back to soberness, morality, and good government,
by that peculiar invention of Anglo-Saxon Republican America, the solemn,
awe-inspiring Vigilance Committee of the most grave and responsible
citizens, the last resort of the thinking and the good, taken to only
when vice, fraud, and ruffianism have intrenched themselves behind
the forms of law, suffrage, and ballot, and there is no hope but
in organized force, whose action must be instant and thorough, or
its state will be worse than before. A history of the passage of this city
through those ordeals, and through its almost incredible financial extremes,
should be written by a pen which not only accuracy shall govern, but
imagination shall inspire.
I cannot pause for the civility of referring to the many
kind attentions I received, and the society of educated men and women from
all parts of the Union I met with; where New England, the Carolinas,
Virginia, and the new West sat side by side with English, French, and German
civilization.
My stay in California was interrupted by an absence of nearly
four months, when I sailed for the Sandwich Islands in the noble
Boston clipper ship Mastiff, which was burned at sea to the water's
edge; we escaping in boats, and carried by a friendly British bark
into Honolulu, whence, after a deeply interesting visit of three months in
that most fascinating group of islands, with its natural and its moral
wonders, I returned to San Francisco in an American whaler, and found myself
again in my quarters on the morning of Sunday, December 11th,
1859.
My first visit after my return was to Sacramento, a city of
about forty thousand inhabitants, more than a hundred miles inland
from San Francisco, on the Sacramento, where was the capital of the State,
and where were fleets of river steamers, and a large inland commerce. Here I
saw the inauguration of a Governor, Mr. Latham, a young man from
Massachusetts, much my junior; and met a member of the State Senate, a man
who, as a carpenter, repaired my father's house at home some ten years
before; and two more Senators from southern California, relics of another
age,—Don Andres Pico, from San Diego; and Don Pablo de la Guerra, whom I
have mentioned as meeting at Santa Barbara. I had a good deal of
conversation with these gentlemen, who stood alone in an assembly of
Americans, who had conquered their country, spared pillars of the past.
Don Andres had fought us at San Pazqual and Sepulveda's rancho, in 1846,
and as he fought bravely, not a common thing among the Mexicans, and, indeed,
repulsed Kearney, is always treated with respect. He had the satisfaction,
dear to the proud Spanish heart, of making a speech before a Senate of
Americans, in favor of the retention in office of an officer of our army who
was wounded at San Pazqual, and whom some wretched caucus was going to
displace to carry out a political job. Don Andres's magnanimity
and indignation carried the day.
My last visit in this part of the country was to a new and
rich farming region, the Napa Valley, the United States Navy Yard at Mare
Island, the river gold workings, and the Geysers, and old Mr. John Yount's
rancho. On board the steamer, found Mr. Edward Stanley, formerly member of
Congress from North Carolina, who became my companion for the greater part of
my trip. I also met— a revival on the spot of an acquaintance of twenty
years ago—Don Guadalupe Vallejo; I may say acquaintance, for although I was
then before the mast, he knew my story, and, as he spoke English
well, used to hold many conversations with me, when in the boat or
on shore. He received me with true earnestness, and would not hear of my
passing his estate without visiting him. He reminded me of a remark I made to
him once, when pulling him ashore in the boat, when he was commandante at the
Presidio. I learned that the two Vallejos, Guadalupe and Salvador, owned, at
an early time, nearly all Napa and Sonoma, having princely estates. But they
have not much left. They were nearly ruined by their bargain with
the State, that they would put up the public buildings if the
Capital should be placed at Vallejo, then a town of some promise.
They spent $100,000, the Capital was moved there, and in two years removed
to San José on another contract. The town fell to pieces, and the houses,
chiefly wooden, were taken down and removed. I accepted the old gentleman's
invitation so far as to stop at Vallejo to breakfast.
The United States Navy Yard, at Mare Island, near Vallejo,
is large and well placed, with deep fresh water. The old Independence, and
the sloop Decatur, and two steamers were there, and they were experimenting
on building a despatch boat, the Saginaw, of California timber.
I have no excuse for attempting to describe my visit through
the fertile and beautiful Napa Valley, nor even, what exceeded that
in interest, my visit to old John Yount at his rancho, where I heard from
his own lips some of his most interesting stories of hunting and trapping and
Indian fighting, during an adventurous life of forty years of such work,
between our back settlements in Missouri and Arkansas, and the mountains of
California, trapping the Colorado and Gila,—and his celebrated dream,
thrice repeated, which led him to organize a party to go out over the
mountains, that did actually rescue from death by starvation the
wretched remnants of the Donner Party.
I must not pause for the dreary country of the Geysers,
the screaming escapes of steam, the sulphur, the boiling caldrons of black
and yellow and green, and the region of Gehenna, through which runs a quiet
stream of pure water; nor for the park scenery, and captivating ranchos of
the Napa Valley, where farming is done on so grand a scale,—where I have
seen a man plough a furrow by little red flags on sticks, to keep his range
by, until nearly out of sight, and where, the wits tell us, he returns the
next day on the back furrow; a region where, at Christmas time, I have
seen old strawberries still on the vines, by the side of vines in
full blossom for the next crop, and grapes in the same stages, and
open windows, and yet a grateful wood fire on the hearth in early morning;
nor for the titanic operations of hydraulic surface mining, where large
mountain streams are diverted from their ancient beds, and made to do the
work, beyond the reach of all other agents, of washing out valleys and
carrying away hills, and changing the whole surface of the country, to expose
the stores of gold hidden for centuries in the darkness of their earthy
depths.
January 10th, 1860. I am again in San Francisco, and my
revisit to California is closed. I have touched too lightly and rapidly
for much impression upon the reader on my last visit into the interior;
but, as I have said, in a mere continuation to a narrative of a sea-faring
life on the coast, I am only to carry the reader with me on a revisit to
those scenes in which the public has long manifested so gratifying an
interest. But it seemed to me that slight notices of these entirely new parts
of the country would not be out of place, for they serve to put in strong
contrast with the solitudes of 1835-6 the developed interior, with its mines,
and agricultural wealth, and rapidly filling population, and its large
cities, so far from the coast, with their education, religion, arts, and
trade.
On the morning of the 11th January, 1860, I passed, for the
eighth time, through the Golden Gate, on my way across the
delightful Pacific to the Oriental world, with its civilization
three thousand years older than that I was leaving behind. As the
shores of California faded in the distance, and the summits of the
Coast Range sank under the blue horizon, I bade farewell—yes, I do
not doubt, forever—to those scenes which, however changed or unchanged,
must always possess an ineffable interest for me.
---------
It is time my fellow-travellers and I should part company. But
I have been requested by a great many persons to give some account of the
subsequent history of the vessels and their crews, with which I had made them
acquainted. I attempt the following sketches in deference to these
suggestions, and not, I trust, with any undue estimate of the general
interest my narrative may have created.
Something less than a year after my return in the Alert, and
when, my eyes having recovered, I was again in college life, I found
one morning in the newspapers, among the arrivals of the day before, ``The
brig Pilgrim, Faucon, from San Diego, California.'' In a few hours I was down
in Ann Street, and on my way to Hackstadt's boarding-house, where I knew Tom
Harris and others would lodge. Entering the front room, I heard my name
called from amid a group of blue-jackets, and several sunburned, tar-colored
men came forward to speak to me. They were, at first, a little
embarrassed by the dress and style in which they had never seen me, and one
of them was calling me Mr. Dana; but I soon stopped that, and we
were shipmates once more. First, there was Tom Harris, in a characteristic
occupation. I had made him promise to come and see me when we parted in San
Diego; he had got a directory of Boston, found the street and number of my
father's house, and, by a study of the plan of the city, had laid out his
course, and was committing it to memory. He said he could go straight to the
house without asking a question. And so he could, for I took the book from
him, and he gave his course, naming each street and turn to right or left,
directly to the door.
Tom had been second mate of the Pilgrim, and had laid up no
mean sum of money. True to his resolution, he was going to England to find
his mother, and he entered into the comparative advantages of taking his
money home in gold or in bills,—a matter of some moment, as this was in the
disastrous financial year of 1837. He seemed to have his ideas well arranged,
but I took him to a leading banker, whose advice he followed; and, declining
my invitation to go up and show himself to my friends, he was off for New
York that afternoon, to sail the next day for Liverpool. The last I ever saw
of Tom Harris was as he passed down Tremont Street on the sidewalk, a man
dragging a hand-cart in the street by his side, on which were his voyage-worn
chest, his mattress, and a box of nautical instruments.
Sam seemed to have got funny again, and he and John the Swede
learned that Captain Thompson had several months before sailed in command
of a ship for the coast of Sumatra, and that their chance of
proceedings against him at law was hopeless. Sam was afterwards lost in a
brig off the coast of Brazil, when all hands went down. Of John and
the rest of the men I have never heard. The Marblehead boy, Sam,
turned out badly; and, although he had influential friends, never
allowed them to improve his condition. The old carpenter, the Fin, of
whom the cook stood in such awe (ante, p. 47), had fallen sick and died in
Santa Barbara, and was buried ashore. Jim Hall, from the Kennebec, who sailed
with us before the mast, and was made second mate in Foster's place, came
home chief mate of the Pilgrim. I have often seen him since. His lot has been
prosperous, as he well deserved it should be. He has commanded the largest
ships, and, when I last saw him, was going to the Pacific coast of South
America, to take charge of a line of mail steamers. Poor, luckless Foster I
have twice seen. He came into my rooms in Boston, after I had become a
barrister and my narrative had been published, and told me he was chief mate
of a big ship; that he had heard I had said some things unfavorable of
him in my book; that he had just bought it, and was going to read it
that night, and if I had said anything unfair of him, he would punish
me if he found me in State Street. I surveyed him from head to foot,
and said to him, ``Foster, you were not a formidable man when I last knew
you, and I don't believe you are now.'' Either he was of my opinion, or
thought I had spoken of him well enough, for the next (and last) time I met
him he was civil and pleasant.
I believe I omitted to state that Mr. Andrew B. Amerzene,
the chief mate of the Pilgrim, an estimable, kind, and trustworthy man,
had a difficulty with Captain Faucon, who thought him slack, was turned off
duty, and sent home with us in the Alert. Captain Thompson, instead of giving
him the place of a mate off duty, put him into the narrow between-decks,
where a space, not over four feet high, had been left out among the hides,
and there compelled him to live the whole wearisome voyage, through trades
and tropics, and round Cape Horn, with nothing to do,—not allowed
to converse or walk with the officers, and obliged to get his grub himself
from the galley, in the tin pot and kid of a common sailor. I used to talk
with him as much as I had opportunity to, but his lot was wretched, and in
every way wounding to his feelings. After our arrival, Captain Thompson was
obliged to make him compensation for this treatment. It happens that I have
never heard of him since.
Henry Mellus, who had been in a counting-house in Boston, and
left the forecastle, on the coast, to be agent's clerk, and whom I met, a
married man, at Los Angeles in 1859, died at that place a few years ago, not
having been successful in commercial life. Ben Stimson left the sea for the
fresh water and prairies, settled in Detroit as a merchant, and when I
visited that city, in 1863, I was rejoiced to find him a prosperous and
respected man, and the same generous-hearted shipmate as ever.
This ends the catalogue of the Pilgrim's original crew, except
her first master, Captain Thompson. He was not employed by the same firm
again, and got up a voyage to the coast of Sumatra for pepper. A cousin and
classmate of mine, Mr. Channing, went as supercargo, not having consulted me
as to the captain. First, Captain Thompson got into difficulties with another
American vessel on the coast, which charged him with having taken
some advantage of her in getting pepper; and then with the natives,
who accused him of having obtained too much pepper for his weights. The
natives seized him, one afternoon, as he landed in his boat, and demanded of
him to sign an order on the supercargo for the Spanish dollars that they said
were due them, on pain of being imprisoned on shore. He never failed in
pluck, and now ordered his boat aboard, leaving him ashore, the officer to
tell the supercargo to obey no direction except under his hand. For
several successive days and nights, his ship, the Alciope, lay in
the burning sun, with rain-squalls and thunder-clouds coming over the high
mountains, waiting for a word from him. Toward evening of the fourth or fifth
day he was seen on the beach, hailing for the boat. The natives, finding they
could not force more money from him, were afraid to hold him longer, and had
let him go. He sprang into the boat, urged her off with the utmost eagerness,
leaped on board the ship like a tiger, his eyes flashing and his face
full of blood, ordered the anchor aweigh, and the topsails set, the four
guns, two on a side, loaded with all sorts of devilish stuff, and wore her
round, and, keeping as close into the bamboo village as he could, gave them
both broadsides, slam-bang into the midst of the houses and people, and stood
out to sea! As his excitement passed off, headache, languor, fever, set in,—
the deadly coast-fever, contracted from the water and night-dews on shore
and his maddened temper. He ordered the ship to Penang, and never saw the
deck again. He died on the passage, and was buried at sea. Mr. Channing, who
took care of him in his sickness and delirium, caught the fever from him,
but, as we gratefully remember, did not die until the ship made port, and he
was under the kindly roof of a hospitable family in Penang. The chief mate,
also, took the fever, and the second mate and crew deserted; and, although
the chief mate recovered and took the ship to Europe and home, the voyage
was a melancholy disaster. In a tour I made round the world in 1859-1860, of
which my revisit to California was the beginning, I went to Penang. In that
fairy-like scene of sea and sky and shore, as beautiful as material earth can
be, with its fruits and flowers of a perpetual summer,—somewhere in which
still lurks the deadly fever,—I found the tomb of my kinsman, classmate,
and friend. Standing beside his grave, I tried not to think that his life
had been sacrificed to the faults and violence of another; I tried not to
think too hardly of that other, who at least had suffered in
death.
The dear old Pilgrim herself! She was sold, at the end of
this voyage, to a merchant in New Hampshire, who employed her on
short voyages, and, after a few years, I read of her total loss at sea, by
fire, off the coast of North Carolina.
Captain Faucon, who took out the Alert, and brought home
the Pilgrim, spent many years in command of vessels in the Indian
and Chinese seas, and was in our volunteer navy during the late
war, commanding several large vessels in succession, on the blockade
of the Carolinas, with the rank of lieutenant. He has now given up the
sea, but still keeps it under his eye, from the piazza of his house on the
most beautiful hill in the environs of Boston. I have the pleasure of meeting
him often. Once, in speaking of the Alert's crew, in a company of gentlemen,
I heard him say that that crew was exceptional; that he had passed all his
life at sea, but whether before the mast or abaft, whether officer or master,
he had never met such a crew, and never should expect to; and that the two
officers of the Alert, long ago shipmasters, agreed with him that, for
intelligence, knowledge of duty and willingness to perform it, pride in the
ship, her appearance and sailing, and in absolute reliableness, they never
had seen their equal. Especially he spoke of his favorite seaman, French
John. John, after a few more years at sea, became a boatman, and kept his
neat boat at the end of Granite Wharf, and was ready to take all, but
delighted to take any of us of the old Alert's crew, to sail down the
harbor. One day Captain Faucon went to the end of the wharf to board
a vessel in the stream, and hailed for John. There was no response, and
his boat was not there. He inquired, of a boatman near, where John was. The
time had come that comes to all! There was no loyal voice to respond to the
familiar call, the hatches had closed over him, his boat was sold to another,
and he had left not a trace behind. We could not find out even where he was
buried.
Mr. Richard Brown, of Marblehead, our chief mate in the
Alert, commanded many of our noblest ships in the European trade,
a general favorite. A few years ago, while stepping on board his ship from
the wharf, he fell from the plank into the hold and was killed. If he did not
actually die at sea, at least he died as a sailor,—he died on board
ship.
Our second mate, Evans, no one liked or cared for, and I
know nothing of him, except that I once saw him in court, on trial
for some alleged petty tyranny towards his men,—still a
subaltern officer.
The third mate, Mr. Hatch, a nephew of one of the owners,
though only a lad on board the ship, went out chief mate the next
voyage, and rose soon to command some of the finest clippers in
the California and India trade, under the new order of things,—a man of
character, good judgment, and no little cultivation.
Of the other men before the mast in the Alert, I know nothing
of peculiar interest. When visiting, with a party of ladies and gentlemen,
one of our largest line-of-battle ships, we were escorted about the decks by
a midshipman, who was explaining various matters on board, when one of the
party came to me and told me that there was an old sailor there with a
whistle round his neck, who looked at me and said of the officer, ``he can't
show him anything aboard a ship.'' I found him out, and, looking into his
sunburnt face, covered with hair, and his little eyes drawn up into the
smallest passages for light,—like a man who had peered into hundreds
of northeasters,—there was old ``Sails'' of the Alert, clothed in
all the honors of boatswain's-mate. We stood aside, out of the cun of
the officers, and had a good talk over old times. I remember the
contempt with which he turned on his heel to conceal his face, when
the midshipman (who was a grown youth) could not tell the ladies
the length of a fathom, and said it depended on
circumstances. Notwithstanding his advice and consolation to ``Chips,'' in
the steerage of the Alert, and his story of his runaway wife and
the flag-bottomed chairs (ante, p. 318), he confessed to me that he
had tried marriage again, and had a little tenement just outside the gate
of the yard.
Harry Bennett, the man who had the palsy, and was unfeelingly
left on shore when the Alert sailed, came home in the Pilgrim, and I had
the pleasure of helping to get him into the Massachusetts General Hospital.
When he had been there about a week, I went to see him in his ward, and asked
him how he got along. ``Oh! first-rate usage, sir; not a hand's turn to do,
and all your grub brought to you, sir.'' This is a sailor's paradise,—not a
hand's turn to do, and all your grub brought to you. But an
earthly paradise may pall. Bennett got tired of in-doors and
stillness, and was soon out again, and set up a stall, covered with
canvas, at the end of one of the bridges, where he could see all
the passers-by, and turn a penny by cakes and ale. The stall in
time disappeared, and I could learn nothing of his last end, if it
has come.
Of the lads who, beside myself, composed the gig's crew, I
know something of all but one. Our bright-eyed, quick-witted
little cockswain, from the Boston public schools, Harry May, or
Harry Bluff, as he was called, with all his songs and gibes, went the road
to ruin as fast as the usual means could carry him. Nat,
the ``bucket-maker,'' grave and sober, left the seas, and, I believe, is a
hack-driver in his native town, although I have not had the luck to see him
since the Alert hauled into her berth at the North End.
One cold winter evening, a pull at the bell, and a woman in
distress wished to see me. Her poor son George,—George Somerby,—
``you remember him, sir; he was a boy in the Alert; he always talks
of you,—he is dying in my poor house.'' I went with her, and in a small
room, with the most scanty furniture, upon a mattress on the floor,—
emaciated, ashy pale, with hollow voice and sunken eyes,— lay the boy
George, whom we took out a small, bright boy of fourteen from a Boston public
school, who fought himself into a position on board ship (ante, p. 295), and
whom we brought home a tall, athletic youth, that might have been the pride
and support of his widowed mother. There he lay, not over nineteen years of
age, ruined by every vice a sailor's life absorbs. He took my hand in his
wasted feeble fingers, and talked a little with his hollow, death-smitten
voice. I was to leave town the next day for a fortnight's absence, and
whom had they to see to them? The mother named her landlord,—she knew
no one else able to do much for them. It was the name of a physician of
wealth and high social position, well known in the city as the owner of many
small tenements, and of whom hard things had been said as to his strictness
in collecting what he thought his dues. Be that as it may, my memory
associates him only with ready and active beneficence. His name has since
been known the civilized world over, from his having been the victim of one
of the most painful tragedies in the records of the criminal law.[3] I tried
the experiment of calling upon him; and, having drawn him away from the
cheerful fire, sofa, and curtains of a luxurious parlor, I told him this
simple tale of woe, of one of his tenants, unknown to him even by name. He
did not hesitate; and I well remember how, in that biting, eager air, and at
a late hour, he drew his cloak about his thin and bent form, and walked off
with me across the Common, and to the South End, nearly two miles of an
exposed walk, to the scene of misery. He gave his full share, and more,
of kindness and material aid; and, as George's mother told me, on
my return, had with medical aid and stores, and a clergyman, made
the boy's end as comfortable and hopeful as possible.
The Alert made two more voyages to the coast of
California, successful, and without a mishap, as usual, and was sold
by Messrs. Bryant and Sturgis, in 1843, to Mr. Thomas W. Williams,
a merchant of New London, Connecticut, who employed her in the whale-trade
in the Pacific. She was as lucky and prosperous there as in the merchant
service. When I was at the Sandwich Islands in 1860, a man was introduced to
me as having commanded the Alert on two cruises, and his friends told me that
he was as proud of it as if he had commanded a frigate.
I am permitted to publish the following letter from the owner
of the Alert, giving her later record and her historic end,— captured and
burned by the rebel Alabama:--
New London, March 17, 1868.
Richard H. Dana, Esq.:
Dear Sir,—I am happy to acknowledge the receipt of your
favor of the 14th inst., and to answer your inquiries about the good
ship Alert. I bought her of Messrs. Bryant and Sturgis, in the year 1843,
for my firm of Williams and Haven, for a whaler, in which business she was
successful until captured by the rebel steamer Alabama, September, 1862,
making a period of more than nineteen years, during which she took and
delivered at New London upwards of twenty-five thousand barrels of whale and
sperm oil. She sailed last from this port, August 30, 1862, for Hurd's Island
(the newly discovered land south of Kerguelen's), commanded by Edwin
Church, and was captured and burned on the 9th of September
following, only ten days out, near or close to the Azores, with
thirty barrels of sperm oil on board, and while her boats were off
in pursuit of whales.
The Alert was a favorite ship with all owners, officers, and
men who had anything to do with her; and I may add almost all who heard
her name asked if that was the ship the man went in who wrote the book called
``Two Years before the Mast''; and thus we feel, with you, no doubt, a sort
of sympathy at her loss, and that, too, in such a manner, and by wicked acts
of our own countrymen.
My partner, Mr. Haven, sends me a note from the office this
P.M., saying that he had just found the last log-book, and would send
up this evening a copy of the last entry on it; and if there should be
anything of importance I will enclose it to you, and if you have any further
inquiries to put, I will, with great pleasure, endeavor to answer
them.
Remaining very respectfully and truly yours,
Thomas W. Williams.
P.S.—Since writing the above I have received the extract
from the log-book, and enclose the same.
The last Entry in the Log-Book of the
Alert.
``September 9, 1862.
``Shortly after the ship came to the wind, with the main
yard aback, we went alongside and were hoisted up, when we found we were
prisoners of war, and our ship a prize to the Confederate steamer Alabama. We
were then ordered to give up all nautical instruments and letters
appertaining to any of us. Afterwards we were offered the privilege, as they
called it, of joining the steamer or signing a parole of honor not to serve
in the army or navy of the United States. Thank God no one accepted the
former of these offers. We were all then ordered to get our things ready
in haste, to go on shore,—the ship running off shore all the time. We
were allowed four boats to go on shore in, and when we had got what things we
could take in them, were ordered to get into the boats and pull for the
shore,—the nearest land being about fourteen miles off,—which we reached
in safety, and, shortly after, saw the ship in flames.
``So end all our bright prospects, blasted by a gang
of miscreants, who certainly can have no regard for humanity so long as
they continue to foster their so-called peculiar institution, which is now
destroying our country.''
I love to think that our noble ship, with her long record of
good service and uniform success, attractive and beloved in her
life, should have passed, at her death, into the lofty regions
of international jurisprudence and debate, forming a part of the body of
the ``Alabama Claims'';—that, like a true ship, committed to her element
once for all at her launching, she perished at sea, and, without an extreme
use of language, we may say, a victim in the cause of her
country.
R.H.D., Jr.
Boston, May 6, 1869.
[1] Pronounced Leese.
[2] This journal was of 1859 before Colonel Robert E. Lee
became the celebrated General Lee in command of the Confederate forces in
the Civil War.
[3] [Dr. George Parkman.]
SEVENTY-SIX YEARS AFTER
By the Author's Son
In the preceding chapter, my father contrasted the solitary
bay of San Francisco in 1835, its one, or at most, two vessels and
one board hut on shore, with the city of San Francisco in 1859 of nearly
one hundred thousand inhabitants and a fleet of large clipper ships and sail
of all kind in the harbor, which he saw on his arrival in the steamer Golden
Gate bringing the ``fortnightly'' ``mails and passengers from the Atlantic
world.'' The contrast from 1859 to 1911 is hardly less striking.
San Francisco has now grown to over four hundred thousand inhabitants, has
twelve daily trains bringing mails and passengers from across the continent
and beyond, and steamers six to ten times the size of the Golden Gate. In
visiting San Pedro in 1859 he speaks of the landing at the head of a creek
where boats discharged and took off cargoes from a mole or wharf, and of how
``a tug ran to take off passengers from the steamer to the wharf, for the
trade of Los Angeles is sufficient to support such a vessel.'' From
this landing, a stage-coach went daily to Los Angeles, a town of
about twenty thousand inhabitants. Now there is a fine harbor at
which large steamers themselves can land at San Pedro and a
four-track electric road leading to Los Angeles, now a city of three
hundred thousand inhabitants. Trains on this road go at the rate of
sixty miles an hour. The picturesqueness, the Aladdin lamp character
of the change, would not perhaps be heightened, but certainly the contrast
is greater, if the days of 1835 be compared with 1911 instead of 1859, while
the startling growth from 1859 to the present makes one pause to ask what
will be the progress and the changes in the next fifty-two
years.
Of the fate of the vessels since my father wrote
``Twenty-four Years After,'' little has come to our knowledge. Of the
brig Pilgrim, he says, ``I read of her total loss at sea by fire off the
coast of North Carolina.'' On the records of the United States Custom House
at Boston is this epitaph, ``Brig Pilgrim, owner, R. Haley, surrender of
transfer 30 June 1856, broken up at Key West.'' Is it not romantic and
appropriate that this vessel, so associated with the then Mexican-Spanish
coast of California, should have left her bones on the coast of the once
Spanish colony of Florida?
A schoolmate of mine dwelling at Yokohama tells us of the fate
of the ship Lagoda. This is the vessel that Captain Thompson of
the Pilgrim came aboard and ``brought his brig with him'' (page 137),
and to which poor Foster fled (page 154), in fear of being flogged.
The Lagoda was under three hundred and forty tons, built at
Scituate, Mass., in 1826, of oak with ``bluff bows and square stern.''
Later she was sold to a New Bedford owner, converted into a bark
and turned into a whaler. In 1890, she came to Yokohama much damaged, was
officially surveyed and pronounced not worth repair, was sold at auction and
bought as a coal hulk for the Canadian Pacific Company's steamers at that
port, and in 1899 was sold to the Japanese, burned and broken up at Kanagawa.
The fate of these vessels, with that of the Alert burned at sea by the
Alabama, illustrates how vessels, as Ernest Thompson Seton says of
wild animals, seldom fail to have a hard, if not a tragic,
ending.
It may be interesting to state that the Ayacucho
(pronounced I-ah-coo-tsho) was named after the battle fought December 9,
1824, in Peru, South America, in which the Spaniards were defeated by the
armies of Columbia and Peru, which battle ended the Spanish rule in America.
What became of her after she was sold to the Chilian government as a vessel
of war, we do not know.
The Loriotte, we learn, was built at Plymouth, Mass., in 1828,
was ninety-two tons, originally a schooner and later changed into
an hermaphrodite brig. Gorham H. Nye, her captain and part owner, was born
in Nantucket, Mass.
As to persons, there is little to add about Captain
Thompson. Captain Faucon gave it as his opinion that Thompson was not a
good navigator and that Thompson knew his sailors knew it, and to
this cause he attributed in some measure Thompson's hard treatment of the
men. His navigation of the Alert some twelve or fifteen hundred miles
westward of the usual course around Cape Horn on the return passage was an
instance. It was much criticised by his sailors and officers. It not only
greatly lengthened the total distance but brought the vessel into currents
that were more antarctic and more frequented with ice than those currents
nearer the southwest coast of South America, usually taken advantage of on
the trip west to east. In 1880, on my visit to the scenes of ``Two Years
Before the Mast,'' I met a nephew of Captain Thompson at Santa Barbara. He
was then the proprietor of the hotel at which I stayed. He invited me to walk
with him Sunday afternoon. When we started out together I noticed he had a
large, thick cane, while I had none. Could it be he was to wreak vengeance on
the son of the man who had exposed his uncle? I was strong and athletic after
a year as stroke of the Freshman crew and three years as stroke of the
University crew at Harvard. I kept my weather eye open and took care to be a
little behind rather than ahead of my companion. At last he began on my
father's story, ``Two Years Before the Mast,'' and his uncle. Now it is
coming, thought I, but to my surprise and relief he detailed a family trouble
in which the uncle had tried to get into his own possession land which
belonged in part to his brothers and of which he, the captain, had
been placed in charge, and my friend, for so I could then think of
him, wound up with saying my father had done his uncle perfect
justice. The year of Captain Thompson's death was 1837.
The chief mate of the Pilgrim on her outward voyage, Mr.
Andrew B. Amerzeen, was born at Epsom, N.H., June 7, 1806. After
returning in the Alert in 1836, as described by my father, his
mother prevailed on him to give up long voyages, owing to the fact
that his father, a ship owner and master, had been lost at sea with
his ship a year or two before. Mr. Amerzeen then made several
short voyages to the West Indies and in the fall of 1838 his ship
was dismasted in a storm somewhere below Cape Hatteras. He was ill with
yellow fever and confined to his stateroom at the time. The ship was worked
into one of the southern ports, Savannah I am told, and there Mr. Amerzeen
died September 27, 1838, from this fever.
``Jim Hall,'' the sailor who was made second mate of the
Pilgrim in Foster's place, after several years' successful career
as Captain and Manager of the Pacific Steamship Navigation Company on the
west coast of South America with the title of Commodore, returned to this
country, having saved a competence, and settled at East Braintree,
Massachusetts. He called on me at my office some ten years after my father's
death. He was six feet tall, a handsome man of striking appearance, with blue
eyes, nearly white hair, a ruddy countenance, and a very straight figure for
one of nearly eighty years of age. He was born at Pittston, Maine, July 4,
1813. He is said to have commanded twenty-seven different vessels, steam and
sail, and never to have had an accident, ``never cost the underwriters a
dollar.'' He died April 22, 1904. His wife (Mary Ann Kimball of Hookset,
N.H.) survived him.
Of George P. Marsh, the new hand shipped at San Pedro October
22, 1835, the Englishman with a strange career, we have heard in a letter
from Mr. Samuel C. Clarke of Chicago, passenger with Captain Low on the ship
Cabot when she took Marsh from the Pelew Islands. Mr. Clarke kept a journal
at the time, which confirms in almost every detail the story as told by
Marsh, with one or two very minor exceptions but one important difference. He
told them when first rescued that he was ``a native of Providence,
Rhode Island'' in America, while to his shipmates in California he always
said he was a native of England and brought up on a smuggler. By a letter
from his nephew, Edward W. Boyd, we learn that his real name was George
Walker Marsh, that he was the eldest son of a retired English army officer
and his wife, and was born in St. Malo, France, hence his knowledge of the
French language. He went to sea against their will but communicated with
them several times afterwards. After he left to join the Ayacucho
in Chili, all trace of him was lost at Valparaiso.
Captain Edward Horatio Faucon, who took out the Alert and
brought back the Pilgrim, continued, after my father's last chapter,
to live at Milton Hill where he still kept ``the sea under his eye from
the piazza of his house.'' He was occasionally employed by Boston marine
underwriters on salvage cases, going to many places, from St. Thomas, W.I.,
and the Bermudas, to Nova Scotia in the north. He was a constant reader,
chiefly interested in history, political economy and sociology. He made
visits, annually or oftener, on my mother until his death on May 22, 1894. We
all remember his keen eye, erect figure, quiet reserve, and
old-time courtesy of manner, and his personal interest in those who
come and go in ships, and more particularly in those of the Alert,
his favorite ship. He was born in Boston, November 21, 1806. His father,
Nicolas Michael Faucon, was a Frenchman of Rouen, who fought in the
Napoleonic wars with distinction as Captain of the Second Regiment of the
Hussars, and came to this country, where he married Miss Catherine Waters at
Trinity Church, Boston. He was instructor in French at Harvard, 1806-1816.
Our Captain Faucon left a widow and daughter, and a promising son, Gorham
Palfrey Faucon, a Harvard graduate, a well-trained civil engineer in
the employ of large railroads, and, like his father, interested
in literature and public problems. He died in 1897, in the early prime of
life.
The third mate, James Byers Hatch, whom Captain Faucon in a
letter to us called ``one of the best of men,'' continued to command large
sailing vessels on deep sea voyages with some mishaps and narrow escapes.
While in California on one of these voyages he found James Hall on board
another ship at the same wharf, and in a letter to Captain Faucon written
June, 1893, says, ``I persuaded him to take the first officer's berth, and
what an officer he was!! Everything went on like clockwork. I do not think I
ever found the least fault with him during the whole time he was
with me.'' Captain Hatch lost his only son, a lad of seven, on a voyage to
Calcutta. ``The boy,'' said he, ``fell from the top of the house on the poop
deck and died in about a week.'' His wife and married daughter both died in
1881. He himself settled in Springfield, Mass., his birthplace, and lost
almost all he had saved in some unsuccessful business venture in that city,
and lived a rather lonely and sad life. In the above letter he said, ``I
am now ready and anxious to leave this earth and take my chance in the
next.'' He died at Springfield soon after 1894.
Benjamin Godfrey Stimson, the young sailor about my father's
age, was born in Dedham, Mass., March 19, 1816. It came naturally to him
to go to sea, for his great-uncle Benjamin Stimson commanded the colonial
despatch vessel under Pepperell, in the siege of Louisburg. After settling in
Detroit in 1837, he married a Canadian lady (Miss Ives), owned many lake
vessels, including the H. P. Baldwin, the largest bark of her day on the
great lakes, and was Controller of that city from 1868 to 1870, during which
time the city hall was built by him at less than estimated cost. He died
December 13, 1871, leaving a widow and two sons, Edward I. and Arthur K.
Stimson. The agent Alfred Robinson died in 1895.
Jack Stewart I met in San Diego on my visit there in 1881, as
I have stated in the Introduction. He was quite a character in the ``old''
town and made a good deal of his being one of the crew of the Alert. He died
January 2, 1892, leaving children and grandchildren. Henry Mellus, who went
out before the mast and left the Pilgrim to be agent's clerk ashore, and whom
my father met at Los Angeles in 1859, was made mayor of that city the very
next year.
Last, but not least, from the point of view of friendship, was
my father's ``dear Kanaka'' (Hope), whose life my father saved (by getting
ship's medicines from the mate, after Captain Thompson had refused to give
them), and for whom he had so much real affection. The last mention we have
of Hope is found in my father's journal under date of May 24,
1842.
``Horatio E. Hale called. Been away four years as Philologist
to the Exploring Expedition. Was in San Francisco three months ago and saw
the Alert there collecting hides. Also saw `Hope' the Kanaka mentioned in my
`Two Years.' Hope desired his Aikane to me— Remembered me well. Hale said
his face lighted up as soon as my name was mentioned to him.''
As to all the rest of the officers and crews, they have
doubtless all handed in their last account and taken passage across
the Unknown Sea to the other world.
Of the ``fascinating'' Doña Angustias dela Guerra, whose
graceful dancing with Don Juan Bandini in Santa Barbara during the
ceremonies attending the marriage of her sister, Doña Anita with Mr.
Robinson, the Agent, in January, 1836, my father describes (pages
300-305), something more is to be said.
On my visit to Santa Barbara in 1880, I had the privilege
of seeing her. I was much impressed with her graceful carriage, her face
still handsome, though she was then sixty-five years of age, with her
dignity, calm self-possession, and above all with her true gentility of
manner and evidently high character and purpose, together with a delightful
humor, which shone in her eyes. General Sherman, in a letter as late as 1888,
says of her, she ``was the finest woman it has been my good fortune to
know,'' and Bayard Taylor in El Dorado (Putnam's edition of 1884, page 141)
writes, ``she is a woman whose nobility of character, native vigor
and activity of intellect, and above all, whose instinctive refinement,''
etc.
In 1847, when our officers took possession of California, she,
a Mexican, of the first Mexican family of California, took care of the
first United States officer who died in Monterey, Lieutenant Colville J.
Minor, an enemy to her country, for which service she received a letter of
thanks from the First Military Governor, dated August 21, 1848.
She died January 21, 1890, at the age of seventy-five. The
name of her first husband was Don Manuel Jimeno and of her second Dr.
Ord. Caroline Jimeno was the daughter ``as beautiful as her mother'' that
Mr. Dana met in 1859, then a young lady of seventeen. Her daughter by the
second marriage, Rebecca R. Ord, an ``infant in arms'' when my father saw her
in 1859, married Lieutenant John H. H. Peshine of the United States Army, who
in 1893 was made First Military Attaché to the Court of Madrid.
The dela Guerra family of California, I am told, is dying out
in the male line and will soon leave no representative.
As to Richard Henry Dana, Jr., the author of the book, the
reader may wish to know something. He came back from his two years'
trip in 1836 ``in a state of intellectual famine, to books and study and
intercourse with educated men.'' He had left his class at Harvard at the end
of the sophomore year (1833), on account of the trouble with his eyes and
sailed about a year later. When he returned, September, 1836, his class had
graduated in the summer of 1835, but with a little study he passed the
examinations for the then senior class, which he entered late in the autumn
of 1836. On graduation in 1837 he not only stood first, but ``had
the highest marks that were given out in every branch of study.'' He took
the Bowdoin prize for English prose composition and the first Boylston prize
in elocution. He then entered the Law School and became instructor in
elocution under Professor Edward T. Channing, and during this period wrote
the ``Two Years Before the Mast.'' In February, 1840, he went into the office
of Charles G. Loring and in the following September opened his own office and
began the active practice of law. He was born August 1, 1815, at
Cambridge, Mass., with a line of ancestors reaching back to the early days
of the Massachusetts Bay Colony, with several colonial governors in the
maternal lines. His great grandfather, Richard Dana, was one of the early
patriots, a ``Son of Liberty,'' who frequently presided at the meetings at
Faneuil Hall at which Otis, Adams and others spoke. This man's son, my
father's grandfather, Francis Dana, was several times member of the State
Colonial Legislature and of the Continental Congress. He was one of the
signers of the Articles of Confederation and married Elizabeth Ellery,
the daughter of William Ellery, one of the signers of the Declaration of
Independence. Francis Dana had been sent abroad on a special mission to
England in 1774 before the breaking out of the Revolutionary War, to sound
English public opinion, for which he had unusual advantages. He returned in
the late spring of 1776 advising independence, and soon after this the
Declaration of Independence was signed. Francis Dana was also appointed on
a special mission to Paris and Holland with John Adams, later was made
Minister to Russia, and after the peace with Great Britain was made Chief
Justice of Massachusetts. Mr. Dana's own father, Richard Henry Dana, Senior,
was a poet and literary critic and a founder of the ``North American
Review.'' Young Richard was brought up in very moderate circumstances. His
grandfather, who had accumulated a good deal of property, lost the larger
part of it through unfortunate investments in canals by a relation,
in which he had himself become more deeply involved than he supposed. I
remember my father's saying that his spending money for one whole term
consisted of twenty-five cents, which he carried in his pocket in cases of
emergencies. He walked to and from Boston to save omnibus fares, had no
carpet on his college room and had no chore-man to black his boots and fetch
his water and fuel. This, however, was the usual custom in his day with all
but the rich collegian. The necessities of life did not then demand so high
a rate of ``living wage'' as to-day.
He entered on this sea experience with his eyes open. He had
the opportunity of going on a long voyage as a passenger, but he refused
it, and resolutely took the harder way of accomplishing his purpose of
toughening himself. A little incident of his boyhood gives a hint of his
pluck. His schoolmaster, angry at what he chose to call ``disobedience'' on
the excuse of a ``pretended'' illness, told the boy to put out his left hand.
``Upon this hand,'' wrote Dana years afterward, ``he inflicted six blows
with all his strength, and then six upon the right hand. I was in such a
frenzy of indignation at his injustice and his insulting insinuation, that I
could not have uttered a word for my life. I was too small and slender to
resist, and could show my spirit only by fortitude. He called for my right
hand again, and gave six more blows in the same manner, and then six more
upon the left. My hands were swollen and in acute pain, but I did not flinch
nor show a sign of suffering. He was determined to conquer, and gave six
more blows upon each hand, with full force. Still there was no sign from me
of pain or submission. I could have gone to the stake for what I considered
my honor. The school was in an uproar of hissing and scraping and groaning,
and the master turned his attention to the other boys and let me alone. He
said not another word to me through the day. If he had I could not have
answered, for my whole soul was in my throat and not a word could get out.
. . . I went in the afternoon to the trustees of the school, stated my
case, produced my evidence, and had an examination made. The next morning but
four boys went to school, and the day following the career of Mr. W.
ended.''
That Dana had a keen sense of injustice not merely when he
himself was concerned, but whenever he was brought face to face
with injustice, the reader of this book has discovered for himself,
and that a high sense of honor and right was a controlling passion of his
life will appear when one knows his career after he returned from his long
voyage. It rendered his attitude toward his profession, that of a lawyer,
very different from that of a man merely seeking a livelihood.
Beside his work for the sailors to which I refer later there
was another class of peculiarly helpless sufferers to make even stronger
demand upon his sense of justice. By his social relations and by his strong
antipathy to violence of every kind, Dana would naturally have found his
place amongst the men who in politics prefer orderly and regular and
especially respectable associations. He came into active life when a small
band of earnest men and women were agitating for the abolition of
slavery. Some among them were also attacking the church, and proposing
all sorts of changes in society. But Dana was a man of strong religious
principles and feelings, and he had little faith in any violent change in the
social order. His diaries and letters of the period show that he was annoyed
by the temper of the Abolitionists. They were not his kind. Nevertheless he
was not a man to steer between two parties. In a great moral crisis he
was sure to take sides. He took sides now and came out as a member of the
Free Soil party. He made a distinction, which was a clear one, between the
Free Soil party and the uncompromising Abolitionists. But in the rising heat
of political feeling, other people did not make a like distinction, and Dana,
a young lawyer, married now, and with a family growing up about him, found
himself put out into the cold by the well-to-do, the successful, and the
respectable.
Dana had a keen scent for politics, and he looked with
the strongest interest upon the great political movement which
was stirring the country; but he did not espouse the cause of free soil
because he expected to profit by it politically. On the contrary, he knew
that he was shutting himself out from political preferment by such a course,
and at the same time was imperilling his professional success. It was the act
of a man who stood up for the cause of righteousness, without counting the
cost. In like manner he now had the opportunity of illustrating afresh
his attitude toward the law, for he held that law was for
the accomplishment of justice, and that it was most glorious when
its strong arm protected and defended the weak and downtrodden. By
a natural course, therefore, he became a prominent counsel for
those unfortunate negroes who, at this time, in Boston, were held
as fugitive slaves. While the ingenuity of some was expended in putting
the law on the side of the strong and the rich, Dana, who was convinced in
his mind that the law of the state was honestly to be invoked in defence of
the fugitive slave, gave himself heart and soul to the work of applying the
law, and received no remuneration for his services in any fugitive slave
case. Instead, he received at the close of one of the most important cases,
a blow from a blackguard which narrowly missed maiming him for life. It is
worth while to read what Dana wrote after rendering all the aid he could in
the defence of Anthony Burns: ``The labors of a lawyer are ordinarily devoted
to questions of property between man and man. He is to be congratulated if,
though but for once, in any signal cause he can devote them to the
vindication of any of the great primal rights affecting the highest interests
of man.'' He was a member of the noted Free Soil Convention at Buffalo of
1848, and presided at the first meeting of the Republican party
in Massachusetts.
It may be a source of wonder to some that Dana, who achieved
a great literary success in the book which he wrote when a young man, did
not pursue literature as an avocation, if not as a vocation. He published but
one other book, a narrative of a trip to Cuba made in 1859, and he wrote a
few magazine articles. The explanation must be found in the temperament and
character of the man. His Two Years Before the Mast is a vivid
representation of what he saw and experienced at a most impressionable age.
He put his young life into it; he was not thinking of literature when he
wrote it, and thus the book takes rank with those books which are bits of
life rather than products of art. Afterward he was immersed in his law
practice, and he was a prodigious worker. He saw with great clearness the
points in the cases he took up, and he was untiring in his industry to cover
the whole case. He did all the work himself; he did not lay the details on
others, and avail himself of their diligence. His time, moreover, as we
have shown, was very much at the disposal of those who could pay
him little or nothing for his services, and he gave months of labor to the
unremunerative defence of the fugitive slave. Moreover, his deep religious
conviction and his high sense of legal honor often stood in the way of his
profit. So it was that his life was one of hard work and little more than
support of his family. There was scant time for any wandering into fields of
literature.
Yet he left behind him some other writings which show well
that the hand which penned the ``Two Years'' never lost its cunning.
He made an interesting visit to Europe, and, later in life, in 1859-60,
made a journey round the world. The record which he kept on these journeys
has been drawn upon largely in the biography prepared by Charles Francis
Adams, who was in his early days a student in Dana's office, and there one
finds page after page of delightfully animated description and narrative. He
wrote for his own pleasure and for that of his family, and his writing was
like brilliant talk, the outflow of a generous mind not easily saved for
more common use. He published notes to Wheaton's ``International Law,''
several of which are quoted in all new works on the subject to this
day.
The journey which he took round the world was for the purpose
of restoring his health, which had been greatly impaired. He came back in
improved condition, and entered upon the excited period of the war, when he
held the office of United States District Attorney. During this time he
argued the famous prize causes before the United States Supreme Court, and
his argument was the one that turned the Court, which was democratic in its
politics, to take the unanimous view that the United States Government had
a right to establish blockade and take prizes of foreign vessels that were
breaking this blockade. Had it not been for this decision, so largely
influenced, as the Court itself generously states, by Mr. Dana's argument,
the Civil War would have been greatly prolonged, with possibly another, or at
least a doubtful issue. He afterward served in the Massachusetts legislature,
and there made several noted speeches, among others his argument on the
repeal of the usury laws, a bill for which was unexpectedly carried in that
body as the result of this speech which has been reprinted for use before
legislatures of other states.
He accepted a nomination to Congress, chiefly as a protest
against the nomination of B. F. Butler, who was running on a paper
money and repudiation platform against the principles of his own
party, but Mr. Dana was defeated. In 1876 he was nominated by
President Grant minister to England, but his nomination was not confirmed
by the Senate, for his nomination had been made without consulting the
Senatorial cabal and also he had bitter enemies, who carried on a warfare
against him upon terms which he was too honorable to accept.
A selection of Mr. Dana's speeches, the most
interesting historically or those of most present value, have been
published, together with a biographical sketch, Supplementing the
Life written by Charles Francis Adams.
Two years later, broken now in health, but with his mind
vigorous, he resolved to give up the practice of law and devote himself
to writing a work on international law. For this purpose, and as a measure
of economy, he went to Europe, and for two years applied himself diligently
to his plan for a book which he believed would give some fundamentally new
views on international law. He had made many notes and had begun to write the
first few chapters when he died, after a short illness, from pneumonia, in
Rome, January 6, 1882. He was buried in the beautiful Protestant cemetery
of that city.
His wife, who was Sarah Watson of Hartford, Conn., survived
him, and he left five daughters and a son. There are now nine of
his grandchildren living (four of them Dana grandsons), and also
four great-grandchildren.
Finally, what did Mr. Dana accomplish for sailors? In the
preface to the first edition (1840) he said, ``If it shall . . . call
more attention to the welfare of seamen, or give any information as
to their real condition which may serve to raise them in the rank
of beings, and to promote in any measure their religious and
moral improvement, and diminish the hardships of their daily life, the end
of its publication will be answered.'' And after the flogging at San Pedro,
there was his vow (page 1252), ``that, if God should ever give me the means,
I would do something to redress the grievances and relieve the sufferings of
that class of beings with whom my lot had so long been cast.'' For redressing
individual grievances he took the part of the sailor in many a lawsuit
where his remuneration was often next to nothing, and by which action
he incurred the ill will of possible future rich and influential clients.
In his journal December 14, 1847, he says, ``I often have a good deal to
contend with in the slurs or open opposition of masters and owners of vessels
whose seamen I undertake to defend or look after,'' though he adds there were
honorable exceptions. These cases he fought hard and bravely, and into them
he put his whole mind, heart and soul. He could not have done better in them
if he had been paid the highest fees known to the Bar. He settled as
many of these cases out of court as he could. He believed any
reasonable settlement better for the sailor than a legal contest, though
his own fees would be less. Beside taking the part of the
individual seamen, he published the ``Seamen's Friend,'' a book giving the
full legal rights of sailors as well as their duties, a set of
definitions of sea terms, which to this day is quoted in all the
dictionaries, and much information for the use of beginners. He drew up a
petition and prepared an accompanying leaflet addressed to Congress
for ``The More Speedy Trial of Seamen.'' He wrote numerous articles for
the press and delivered many addresses on behalf of seamen, or for
institutions for their benefit such as ``Father'' Taylor's Bethel and for a
more cordial reception of sailors in the church. He wrote the introduction of
Leech's ``A Voice from the Main Deck,'' but above all it was the indirect
influence of his ``Two Years Before the Mast'' which did the most to relieve
their hardships.
While on a trip in Europe in 1875-76, I spent some weeks in
London and visited Parliament frequently to study the proceedings and
see and hear its leading men. By a strange coincidence at my very first
visit, made at the invitation of the late Sir William Vernon Harcourt, after
I had sent in my card and was ushered into the inner lobby, I saw a man,
evidently a member, rushing out into this lobby, and, to quote from my
journal written at the time, ``in a wild state of excitement, throwing about
his arms and shaking his fists, with short ejaculations such as `I'll
expose the villains, all of them,' and I heard the words `Cheats!' and
I think `Liars!''' This was a strange introduction to the then decorous
British House of Commons, for this was before the active days of Parnell. I
saw poor, blind Henry Fawcett and others trying to calm the man. The lobby
was immediately cleared of strangers, so I saw no more just then, but I was
later admitted into the House and learned that this man was the famous
Plimsoll (1824-1898). He had become enraged because his Merchants'
Shipping Bill had just been thrown out by Disraeli, then Prime Minister,
on this day of the so-called ``Slaughter of the Innocents,'' that is, the
day when the Government abandoned all bills which they were not to carry out
that session. Justin McCarthy, in his History of Our
Own Times (Vol. IV, page 24, et seq.), gives a full account of this
scene. Plimsoll's Bill was a measure for the protection of seamen against the
danger of being sent to sea in vessels unfit for the voyage. To understand
the whole situation of the sailor in civilized countries, one must know that
the only way allowed by law or custom for him to get employment is to
sign articles sometimes without even knowing the name of the vessel, and
almost always without an opportunity to examine or even see her. Once having
signed these papers, sailors are by law compelled to keep their contracts and
can be imprisoned and sent aboard if they try to escape. Every other person
in every other kind of employment, since the abolition of slavery, signing
similar papers has a right to refuse to carry out his agreement, with no
other penalty than a suit for damages. He cannot be forced to carry
out the contract in person. If this were not so, there would be a sort of
contract peonage or slavery endorsed by the law. It is otherwise, however,
with the sailors. The United States Supreme Court in the case of Robertson v.
Baldwin (165 U.S. 275, 1896) decided, Judge Harlan dissenting, that
notwithstanding the thirteenth amendment to the Constitution which, it was
supposed, had prohibited involuntary servitude except as punishment
for crime, sailors could be forced on board of vessels, and the facts that
the vessel was unfit for living, the food bad, and the master brutal were no
defences. The headnote of the case says, ``The contract of a sailor has
always been treated as an exceptional one involving to a certain extent the
surrender of his personal liberty during the life of his contract.'' Mr.
Plimsoll was rightly convinced that unseaworthy vessels left port for the
sake of insurance money on valued policies, that the lives of the seamen
were thereby imperilled, and that the poor sailor had no redress before the
law. The bill that had just been thrown out by Disraeli provided that if
one-quarter of the seamen appealed on the ground of unseaworthiness a survey
would be ordered, the vessel detained till the survey was made, and if she
were unseaworthy or improperly provisioned the sailors would be relieved
from their contract unless those defects were cured. It also had other minor
provisions for the benefit of the sailors. In Parliament that night, it was
thought that Plimsoll's wild conduct had destroyed his reputation as a sane
man and had ruined the chances of ever passing his bill, but outside of
Parliament the effect was just the reverse. The public was aroused to a
full understanding of the essential merits of his bill and the government
was forced to put it on the calendar and carry it through that session in its
substantial features, and the following year (1876) a more complete and
perfected act covering the same points was passed.
In the United States, a most interesting character,
Andrew Furuseth, a Norwegian, himself a sailor, and without much education
but a man of wonderful force, has succeeded, largely by the aid of labor
unions, in forcing through Congress bills by which no American seaman can any
longer be forced against his will into this servitude nor any foreign seaman
on domestic voyages. Another evil tending to degrade and enslave the sailor
was the allowance made by law of three months' advance wages on
beginning a voyage. This apparently harmless and, to the credulous
and inexperienced legislator, beneficial provision gave a chance to the
sailors' boarding-house keeper and runner, or ``crimp,'' as he or she is
called, to ``shanghai'' seamen and put them aboard drunk or drugged, with
little or no clothing but what they had on their backs and rob them of this
advance money. The ``crimps''' share of this money in San Francisco alone has
been calculated at one million dollars a year, or equal to eighty per cent of
the seamen's entire wages. Part of this had to be shared with
corrupt police and politicians and some of it has been traced to
sources ``higher up.'' So common was this practice that vessels
sailing from San Francisco and New York had so few sober sailors
aboard, that it was customary to take longshoremen to set sail,
heave anchor and get the ship under way, and then send them back by
tug. This is precisely what happened on the well-equipped and new ship on
which I sailed from New York in 1879 for California, and the same situation
is described by Captain Arthur H. Clark in his account of seamen in his
Clipper Ship Era. These poor sailors, without proper clothing, had to
draw on the ship's ``slop chest'' for necessary oilskins, thick jackets,
mittens and the like, and used up almost all the rest of their wages. The
small balance was wasted or stolen, or both, at the port of arrival, and off
they were shipped again by the ``crimp'' with no chance to save or improve
their condition. After years of agitation by the friends of sailors the
advance pay is now wholly abolished in the coastwise trade in America and the
three months' advance cut down to one in the foreign trade, immensely to the
benefit of the sailor and the discouragement of the ``crimp.'' The argument
that without this system of bondage and ``crimpage'' it would
be impossible to secure crews is fully answered by the experience of Great
Britain since the passage of the Plimsoll Acts and in the United States since
the recent acts of Congress. On the contrary, these measures tend to secure a
better class of sailors and compel improvement of the conditions under which
they do their work. I was told when in England that Plimsoll, who himself was
not a sailor, was influenced among other things by my father's book Two
Years Before the Mast.''